Anda di halaman 1dari 209

THESE TERMS GOVERN YOUR USE OF THIS DOCUMENT

Your use of this Ontario Geological Survey document (the “Content”) is governed by the
terms set out on this page (“Terms of Use”). By downloading this Content, you (the
“User”) have accepted, and have agreed to be bound by, the Terms of Use.

Content: This Content is offered by the Province of Ontario’s Ministry of Northern Development and
Mines (MNDM) as a public service, on an “as-is” basis. Recommendations and statements of opinion
expressed in the Content are those of the author or authors and are not to be construed as statement of
government policy. You are solely responsible for your use of the Content. You should not rely on the
Content for legal advice nor as authoritative in your particular circumstances. Users should verify the
accuracy and applicability of any Content before acting on it. MNDM does not guarantee, or make any
warranty express or implied, that the Content is current, accurate, complete or reliable. MNDM is not
responsible for any damage however caused, which results, directly or indirectly, from your use of the
Content. MNDM assumes no legal liability or responsibility for the Content whatsoever.

Links to Other Web Sites: This Content may contain links, to Web sites that are not operated by MNDM.
Linked Web sites may not be available in French. MNDM neither endorses nor assumes any
responsibility for the safety, accuracy or availability of linked Web sites or the information contained on
them. The linked Web sites, their operation and content are the responsibility of the person or entity for
which they were created or maintained (the “Owner”). Both your use of a linked Web site, and your right
to use or reproduce information or materials from a linked Web site, are subject to the terms of use
governing that particular Web site. Any comments or inquiries regarding a linked Web site must be
directed to its Owner.

Copyright: Canadian and international intellectual property laws protect the Content. Unless otherwise
indicated, copyright is held by the Queen’s Printer for Ontario.

It is recommended that reference to the Content be made in the following form: <Author’s last name>,
<Initials> <year of publication>. <Content title>; Ontario Geological Survey, <Content publication series
and number>, <total number of pages>p.

Use and Reproduction of Content: The Content may be used and reproduced only in accordance with
applicable intellectual property laws. Non-commercial use of unsubstantial excerpts of the Content is
permitted provided that appropriate credit is given and Crown copyright is acknowledged. Any substantial
reproduction of the Content or any commercial use of all or part of the Content is prohibited without the
prior written permission of MNDM. Substantial reproduction includes the reproduction of any illustration or
figure, such as, but not limited to graphs, charts and maps. Commercial use includes commercial
distribution of the Content, the reproduction of multiple copies of the Content for any purpose whether or
not commercial, use of the Content in commercial publications, and the creation of value-added products
using the Content.

Contact:
FOR FURTHER
PLEASE CONTACT: BY TELEPHONE: BY E-MAIL:
INFORMATION ON
The Reproduction of MNDM Publication Local: (705) 670-5691
Content Services Toll Free: 1-888-415-9845, ext. Pubsales@ndm.gov.on.ca
5691 (inside Canada,
United States)
The Purchase of MNDM Publication Local: (705) 670-5691
MNDM Publications Sales Toll Free: 1-888-415-9845, ext. Pubsales@ndm.gov.on.ca
5691 (inside Canada,
United States)
Crown Copyright Queen’s Printer Local: (416) 326-2678 Copyright@gov.on.ca
Toll Free: 1-800-668-9938
(inside Canada,
United States)
LES CONDITIONS CI-DESSOUS RÉGISSENT L'UTILISATION DU PRÉSENT DOCUMENT.

Votre utilisation de ce document de la Commission géologique de l'Ontario (le « contenu »)


est régie par les conditions décrites sur cette page (« conditions d'utilisation »). En
téléchargeant ce contenu, vous (l'« utilisateur ») signifiez que vous avez accepté d'être lié
par les présentes conditions d'utilisation.

Contenu : Ce contenu est offert en l'état comme service public par le ministère du Développement du Nord
et des Mines (MDNM) de la province de l'Ontario. Les recommandations et les opinions exprimées dans le
contenu sont celles de l'auteur ou des auteurs et ne doivent pas être interprétées comme des énoncés
officiels de politique gouvernementale. Vous êtes entièrement responsable de l'utilisation que vous en faites.
Le contenu ne constitue pas une source fiable de conseils juridiques et ne peut en aucun cas faire autorité
dans votre situation particulière. Les utilisateurs sont tenus de vérifier l'exactitude et l'applicabilité de tout
contenu avant de l'utiliser. Le MDNM n'offre aucune garantie expresse ou implicite relativement à la mise à
jour, à l'exactitude, à l'intégralité ou à la fiabilité du contenu. Le MDNM ne peut être tenu responsable de tout
dommage, quelle qu'en soit la cause, résultant directement ou indirectement de l'utilisation du contenu. Le
MDNM n'assume aucune responsabilité légale de quelque nature que ce soit en ce qui a trait au contenu.

Liens vers d'autres sites Web : Ce contenu peut comporter des liens vers des sites Web qui ne sont pas
exploités par le MDNM. Certains de ces sites pourraient ne pas être offerts en français. Le MDNM se
dégage de toute responsabilité quant à la sûreté, à l'exactitude ou à la disponibilité des sites Web ainsi reliés
ou à l'information qu'ils contiennent. La responsabilité des sites Web ainsi reliés, de leur exploitation et de
leur contenu incombe à la personne ou à l'entité pour lesquelles ils ont été créés ou sont entretenus (le
« propriétaire »). Votre utilisation de ces sites Web ainsi que votre droit d'utiliser ou de reproduire leur
contenu sont assujettis aux conditions d'utilisation propres à chacun de ces sites. Tout commentaire ou toute
question concernant l'un de ces sites doivent être adressés au propriétaire du site.

Droits d'auteur : Le contenu est protégé par les lois canadiennes et internationales sur la propriété
intellectuelle. Sauf indication contraire, les droits d'auteurs appartiennent à l'Imprimeur de la Reine pour
l'Ontario.
Nous recommandons de faire paraître ainsi toute référence au contenu : nom de famille de l'auteur, initiales,
année de publication, titre du document, Commission géologique de l'Ontario, série et numéro de
publication, nombre de pages.

Utilisation et reproduction du contenu : Le contenu ne peut être utilisé et reproduit qu'en conformité avec
les lois sur la propriété intellectuelle applicables. L'utilisation de courts extraits du contenu à des fins non
commerciales est autorisé, à condition de faire une mention de source appropriée reconnaissant les droits
d'auteurs de la Couronne. Toute reproduction importante du contenu ou toute utilisation, en tout ou en partie,
du contenu à des fins commerciales est interdite sans l'autorisation écrite préalable du MDNM. Une
reproduction jugée importante comprend la reproduction de toute illustration ou figure comme les
graphiques, les diagrammes, les cartes, etc. L'utilisation commerciale comprend la distribution du contenu à
des fins commerciales, la reproduction de copies multiples du contenu à des fins commerciales ou non,
l'utilisation du contenu dans des publications commerciales et la création de produits à valeur ajoutée à l'aide
du contenu.

Renseignements :
POUR PLUS DE
VEUILLEZ VOUS PAR TÉLÉPHONE : PAR COURRIEL :
RENSEIGNEMENTS SUR
ADRESSER À :
la reproduction du Services de Local : (705) 670-5691
contenu publication du MDNM Numéro sans frais : 1 888 415-9845, Pubsales@ndm.gov.on.ca
poste 5691 (au Canada et aux
États-Unis)
l'achat des Vente de publications Local : (705) 670-5691
publications du MDNM du MDNM Numéro sans frais : 1 888 415-9845, Pubsales@ndm.gov.on.ca
poste 5691 (au Canada et aux
États-Unis)
les droits d'auteurs de Imprimeur de la Local : 416 326-2678 Copyright@gov.on.ca
la Couronne Reine Numéro sans frais : 1 800 668-9938
(au Canada et aux
États-Unis)
Ontario Geological Survey
Miscellaneous Paper 129

Volcanology and Mineral


Deposits

edited by
John Wood and Henry Wallace

1986

Reprinted by:

Ministry of
Northern Development
and Mines
Ontario
1986 Government of Ontario ISSN 0704-2752
Printed in Ontario, Canada ISBN 0-7729-1327-7
Reprinted 1988
Publications of the Ontario Geological Survey, Ministry of Northern Development
and Mines, are available from the following sources. Orders for publications
should be accompanied by cheque or money order payable to the Treasurer of
Ontario.
Reports, maps, and price lists (personal shopping or mail order):
Public Information Centre, Ministry of Natural Resources
Room 1640, Whitney Block, Queen's Park
Toronto, Ontario M7A 1W3
Reports and accompanying maps only (personal shopping):
Main Floor, 880 Bay Street
Toronto, Ontario
Reports and accompanying maps (mail order or telephone orders):
Publications Services Section, Ministry of Government Services
5th Floor, 880 Bay Street
Toronto, Ontario M7A 1N8
Telephone (local calls) 965-6015
Toll-free long distance 1-800-268-7540
Toll-free from Area Code 807 O-ZENITH-67200

Canadian Cataloguing in Publication Data


Wood, John
Volcanology and mineral deposits
(Ontario Geological Survey miscellaneous paper, ISSN 0704-2752 ; 129
ISBN 0-7729-1327-7

1. Volcanic ash, tuff, etc. l. Wallace, Henry. II. Ontario. Ministry of Northern Devel
opment and Mines. III. Ontario Geological Survey. IV. Title. V. Series.
QE461.W66 1986 549.11423 C86-099663-8

Every possible effort is made to ensure the accuracy of the information contained
in this report, but the Ministry of Northern Development and Mines does not
assume any liability for errors that may occur. Source references are included in
the report and users may wish to verify critical information.

Parts of this publication may be quoted if credit is given. It is recommended that


reference be made in the following form:

Easton, R.M., and Johns, G.W.


1986: Volcanology and Mineral Exploration: The Application of Physical Vol
canology and Facies Studies; P.2-40 in Volcanology and Mineral Deposits,
edited by John Wood and Henry Wallace, Ontario Geological Survey, Miscella
neous Paper 129, 183 p.

If you wish to reproduce any of the text, tables or illustrations in this report, please
write for permission to the Director, Ontario Geological Survey, Ministry of Northern
Development and Mines, 11th floor, 77 Grenville Street, Toronto, Ontario,
M7A 1W4.
Cover: Photo of lava lake activity, Mount Nyiragongo, West African Rift Valley, Zaire.
Photo taken by R.M. Easton, August 1972.
Scientific Editor: Guy Kendrick 1500-88-U of T Press
Foreword

In December of 1982, during the annual Ontario Geoscience Seminar, the staff of
the Precambrian Section of the Ontario Geological Survey conducted a half-day
forum with the theme "Volcanology and Mineral Deposits".

This volume documents the presentations given at that seminar in an ex


panded form. The chapters included here are intended to remind geologists of
basic principles and techniques employed in fields such as physical volcanology
and volcanic stratigraphy, and to acquaint them with new developments in these
areas that have significant implications for mineral exploration. Examples are
taken from Ontario's Archean greenstone belts, and illustrate the types of work
done by many Ontario Geological Survey geologists over the past several years, l
hope that the reader will find this a useful aid and reference in these increasingly
complex fields.

V.G.Milne
Director
Ontario Geological Survey

Mi
Introduction

Stratigraphy, lithologic parameters and structural features are fundamentally im


portant controls known to influence the location and character of most types of
mineral deposits. This volume deals with the interrelationship between these
fundamental factors in volcanic terrains. Even though the emphasis here is on the
discussion of volcanic stratigraphy and lithologies, it should be clear that a
knowledge and understanding of structure are obligatory in describing and inter
preting both mineral deposits and the rocks in which they occur. This maxim
applies equally in the quest for new deposits, particularly in complex Archean
terrain.
The purpose of this publication is to inform and interest the exploration
geologist in a wide variety of topics related to volcanology, mineral deposits, and
the geology of Ontario. Volcanology, like many other subdisciplines of geology,
has become a multi-faceted, rapidly expanding field. In light of this, the first
chapters included here introduce terminology commonly employed, and describe
concepts, principles and techniques applied in the later chapters. Two of these
principles, volcanic facies analysis and stratigraphic analysis are basic to under
standing spatial and genetic relationships between volcanic rocks and mineral
deposits.
Following the thematic chapters are a series which illustrate the use and
utility of these techniques and concepts when applied to common problems of
mapping and mineral exploration in Archean supracrustal belts. Mineral deposits in
such areas as Timmins-Kirkland Lake, Wawa, Red Lake, and Lake of the Woods
are placed within their stratigraphic context.and possible volcanological controls
on their development are discussed.
The last two chapters in the volume differ from those outlined above in that
they are concerned primarily with chemical characteristics of volcanic rocks
which serve as useful clues in the search for mineral deposits. The first illustrates
the significance of these related concepts in volcanology, namely volcanic cyclic-
ity within volcanic environments and stratigraphic intervals of high mineral poten
tial.
The last chapter deals with the use of statistical techniques which, when
applied to lithogeochemical data, can help define the extent and character of
alteration commonly associated with mineral deposits. These methods, used in
conjunction with geological information, greatly enhance the geologist's ability to
identify exploration targets from the mass of chemical data typically acquired
during modern regional exploration programs.
This volume by no means provides an exhaustive coverage of our stated
subject; we hope that for many it will serve as a useful introduction or reminder of
what can be accomplished. Even though many of the cited examples of economic
mineralization are base-metal deposits, it should be borne in mind that the ability
to unravel volcanology and stratigraphy is fundamental to the understanding of
the geology of any Archean greenstone belt, and hence is of immense value even
in the search for structurally controlled deposits. For more information on the
topics outlined; references are of course included in each of the chapters, and the
geological staff of the Ontario Geological Survey are always available to those
interested in discussing any aspect of Ontario's geology and mineral potential.
Contents

PART ONE: CONCEPTS AND PRINCIPLES IN THE STUDY OF


VOLCANOES AND VOLCANIC ROCKS___________________
Chapter 1 Volcanology and Mineral Exploration:
The Application of Physical Volcanology and Facies Studies
P.M. Easton and G. W. Johns ...................................................................................... 2

Chapter 2 Stratigraphic Correlation Techniques


N.F. Trowell................................................................................................................ 41

PART TWO: VOLCANIC STRATIGRAPHY IN ARCHEAN GREENSTONE


BELTS_______________________________________
Chapter 3 Stratigraphic Correlation of the
Western Wabigoon Subprovince, Northwestern Ontario
N.F. Trowel! and G. W. Johns .................................................................................... 50

Chapter 4 Stratigraphic Correlation in the Wawa Area


P.P. Sage.................................................................................................................... 62

Chapter 5 Mineralization and Volcanic Stratigraphy


in the Western Part of the Abitibi Subprovince
L.S. Jensen................................................................................................................. 69

Chapter 6 Developments in Stratigraphic Correlation:


Western Uchi Subprovince
H. Wallace, P.O. Thurston, and F. Corfu................................................................. 88

PART THREE: VOLCANIC LITHOGEOCHEMISTRY AND MINERAL


EXPLORATION____________________________
Chapter 7 Volcanic Cyclicity in Mineral Exploration;
the Caldera Cycle and Zoned Magma Chambers
P.O. Thurston ........................................................................................................... 104

Chapter 8 Recognition of Alteration in Volcanic Rocks


Using Statistical Analysis of Lithogeochemical Data
E.G. Grunsky............................................................................................................. 124

vii
CONVERSION FACTORS FOR MEASUREMENTS IN ONTARIO GEOLOGICAL
________________SURVEY PUBLICATIONS.—-———————-————-
CONVERSION FROM SI TO IMPERIAL CONVERSION FROM IMPERIAL TO SI
SI Unit Multiplied by Gives Imperial Unit Multiplied by Gives
LENGTH
1 mm 0.039 37 inches 1 inch 25.4 mm
1 cm 0.393 70 inches 1 inch 2.54 cm
1 m 3.280 84 feet 1 foot 0.304 8 m
1 m 0.049 709 chains 1 chain 20.1168 m
1 km 0.621 371 miles (statute) 1 mile (statute) 1.609 344 km

AREA
1 cm2 0.1550 square inches 1 square inch 6.451 6 crrr
1 m2 10.7639 square feet 1 square foot 0.092 903 04 m2
1 km2 0.386 10 square miles 1 square mile 2.589 988 km2
1 ha 2.471 054 acres 1 acre 0.404 685 6 ha

VOLUME
1 cm3 0.061 02 cubic inches 1 cubic inch 16.387 064
1 m3 35.314 7 cubic feet 1 cubic foot 0.028 316 85 m
1 m3 1.3080 cubic yards 1 cubic yard 0.764 555 m3

CAPACITY
1 L 1.759 755 pints 1 pint 0.568 261
1 L 0.879 877 quarts 1 quart 1.136 522
1 L 0.219969 gallons 1 gallon 4.546 090

MASS
19 0.035 ounces (avdp) 1 ounce (avdp) 28.349 523
273 96 g
19 0.032 ounces (troy)
15075 1 ounce (troy) 31.1034768 g
1 kg 2.204 62 pounds (avdp) 1 pound (avdp) 0.453 592 37 kg
1 kg 0.001 tons (short)
102 3 1 ton (short) 907.18474 kg
1 t 1.102 311 tons (short) 1 ton (short) 0.907 184 74 t
1 kg 0.00098421 tons (long) 1 ton (long) 1016.046 908 8 kg
1 t 0.984 206 5 tons (long) 1 ton (long) 1.016 046 908 8 t
CONCENTRATION
1 g/t 0.029 166 6ounce (troy)/ 1 ounce (troy)/ 34.285 714 2 g/t
ton (short) ton (short)
1 g/t 0.58333333 pennyweights/ 1 pennyweight/ 1.7142857 g/t
ton (short) ton (short)

OTHER USEFUL CONVERSION FACTORS


1 ounce (troy) per ton (short) 20.0 pennyweights per ton (short)
1 pennyweight per ton (short) 0.05 ounces (troy) per ton (short)
Note. Conversion factors which are in bold type are exact. The conversion
factors have been taken from or have been derived from factors given in the
Metric Practice Guide for the Canadian Mining and Metallurgical Industries,
published by the Mining Association of Canada in cooperation with the Coal
Association of Canada.

viii
Part One: Concepts and Principles in the
Study of Volcanoes and Volcanic Rocks
Chapter 1

Volcanology and Mineral Exploration: The Application


of Physical Volcanology and Facies Studies
R.M.Easton and G.W.Johns

CONTENTS Example 2 - Berry River formation 34


Volcanic Facies and Known
Abstract............................................................................. 4
Massive-Sulphide Deposits ................ 35
Introduction ....................................................................... 4 The Millenbach Deposit.................. 35
Relationship Between Physical The Corbet Mine .............................. 36
Volcanology and Mineral Exploration ....................... 4 Discussion ............................................ 36
Scope of Chapter......................................................... 4
Terminology .................................................................. 5 Summary ................ 37
Physical Volcanology ...................................................... 5 Acknowledgments 37
Types of Volcanic Eruptions ...................................... 5 References ............. 38
Eruption Products......................................................... 5
Volcanic Rock Classification ..................................... 8 TABLES
Extrusive Rocks ....................................................... 8 1.1. Classification of volcanic eruptions
Grain Size Classification .................................... 8 and the types of volcanic products
Textures ................................................................ 8 associated with each .......................... .. 6
Structures.............................................................. 8 1.2. Origin of lahars .................................... 12
Flow Morphology .............................................. 11
Volcanic Fragmental Rocks ................................ 11 1.3. Comparison of other coarse-grained
Type of Fragmentation .................................... 11 deposits with lahars ............................ 12
Grain Size Classification ................................. 12 1.4. Some types of volcanic breccias ...... 13
Fragment Composition and Shape ................ 13 1.5. Terms for mixed pyroclastic-
Method of Emplacement ................................. 13 epiclastic rocks .................................... 15
Criteria Used to Distinguish Types of 1.6. Some characteristics of the three
Volcanic Fragmental Rocks..................................... 16 main pyroclastic deposit types........... 17
Grain Size .............................................................. 17 1.7. Types of pyroclastic flows ................., 18
Fragment Type ...................................................... 17
Fragment Shape.................................................... 18 1.8. Summary descriptions of types of
Welding .................................................................. 19 pyroclastic flow and surge deposits.. 19
Sorting .................................................................... 19 1.9. Criteria for subdividing pyroclastic
Bedding/Stratification .......................................... 19 rocks ....................................................... 20
Matrix ...................................................................... 19 1.10. Selected characteristics of some
Facies and Extent of Deposit.............................. 21 common breccia types ......................... 20
Summary ................................................................ 21 1.11. Bedding thickness terms ...................... 25
Volcanic Facies......................................................... 21 1.12. Field criteria used in the greenschist
Introduction............................................................ 21 facies to distinguish between felsic
Volcanic Facies .................................................... 21 metatuff, porphyritic felsic flows, and
Volcanic Facies on a Regional poorly bedded, muscovite-bearing
Scale................................................................... 23 metagreywacke...................................... 25
Composite Volcano .......................................... 23
Central or Vent Facies ................................. 23 1.13. Products associated with the four
Proximal Facies ............................................ 24 main volcanic facies of a central
Distal Facies ................................................. 24 vent composite volcano, as shown in
Epiclastic Facies .......................................... 24 Figure 1.25 .............................................. 28
Mafic Shield Volcano....................................... 26 1.14. Products associated with the main
Central or Vent Facies ................................. 26 volcanic facies of a mafic shield
Proximal Facies ............................................ 26 volcano, as shown in Figure 1.26 ....... 28
Distal Facies ................................................. 26 1.15. Exploration criteria for Archean
Volcanic Facies on a Deposit Scale.............. 26 volcanogenic massive-sulphide
Felsic and Intermediate deposits ..................................................., 37
Pyroclastic Flows ......................................... 26
Mafic Flows ................................................... 31 FIGURES
Environment Indicators.................................... 31
1.1. Relationship between physical
Summary ............................................................ 32
volcanology and mineral exploration .................. 4
Case Studies ................................................................. 32
1.2. Relationship of landform to
Mapping of Pyroclastic Sequences and
environment for basaltic volcanism .................... 7
Identification of Volcanic Facies............................ 32
Example 1 - Skead Group, Abitibi
Subprovince .......................................................... 32
P.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

1.3. a) Facies model for pyroclastic 1.22. Principal facies variation in volcanic
deposits resulting from a medium- to rocks related to a large central vent
large-scale silicic explosive eruption composite volcano ............................... 26
in a subaerial environment; b) 1.23. Principal facies variation in volcanic
Schematic diagram showing the rocks related to a large shield
deposits of an explosive silicic volcano................................................... 27
eruption. ................................................., ,. 7 1.24. Conditions of initiation and types of
1.4. Model of an Archean island volcanic subaqueous transport........................... 29
system ...................................................., .. 8 1.25. Schematic drawings of a submarine
1.5. Two types of facies variation eruption producing subaqueous
observed in subaqueous basalt and pyroclastic flows, and subsequent
andesite flows ........................................ , 9 appearance of the deposits of such
1.6. Vesicle shape and distribution in aa, an eruption.............................................. 29
pahoehoe, and pillowed lava flows..... , 9 1.26. Lateral facies variation in
1.7. Flow morphology in aa (a), pahoehoe subaqueous pyroclastic flows ............. 30
(b), and pillowed (c) lava flows as 1.27. Structure sequences of subaqueous
seen in cross section ............................. 10 pyroclastic flows.................................... 30
1.8. a) Schematic cross sections through 1.28. Facies model for subaqueous mafic
an endogeneous dome and flow of flows on the flank of a shield
viscous lava and b) through a volcano, showing proximal massive
rhyolitic obsidian flow........................... 10 facies and distal pillowed facies ........ 31
1.9. Structure of an Archean subaqueous 1.29. Environment of formation of volcanic
rhyolite flow from Rouyn- Noranda, breccias and specific lava flow
Quebec .................................................... 10 features (water depth figures only
1.10. Illustration showing the inherent approximate)........................................... 31
classification problems with some 1.30. Distribution of the pyroclastic rocks
pyroclastic rocks............................... 11 of the Skead Group in southern
1.11. Granulometric classification for Bryce and Tudhope Townships........... 32
unimodal, well-sorted pyroclastic 1.31. Distribution of volcanic facies of the
rocks ................................................... 13 pyroclastic rocks of the Skead Group
1. 12. Granulometric classification of in southern Bryce and Tudhope
pyroclastic deposits (left) and Townships............................................... 33
subdivision of tuffs and ashes 1.32. Volcanic facies of the Berry River
according to their fragmental formation, eastern Lake of the
composition (right) ................................. 14 Woods...................................................... 34
13. Granulometric classification for 1.33. Geology of the Millenbach deposit,
polymodal volcanic fragmental rocks looking northeast along a northwest-
where a more detailed classification southeast section ................................ 36
than shown in Figure 1.12 is needed .. 14 1.34. Geology through the Corbel Mine,
14. Sketch showing characteristics of looking north along section 800 N 36
various pyroclastic rocks under the
microscope .............................................. 16 PHOTOGRAPHS
1 15. The three main types of pyroclastic
deposit based on depositional 1.1. Structure and features in Archean
mechanism, and their geometric and Proterozoic volcanic fragmental
relations with the underlying rocks ...................................................................... 15
topography............................................... 16 1.2. Pyroclastic breccias............................................ 22
16. Classification scheme of pyroclastic 1.3. Flow breccias and hyaloclastites ..................... 23
fall deposits ............................................. 20
17. Md^/o Median grain diameter versus
deviation in grain diameter) plot
showing the fields of pyroclastic fall
and flow deposits ................................... 21
18. Grain size distribution in ash-flows
and lahars ................................................ 21
1.19. Schematic diagrams showing
characteristics of some common
volcanic fragmental rocks................. 24
1.20. Types of volcanoes............................ 25
1.21. Pyroclastic rock distribution in the
western and the eastern Caribbean 25
CHAPTER 1

ABSTRACT Q
EMPIRICAL
Recognition of volcanic facies regimes in the Ar
chean is a potential mineral exploration tool which
can help discriminate between barren and mineral
ized environments. Recognition of volcanic facies re
quires the ability to classify Archean pyroclastic and
volcanic fragmental rocks, and to identify, where pos
sible, the eruptive and depositional mechanisms
which produced these deposits. This chapter reviews
the classification of volcanic fragmental rocks.the
classification of facies models for volcanic se
quences, and illustrates how these concepts can be
applied in four Archean case studies with reference
to their potential use in mineral exploration. b phreatic"\L CONCEPTUAL
ORE
INTRODUCTION
Mineral deposits are anomalies, and Sangster (1980)
has noted that massive-sulphide mining districts
have an average diameter of 32 km; that is, an area
of 800 km2. Within this 800 km2 area, a mineral de
posit is still a very small target. Many massive-sul
phide deposits are associated with volcanic rocks in
what is commonly called a proximal volcanic environ
ment. Identification and mapping of the physical heat flow:
character of volcanic rocks (physical volcanology)
and their environment of deposition (facies analysis)
will narrow the search area and make more efficient
use of the exploration dollar. Figure 1.1. Relationship between physical vol
canology and mineral exploration may be seen
RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN PHYSICAL VOLCANOLOGY
in an empirical or a conceptual sense. In an
AND MINERAL EXPLORATION
empirical sense (a), there is an observed asso
ciation between ore and rock type. In a con
Physical volcanology can be related to mineral ex ceptual sense (b), a model is developed to
ploration in two ways. Firstly, it can be related to explain the observed ore/rock associations.
mineral exploration in an empirical sense, as is This model can then be used to explore for
shown in Figure 1.1 a. In this model of a typical new deposits. Both examples shown are for
Kuroko massive-sulphide deposit, there exists a the Kuroko massive-sulphide district, Japan
physical association between lava domes, phreatic (modified from Franklin et al. 1981). a) ideal
breccias, and ore. This association most commonly ized cross section of a typical Kuroko deposit;
occurs in a proximal volcanic environment. Sangster b) essential features of recent genetic models
(1972) has observed a similar association between for volcanic-associated deposits.
coarse pyroclastic breccias, which he termed
"mill-rock", and volcanogenic massive-sulphide de
posits in the Superior Province of Ontario. Thus, ex
ploration methods rely on the ability of the geoscien-
tist to identify coarse pyroclastic breccias in proximal volcanic rocks found in association with known ore-
to vent environments in the search for such deposits. deposits are well described and understood in terms
Secondly, physical volcanology and mineral ex of their eruptive mechanisms and environments of
ploration can be related in a conceptual sense, as deposition, important associations between ore and
shown in Figure 1.1 b. Here, physical volcanology and particular rock types could be missed, making it dif
facies analysis have been used to develop models of ficult to deduce models for ore-genesis and explora
ore genesis, as is shown in this example from the tion.
Kuroko region of Japan. Such models can then be
used to outline areas of favourable mineral potential SCOPE OF CHAPTER
in other similar areas. Even though the Kuroko model in this chapter the authors hope to:
for the genesis of massive-sulphide deposits was
developed for a modern volcanic region, the model 1. provide an introduction to the types of volcanic
has been successfully applied to Archean mining eruptions and the products of these eruptions
camps (Franklin era/. 1981). 2. provide an introduction to the classification of
In both these cases, physical volcanology and volcanic products
facies analysis are tools which can be used in con 3. discuss criteria that can be used to distinguish
junction with other tools such as stratigraphic correla different eruptive products, with emphasis on
tion and geochemistry to form the basis of mineral pyroclastic rocks
exploration programs (Trowell, Chapter 2, this vol
ume). This, however, is a two-way process, for unless
P.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

4. discuss volcanic facies, and how facies analysis are deposited, and hence, their usefulness as an
of volcanic rocks can aid mineral exploration exploration tool. For example, in order to use Sang-
programs ster's (1972) observation that coarse pyroclastic
5. present some examples of how physical vol breccias ("mill-rock") are associated with massive-
canology can be applied to mineral exploration sulphide deposits as an exploration tool, it is neces
sary to know how such breccias are formed. In re
In doing so, the authors hope to illustrate the cent volcanic terrains, coarse pyroclastic breccias
utility, the limitations, and the application of physical may form by a variety of mechanisms:
volcanology studies in the Archean to aid mineral
exploration. 1. pyroclastic flow, including ignimbrites,
"block-and-ash" flows
The chapter is divided into three, semi-indepen
dent sections. The first section is a review of vol 2. autobrecciation during flowage or extrusion of
canic rock classifications, emphasizing field meth lava domes
ods, the types of materials produced by volcanic 3. phreatic eruptions
eruptions, and their mode of emplacement. The sec 4. debris flows, including lahars, mudflows
ond section examines facies models for volcanic
rocks to the extent that is possible at present, be Naturally, not all of these deposits are likely to
cause this subject is still in its infancy. The final be mineralized. Phreatic eruption breccias are be
section presents several examples from the Superior lieved to be the most closely associated with
Province showing how facies analysis and physical massive-sulphide deposits in the Archean (Hodgson
volcanology can be used to narrow the search area and Lydon 1977; Franklin el at. 1981). Thus, if dif
for mineral deposits. ferent volcanic breccias and their eruptive mecha
nisms can be distinguished, such knowledge can be
used to reduce the size of the potential exploration
TERMINOLOGY area.
For the purposes of this chapter, the following terms For the purposes of this chapter, three main
are defined below: eruptive mechanisms exist:
Physical Volcanology can be defined as the study 1. Phreatic (steam) eruptions result when meteoric
of the products of volcanic eruptions, eruptive water is vapourized with sufficient pressure to
mechanisms, and the landforms produced by vol fracture and eject the confining rocks. Purely
canic eruptions. By definition, physical volcanology phreatic explosions expel no juvenile (magmatic)
includes aspects of the physical character of erup material.
tion products and facies analysis (the focus of this
chapter), stratigraphy (Trowell, Chapter 2, this vol 2. Phreatomagmatic (Surtseyan) eruptions are pro
ume), and the reconstruction of paleoenvironments (a duced by the interaction of ground or surface
goal of most geologic mapping). water and magma, and may eject much lithic
(accidental or accessory) material as well as
A facies is a deposit or an eruptive unit, or part juvenile material.
thereof, having distinct spatial and geometric rela
tions and internal characteristics (Self 1982d). 3. Magmatic eruptions result from the ejection on
surface of molten material, either in an explosive
A facies model is a generalized summary of the or an extrusive eruption. Magmatic eruptions are
organization of the deposits in space and time. The further divided into several types. These are
model should be a "norm", a basis for interpretation, named after volcanoes which typically produce
and a predictor of new geologic situations (Self eruptions of that type (Table 1.1). In order of
1982d). increasing intensity, they are basaltic flood erup
Pyroclastic deposits/rocks is used in a broad tions, Hawaiian eruptions, Strombolian eruptions,
sense, as recommended by the IUGS (Schmid 1981). Vulcanian eruptions, Sub-Plinian eruptions,
Schmid (1981) defined a pyroclast as "being gen Plinian eruptions, and Ultra-Plinian eruptions. Fur
erated by disruption as a direct result of volcanic ther details on these eruption types are given in
action"; pyroclastic deposits are assemblages of Macdonald (1972), Williams and McBirney
pyroclasts. Moreover, Schmid (1981) allowed (1979), and in Table 1.1. An individual volcano
pyroclastic deposits to contain as much as 25 07o by may exhibit one or more of these eruptive
volume of epiclastic, organic, chemical, sedimentary, mechanisms during its lifetime.
and diagenetic admixtures. Included in the term
pyroclastic deposits are subaerial and subaqueous ERUPTION PRODUCTS
fall, flow, and surge deposits, lahars, subsurface, and
vent deposits, hyaloclastites, intrusion and extrusive The eruptive mechanisms cited above produce two
breccias, and diatremes. broad classes of deposits:
1. Extrusive Deposits. These include lava flows and
PHYSICAL VOLCANOLOGY lava domes produced only during magmatic erup
tions.
TYPES OF VOLCANIC ERUPTIONS 2. Explosive/Pyroclastic Deposits. These include
Before the methods of classifying and subdividing fall, flow, and surge deposits, and other
volcanic products are discussed, it is necessary to pyroclastic deposits which may be produced by
review how volcanic rocks are produced. This is all three types of volcanic eruptions.
because eruptive mechanisms affect the physical
character of volcanic products, how and where they
co- •Q.^
CO 2 CO
(D
CO

i
^ CO
"D
•4—
C CD S5 co CD
"D CO o c o
CO
0
CO — CO 0 o CD CD
o
O)
.c
TJ P TJ TJ O o 0 C
c c fs co c fs -*: E 8)^
o
0 CD
o D P?.E 3
SB
TRUCTURES Spatcones
ater 1 ravery
mparts; bro
lacones;
va Spatcones
ater t ravery
mparts; ^ Q. co' T3 co' 2
(F
VCH
MODIFIED VENT
AROUND
Cicones
nder co" 1Q. ^o3
g -Q -Q CD
CO-
0) C CD
laconesva •D o
E OT ^2 o
plain
O
O CO CD o ro 8 8 {2
.c .c E •D TJ U
B| 5: S
CO co "D
o 5: c o m -c ^ E
c
< t-
•*fc
<
^ CO C

Ul

si
"O JT
X o"
1- H :*s
t- ^
k. 2 ku CO
O co ^c o0) CD c
z
0 ^

B: 0)
>
0)
> ETS* E
O CD
'o
TJ
^TJ
o z ;j- ,j- t CO -ri. o D E 0 C
0 3 E ^ D CO CO
Ul
H- 2 0)
• —- C/5 ^^
co w 0 ^
Q. Q. O
CO c5j2
o co CO CO if TJ
E^
<
O o Q.
CO
Q.
CO
a&a CO CO
CO CO CO CO a ro
ol
CO O
o u. •o s?i 0) TJ .c ^"0 .n
CO o TJ
C — -rt O CO
o CO c"c co "co
(O NATURE cojc CO JC CO o C
Essential CO CO O CO ro c
< EJECTA w w CO J2, .2 CO" ci CO
>
3 ^ to ,-
CO JO 3** 0
jQ CO jQ CO .*:
CO
E o? E v
d) -O CO
.c E 0)n o CD
CO
CO CD-^ 8?
o O ~
CO JS
Si D. O is co
CO JD ™ CO
0
jQ
x.
LJ 0
CO 0 f^
0 5
< r*
^58
O co
o
o CO CO
0
oc
o. 1O wCO 0 CO* ^N
P
c
•4—

o Ul
0 5: > •*- >
CD 2^ CD ^ D
CD ^2 -p >
>0
CD CO

g
CO 2*0) CO
< •- 5 c •-•DO) n co co T3
o ;^CO
0^5? 0 JO
O 3 g 05 CO ~
c^n
CO CO
2^ •S
® b; ^2
co 3* -c:
CO

s*
U.
-co Q) H- co ^3
j- g n
O
^ E .i l!
U.
Ul !M — ^J O
> 25 fS 0
C 0 w co
u. li.
0^ 3^3 2 SI S "5
5 D) co' 5
^ CO* C 0
o (D-D 2 c
CO Q)
O o 2-o 52 15 co S^cS i O
CO gt c 0.3 "o -o E 0) (D c
— T3 b o o. S 2
I-L co
CO g~
*- CO ^ *i 1-E^
to co
CO .t±
Ul
SE E ?- 0~n
C---2 3 Jt O CO 2^ s g |S
CO C ^ CO
CD
la
0 ^0 ^ 2
O. K- 1- 3 .g 5* .2 E 5
<o S !F
55^
0 -0
52 co o -Q
> .b w- CO JC .2 CO
.c— o o
•z. :x0
z< 111 f "5 .E 1— O 5Z U- Q 5 co < ^ CO D. TJ
Z
T3 "o J^ "o
^co
0) C 3 OM-
^2 ^o •D 0
1 "o c
^co
.0 CD i2
> c
*-'i m
3 -r S l-o .^ ^ CO
0 r1 Jt
z: ^ 5
:* -E
t) r- ^
S 52
*D
TJ O o ^ T3 CO 5- O
'CoD
CO ^-rf
z co
O u.
SS
o ro
15 1 c w. 0)
0) o E
o co
z: .^
0*5
-^
co
o
^"^ c
CD 0 g W
" r?P
c&o
O
TJ
•t; co o TJ O)

11
d^ m /-\ ^

5^ ™ CO
oxysmal lvaol*urge
mes |S| fof
*—' "^

LCANI
ERUPTIC
CO
HARACTER .2. w
0) — ^ o^. Pareje ac ompanying olen fsolragmentid s rock,
Weak
vito dei:
surge flov
pyroclastic ol
ragments
.25 0 CO ^
LiVulckaneian
fi
o 5 CD 0 CO
EXPLOSIVE .^ CO
CO JO 0 o5 n 'cF ™
ACTIVITY 0) 0)
55 li 2 o D re
o3
C CO > collapse r: co >
c 3 w
fi
-se co"
^"0
o 'D
CO JO
0) 0)
•D
o
o0) 8co 5J ^ 8 3r
owl
>=: ^ JO ^ D. 2 (D > C ^5 c
O
u. "•S
0 io2 ^ CO
Z ^S 0 0)
"co E
^ Ul ^ o w
o O
— o: S CO
13
o
CO
D
CO
a CT
CO
P COS 2 •Q
'5 TJ
'r: l-o o
O o
o E ^8
< ^H- Ul
o3
O
o I^X
O.Z h- Li. LL. 2^ ^
CO
>
CO
^
CO 0
"Z. D CO
U- ^
LL. ^I.
cow
Ss O

^
Ul
Q. TO
> TJ E
c
^
^^ O O)
^ co c CO
CO
C
0 O CO O CO
'c ^c o o
mO '5 13 "co
yo p
sc
"co co E C
co CO
jj 'c CD
m^ CO 5 o JO 0
•^^ CO CO D D JZ JC.
t- Z Ul CO x CO > CO E Q. Q.
P.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

Figure 1.2. Relationship of landform to environ COMMON


ment for basaltic volcanism. The figure reflects
volcanism in 4 distinct environments; such as
LANDFORM
at varying elevations in an island system, with
A being 500 m above sea level; B being 10 m Cinder cone'
above; C being WO m below; and D being Little or No
1000m below sea level. Eruptive mechanisms Water
responsible for these landforms are: A, D -
magmatic eruption; B, C - phreatic or
phreatomagmatic eruptions, or both. (Modified Ground Water
from Wholetz and Sheridan 1983).

Shallow Surface
Water

Deep Water

fine
PROXIMAL DISTAL ash-fall
0 ^ deposit

one
laterally extensive flow
co-ignimbrite ash-fall unit

;a
pyroclastic surge pyroclastic
surge
deposit
ignimbrite flow units Plinian ash-fall X'; Plinian
ash-fall
deposit

Figure 1.3. a) Facies model for pyroclastic deposits resulting from a medium- to large-scale silicic explosive
eruption in a subaerial environment. X-X' denotes cross section shown in b. After Wright et al. (1981). b)
Schematic diagram showing the deposits of an explosive silicic eruption. An inversely graded Plinian
ash-fall bed is overlain by a surge deposit. The basal layer of the pyroclastic flow unit (a) may show
inverse grading, whereas in the main part of the flow (b), lithic inclusions (filled clasts) are concentrated
near the base, and pumice fragments (large open clasts) and fumarolic pipes are concentrated near the
top of the flow. Deposits of fine co-ignimbrite ash occur above the flow unit. A lava flow may cap the
sequence, which reflects eruption of increasingly volatile-poor magma. (After Self 1982a, 1982b and
Sparks et al, 1973).

Some important factors which influence the type of water-magma interaction, which may be in
of volcanic products involved in any one eruption directly related to water depth, can have a sig
are: nificant effect on the types of volcanic products
1. Environment. For example, a subaerial magmatic erupted as shown in Figure 1.2.
eruption may produce a pahoehoe, aa, or block The Flow Unit Concept. In many cases, a flow,
lava flow of andesitic composition, but a sub either of lava or a pyroclastic flow, may be com
aqueous eruption of the same magma will pro posed of a variety of distinct rock types. All of
duce a pillowed flow, perhaps with associated these rock types constitute a flow unit, and are
pillow-breccia and hyalotuff. Indeed, the amount the product of a single eruptive event. An exam-
CHAPTER 1

500
second generation
pyroclastic cone

first
generation
pyroclastic
cone

Figure 1.4. Model of an Archean island volcanic system. Second generation felsic to intermediate
pyroclastic cone has been constructed atop an earlier wave-modified pyroclastic cone. Both are
constructed atop a mafic shield volcano. Most volcanic products of the second cone are erupted
subaerially, but are deposited, or redeposited subaqueously. (After Ayres 1982).

pie of this can be seen in the ash-flow deposit be aware that the two are commonly intimately inter
shown in Figure 1.3. Recognition of flow units is mixed. In this chapter, emphasis is placed on the
important in recognizing volcanic facies, recon mesoscopic and microscopic lithological features of
struction of paleoenvironments, and eruptive volcanic rocks, and not on the classification of vol
mechanisms, as discussed in later sections. canic rocks on the basis of chemistry.
3. Facies. The facies regime of a particular deposit
being studied has an effect on the volcanic pro Extrusive Rocks
ducts observed. Figure 1.3 is a facies model for Extrusive volcanic rocks are classified mainly on the
a subaerial pyroclastic flow. The cross section basis of grain size, primary textures, structures, and
shown in Figure 1.3b is what a deposit in the flow morphology. Salient points of such classifica
proximal facies of the flow would resemble. A tions are listed below:
deposit in the distal facies (Figure 1.3a) would
consist of only the Plinian ash-fall deposit and
the co-ignimbrite ash-fall, and may not be readily Grain Size Classification A commonly used system
is that of Moorhouse (1959):
recognized as part of a pyroclastic flow deposit.
Near the vent, a co-ignimbrite lag deposit would Aphanitic: grains not visible with a hand lens
be present interfingering with the main part of the Fine grained: -O mm
pyroclastic flow. Thus, an approximate idea of Medium grained: 1 to 5 mm
what facies regime the deposits under study may
be in is required in order to accurately interpret Coarse grained: ^ mm
the depositional mechanisms that formed the
rocks under study. Textures Most standard igneous petrology texts de
4. Island Systems. Ayres (1982) has argued that fine common textural terms (for example: Joplin 1968;
many Archean volcanic systems, especially the Williams et at. 1954; Harker 1962; Macdonald 1972),
mafic-felsic systems, were islands (Figure 1.4). In and hence these are not repeated here. Some tex
this case, most products may be erupted sub tures, however, may be diagnostic of individual flows
aerially after a certain point in the evolution of or flow units; or of the specific chemical composition
the volcanic edifice has been passed. Most pro and flow type (for example, spinifex texture in ul
ducts, however, will be deposited subaqueously, tramafic flows).
either through primary deposition, or through re
working and redeposition. This is an important Structures Many flows in the Archean are mapped
concept when it comes to the application of stud on the basis of internal structures, or lack of struc
ies of modern volcanoes (mainly subaerial) to tures as in the case of massive flows. Some of the
Archean volcanism. more important structures are discussed as follows:
Pillow Lavas. Pillow lavas are common throughout
VOLCANIC ROCK CLASSIFICATION Archean volcanic terrains. Features to note in de
Now that we are aware of how volcanic rocks are scribing pillow lavas include the following:
produced, how do we classify such rocks, and how 1. size and shape
do we distinguish between different kinds of volcanic 2. amygdaloidal or non-amygdaloidal
products, in particular explosive (pyroclastic) depos 3. variolitic or non-variolitic
its?
4. selvage thickness and possible differences in
Even though in this chapter, volcanic rocks are chemistry from the interior outward
separated into two groups, extrusive rocks and vol
canic fragmental (explosive) rocks, the reader should 5. internal structure, for example, radial, concentric

8
RM EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

PROXIMAL DISTAL

(r*
o o" 0 . O"
O oo o Ooo
o 0 o, 0 o
co

ra PILLOW
La!) BRECCIA
S PILLOW
53 LAVA
pq MASSIVE Figure 1.6. Vesicle shape and distribution in: a) aa;
L2JLAVA
b) pahoehoe; and c) pillowed lava flows.

Figure 1.5. Two types of facies variation observed


in subaqueous basalt and andesite flows. Each
column represents a flow unit, and is com in subaerial flows; aa flows and pahoehoe flows
posed of varying proportions of hyalotuff, pillow have characteristic vesicle shape and size and abun
breccia, pillow lava, and massive lava. dance (Macdonald 1972; Figure 1.6), and can be
(Modified from Dimroth et al. 1978). For com used to distinguish between the two flow types. Fea
plete range of possible flow unit variation, see tures that should be noted in the field pertaining to
Dimroth et al. (1978). vesicles and amygdules include the following:
1. size and variation in size: possible indication of
flow type, or relative water depth
2. shape: spherical, elongate, deformed
6. packing relations, possible top determinations 3. filling: mineralogy, variation if any
7. amount and type of interpillow material 4. distribution in pillows, sometimes concentrated at
Dimroth et al. (1978, 1979), Dimroth and Rocheleau pillow top
(1979), and Wells et al. (1979) have described how Varioles and Variolitic Lavas. Varioles are pea-
features such as size and shape and packing rela sized spheres, usually composed of radiating crystals
tions can be used to map out pillowed flows, and of plagioclase or pyroxene. This term is generally
have developed a facies concept for pillowed flows applied only to these spherical bodies in basic ig
(Figure 1.5; see Facies Section). neous rocks (AGI 1980). A spherulite is a rounded or
Moore et al. (1971) pointed out some of the spherical mass of acicular crystals, commonly com
dangers in making top and thickness determinations posed of feldspar, radiating from a central point (AGI
of ancient pillow lavas because the bedding plane 1980).
measured may actually be from foreset beds on an Varioles are common in Archean mafic lavas,
initially steep slope. Borradaile (1982) has also exam and have been used in tracing individual flows and
ined how deformation can affect the accuracy of top packages of flows in Archean "greenstone belts".
determinations in pillowed volcanic sequences. In The origin of varioles has been a subject of con
shallow dipping pillow lava sections, the accurate troversy (Carstens 1963; Furnes 1973; Gelinas et al.
determination of facing directions may not be possi 1976; Hughes 1977: Philpotts 1977; Dimroth and
ble because of the shallow-angle of the exposed Rocheleau 1979). There are probably two varieties of
plane through the sequence. varioles: those formed by devitrification processes;
Vesicles and Amygdules. A vesicle is a cavity of and those formed by spherulitic crystallization of
variable shape in a lava which is formed by the immiscible silicate globules.
entrapment of a gas bubble during solidification of Melson and Thompson (1973) and Furnes (1973)
the lava (AGI 1980). An amygdule is a gas cavity or have noted that varioles have been found in basalts
vesicle in an igneous rock which is filled with such dredged from the ocean floor at depths of 1600 to
secondary minerals as calcite, quartz, chalcedony, or 5000 m. Amygdules, which are known to form in
a zeolite (AGI 1980). water depths of ^000 m, have also been reported in
In a study of vesicles in pillow lavas, Jones variolitic flows. In pillow lavas, Dimroth and
(1969) concluded that the size of vesicles Rocheleau (1979) noted three types of variole dis
(amygdules in most Archean flows) were related to tribution:
water depth, that is, the deeper the water, the smaller 1. rim type which is close to the inner chill margin
the vesicles. The maximum water depth of vesicle in a zone up to 15 cm thick
formation is about 2000m. Higgins (1971) arrived at 2. central type which is close to the pillow core,
the same conclusions. Moore (1970) noted that al margins may be variole-free
kalic basalts are more vesicular than tholeiitic basalts
that have been erupted at the same water depth. 3. random type
Note that vesicle size and abundance is a measure Varioles have also been observed in hyaloclastite
of the depth of emplacement, not necessarily the units (Dimroth and Rocheleau 1979; Furnes 1973).
depth of eruption (Jones 1969). Vesicles also occur
CHAPTER 1

a Figure 1.7. Flow


morphology in aa (a),
pahoehoe (b), and
pillowed (c) lava flows
as seen in cross section.
Arrows indicate top
indicators commonly
found in the flows. Dark
areas represent voids.

FLOW DOME
1m surface breccia
5m finely vesicular pumice
surface spines
ramp ridges
structure
flow blocky 15m Z^r^LHl-T^ obsidian
banding top

9m •'.•['•'•'•••'•'•'' coarse 'y vesicular pumice


. , . . blocky
blocky spherulitic
base lava basal breccia
tephra

Figure 1.8. a) Schematic cross section through an endogeneous dome and flow of viscous lava. (After Self
1982c). b) Schematic cross section through a rhyolitic obsidian flow. Compare with mafic flow cross
section shown in Figure L7a. (After Self 1982c).

PROXIMAL DISTAL Figure 1.9. Structure of


an Archean subaqueous
hyalotuff layered breccia massive breccia rhyolite flow from
500 metres -
metres———^....)}....^ ...,.^-l ..... T; .... ....... T7TT^;;... ......,\ .... ...... Rouyn-Noranda, Quebec.
.00.. o" 0 . jr;'-oo
'•'•'." 0 ''"' Vo;^ov o:V^Vo;7"V-":
00 ''-'* 0 0 -*o'o'"•O'L'o
0 o ."-voVoiroT
o '" (Modified from Dimroth
and Rocheleau 1979).
"O - O o-0
0.0
Compare with mafic
'o\oo0!;
' O0 f ' 0

flows shown in Figure


' '. oOo 1.5.

brecciated rhyolite lava heterogeneous fine microbreccia


microbreccia

10
R.M. EASTON AND C. W. JOHNS

TEMPERATURE PHASE lava domes associated with caldera collapse may be


CONTROLLED CONTROLLED mineralized. Domes may also occur as shallow-level,
subsurface intrusions.
lahars Several zones are commonly developed within
WATER lava domes and flows, and are labelled in Figures
lahars 1.8a and 1.8b, respectively. Descriptions of lava
GAS ash ash flows domes are given in Macdonald (1972), Williams and
flows
McBirney (1979), and Self (1982c), and of viscous
100 200 o 100 200 lava flows in Christiansen and Lipman (1966), Fink
(1980), Self (1982C), and Macdonald (1972).

Figure 1.10. Illustration showing the inherent clas Volcanic Fragmental Rocks
sification problems with some pyroclastic The classification of volcanic fragmental rocks pre
rocks. Note the difference in the fields for ash sented herein is based on the classification schemes
flows and mudflows (lahars) according to of Schmid (1981) and Wright et al. (1980), as well as
whether temperature (left) or the nature of the the work of Fisher (1966), Parsons (1969), Schmin-
continuous phase (liquid water or gas) (right) is cke (1974), and Dimroth (1977). Volcanic fragmental
regarded as more important. (Adapted from rocks are classified on the basis of the method of
Walker 1981). fragmentation, grain size, and fragment composition
(Schmid 1981). These rocks can also be classified
on the basis of the method of emplacement, as is the
case for many modern volcanic fragmental rocks
(Wright et al. 1980).
Flow Morphology Flow morphology refers to the
constitution of an individual flow unit. Differences in
flow morphology can be seen in Figure 1.7, where Type of Fragmentation Autoclastic Rocks. Fragmen
the morphology of an aa, pahoehoe, and pillowed tation is due to mechanical deformation where dif
flow are compared. In addition, flow morphology may ferent parts of a flow or dome differ in viscosity.
show lateral variations, such as is shown in the Flowage will cause the less viscous parts of the flow
pillowed flows shown in Figure 1.5. These lateral to deform plastically, whereas the outer more brittle
variations may be related to a facies model, as in the parts which are cooler than the interior will fracture.
case of pillowed flows (Dimroth et at. 1978, 1979; Pyroclastic Rocks. Fragmentation is related to either
see Facies Section). In addition, lava domes and magmatic, phreatomagmatic, or phreatic eruptions, as
flows of felsic and intermediate composition have was discussed earlier. In addition, fragmentation may
morphology different from mafic extrusive rocks also occur due to rapid chilling of hot magma with
(compare Figure 1.7 with Figure 1.8). Pillow lavas are water, causing shattering of the magma with no ex
restricted to andesitic or more mafic lavas, but a plosive activity producing hyaloclastic rocks.
modern pillow composed of dacite has been reported Alloclastic Rocks. These rocks are formed by the
at one locality (Macdonald 1972). The pillow forma fragmentation of pre-existing rocks by subsurface
tion in that case was ascribed to an unusually high volcanic processes, such as intrusion (Wright and
volatile content. Although pillowed structures are not Bowes 1963). Under the IUGS classification scheme
normally found in felsic and intermediate flows, Dim (Schmid 1981), these rocks are pyroclastic rocks, as
roth and Rocheleau (1979) and de Rosen-Spence et their origin is directly related to volcanic action. Al
al. (1980) suggested that subaqueous rhyolite and loclastic rocks are typically found in eroded volcanic
dacite flows behaved much the same as their more vents and show crosscutting relationships.
mafic counterparts. These flows consist of a massive
core overlain by fine breccia and hyalotuff derived Redeposited Fragmental Rocks. This is an important
from the flow near the vent, and consist of breccia subcategory of volcanic fragmental rocks, that does
not neatly fit into a classification system based on
and hyalotuff distal to the vent (Figure 1.9).
the fragmentation mechanism. These rocks consist
Lava domes may occur in both vent and proximal entirely of volcanic material, and many form by direct
areas, and may precede or follow large-scale caldera volcanic action (Crandell 1971), and hence, are
collapse. Lava domes do not indicate a waning of pyroclastic rocks as defined by the IUGS (Schmid
volcanic activity as was previously considered 1981). These deposits include debris avalanche and
(Newhall and Melson 1983). In addition, lava domes debris flow deposits, of which lahars are an impor
can be associated with phreatomagmatic eruptions, tant subset. These rocks pose many difficulties in
and can occur in a number of volcanic environments. terms of classification, partly because of the various
Lava domes may have associated lava flows, that usages of the terms in the past, and inherent clas
can form by breaching of the dome and outflow. sification problems as are shown in Figure 1.10. Be
Morphology of lava domes in subaerial and sub cause of the confusion surrounding terms such as
aqueous environments is probably similar, although lahar, a brief discussion of these rocks is warranted.
more breccia and hyalotuff may be present with the The following definitions are used in this chapter,
latter. Domes may also be associated with pyroclastic and follow the usage of Fisher (1982b) and Lipman
flows, either directly, as in the case of pyroclastic and Mullineaux (1981).
flows generated by dome collapse, or indirectly, as in
the association with post-caldera collapse volcanism. A debris avalanche is the result of the very rapid
and usually sudden sliding and flowage of incoher-
As discussed by Thurston (Chapter 7, this volume),

11
CHAPTER 1

ent, unsorted mixtures of soil and bedrock (AGI


1980). TABLE 1.2: ORIGIN OF LAHARS (AFTER
A debris flow is a moving mass of rock frag CRANDELL 1971).___________________
ments, soil, and mud. More than half of the particles
are larger than sand size (2mm) (AGI 1980). Mud I. DIRECT AND IMMEDIATE RESULT OF
flow should be restricted to debris flows consisting ERUPTION
dominantly of mud (that is, ^007o sand, silt, and 1. Eruption through crater lake, snow,
clay) (Fisher 1982b; Sharp and Nobles 1953). A lahar or ice.
is a special class of debris flow composed of vol 2. Heavy rain during an eruption.
canic particles (Fisher 1982b). A lahar may consist of 3. Flow of hot pyroclastic material
mainly mud (ash), and may grade into mudflows with into rivers or onto snow or ice.
increasing distance from the vent. Not all lahars form
as a direct result of volcanic activity (Crandell 1971; II. INDIRECTLY RELATED TO AN ERUPTION
Table 1.2), and technically, not all lahars are 1. Triggering of water-soaked debris
pyroclastic rocks. In practice, it is not always possi by earthquake.
ble to determine the origin of an Archean laharic
2. Bursting and rapid drainage of
deposit. Thus, if such a deposit is composed of crater lakes.
^5 07o epiclastic material, it is commonly considered 3. Dewatering of large avalanches
a pyroclastic rock. Table 1.3 compares the char
acteristics of other coarse-grained volcanic fragmen originating from collapse of volcano
side.
tal rocks with lahars. Subaqueous lahars are believed
to be similar to subaerial lahars (Fisher 1982b).
III. NOT RELATED TO CONTEMPORANEOUS
VOLCANIC ACTIVITY
Grain Size Classification Grain size limits of 1. Mobilization of loose tephra by rain
pyroclasts are comparable to the grain size limits or meltwater.
used by sedimentologists, as is shown in Figure 1.11. 2. Collapse of unstable clay- and
These size limits apply to autoclastic, pyroclastic, water-rich debris.
alloclastic, and hyaloclastic rocks, as well as to de 3. Bursting of dams from overloading.
bris flows. The terms for unimodal, well-sorted 4. From volcanoes or volcanic terrains
pyroclastic rocks (Figure 1.11; Schmid 1981) are de undergoing active weathering and
scribed below: erosion.

TABLE 1.3: COMPARISON OF OTHER COARSE-GRAINED DEPOSITS WITH LAHARS (AFTER FISHER 1982 b).
LAHARS TILL (EXCLUDING UNWELDED FLUVIAL
WATER-LAID TILL) IGNIMBRITE DEPOSITS
Large fragments May have boulders May have boulders Extremely large Extremely large
^2 mm) weighing many tons. weighing many tons. boulder absent. boulders rare.
Sorting Poor. May contain Poor. May contain Poor. Clay-size Poor. Clay-size
abundant clay-size abundant clay-size material rare or material sparse.
material. material. absent.
Grading Commonly reversed. Commonly absent. Commonly Commonly
May be normal or absent, but may normal.
absent. be normal or
reverse.
Bedding and Commonly very thick Very thick. No bedding. Commonly very Thin with
thickness with vague internal thick with vague channels and
bedding. internal layering. crossbeds.
Composition Commonly 100 07o Commonly heterolithic Pyroclastic. May Material usually
volcanic. May be and mostly contain abundant 100 07o epiclastic.
pyroclastic or mixed non-volcanic materials. breadcrust
with epiclastic Epiclastic bombs.
materials. May contain
breadcrust bombs.
Round ing of Commonly angular to Commonly subangular Commonly Commonly
large fragments subangular. to subrounded. May be subangular. subrounded to
faceted. rounded.
Pumice Common in some Not present. Common. Not present.
lahars.
Lower surfaces Commonly not Commonly erosional. Commonly not Erosional.
erosional erosional.

12
R.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

UNCONSOLI DATED DEPOSITS CONSOLIDATED


TABLE 1.4: SOME TYPES OF VOLCANIC
SIZE EPICLASTIC PYROCLASTIC
mm BRECCIAS (AFTER PARSONS 1969)._______
BOULDERS Coarse BLOCKS
O RC or BRECCIA I. Autoclastic volcanic breccias
COBBLE Fine BOMBS A. Friction breccias
1. Flow breccias, by autobrecciation
of lavas
LAPILLI - 2. Crumbling of plugs, domes, and
PEBBLE LAPILLI TUFF
spines
- 2 — B. Explosion breccias (disruption by gas
SAND Coarse Coarse
explosion)
- 1/16 TUFF
SILT ASH
II. Pyroclastic breccias
- 1/256- Fine Fine A. Vulcanian breccias: aerial ejection by
CLAY explosive eruption
1. Breccias by strombolian and
lava-fountain eruptions
B. Pyroclastic-flow breccias
Figure 1.11. Granulometric classification for un C. Hydrovolcanic breccias
imodal, well sorted pyroclastic rocks, both un 1. Breccias formed by phreatic
consolidated and consolidated. Terms for epi eruptions
clastic rocks are shown for comparison. 2. Laharic breccias (volcanic-mudflow
deposits)
3. Hyaloclastic breccias
(hyaloclastites)
D. Vent agglomerates and vent breccias
A pyroclastic breccia is a pyroclastic rock whose
average pyroclast size exceeds 64 mm and in which III. Alloclastic volcanic breccias
angular pyroclasts (blocks) predominate. If rounded, A. Intrusion breccia (caused by intrusion
aerodynamically shaped pyroclasts predominate of magma)
(Photo 1.1), then the rock is termed an agglomerate. B. Explosion breccias
Table 1.4 is a classification of pyroclastic breccias C. Intrusive breccias (show crosscutting
based on the type of fragmentation. relationships)
A lapilli-tuff is a pyroclastic rock whose average
pyroclast size is 2 to 65 mm. IV. Epiclastic volcanic breccias
A tuff is a pyroclastic rock whose average A. Laharic breccias (in part)
pyroclast size is ^ mm. B. Water-laid volcanic breccias
Polymodal or poorly sorted pyroclastic rocks con
taining pyroclasts of more than one dominant size
fraction can be named by using an appropriate com
bination of the terms which are given above, and are
also given in Figure 1.12 (Schmid 1981). For some (Figures 1.12 and 1.13), as will be discussed later in
field areas, additional subdivisions can be made, as more detail.
illustrated in Figure 1.13. Figure 1.13 represents a Fragment composition is also an important cri
modification of Fisher's (1966) classification, and teria in the classification of volcanic fragmental rocks
has been made consistent with the IUGS terminology. (Figures 1.12 and 1.13). Three sources of fragments
Boundaries between rock types are based on the may be found in volcanic fragmental rocks, as fol
ease of use in the field when detailed granulometric lows:
analysis is not possible. 1. essential or juvenile fragments: particles of cool
Terms for mixed pyroclastic-epiclastic rocks are ed magma
listed in Table 1.5. 2. accessory fragments: solidified volcanic rocks
from previous eruption
Fragment Composition and Shape Observation of 3 accidental fragments: broken solid country rock
fragment shape can give clues to the mechanism of
fragmentation and to the eruptive processes involved. In addition, the proportion of rock fragments to
Roundness classes used in sedimentary rock de crystals to glass shards can be used to classify tuffs
scriptions can also be applied to volcanic fragments. (Figure 1.12).
Bounding of vesicular and pumiceous fragments may,
however, occur very rapidly and with only minor Method of Emplacement Wright et al. (1980) pro
transport when compared to sedimentary environ posed a working classification for pyroclastic rocks
ments. The specific shapes of fragments, fine on the basis of depositional/eruptive mechanism.
shards, and crystals can all aid in understanding the This classification, unlike that of Schmid (1981) and
mode of formation of volcanic fragmental rocks Fisher (1966) is genetic in character, and hence,
cannot always be applied to Archean volcanic rocks.

13
CHAPTER 1

BLOCKS a BOMBS PUMICE,


GLASS

PYROCLASTIC
BRECCIA

CRYSTAL
TUFF
ASH

64-2mm c2mm CRYSTALS, ROCK


LAPILLI ASH CRYSTAL FRAGMENTS FRAGMENTS

Figure 1.12. Granulometric classification of pyroclastic deposits (left) and subdivision of tuffs and ashes
according to their fragmental composition (right).

BLOCKS 8 BOMBS Nevertheless, it has utility in understanding recent


^4 mm pyroclastic deposits, and in interpreting the mecha
nisms that may have produced Archean pyroclastic
deposits.
Wright et al. (1980), following Sparks and Walker
(1973), recognized three basic types of pyroclastic
deposits (see Figure 1.15, Table 1.6):
1. Pyroclastic Fall Deposits. These are produced
when material is explosively ejected from the
vent forming an eruption column. Fall deposits
show mantle bedding (Photo 1.1, Figure 1.14),
maintaining a uniform thickness over restricted
areas while draping all but the steepest topog
raphy. The deposits are generally well sorted.
Although Wright et al. (1980) only discussed air-
fall deposits, fall deposits may also form by
settling through water, either from a subaerial, or
a subaqueous eruption column.
64-2 mm ^ 2 mm 2. Pyroclastic Flow Deposits. Pyroclastic flows in
ASH
LAPILLI volve the lateral movement of pyroclasts as a
gravity-controlled, hot, high concentration
gas/solid dispersion (Wright et al. 1980). Depos
Figure 1.13. Granulometric classification for poly its are topographically controlled in high-aspect
modal volcanic fragmental rocks where a more ratio flows (average thickness versus horizontal
detailed classification than shown in Figure dimension, Walker 1983), and fill valleys and
1.12 is needed. (Adapted from Schmid 1981 depressions. In contrast to fall deposits these
and Fisher 1966). The term tuff- breccia would flows are poorly sorted. Low aspect-ratio flows
include lapilli- and ash-tuff breccia. are controlled by topography only in a minor way.
3. Surge Deposits. Pyroclastic surges involve the
lateral movement of pyroclasts as expanded, tur
bulent, low-concentration gas/solid dispersions
(Wright et al. 1980). Deposits mantle topography,
but accumulate in depressions (Figure 1.15).
Surge deposits are most commonly associated
with phreatomagmatic eruptions. Such deposits
are often thin, and near-vent; hence, in terms of

14
R.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

TABLE 1.5: TERMS FOR MIXED PYROCLASTIC-EPICLASTIC ROCKS (AFTER SCHMID 1981).

Pyroclastic Tuffites (Mixed Epiclastic Average Clast


Pyroclastic-Eplclastic) (Volcanic and/or Size (mm)
Nonvolcanic)
Agglomerate, agglutinate
pyroclastic breccia Tuffaceous conglomerate Conglomerate, 64
breccia
Lapilli-tuff Tuffaceous breccia
coarse Tuffaceous sandstone Sandstone 2
(Ash) tuff
fine Tuffaceous siltstone Siltstone 1/16
Tuffaceous mudstone, shale Mudstone, shale 1/256
IOQ-75% by volume Pyroc lasts 25-00/0
D-25% by volume Volcanic -t- nonvolcanic
epiclasts ^ minor amounts of
biogenic, chemical sedimentary
and authigenic constituents)

Photo 1.1. Structure and features in Archean and Proterozoic volcanic fragmental rocks, a) Aerodynamically
shaped bomb in coarse tuff to lapilli-tuff, Back River Complex, Archean age, Northwest Territories, b)
Bomb and bomb-sag in underlying stratified layers, Archean tuff, Rouyn-Noranda, Quebec, c) Eutaxitic
structure (flattened pumic) in a Proterozoic age, partly welded, ignimbrite, Great Bear Lake, Northwest
Territories, d) Large-scale stratification in lapilli-tuff and tuff-breccia, subaqueous pyroclastic flow and
fall deposits, Rouyn-Noranda, Quebec.

15
CHAPTER 1

plagioclase
u 7 welded
'oY/TvA glass
ift&S *hard
flattened
pumice

quartz

basalt hyaloclastite vitric welded crystal lithic


ash tuff tuff tuff tuff

Figure 1.14. Sketch showing characteristics of various pyroclastic rocks under the microscope. Field
Diameter is 2 mm. a) Sketch showing characteristic outlines of fragments in glassy basaltic ash
(magmatic origin). (After Macdonald 1972). b) Sketch showing characteristic outlines of fragments in
hyaloclastite (phreatomagmatic origin). (After Macdonald 1972). c) Vitric tuff from the unwelded top of
an ignimbrite. The tuff consists of angular glass shards, showing typical arcuate and forked forms, bits
of pumice, and crystals of quartz and feldspar. Fine dust matrix is not shown. (Modified from Macdonald
1972 and Williams et al. 1954). d) Welded tuff from base of ignimbrite is c). Constituents as in c), but
pumice and glass shards are deformed and flattened. Fine dust matrix is not shown. (Modified from
Williams et al. 1954). e) Crystal tuff consisting of broken crystal fragments of quartz, feldspar, and mafic
minerals. Accessory rock fragments are a minor component. Fine dust matrix is not shown. (Modified
from Williams et al. 1954). f) Lithic tuff containing a variety of accessory fragments, as well as broken
crystal fragments and glass shards. (After Williams e t al. 1954).

the Archean rock record, are uncommon relative


to fall and flow deposits.
Characteristics of the 3 main pyroclastic types
are listed in Table 1.6. Table 1.7 describes the types
of pyroclastic flows found in recent volcanic terrains;
Table 1.8 compares summary descriptions of the var
ious types of pyroclastic flow and surge deposits.
Figure 1.16 shows the classification scheme for
pyroclastic fall deposits proposed by Wright et al.
(1980). This scheme cannot be rigorously applied to
Archean terrains, although areally well distributed
rocks in Archean volcanic belts could be distin
guished in a rough way using this scheme.
In terms of classification, genetic interpretations
can best be indicated by a prefix, for example, "air-
fall tuff", "laharic ash-lapilli tuff", "vent agglomer
ate". Purely genetic terms, such as "hyaloclastite"
and "lahars" should only be used where the deposit
is well described. One man's "lahar" may be an
other's "phreatic breccia". This confusion in terminol
ogy can only be resolved by detailed rock descrip
tions (see next section and Table 1.9 for suggestions
on what should be included in such descriptions).
surge CRITERIA USED TO DISTINGUISH TYPES OF
VOLCANIC FRAGMENTAL ROCKS
Figure 1.15. The three main types of pyroclastic
deposit based on depositional mechanism, and In terms of potential utility in mapping and explora
their geometic relations with the underlying tion, it is not only necessary to be able to subdivide
topography. (After Wright et al. 1980). pyroclastic rocks into lithologic types, but it is neces-

16
R.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

TABLE 1.6: SOME CHARACTERISTICS OF THE 3 MAIN PYROCLASTIC DEPOSIT TYPES (AFTER WALKER
1981).

1. Pyroclastic fall deposits show: 3. Pyroclastic surge deposits show:


(a) mantle bedding (a) draping of topography
(b) good to moderate sorting (b) rapid and irregular or periodic thickness
(c) more or less exponential decrease in fluctuations
thickness and grain size with distance (c) general decrease in thickness and grain
from vent size with distance from source
(d) block impact structures (d) commonly erosional base
Exception - water-flushed ash may show (a) only, Two main types of pyroclastic surges occur:
but gives independent evidence for water flushing A - cold, damp or wet...base surges; deposits
(e.g. accretionary lapilli, vesicles). Fall deposits show:
can be sufficiently hot when they accumulate to
show primary welding near vent. (a) good internal stratification or
cross-stratification
2. Pyroclastic flow deposits show: (b) great grain size variations between
(a) ponding in depressions, with a nearly contiguous beds
level top surface (c) evidence for dampness (e.g. accretionary
(b) irregular thickness variation with distance lapilli, vesicles, plastering of up-vent side
from vent of obstacles)
(c) minimal sorting or internal stratification (d) association with vents in low-lying or
(d) evidence for being hot (e.g. welding, aqueous situations, or vents containing
pervasive thermal colouration) water (crater lakes)
Exception - low-aspect ratio ignimbrites include a B - hot, dry...surges of nuee ardente types;
mantling layer which passes laterally into the deposits show:
valley-pond ignimbrite.
Note 1 - ignimbrite can be defined as a pyroclastic (a) little or no internal stratification
flow deposit made mostly from pumiceous material (b) good sorting, depletion in fine or
(pumice, shards). lightweight particles (but these may occur
Note 2 - primary mudflows (lahars) resemble in an overlying fall deposit)
pyroclastic flow deposits but lack (d). (c) evidence for being hot
Exception - very similar deposits underlying
ignimbrite can be produced by sedimentation from
the pyroclastic flow.

sary to go one step further and speculate on the and 0 are determined in modern volcanic rocks
mode of emplacement and the genesis of the rocks through sieving. Naturally, this is not practical in
in question. Some criteria that can be used to sub Archean deposits. Mean grain size may be substi
divide pyroclastic rocks in the field are listed in tuted (Schmid 1981) and can be measured on the
Table 1.9. In Table 1.10, these criteria are tabulated outcrop. In addition, a qualitative estimate can be
in a form designed to show key characteristics of made on the outcrop of the size range in size of
various volcanic breccias. In many instances, a sin grains from the mean. Thus, with appropriate modi
gle criterion may not be diagnostic, but several cri fication, Figure 1.18 can be adopted for use in Ar
teria may allow for distinction between various brec chean volcanic terrains. Fox (1977) has proposed
cia types. What follows is a brief discussion of how that a measurement of the ten largest fragments in
the criteria listed in Table 1.9 can be applied. Exam volcanic breccias can be a useful measure to trace
ples are also provided. Some of the factors listed in very rapidly lateral grain size variations in pyroclastic
Table 1.9 are the same factors used for rock clas breccias. In addition, lahars differ in grain- size dis
sification. tribution compared to pyroclastic flows, in this case,
ignimbrites (Figure 1.18).
Grain Size
In addition to its use in rock classification, as shown Fragment Type
in Figure 1.11, grain size can be used to classify Fragment type is also an important criterion for sub
pyroclastic rocks as to mode of emplacement. In dividing volcanic breccias, as it is in subdividing
Figure 1.17, pyroclastic fall deposits generally have a tuffs (see Figure 1.12). Important features to look for
lower Md0 (medium grain diameter), that is, the de are pumice and glass shards. Abundant pumice and
posits are finer grained, and have a lower 0 glass shards indicate that the deposit is an ignimbrite
(deviation from median), that is, the deposits are or pyroclastic flow if the deposit is poorly sorted. If
better sorted, than pyroclastic flow deposits. the deposit is well sorted, it is probably a fall deposit.

17
CHAPTER 1

TABLE 1.7: TYPES OF PYROCLASTIC FLOWS (MODIFIED FROM SELF 19823).


ESSENTIAL FRAGMENTS ERUPTIVE MECHANISM PYROCLASTIC FLOW DEPOSIT
VESICULATED

PUMICE FLOW- - IGNIMBRITE,


PUMICE, AND
ASH DEPOSIT

ERUPTION COLUMN
COLLAPSE

'SCORIA FLOW- - SCORIA AND


ASH DEPOSIT

Decreasing
average density
of juvenile clasts

.EXPLOSIVE-LAVA- -BLOCK AND


DEBRIS FLOW ASH DEPOSIT
(NUEE ARDENTE)

LAVA/DOME COLLAPSE

GRAVITATIONAL-LAVA- -BLOCK AND


DEBRIS FLOW ASH DEPOSIT
(NUEE ARDENTE)
NON-VESICULATED

Both pumice and shards can be observed with a basaltic material is most likely to be a strombolian or
hand lens (see Photo 1.1), or under the microscope a hyaloclastite deposit (Photo 1.3). The presence of
(see Figure 1.14). Pumice in ignimbrites is often flat broken pillow rinds in addition would favour the latter
tened due to post-emplacement compaction, or weld (Photo 1.3). A heterolithic breccia, a breccia in which
ing, or both, and deformation (see Photo 1.1). the fragments have a differing composition, mineral
Other features include the presence of lithic frag ogy, texture, and colour, may be a phreatic breccia
ments, the proportion of lithic to other fragments, and (Photo 1.2), a lahar, or a pyroclastic flow. If pumice is
their variation vertically or laterally, or both, in the abundant, the latter is more likely. If there is no one
deposit. Some phreatic breccias may consist almost dominant fragment type, the breccia is most likely to
entirely of lithic fragments (Photo 1.2). If crystals and be a lahar (Fisher 1982b; Photo 1.2).
crystal fragments are abundant, then the deposit may
be an ignimbrite. Euhedral crystals may be more Fragment Shape
abundant in lava flows and domes than in ignim Phreatic and phreatomagmatic eruptions produce an
brites. The presence, or absence of a dominant frag gular fragments (Photo 1.3). Rounded fragments may
ment type may also be important. A monolithic brec indicate pyroclastic flow deposits (Photo 1.2), or re
cia is composed of fragments which have the same deposition. The variations in fragment shape are also
composition, mineralogy, texture, and colour. Such a
breccia consisting of glass fragments composed of

18
RM EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

TABLE 1.8: SUMMARY DESCRIPTIONS OF TYPES OF PYROCLASTIC FLOW AND SURGE DEPOSITS
(MODIFIED FROM SELF 1982a).
Deposit Description
FLOW
Ignimbrite Pumice Unsorted ash deposits containing variable amounts of rounded salic pumice
and Ash lapilli and blocks up to 1 m in diameter. The pumice fragments are generally
reversely graded, whereas the lithic clasts show normal grading.
The coarser smaller volume deposits usually form valley infills, whereas the
larger volume deposits may form large ignimbrite sheets. They may show 1 or
more zones of welding.
Scoria and Ash Topographically controlled, unsorted ash deposits containing basalt to andesite
vesicular lapilli and scoriaceous ropey surfaced clasts up to 1 m in diameter. In
some circumstances, they may contain large non-vesicular cognate lithic clasts.
Block and Ash Topographically controlled, unsorted ash deposit containing large, generally
non-vesicular, jointed, cognate lithic blocks which can exceed 5 m in diameter.
The deposits are usually reversely graded.
SURGE

Base Surge Stratified and laminated deposits containing juvenile vesiculated fragments
ranging from pumice to non-vesiculated cognate lithic clasts, ash, and crystals
with occassional accessory lithics (larger ballistic ones may show bomb sags
near-vent) and deposits produced in some phreatic eruptions which are
composed totally of accessory lithics. Juvenile fragments are usually OO cm in
diameter due to the high fragmentation caused by the water/magma
interaction. Deposits show unidirectional bedforms. Generally, they are
associated with maar volcanoes and tuff rings. When basaltic in composition,
they are usually altered to palagonite.
Ground Surge Generally -d m thick; composed of ash, juvenile vesiculated fragments,
crystals, and lithics in varying proportions depending on the parent pyroclastic
flow (or constituents in the eruption column in the case of those not associated
with a pyroclastic flow). Typically enriched in denser components (less well
vesiculate juvenile fragments, crystals, and lithics) compared to parent flow.
Again they show unidirectional bedforms.
Ash Cloud Surge Thin, stratified ash deposits found at the top of the flow units of pyroclastic
flows. They show unidirectional bedforms, pinch and swell structures and may
occur as discrete separated lenses. Composed of ash sized material;
proportions of components vary depending on the parent pyroclastic flow.

useful in distinguishing between pyroclastic deposits, loclastic breccias. Fall deposits are commonly well
as are shown in Figure 1.14 and Photo 1.3. sorted.

Welding Bedding/Stratification
Welding is mainly present in pyroclastic flows Bedding thickness terms applicable to tuffs are listed
(ignimbrites), and can occur in both subaqueous and in Table 1.11. For coarse breccias, no uniform terms
subaerial pyroclastic flows. In ignimbrites in which exist to describe the stratification of large-scale bed
welding is fully developed, three characteristic zones ding. Stratification does occur in some pyroclastic
are present. These are dense, partial and incipient, flows and lahars, and may be more prominent in the
and no welding (Smith 1960). Welding has been upper part of the deposit (see Photos 1.1 and 1.2).
reported in some near-vent, pyroclastic surge depos
its (Wright et al. 1980). Matrix
Sorting The nature of the matrix may vary considerably be
tween volcanic breccias (Photo 1.3). The same fac
As seen in the section on grain size and Figure 1.17, tors used to describe the entire deposit also apply to
the rock names are an expression of both fragment the matrix, the mean of and range in grain size,
sorting and size. Poorly sorted deposits are generally fragment type, and shape and sorting. Is the deposit
pyroclastic flows, lahars, and autoclastic and al matrix- or fragment-supported?

19
CHAPTER 1

100 l
SURTSEYAN l PHREATOPLINIAN
l " ULTRA- TABLE 1.9: CRITERIA FOR SUBDIVIDING
I PLINIAN
PYROCLASTIC ROCKS.
GRAIN SIZE - mean vs. range
50-
i0 S PLINIAN '
/l 7 FRAGMENT TYPE - glass pumice
S shards
STROMBOLIAN^^-'
HAWAIIAN _^-\—-''~\ SUB-PLINIAN
- lithic fragments
- crystals
0.05 5 500 50000 - dominant fragment type
D km 2 (if any)
FRAGMENT SHAPE
WELDING
Figure 1.16. Classification scheme of pyroclastic SORTING (may be affected by the depositional
fall deposits (after Wright et a/. 1980 and environment)
Walker 1973). F is weight percentage of de BEDDING/STRATIFICATION
posit finer than 1 mm on the axis of dispersal MATRIX - composition, size, proportion
where it is crossed by the 0.1 T max isopach, EXTENT OF DEPOSIT/RELATION TO ADJACENT
where T = thickness. D is the area enclosed ROCKS
by the 0.1 T max isopach. This scheme is not
readily adaptable to Archean terrains, although
widespread deposits, if not reworked, are prob
ably the result of Plinian or Ultra-Plinian erup
tions.
TABLE 1.10: SELECTED CHARACTERISTICS OF SOME COMMON BRECCIA TYPES.
-^>I2o MENT
PE
FRAG MENT
Sl- APE
FRAG ABUNDA MCE STRATIFIC 5 SORT ING WEL DING

Esacsecntz
esi,alory,
BRECCIA TYPE ~c
0 1
3
Monolithic Haccidental E a. g
Unstratif ed •o
T3
3 TJ
1
V
o
0) -o
1 T3 XI

s O"
1
0)
K |
S 2
tt LJ z I

AUTO CLASTIC
FLOW
BRECCIAS
BRECCIA
x x x -*
x X
x x *— -X
CRUMBLE BRECCIA
x x x x
—* x
x x x *—

PYROC LASTIC BRECCIAS

STROM BOLIAN
x x x X x x
VULCANIAN
BRECCIA x x X x x x
SUBAERIAL
ASH-FLOWS
x- x- -* x -* x x- X -x —*x
x X x x *— x ^—

SUBAQUEOUS
ASH- FLOWS
x- x- -* x -* x X" - x X x x x x -* x

PHREATOMAGMATIC X" x- -* x h4 X
x x x x x
PHREATIC
BRECCIA x x X x x x x
BASE-SURGE
DEPOSITS
x- x- ^ x -* x
x x x x x
HYALOCLASTITES
X x- 4 X x- x- x
-* x
x —* x -* x

ALLOCLASTIC BRECCIAS
x x- -) X
X x x x
EPICLA STIC BRECCIAS ~x x-
X f—— i-* X x- x- -x -x
-* x
x -* x x *— x*—

x x-
LAHARIC

TALUS BRECCIA
x X x x x x -* X

x - grade into - commonly presenl x - rare to uncommon

20
P.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

T7 field of ^
pyroclastic
flow deposits

x \x\ \\x\\ x\ xxx \x\\\\\\\\ \vx"s^


;field of pyroclastic fall deposits
X, X, \ X, \ \ X, •fX-'X \ "~. ":. \ X. \ X \ X X \ \ V X. V \ S \ \ s

4 6 Md 0
1/16 Md mm I28 2 l I/2 I/8 I/32 I/I28 I/5I2
Diameter in mm

Figure 1.17. Ma'0/0 (Median grain diameter vs.


deviation in grain diameter) plot showing the Figure 1.18. Grain-size distribution in ash-flows
fields of pyroclastic fall and flow deposits and lahars (after Schmincke 1974).
(after Walker 1971, 1973; Wright et al. 1980).
Note that pyroclastic flow deposits are coarse
(greater Mcty) and less sorted (greater 0j than
pyroclastic fall deposits. Mean grain diameter
(as measured on outcrop) and range in grain To cope with these problems, facies models de
size (as measured on outcrop) can be used for veloped for more youthful volcanic terrains, must be
Archean pyroclastic rocks, where MdQ/ti can investigated, and then these models should be ap
not be readily measured (Schmid 1981; Fox plied to Archean volcanic sequences. Facies analysis
1977; see text for further discussion). of modern and deformed volcanic rocks is still in its
infancy, and facies analysis in the Archean is just
beginning. In this section, the authors will review
what is known about volcanic facies, and suggest
how this knowledge may be applied to Archean vol
Facies and Extent of Deposit canic terrains. In the final section, the authors will
present some case examples of how volcanic facies
Facies is important because distance from the vent have been interpreted in the Superior Province of
will affect the degree of sorting, the size distribution, Ontario and Quebec, and how this information can be
and so on. In addition, the relationship of the deposit of use in mineral exploration.
in question to other rocks is important. For example, Firstly, a word of caution must be given. Facies
is the deposit part of a flow unit, or is it a flow unit in
itself? (see Figures 1.3 and 1.5). analysis involves an examination of the lateral and
vertical changes in a volcanic sequence, or a vol
canic deposit. As such, it requires a regional exami
Summary nation of outcrops, as well as detailed outcrop study.
The application of these criteria is illustrated in Fig Hence, it is not always possible to determine the
ure 1.19, which compares some of the more common volcanic facies for an area by examining only a few
breccia types. In Table 1.12, these criteria are used outcrops of limited areal extent. In addition, we must
to distinguish volcanic versus epiclastic rocks. face the basic problem of dealing with deformed
Many pyroclastic breccias can be subdivided on volcanic rocks, namely: deformation and metamor
the basis of origin and mode of emplacement by phism destroy delicate textures and structures; and
using the relatively straightforward criteria given analytical techniques used with unconsolidated or
above and those listed in Table 1.9. This information weakly consolidated deposits cannot be used with
can then be applied to the development of a facies metamorphosed pyroclastic deposits. Despite these
model for the area in question. This is elaborated on difficulties, knowledge of volcanic facies is critical
in the next section. when it comes to the interpretation of Archean vol
canic terrains.
VOLCANIC FACIES
Volcanic Facies
Introduction
Scale is an important consideration in regard to vol
One of the difficulties faced by geologists working in canic facies. The authors would apply different cri
Archean (and other Precambrian) volcanic terrains is teria in trying to understand the facies setting of a
the interpretation of the highly varied and discontinu large volcanic feature, such as a shield volcano
ous outcrops of volcanic rocks present in these re (Figure 1.20), a composite volcano (Figure 1.20), or a
gions. The original constructional volcanic landform smaller volcanic edifice such as a cinder cone ver
has long since been destroyed by erosion, and the sus a particular volcanic unit or units (for example,
normal rules applied to interpreting layered se Figures 1.3 and 1.5). We will start by examining
quences of rocks have only limited application in large-scale facies variations, and proceed to deposit-
volcanic terrains, as discussed by Trowell and Johns scale facies variations.
(Chapter 3, this volume), and Trowell (Chapter 2, this
volume).

21
CHAPTER 1

Photo 1.2. Pyroclastic breccias, a) Lahar, Back River Complex, Northwest Territories, Archean age. May be
derived from flow front of a lava dome. Dark fragments are epiclastic sediments. Most fragments are
lithologically similar to nearby rhyolite lava domes and flows, b) Phreatic breccia, Noranda, Quebec,
Archean age. Note angular fragment size, and overall monolithic character of this outcrop, c)
"Block-and-ash" flow sandwiched between an upper and lower air-fall pumice layer. Hammer is in
f'block-and-ash" flow. Older deposits of Mount St. Helens volcano, Washington, U.S.A. d) Subaqueous
pyroclastic flow, lower massive unit is shown, Wawa, Ontario, Archean in age.

22
P.M. EASTON AND G.W. JOHNS

Photo 1.3. Flow breccias and hyaloclastics. a) Broken pillow fragment in hyaloclastite matrix, Rouyn-
Noranda, Quebec, Archean in age. b) Disrupted rhyolite flow. Near border between massive and breccia
facies as shown in Figure 1.9. Rouyn-Noranda, Quebec, Archean in age. c) Flow breccia with matrix of
epiclastic, weakly laminated sediment. Back River Complex, Northwest Territories, Archean in age. d)
Basal flow breccia, consisting of hyaloclastite matrix and angular fragments. Large clast by hammer is a
clast from an adjacent breccia unit (top of underlying flows). Yellowknife, Northwest Territories, Archean
in age.

Volcanic Facies on a Regional Scale An example of rocks of any age, or for that matter, any edifice, can
facies variation on a regional scale is illustrated in be divided into 4 volcanic facies as shown in Figure
Figure 1.21, a schematic diagram of volcanic rock 1.22:
distribution in the Lesser Antilles volcanic arc in the 1. central or vent facies
Caribbean. A prevailing westerly wind direction
causes considerable lithologic differences to exist 2. proximal facies
between the western and the eastern basins. Air-fall 3. distal facies
and turbidity current-deposited rocks predominate in 4. epiclastic facies
the east, debris flow and pyroclastic flow deposits
dominate in the west. Similar sorts of facies variation The characteristics of each of these volcanic
might be expected in Archean basinal environments. facies will vary depending on the type of volcanic
Additional modern examples are described in Si- edifice in question. In the Archean, the two most
gurdsson (1982). common are probably the composite volcano shown
in Figure 1.22 and the shield volcano (Figure 1.23).
The characteristics of each facies zone for a central
Composite Volcano As discussed in the previous vent volcano are listed in Table 1.13. Important fea
section and in Ayres (1982, 1983), an island type tures of each volcanic facies are described below.
setting is a reasonable assumption to explain Ar
chean late volcanic sequences. Such volcanic se Central or Vent Facies (0.5 to 2 km from vent) Rocks
quences will develop composite, central vent volca from this facies are primarily depositional in origin,
noes, such as are shown in Figure 1.22. Volcanic and may consist of the deposit types listed in Table

23
CHAPTER l

PROXIMAL FACIES:
DEBRIS FLOW (lahar) PYROCLASTIC FLOW FLOW BRECCIA
.fluvial sedimentary
' structures uniform layering -^massive lava
crossbedding variable grain size .matrix:
r epiclastic,
variable grain size locally sorted,
coarse clasts stratified
coarser clasts are common
near base "^ sub-angular clasts,
fine ash layers monolithic
bread crust bomb vesicular fragments
layering variable clast -supported
breccia
lensoidal

coarser clasts
near base fine ash and pumice massive lava
^non-eroded base mantle topography
^fluvial volcanic at base
sediments
(preceeded
mud flow)

VENT FACIES:
PHREATIC BRECCIA AGGLOMERATE TALUS BRECCIA
(heterolithic breccia)

angular bomb sag pillowed


fragments stratified, cinders flow
fragment
lithic fragments
sand,
breccia, silt matrix
mainly layer of bombs, breccia
source rock partly agglomerate fragment
altered
fragment
unbrecciated sharp base
source rock underlying breccia

Figure 1.19. Schematic diagrams showing characteristics of some common volcanic fragmental rocks.

1.13. The important ones, with respect to massive avalanche and other large-scale slump deposits may
sulphides, are dikes, sills and domes, and the crum also be expected. Subaqueous pyroclastic flows, and
ble breccias or talus from domes. Phreatic breccias lava flows and domes and their attendant breccias
associated with the vent, or with the domes are also have the greatest mineral potential.
potential zones for mineralization. Salient features of Distal Facies (5 to 15km from the vent) Distal fa
phreatic breccias are given in Table 1.10 and Figure cies rocks can often be delineated by their greater
1.19. The two most prevalent aspects of central or lateral continuity. As in the proximal facies, these
vent facies are their bewildering structural and rocks may be the result of deposition, or, erosion and
lithologic diversity. redeposition. Again, they may be mapped as volcanic
Proximal Facies (2 to 15 km from the vent) Rocks or sedimentary depending on transport distance and
within this zone may be the result of primary deposi bias. Distal facies rocks tend to be finer grained,
tion or the result of secondary transport and re better sorted, and more distinctly bedded than rocks
deposition. The resultant deposit may be mapped as found in the proximal facies.
volcanic or sedimentary depending on the bias of the Epiclastic Facies (0.5 to 15km from vent) Epiclastic
observer, the distance travelled, and the degree of sediments also form in an active volcanic environ
reworking. Rocks from this facies which are deposi ment, and are intercalated with the volcanic deposits.
tional in origin are domes and flows with their atten These rocks include sheetwash fans related to flash-
dant breccias, air-fall tephra, pyroclastic flow depos floods in rapidly eroding volcanic terrains; perched
its, and subaqueous pyroclastic flow deposits. Re- ponds, volcanic moats, and other lacustrine deposits,
deposited rocks include debris flows (lahars), tur- and talus and landslide deposits. As such, they can
bidites, and subaqueous pyroclastic flows. Debris be classified as a separate facies. Their metallogenic

24
R.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

TABLE 1.11: BEDDING THICKNESS TERMS. STRATO-VOLCANO


COMPOUND VOLCANO
COMPLEX VOLCANO COMPOSITE VOLCANO
Thinly laminated ^.3 cm
Thickly laminated 0.3 to 1 cm
Very thinly bedded 1 to 3 cm
Thinly bedded 3 to 10 cm
Medium bedded 10 to 30 cm
Thickly bedded 30 to 100 cm (1 m)
Very thickly bedded 1 m to 3 m SHIELD VOLCANO
Extremely thickly bedded ^ m

A*^ o-o-o- o- o
j.0
*t-^.
^ ^ ^ ^
•PYROCLASTIC CONES'

TABLE 1.12: FIELD CRITERIA USED IN THE Figure 1.20. Types of volcanoes. Schematic pro
GREENSCHIST FACIES, TO DISTINGUISH files are vertically exaggerated by 2 to 1
BETWEEN FELSIC METATUFF, PORPHYRITIC (shaded) and 4 to 1 (dark). Relative sizes are
FELSIC FLOWS, AND POORLY BEDDED, only approximate. (After Simkin et at. 1981).
MUSCOVITE-BEARING METAGREYWACKE. MOST
OF THESE CRITERIA ARE MORE EASILY
RECOGNIZED ON WEATHERED SURFACES
THAN ON FRESH SURFACES (AFTER AYRES Caribbean
1969).___________________________ aoo-FT7!
ash-fall
FELSIC METATUFF
100- dispersed ash
pyroclastic gravity
1. Abundant sand-size, lenticular, felsic E53 flow deposits
fragments lavas and domes
Atlantic
Forearc
2. Rare sand-size, lenticular, mafic fragments 80-
*1 pyroclastic flows Region
3. Abundant angular, sand-size plagioclase
4. Rare sand-size quartz
5. Rare felsic metavolcanic lapilli
6. Abundant, wispy, very fine grained,
quartz - plagioclase - white mica matrix

PORPHYRITIC FELSIC FLOWS

1. Sand-size rock fragments absent


2. Rare metavolcanic lapilli
3. Subhedral to euhedral, locally oriented,
fine- to medium-grained, plagioclase
phenocrysts
4. Rare fine- to medium-grained, quartz
phenocrysts
5. Abundant very fine grained, locally
aphanitic, quartz-plagioclase-white mica
groundmass
MUSCOVITE-BEARING METAGREYWACKE

1. Rare visible, sand-size rock fragments


2. Abundant sand-size quartz
3. Abundant angular to rounded, sand-size
plagioclase
4. Sand-size quartz and plagioclase appear
to form an intact to slightly disrupted
framework; visible matrix is rare
5. Rare quartz, metachert, and felsic and Figure 1.21. Pyroclastic rock distribution in the
mafic metavolcanic pebbles western and the eastern Caribbean. (Adapted
from Sigurdsson et al. 1980).

25
CHAPTER 1

CENTRAL ZONE-

PROXIMAL ZONE epiclastic


rocks
dome
DISTAL ZONE dikes
.sills
mixture of lava
and pyroclastic flows
and air-fall deposits

epiclastic
rocks

volcanic' sediments subvolcanic


air-fall deposits," ' intrusions
debris flows,
pyroclastic flows POTENTIAL ZONE FOR COLLAPSE FEATURES^

Figure 1.22. Principal facies variation in volcanic rocks related to a large central vent composite volcano.
Central zone is also known as the vent facies. Epiclastic facies can occur in all three zones. Products of
each zone/facies are listed in Table 1.13. (Modified from Williams and McBirney 1979).

significance may be to serve as a caprock or an wackes and other epiclastic rocks will also occur in
aquifer for hydrothermal systems, and thus may be the upper part of the volcanic sequence. Shear
closely associated with ore in some instances. zones, possibly the remnant of syn-volcanic faults,
may also form in this zone.
Mafic Shield Volcano Shield volcanoes are probably Distal Facies (5 to 15km from the vent) As in the
the best analogy for the large, mafic volcanic piles proximal facies, pillow lavas will be the dominant
that constitute the bulk of the volcanic material pre rock type, but massive lava will be uncommon, and
sent in Archean "greenstone belts". There is prob both tube-fed and isolated pillow types will be pre
ably not a great deal of difference between the sent. Flow breccia and pillow breccia will also be
volcanic facies present in a subaerial (Figure 1.23a) more abundant. Tuffaceous material will be more
and a submarine shield (Figure 1.23b). Important fea common, and landslide and debris avalanche depos
tures of each facies are described below. its may also be present. Wackes and other epiclastic
Central or Vent Facies (0.5 to 2km from the rocks can be expected to be interdigitated with the
Vent) Rocks from this facies are primarily deposi distal flow rocks and breccias.
tional in origin, and may consist of the deposit types
listed in Table 1.14. The important ones with respect Volcanic Facies on a Deposit Scale Volcanic facies
to mineralization are found in the vent complex, an regimes can also be recognized in deposits from a
area of collapse features, talus cones, minor sub single eruption, either as lateral or vertical scale
aerial and submarine shields. Phreatic breccias and variations or both. As shown in Figure 1.24, the
phreatomagmatic deposits can also be expected in facies variations are the result of a change in trans
this facies. port mechanism and depositional mechanism with
Proximal Facies (2 to 15km from the vent) Rocks increasing distance from the vent. Figure 1.24 applies
within this zone are mainly the result of primary to both pyroclastic and epiclastic deposits. Fisher
deposition. In the Archean, subaerial lavas would be (1982a, 1982b) and Fisher and Schmincke (1984)
for the most part eroded, so pillow lavas will be the illustrated in greater detail, the nature of the flow
main rock type in this setting. Massive lavas will be mechanisms involved. Deposit scale variations can
abundant near the vent, with the pillowed lavas in also occur in both mafic and felsic composition
creasing in abundance as distance from the vent rocks, as outlined below.
increases. Flow thickness will generally decrease Felsic and Intermediate Pyroclastic Flows An exam
away from the vent. Subaqueous debris flows and ple of facies variation in a deposit from a single
tuffs will also be present. If another sediment source eruptive event is shown in Figure 1.3, which depicts
region is present adjacent to the shield volcano, a subaerial pyroclastic flow. The left-hand side of

26
RM EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

CENTRAL ZONE
PROXIMAL ZONE-
DISTAL ZONE
pahoehoe and aa flows
epiclastic rocks
mixture of phreatic ash, phreatomagmatic ash,
flow breccias, isolated pillows, and pillow breccia

landslide deposits

^^^
CX^
cZ?^
** subvolcanic
intrusions
^ - -V'-v- "'"^rr—^-^rr^TTI'Tx - xN T^T^^----^^^, , v u 'i^^\T:^7J~----...^|*' 4 , iT w-* *A V
isolated and tube-fed' pillows,\,'';-\-;M'7s ' ^,X\ ^(,x V massive lava', megapillowsTj*. '*-^* ^ * 4 ,T 7.

X-V^J^M^^^ICQ isi-7^frTc^iy^^r" e"t' ' ^^i^r^v^^v^'1 ^'^ iM^vN *^^4 ^ * * ^ ^ y JT"


pillow breccia, thin flows , \^S~^^L( -VV^VixT^C? x~ tube ~ fed Pi"ows,thick^ flows^ A ^^ " ^ \ *'f'-x/

phreatomagmatic
hyalotiiff

phreatic and
phreatomagmatic breccia

tube-fed pillows
pillow breccias^ i;
minor massive lavas
epiclastic rocks

subvolcanic
intrusions

Figure 1.23. Principal facies variation in volcanic rocks related to a large shield volcano. Central zone is
also known as the vent facies. Upper half shows a subaerial and a submarine volcano, lower half shows
a subaerial and a submarine volcano, lower half shows a submarine volcano. Model is based on
knowledge of Hawaiian-type shield volcanoes. Note, vertical exaggeration 2X, horizontal shortening, 5X.
Products of each zone are listed in Table L 14. Compare with Figure 1.22.

27
CHAPTER 1

TABLE 1.13: PRODUCTS ASSOCIATED WITH TABLE 1.14: PRODUCTS ASSOCIATED WITH
THE 4 MAIN VOLCANIC FACIES OF A THE MAIN VOLCANIC FACIES OF A MAFIC
CENTRAL VENT, COMPOSITE VOLCANO, AS SHIELD VOLCANO, AS SHOWN IN FIGURE
SHOWN IN FIGURE 1.22. (ADAPTED FROM 1.23.__________________________
WILLIAMS AND MCBIRNEY 1979).———————-
CENTRAL OR VENT FACIES
CENTRAL OR VENT FACIES (within 0.5 to 2 km of vent)
(within 0.5 to 2 km vent)
Depositional
- dikes, sills, subvolcanic
Depositional
- dikes, sills, and domes intrusions
- co-ignimbrite lag deposits - hydrothermal alteration related
- phreatomagmatic deposits to subvolcanic intrusions
________- talus breccia, megabreccia - alloclastic breccias
- phreatomagmatic and phreatic
PROXIMAL FACIES deposits
(up to 2 to 15 km from vent) - talus breccia, fault breccia,
caldera fill
Depositional
- air-fall deposits (tuffs) - thick flows in pit craters
- pyroclastic flows ________(subaerial only)_________
- subaqueous pyroclastic flows
- lava flows and domes PROXIMAL FACIES
Redeposited Recognizable as - lahars (up to 2 to 15 km from vent)
volcanic - pyroclastic
flows Depositional - air-fall deposits (tuffs)
- tuffs - thick-bedded lava flows, mainly
massive lava, minor pillow lava
Recognizable as - debris flows and pillow breccias, tube-fed
volcanic - arenites pillows
________sediments____- wackes^^^
Redeposited - Recognizable - subaqueous
DISTAL FACIES as volcanic debris flows
(more than 5 to 15 km from vent) - tuffs
-' Recognizable - debris flows
Depositional - air-fall deposits (tuffs) as volcanic - wackes
- pyroclastic flows sediments
- subaqueous pyroclastic flows
- lava flows DISTAL FACIES
Redeposited - Recognizable - lahars (more than 5 to 15 km from vent)
as volcanic - pyroclastic
flows Redeposited - air-fall deposits (tuffs)
- tuffs - thin-bedded tube-fed pillowed
lava and pillow breccia, isolated
- Recognizable - debris flows pillows
as volcanic - arenites - landslide and debris avalanche
sediments - wackes deposits
- siltstones
Recognizable as - subaqueous
EPICLASTIC FACIES volcanic debris flows
- tuffs
Redeposited - talus - Recognizable - debris flows
- debris flows as sedimentary - wackes
sediments - in crater lakes - siltstones and
(active, mudstones
extinct)
- perched ponds
- alluvial fans

28
P.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

SOURCE:
volcanic slopes,
deltas,
narrow shelves;
active faults

TURBIDIfY CURRENTS:
laminar, ijcjuilied, or
fluid i zed u n d er f f o w s
with turbulent
t

F/gure r.24. Conditions of initiation and types of subaqueous transport. Range of subaqueous transport
influences the type of deposits found in volcanic facies regime. Scale of figure ranges from Ws of m to
100s of km. (After Fisher 1982b).

ERUPTIVE EVENTS DEPOSITS

mudstone

turbidity currents,
fine ash,
minor pumice lapilli

pumice lapilli,
fine crystals

dense fragments,
large crystal
fragments

pumice fragments
in ash and
crystal matrix

lithic and
pumice fragments
fine ash

Figure 1.25. Schematic drawings of a submarine eruption producing subaqueous pyroclastic Hows, and
subsequent appearance of the deposits of such an eruption. A. Beginning of eruption. Vesiculating
magma is erupted into sea water. Some fine ash may be deposited near the vent. B. Climax of eruption.
Submarine columm carries much debris high into suspension. Sorting splits the debris into various
fractions. Buoyant pumice floats; dense fragments, large crystals, and compact pumice lapilli settle
around the vent, and are transported laterally in a subaqueous pyroclastic flow. Most ash remains in
suspension. C. End of eruption. Steady pyroclastic flow ceases as amount of erupted material decreases
and is replaced by turbidity current flow. Later turbidity currents contain finer and less dense has
settled from suspension. As shown in the right-hand side of the figure, an important characteristic of
subaqueous pyroclastic deposits are their doubly graded nature. Each bed is graded, and the beds at
the base of the sequence contain coarser and denser ash than the beds at the top of the sequence
(Modified from Fiske and Matsuda 1964 and Fiske 1969).

29
CHAPTER 1

PROXIMAL DISTAL
lava domes, lapilli-tuff, tuff,
lava flows, coarse tuff-breccia, doubly-graded beds,
/minor breccia f minor lava flows turbidites \

fine tuff -breccia, lapilli-tuff, tuff

Figure 1.26. Lateral facies variation in subaqueous pyroclastic flows. (Based on data from Fiske 1963, Fiske
and Matsuda 1964).

Figure 1.27. Structure


Tuff sequences of
subaqueous pyroclastic
flows. See text for
details. (Modified from
Tasse e t at. 1978 and
--- Dimroth and Rocheleau
1979).

Debris Flow Deposits Turbidity Flow Deposits

IVa
Tuff

Lapilli
and
Ash
O

Figure 1.3 shows the model developed by Sparks et prominent, and the upper laminated deposits are
a/. (1973) for pyroclastic flows, and the right-hand more commonly emplaced as turbidity currents
side shows a section through the central part of the (Figures 1.25, 1.26). Smaller eruptive events would
deposit. mainly form graded, laminated deposits in the proxi
More relevant to the Archean would be a model mal environment. In a larger eruption, graded, lami
for subaqueous pyroclastic flows, such as the one nated deposits would occur farther from the vent
developed by Fiske and Matsuda (1964). Key fea (that is, in a more distal environment).
tures of their model are illustrated in Figure 1.25, and As discussed by Dimroth and Rocheleau (1979)
include a massive lower part, which fines upward in and Tasse et a/. (1978), subaqueous pyroclastic
terms of non-vesicular material, and an upper lami flows commonly show diagnostic structure se
nated part, which also fines upward. Reverse grading quences (Figure 1.27; Walker 1976). Walker (1976)
is common in some beds due to flotation of pumice interpreted sequence l (disorganized bed) as debris
(vesicular). The two units are often referred to as a flow deposits, and structures III and IV (normal grad
doubly graded sequence, and they have been recog ed bedding) as turbidites. Reversed graded bedding
nized in the Archean, for example, in the Skead is the result of shearing during deposition. Proximal-
Group as discussed in the next section. With increas distal changes noted by Tasse et at. (1978) are as
ing distance from the vent, bedding becomes more follows:

30
P.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

1. Bed thickness and grain size decrease away


from the source.
2. The number of disorganized beds and beds with
reverse grading decreases away from the source.
3. The number of beds with normal grading in
creases away from the source.
4. The thickness of stratified upper divisions of
beds increases away from the source.
Mafic Flows A facies model for subaqueous mafic
flows on the flank of shield volcano is shown in
Figure 1.28 and is based on the work of Dimroth et
al. (1978, 1979) and Dimroth and Rocheleau (1979).
Near the vent, high flow rates result in the extrusion
of mainly massive lava. As distance from the vent
increases, large channel systems develop, and are
akin to tube-fed subaerial flows (Swanson 1973).
With a further increase in distance from the vent, the
lava channel forms tube-fed pillow lavas. Cross sec
tions of such a flow system are shown in Figure 1.5.
Figure 1.28. Facies model for subaqueous mafic
flows on the flank of a shield volcano, showing Environment Indicators One important aspect in the
proximal massive facies and distal pillowed fa assignment of volcanic facies, and in the application
cies. Cross sections of this facies regime are of the appropriate facies model is the determination
shown in Figure 1.5. (Modified from Dimroth of the depositional environment, that is, subaerial or
and Rocheleau 1979). subaqueous, and if the latter, what water depth is
involved. If this knowledge is available, constraints
can be placed not only on the type of deposits to be
expected in a particular facies, but also on the erup
tive processes that may have produced those depos
its. Figure 1.29 is an illustration of the various envi
ronmental indicators that can be used in the field,
and the constraints they place on the setting of
volcanic activity.

SUBAERIAL
PYROCLASTIC DEBRIS:
FLOWS

: ond ;i
PYROCLASTIC
FALL BRECCIAS

VARIOLES*
SUBAQUEOUS
{non-1 mm isc i bte,
t*P*);M
VARIOLES
; immiscible!

Figure 1.29. Environment of formation of volcanic breccias and specific lava flow features (water depth
figures only approximate).

31
CHAPTER 1

Cobalt Group,
Gowganda Formation

Tuff, Lapilli-Tuff,
Lapilli Ash Tuff

Tuff-Breccia,
Pyroclastic Breccia
Pyroclastic Breccia,
Tuff-Breccia
Quartz-Feldspar
Porphyry (subvolcanic)

Mafic Flows

geological contact
fault

Figure 1.30. Distribution of the pyroclastic rocks of the Skead Group in southern Bryce and Tudhope
Townships (from Figure 13 in Johns 1983). See Figure 1.31 for distribution of volcanic facies.

Summary The various models that exist for volcanic Township) and have been described by Johns
regimes that seem most applicable, or have been (1983). Figure 1.30 is a map of the generalized dis
previously applied to Archean volcanic rocks have tribution of the pyroclastic rocks. Figure 1.31 is an
been outlined in this section. Volcanic facies analysis interpretation of the facies distribution of the rocks
in Archean terrains is still in its infancy, and improve shown in Figure 1.30. Both figures are based on
ments will undoubtedly be made on the models pre information collected in 1980 (Johns e t a/. 1981). The
sented here. In the next section, the authors illustrate geological units shown in Figure 1.30 are based on
the use of volcanic facies information in mapping the major pyroclastic type present in each unit. Finer
Archean sequences, and its role in mineral explora or coarser material may also be present in associ
tion. ation with the main rock type.
All the pyroclastic rocks shown within the facies
CASE STUDIES boundaries (Figure 1.31) are genetically related, as
many outcrops contain multiple pyroclastic rock types
MAPPING OF PYROCLASTIC SEQUENCES AND gradational into one another. The coarser, unsorted
IDENTIFICATION OF VOLCANIC FACIES pyroclastic rocks grade into finer unsorted pyroclastic
The next two examples illustrate how the principles rocks. Sharp contacts have been observed and finer
outlined in the previous sections can be applied to grained beds pinch out along strike.
actual rock sequences in the Archean of the Superior The greatest abundance of coarse pyroclastic
Province. In both examples, one of the authors (G.W. rocks is in the vicinity of Heather Lake (Figure 1.30)
Johns) has mapped a pyroclastic accumulation at a where a 700 m thick amoeboid-shaped deposit com
scale of 1 inch to 1/4 mile with the Ontario Geologi posed of predominantly pyroclastic breccia is 2500 m
cal Survey, and subsequently has assigned the long and grades laterally and vertically into predomi
pyroclastic rocks to a volcanic facies setting. nantly tuff-breccia. These pyroclastic breccias are
poorly to moderately sorted and include both clast-
Example 1 - Skead Group, Abitibi Subprovince and matrix- supported parts. Mafic and intermediate
The Skead Group pyroclastic rocks lie within the to felsic clasts are round to angular and many have
Abitibi Subprovince in the vicinity of Elk Lake (Bryce bleached reaction rims. Essential clasts include

32
RM EASTON AND G.W. JOHNS

Cobalt Group,
Gowganda
Formation

Quartz-Feldspar
Porphyry
:: (subvolcanic)

Mafic Flows

Vent Facies

Proximal Facies

EE Distal Facies
T^LO ZrZ miles~-EZ 1/2 ^^^^^^. 1Z

Figure 1.31. Distribution of volcanic facies of the pyroclastic rocks of the Skead Group in southern Bryce
and Tudhope Townships.

clasts consisting of quartz-feldspar porphyry, similar contain subangular to subround clasts of feldspar-
to the body stratigraphically below the breccias phyric tuff, hornblende porphyry, pumice, vesiculated
(Figure 1.30). Accessory material includes lithic mafic material, and ribbed mafic bombs. The matrix
clasts of tuff, lapilli-tuff, and lapilli-tuff-breccia. The is composed of euhedral and broken crystal ash and
matrix composed of lithic and crystal ash and lapilli, lithic ash and lapilli.
is generally more mafic in composition than the These deposits are composed of both essential
clasts. and accessory clasts. These rocks were deposited in
In the immediate vicinity of Heather Lake, the the near proximal volcanic environment (Figure 1.31).
pyroclastic breccia is very coarse, angular, very poor The massive poorly to indistinct bedding and the
ly sorted, unbedded, and heterolithic. Away from gradation with other pyroclastic deposits was due to
Heather Lake, the pyroclastic breccia deposit be rapid, continuous deposition from phreatic magmatic
comes finer, contains more subangular fragments, eruption of varying magnitude. These deposits were
and forms thick indistinct beds. This assemblage emplaced as subaqueous debris flows as is shown in
also contains fine epiclastic material gradational into Figure 1.25b.
the pyroclastic breccia. Sharp contacts between the Lapilli-tuff is interbedded or is in gradational con
individual pyroclastic deposits are not common. tact with the coarser pryroclastic rocks. Lithic clasts
These very coarse, chaotic pyroclastic breccias are rounded to subrounded feldspar porphyry, pum
are vent facies deposits (Figure 1.31). The lack of ice, and mafic volcanic material. The matrix is com
stratification is the result of deposition from phreatic posed of ash-sized feldspar and pyroxene crystals,
eruptions and rapid, direct deposition. The heat lithic fragments, and amygdaloidal and globular al
source giving rise to these phreatic explosions was tered glass. Lapilli-ash tuff, a chaotic assemblage of
the quartz-feldspar porphyry stratigraphically below lapilli, ash, and minor blocks is interbedded with tuff,
the deposit. lapilli-tuff, and tuff-breccia.
Tuff-breccia, composed of a massive, thick- These deposits, composed of essential and ac
bedded, chaotic assemblage laterally interdigitates cessory clasts, were emplaced in a proximal environ
with and immediately overlies the pyroclastic breccia. ment by phreatomagmatic eruptions. Deposition was
These rocks are poorly sorted, matrix-supported, and rapid and continuous as subaqueous debris flows.
33
CHAPTER 1

OLDER UNITS BERRY RIVER FORMATION VOLCANIC FACIES


OF THE BERRY RIVER FORMATION
Point Bay Group Quartz-Feldspar Porphyry
Vent Facies cs^
^ Diabase Dike
Long Bay - Lobstick Bay Area
Warclub Group Proximal Deposition — ~- fault
Eastern Lake of the Woods
Distal Deposition ——— lithologic contact
Snake Bay Formation
Distal Redeposition 1 — stratigraphic contact
Granitoids Epiclastic Facies ........ f ac i es boundary

Figure 1.32. Volcanic facies of the Berry River formation, eastern Lake of the Woods. See text for further
details.

The irregularly shaped quartz-feldspar porphyry Example 2 - Berry River formation, Wabigoon
intrusion stratigraphically below the proximal facies Subprovince
deposits (Figure 1.31) has sharp contacts. Metamor The Skead Group pyroclastic rocks discussed above
phosed fragments of the pyroclastic host rock are are relatively undeformed, and hence are relatively
found within the porphyry as incorporated blocks easy to interpret compared to most Archean exam
which have indistinct boundaries. This intrusion is ples. It is still possible, however, to assign facies
envisaged to be, in part, a high-level magma cham settings to more severely deformed pyroclastic rocks
ber. by cautiously applying similar principles. The facies
The majority of the finer pyroclastic material contacts may not be as precisely located, but work
northwest of Heather Lake (Figure 1.30) occurs in the ing hypotheses can be developed.
stratigraphically lower part of the sequence. These Mapping of the deformed metavolcanic rocks in
rocks are generally fine grained and have sharper the eastern part of the Lake of the Woods has di
contacts than in the southeastern part of the area. vided the pyroclastic rocks of the Berry River forma
These rocks are interpreted to occur in the distal tion into volcanic facies (Figure 1.32). The Berry River
facies (Figure 1.31). They were emplaced as formation is a 2713.9 Ma year old (Davis and Ed
pyroclastic flows similar to those described by Fiske wards 1982) intermediate to felsic metavolcanic com
(1963). Dimroth and Rocheleau (1979) described plex consisting of quartz-feldspar porphyry and
similar rocks from the Noranda-Rouyn area of Que pyroclastic rocks with minor interbedded sedimentary
bec. Under their classification, the distal facies units rocks. The stratigraphic setting of the Berry River
are turbidity flow deposits (see Figure 1.27). The formation within the western Wabigoon Subprovince
source area for these deposits is not known. is described by Trowell and Johns (Chapter 3, this
Figure 1.26 is an idealized cross section of the volume). In brief, it is a predominantly pyroclastic
Ohanapecosh Formation in Washington, U.S.A. (Fiske complex within the Warclub group of metasedimen-
1963), and shows some similarity with the distribution tary and metavolcanic rocks.
of the pyroclastic rocks as seen in Figure 1.30. The Two ages or events of intermediate to felsic
general model for the pyroclastic rocks in the vent or pyroclastic volcanism appear to have built the Berry
proximal facies (Figure 1.31) may be similar to that River formation. The distal depositional and the distal
proposed by Fiske (1963) for the Ohanapecosh For redeposition facies are the products of the older
mation. event. The quartz-feldspar porphyry, vent facies, and
proximal deposition facies are the result of the youn
ger event.

34
RM EASTON AND G.W. JOHNS

Between the northeastern shore of Long Bay and tuff occur within the homoiolithic sequence. The
the diabase dike (Figure 1.32), the pyroclastic rocks pyroclastic units are matrix- to clast-supported, and
of the distal deposition facies overlie the Warclub poor to well bedded. Some of the beds have char
group with a slight unconformity. These rocks vary acteristics similar to the model developed by Wright
from pyroclastic breccias to tuffs. Tuff and lapilli-ash et at. (1981) and Sparks ef a/. (1973) for subaerial
tuff predominate, with tuff-breccia the next dominant pyroclastic flows (Figure 1.3). Clastic horizons are
rock type, and pyroclastic breccia the least abundant. bounded by thin fine-grained tuff zones, which could
Clasts are felsic to intermediate in composition, are be ground surge or cloud surge deposits, or both.
equigranular, subrounded to subangular, and matrix- Many depositional features seen in this facies cannot
supported. Individual units are distinct and range be explained by debris flow emplacement and may
from very thickly to very thinly bedded. Many of the have a primary depositional origin.
bedded units exhibit double-grading similar to those If the vent facies porphyry is a volcanic dome
shown on the right-hand side of Figure 1.25. These and the lateral porphyry a flow, then explosive activ
beds were deposited by subaqueous debris flows, ity from the end of the flow would account for the
resulting from a volcanic process similar to the one proximal deposition facies rocks in Long Bay. Rose et
proposed by Fiske and Matsuda (1964) and shown al. (1976) have documented explosive activity from
on the left-hand side of Figure 1.25. Fine-grained, andesite flow fronts on the flank of the endogenous
thin-bedded metasediments are found interbedded dome at Santiaquito in Guatemala.
with the pyroclastic rocks. The source of these
pyroclastic rocks was to the east, perhaps in the area Epiclastic rocks that may or may not be directly
where the Kishquabik Lake Stock is presently lo associated with the Berry River formation are found
cated. west of Mist Inlet. These well bedded wackes, many
of which exhibit good Bouma Sequences (Bouma
Associated with these distal deposited 1962), are more quartz-rich than the other wackes of
pyroclastic rocks are the laterally interdigitated rocks the Warclub group. Rounded quartz grains are slightly
classed as distal redeposited. These overlie and are larger than the associated plagioclase feldspar and
infolded with the Warclub group. Generally, these lithic grains in these wackes. These quartz-rich wac
rocks are finer than the distal deposited pyroclastic kes may be the distal equivalent of reworked debris
rocks, and tuff and lapilli-ash tuff predominate. Dou flows and volcanic debris flows of the Berry River
bly graded beds are not common, but normal grading formation that were deposited by turbidity currents.
does occur. In the vicinity of Mist Inlet, wacke inter
bedded on an outcrop scale with redeposited VOLCANIC FACIES AND KNOWN MASSIVE-SULPHIDE
pyroclastic rocks is common. The clasts within the DEPOSITS
pyroclastic rocks are subrounded to subangular and
heterolithic. Clasts of wacke are found within some The previous two examples of Archean volcanolog-
of the pyroclastic beds. Scouring of the underlying ical facies are of rocks containing no known
beds has also been noted. This facies consists of massive-sulphide deposits. The potential for base-
reworked and redeposited pyroclasts from the afore metal mineralization in Bryce Township is high, and
mentioned proximal deposition facies. there is also potential at the eastern end of the Berry
The younger sequence of pyroclastic rocks of River formation.
the Berry River formation overlie the two previous Examples of known massive-sulphide deposits in
facies (Figure 1.32). If there is a hiatus present, the the Noranda area of Quebec can be recognized with
length of time involved is not known. in a particular volcanic facies. The Millenbach and
The vent facies rocks found southeast of Berry Corbet Mines are 8 km north of the city of Rouyn-
Lake consist primarily of an ovoid quartz-feldspar Noranda, Quebec. The Millenbach Mine is associated
porphyry body containing xenoliths and large rafts of with subaqueous quartz-feldspar porphyry bodies
pyroclastic material. Parts of the porphyry are mas and the Corbet Mine is related to coarse phreatic
sive, but others are subtly clastic or brecciated. The breccia in mafic metavolcanics. Both deposits are in
porphyry has a distinctive lithologic type with a vent facies environment.
phenocrysts of rounded white and blue quartz and
smaller euhedral sericitized feldspar in a very fine The Millenbach Deposit
grained to crystalline matrix. This porphyry may in The Millenbach deposit consists of 15 massive-
part be a high-level subvolcanic intrusion, and in part sulphide lenses located on and around a quartz-
an extrusive lava dome. The relationships in the area feldspar porphyry (Knuckey, Comba, and Riverin
are very complex. 1982). The quartz-feldspar porphyry was extruded
A linear body of similar quartz-feldspar porphyry from three or more vents along a northeast-trending
which may be in part, extrusive, can be traced from feeder system (Comba and Gibson 1983). It was
Lobstick Bay west to Long Bay (Figure 1.32). extruded endogenously and as flow lobes over a
South of the linear porphyry body, along the length of 2 km. The thickest parts of the porphyry
northern shore of Lobstick Bay and within the eastern body are over the main vents (Comba and Gibson
end of Long Bay, proximal deposited pyroclastic 1983).
rocks occur (Figure 1.32). These rocks are generally The Millenbach volcano cosisted of an upper and
coarse, clastic, and homoiolithic with the main clast lower part known as the upper QFP and the lower
type being an angular to subangular quartz-feldspar QFP, as shown in Figure 1.36 from the paper by
porphyry that is lithologically similar to the porphyry Knuckey, Comba, and Riverin (1982). The lower QFP
bodies. Beds of mafic pumice-bearing, fine-grained was extruded on the thin Millenbach andesite which

35
CHAPTER 1

FELDSPAR L"a"J FLAVRIAN


PORPHYRY DYKE LVJ VOLCANICLASTIC MASSIVE SULPHIDE

Q F P MASSIVE
DIORITE
SULPHIDE l l FLAVRIAN STRINGER SULPHIDE
FELSIC DYKE |___l ANDESITE
MILLENBACH STRINGER
FELSIC DYKE NW
ANDESITE SULPHIDE V/fy MASSIVE MAGNETITE 'ORE OUTLINE
RHYOLITE

AMULET AMULET
DALMATIANITE
ANDESITE RHYOLITE

FAULT Figure 1.34. Geology through the Corbet Mine,


looking north along section 800 N. (From Knuc
key and Watkins 1982, Figure 1).
Figure 1.33. Geology of the Millenbach deposit,
looking northeast along a northwest-southwest
section. (From Knuckey e t a l. 1982, Figure 6).
Mine. The breccia (Flavrian volcaniclastic, Figure
1.34) is composed of in-situ flow breccia grading to
highly vesiculated andesite debris consisting of un
overlies the Amulet Rhyolite (Figure 1.33). The lower sorted, angular to subangular fragments set in a
QFP formed a hummocky ridge 760 m by 300m and microbreccia matrix. Locally, there is a weak layering
up to 110m thick. The main orebody was deposited and occasional grading. This debris locally reaches
on the upper surface of the lower QFP together with thicknesses of up to 100 m. Clasts composed of new
a local cherty horizon (Knuckey, Comba, and Riverin magma are not found within this breccia (Knuckey
1982). The upper QFP may have been coeval or and Watkins 1982). This breccia is probably a
slightly younger and was extruded to the northwest phreatic breccia.
of the lower QFP and locally overlapped it. A small A roughly concordant quartz-diorite sill stratig-
lens of massive sulphide was deposited on top of the raphically below the orebodies has domed the
upper QFP in an area of constant hot spring activity Flavrian andesites. This sill was intruded syn-
just northwest of the main centre. A local cherty volcanically and acted as a heat source to circulate
exhalite is associated with these sulphides. hydrothermal fluids (Knuckey and Watkins 1982). Ini
Deep-seated northeast-trending syn-volcanic tial heat required for the formation of the phreatic
faults controlled the quartz- feldspar porphyry (QFP) breccias would likely have come from rising magma
volcanism and the ore-forming hydrothermal solu forming the mafic flows. During formation of the
tions. Breccia associated with the extrusive QFP is massive- sulphide lenses, the overlying mafic flows
not believed to be phreatic, but rather the result of encrusted the active vent resulting in the formation of
syn-volcanic slumping (Comba and Gibson 1983). smaller sulphide lenses above the main body
(Knuckey and Watkins 1982; Figure 1.34).
The Corbet Mine
Although phreatic breccias are not associated with DISCUSSION
the Millenbach Mine, they are related to mineraliza These two examples show that volcanogenic
tion at the Corbet Mine. This mine is 1000 m lower in massive-sulphide deposits occur in both felsic to
the Noranda area stratigraphy than the Millenbach intermediate and mafic metavolcanic environments.
Mine. The Corbet Mine is located within the top Sulphide horizons tend to be localized over the dis
250 m of the Flavrian andesite, as shown in Figure charge vents of submarine hydrothermal systems,
1.34 from the paper by Knuckey and Watkins (1982). which are most likely in proximal and vent facies
Figure 1.34 is a section through a part of the Corbet environments. Subvolcanic intrusions are a significant

36
R.M. EASTON AND G.W. JOHNS

TABLE 1.15: EXPLORATION CRITERIA FOR ARCHEAN VOLCANOGENIC MASSIVE-SULPHIDE DEPOSITS.


EXPLORATION CRITERIA

REQUIREMENT OF MODEL GENERAL SPECIFIC VOLCANIC FACIES


Heat - near surface magma - volcanotectonic vent and/or proximal
depression
- exposed central intrusion
or underlying sill
- abundant dikes
Self-sealing cap rock - phreatic explosion - coarse lithic fragment vent
products breccia with altered
mineralized clasts
- evidence of relatively - vesicular, texturally proximal
shallow water K500 m) complex lavas, pyroclastic
rocks, hyaloclastite
Cross-stratigraphic synvolcanic faults - structures filled with vent and/or proximal
permeability synvolcanic dikes
- alignment of structurally vent to proximal
localized features, (eg.
domes, sulphide deposits,
dike swarms)
- alignment of rapid proximal
thickness of facies
changes in units (flows,
slump breccias, ponded
sediments)
- clastic sediments derived proximal to distal
from erosion of unstable
fault scarps, mud flow
breccia, conglomerate

feature, acting as a source of heat for the hydrother SUMMARY


mal systems, and possibly causing phreatic and Knowledge of volcanic facies is of potential use in
phreatomagmatic eruptions. Franklin et at. (1981) es mineral exploration, both in helping to understand
timated that the subvolcanic intusive body must have how orebodies are formed in volcanic terrains, and in
had a volume of several km3 in order to sustain a developing new techniques to explore for them.
hydrothermal circulation system large and long Knowledge of volcanic processes and volcanic rock
enough to form an orebody. classification are essential prerequistes to the study
Hodgson and Lydon (1977) have discussed vol of volcanic facies. The overview presented here
canogenic massive-sulphide deposits and their asso should not be taken as the final word, but rather as
ciation with active hydrothermal systems. These au an introduction to the rapidly developing field of
thors have outlined the exploration implications for activity applicable to Archean volcanism and ore-
such deposit types (Table 2 in Hodgson and Lydon genesis.
1977). Table 1.15 is adapted from their table, and is
an attempt to assign a facies concept to some of the ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
features they noted in their table.
The assignment of volcanic facies in the eastern This chapter has benefited greatly from an earlier
Lake of the Woods area (Figure 1.32) and the Skead review of volcanic rock classification for the Ontario
Group pyroclastic rocks (Figure 1.31) was made from Geological Survey prepared by Norm Trowell, Jim
data collected from 1:15840 scale mapping. Data Pirie, and Larry Jensen. The authors would also like
gathered from a single outcrop or small claim group to thank Barbara Moore, who drafted all figures
is generally not sufficient to permit accurate inter (except Figures 1.2, 1.4, 1.11, 1.18, 1.26, 1.33, and
pretation of a facies, and must be combined with all 1.34 and Photos 1.1, 1.2, and 1.3), for putting our
the information available from a region before mean ideas on paper so clearly and beautifully.
ingful trends can be established.

37
CHAPTER 1

REFERENCES Dimroth, E., Cousineau, P., Leduc, M., and Sanschag-


rin, Y.
AGI
1978: Structure and Organization of Archean Sub
1980: Glossary of Geology, Second Edition; American
aqueous Basalt Flows, Rouyn-Noranda Area, Que
Geological Institute, edited by R.L Bates and J.A.
bec, Canada; Canadian Journal of Earth Sci
Jackson, 751 p.
ences, Volume 15, p.902-918.
Ayres, L.D.
Dimroth, E., Cousineau, P., Leduc, M., Sanschagrin,
1969: Geology of the Muskrat Dam Lake Area; On
Y., and Provost, G.
tario Department of Mines, Geological Report 74,
1979: Flow Mechanisms of Archean Subaquesous
74p.
Basalt and Rhyolite Flows; p.207-211 in Current
1982: Pyroclastic Rocks in the Geologic Record;
Research, Part A, Geological Survey of Canada,
p. 1-17 in Pyroclastic Volcanism, edited by L.D.
Paper 79-1 A.
Ayres, Geological Association of Canada, Short
Course Notes, Volume 2. Dimroth, E., and Rocheleau, M.
1983: Bimodal Volcanism in Archean Greenstone 1979: Volcanology and Sedimentology of Rouyn-
Belts Exemplified by Greywacke Composition, Noranda Area. Quebec; Geological Association of
Lake Superior Park, Ontario; Canadian Journal of Canada, Field Trip Guidebook A-1, 199p.
Earth Sciences, Volume 20, p. 1168-1194. Fink, J.
Borradaile, G.J. 1980: Surface Folding and Viscosity of Rhyolite
1982: Technically Deformed Pillow Lavas as an In Flows; Geology, Volume 8, p.250-254.
dicator of Bedding and Way-Dp; Journal of Struc Fisher, R.V.
tural Geology, Volume 4, p.469-479. 1966: Rocks Composed of Volcanic Fragments and
Bouma, A.M. Their Classification; Earth Science Reviews, Vol
1962: Sedimentology of Some Flysch Deposits; El- ume 1, p.287-298.
sevier, Amsterdam, 168p. 1982a: Pyroclastic Flows; p. 111-131 in Pyroclastic
Volcanism, edited by L.D. Ayres, Geological As
Carstens, H.
sociation of Canada, Short Course Notes, Volume
1963: On Variolitic Structure; Norsk Geologisk Under-
2.
soekelse Arb, Volume 233 p.26-42.
1982b: Debris Flows and Lahars; p. 136-220 in
Christiansen, R.L, and Lipman, P.W. Pyroclastic Volcanism, edited by L.D. Ayres, Geo
1966: Emplacement and Thermal History of a Rhyolite logical Association of Canada, Short Course
Lava Flow near Fortymile Canyon, Southern Notes, Volume 2.
Nevada; Geological Society of America, Bulletin,
Fisher, R.V., and Schmincke, H-U.
Volume 77, p.671-684.
1984: Pyroclastic Rocks; Springer-Verlag, New York,
Comba, C.D.A., and Gibson, H.L 528p.
1983: Geology of the Millenbach Rhyolite Volcano,
Fiske, R.S.
Noranda, Quebec; Geological Association of
1963: Subaqueous Pyroclastic Flows in the
Canada, Abstracts with Programs, Volume 8,
Ohanapecosh Formation, Washington; Geological
p.A-13.
Society of America, Bulletin, Volume 74,
Crandell, D.R. p. 391-406.
1971: Postglacial Lahars from Mount Rainier Volcano, 1969: Recognition and Significance of Pumice in Ma
Washington; United States Geological Survey, rine Pyroclastic Rocks; Geological Society of
Professional Paper 677, p. 1-75. America, Bulletin, Volume 80, p. 1-8.
Davis, D.W., and Edwards, G.R. Fiske, R.S., and Matsuda, T.
1982: Zircon U-Pb Ages from the Kakagi Lake Area, 1964: Submarine Equivalents of Ash Flows in the
Wabigoon Subprovince, Northwest Ontario; Cana Tokiwa Formation, Japan; American Journal of
dian Journal of Earth Sciences, Volume 19, Science, Volume 262, p. 76-106.
p. 1235-1245.
Fox, J.S.
de Rosen-Spence, A., Provost, G., Dimroth, E., Goch- 1977: Rapid Pyroclastic Mapping in Base Metal Ex
nauer, K., and Owen, V. ploration; Canadian Institute of Mining and Metal
1980: Archean Subaqueous Felsic Flows, Rouyn- lurgy, Bulletin, Volume 70, Number 779,
Noranda, Quebec, Canada, and Their Quaternary p. 173-178
Equivalents; Precambrian Research, Volume 12,
Franklin, J.M., Lydon, J.W., and Sangster, D.F.
p.43-77.
1981: Volcanic-Associated Massive Sulphide Depos
Dimroth, E. its; p.485-627 in Seventy-Fifth Anniversary Vol
1977: Archean Subaqueous Autoclastic Volcanic ume, edited by B.J.Skinner, Economic Geology.
Rocks, Rouyn-Noranda Area, Quebec: Classifica
Furnes, H.
tion, Diagnosis, and Interpretation; p.513-522 in
1973: Variolitic Structure in Ordovician Pillow Lavas
Report of Activities, Part A, Geological Survey of
and Its Possible Significance as an Environmen
Canada, Paper 77-1 A.
tal Indicator; Geology, Volume 1, p.27-31.
Gelinas, L, Brooks, C., and Trzcienski, E.J.
1976: Archean Variolites-Quenched Immiscible Liq
uids; Canadian Journal of Earth Sciences, Vol
ume 13, p.210-231.

38
P.M. EASTON AND G. W. JOHNS

Harker, A. Moore, J.G., Cristofoline. R., and Lo Giudice, A.


1962: Petrology for Students, Eighth Edition; Cam 1971: Development of Pillows on the Submarine Ex
bridge University Press, 283p. tension of Recent Lava Flows, Mount Etna, Sicily;
Higgins, M.W. United States Geological Survey, Professional Pa
1971: Depth of Emplacement of James Run Formation per 750-C, P.C89-C97.
Pillow Basalts, and the Depth of Deposition of Moorhouse, W.W.
Part of the Wissakikon Formation, Appalachian 1959: The Study of Rocks in Thin Section; Harper and
Piedmont, Maryland; American Journal of Sci Row, New York, 514p.
ence, Volume 271, p.321-332. Newhall, C.G., and Melson, W.G.
Hodgson, C.J., and Lydon, J.W. 1983: Explosive Activity Associated with the Growth
1977: Geological Setting of Volcanogenic Massive- of Volcanic Domes; Journal of Volcanology and
Sulphide Deposits and Active Hydrothermal Sys Geothermal Research, Volume 17, p. 111-131.
tems: Some Implications for Exploration; Cana Parsons, W.H.
dian Institute of Mining and Metallurgy, Bulletin, 1969: Criteria for the Recognition of Volcanic Brec
Volume 70, Number 786, p.95-106. cias: A Review; p.263-304 in Igneous and Meta
Hughes, C.J. morphic Geology, edited by L. Larson. V. Manson,
1977: Archean Variolites-Quenched Immiscible Liq and M. Priur, Geological Society of America,
uids: Discussion; Canadian Journal of Earth Sci Memoir 115.
ences. Volume 14, p. 137-139. Philpotts, A.R.
Johns, G.W. 1977: Archean Variolites-Quenched Immiscible Liq
1983: Geology of the Hill Lake Area, District of uids: Discussion; Canadian Journal of Earth Sci
Timiskaming; Ontario Geological Survey, Open ences, Volume 14, p. 139-144.
File Report 5478, 222p. Rose, W.I., Pearson, W., and Bonis, S.
Johns, G.W., Hoyle, W., and Good, D. 1976: Nuee Ardente Eruption from the Foot of a
1981: Precambrian Geology of the Hill Lake Area, Dacite Lava Flow, Santiaquito Volcano, Guate
Bryce and Robillard Townships, District of mala; Bulletin Volcanologique, Volume 40-1,
Timiskaming; Ontario Geological Survey, Prelimi p.1-16.
nary Map P.2415, scale 1:15 840. Sangster, D.F.
Jones, V.G. 1972: Precambrian Volcanogenic Massive Sulphide
1969: Pillow Lavas as Depth Indicators; American Deposits in Canada: A Review; Geological Survey
Journal of Science, Volume 267, p. 181-195. of Canada, Paper 72-22, 42p.
Joplin, G.E. 1980: Quantitative Characteristics of Volcanogenic
1968: A Petrography of Australian Igneous Rocks; Massive Sulphide Deposits: l Metal Content and
Elsevier, New York, 214p. Size Distribution of Massive-Sulphide Deposits in
Volcanic Centres; Canadian Institute of Mining
Knuckey, M.J., Comba, C.D.A., and Riverin, G. and Metallurgy, Bulletin, Volume 73, Number 814,
1982: Structure, Metal Zoning and Alteration at the p. 74-81.
Millenbach Deposit, Noranda, Quebec; p.255-295
in Precambrian Sulphide Deposits, edited by R.W. Schmid, R.
Hutchinson, C.D. Spence, and J.M. Franklin, Geo 1981: Descriptive Nomenclature and Classification of
logical Association of Canada, Special Paper 25. Pyroclastic Deposits and Fragments: Recommen
dations of the IUGS Subcommission on the Sys
Knuckey. M.J., and Watkins, J.J. tematics of Igneous Rocks; Geology, Volume 9,
1982: The Geology of the Corbel Massive-Sulphide p.41-43.
Deposit, Noranda District, Quebec, Canada;
p.297-317 in Precambrian Sulphide Deposits, Schmincke, H-U.
edited by R.W. Hutchinson, C.D. Spence, and J.M. 1974: Pyroclastic Rocks; p. 160-190 in Sediments and
Franklin, Geological Association of Canada, Spe Sedimentary Rocks, edited by H. Fuchtbauer,
cial Paper 25. John Wiley and Sons, Inc., New York, p. 160-190
Lipman, P.W., and Mullineaux, D.R., Editors Self, S.
1981: The 1980 Eruptions of Mount St. Helens, Wash 1982a: Terminology and Classifications for Pyro
ington; United States Geological Survey, Profes clastic Deposits; p. 18-37 in Pyroclastic Vol
sional Paper 1250, 845p. canism, edited by L.D. Ayres, Geological Associ
ation of Canada, Short Course Notes, Volume 2.
Macdonald, G.A. 1982b: Processes and Mechanisms of Eruptions;
1972: Volcanoes; Prentice-Hall Inc., Englewood Cliffs, p.38-52 in Pyroclastic Volcanism, edited by L.D.
New Jersey, 51 Op. Ayres, Geological Association of Canada, Short
Melson, W.G., and Thompson, G. Course Notes, Volume 2.
1973: Glassy Abyssal Basalts, Atlantic Sea Floor near 1982c: Lava Flows and Domes; p.53-57 in Pyroclastic
St. Paul's Rocks; Petrography and Composition of Volcanism, edited by L.D. Ayres, Geological As
Secondary Clay Minerals; Geological Society of sociation of Canada, Short Course Notes, Volume
America, Bulletin, Volume 84, p.703-716. 2.
Moore, J.G.
1970: Water Content of Basalt Erupted on the Ocean
Floor; Contributions to Mineralogy and Petrology,
Volume 28, p.272-279.

39
CHAPTER 1

1982d: Nature of Subaerial Pyroclastic Deposits Walker, G.P.L


Based on a Facies Concept; p. 58-63 in 1971: Grain-Size Characteristics of Pyroclastic De
Pyroclastic Volcanism, edited by LD. Ayres. Geo posits; Journal of Geology, Volume 79, p.696-714.
logical Association of Canada, Short Course 1973: Explosive Volcanic Eruptions—A New Classifi
Notes, Volume 2. cation Scheme; Geologische Rundschau, Volume
Sharp, R.P., and Nobles, LH. 62, p.431-446.
1953: Mudflows of 1941 at Wrightwood, Southern 1981: Volcanological Applications of Pyroclastic Stud
California; Geological Society of America, Bul ies; p.391-403 in Tephra Studies, edited by S.
letin, Volume 64, p.547-560. Self and R.S.J. Sparks, D. Reidel, Holland.
1983: Ignimbrite Types and Ignimbrite Problems; Jour
Sigurdsson, H. nal of Volcanology and Geothermal Research,
1982: Volcanogenic Sediments in Island Arcs: Volume 17, p.65-88.
p.221-293 in Pyroclastic Volcanism, edited by
LD. Ayres, Geological Association of Canada, Walker, R.G.
Short Course Notes, Volume 2. 1976: Facies Models 2. Turbidites and Associated
Coarse Clastic Deposits; Geoscience Canada,
Sigurdsson, H., Sparks. R.S.J., Carey, S.N., and Volume 3, p.25-36.
Huang, T.C.
1980: Volcanogenic Sedimentation in the Lesser An Wells, G., Bryan, W.B., and Pearce, T.H.
tilles Arc; Journal of Geology, Volume 88, 1979: Comparative Morphology of Ancient and Mod
p.523-540. ern Pillow Lavas; Journal of Geology, Volume 87,
p. 427-440.
Simkin, T., Siebert, L, McClelland, L., Bridge, D.,
Newhall, C., and Latter, J.H. Williams, H., and McBirney, A.R.
1981: Volcanoes of the World; Hutchinson Ross Pub 1979: Volcanology; Freeman, Cooper and Co., San
lishing Company, Pennsylvania, 233p. Francisco, 397p.
Smith, R.L Williams, H., Turner, F.J., and Gilbert, C.M.
1960: Zones and Zonal Variations in Welded Ash- 1954: Petrography: An Introduction to the Study of
Flows; United States Geological Survey, Profes Rocks in Thin Section; W.H. Freeman, San Fran
sional Paper 354F, p. 149-159. cisco, 406p.
Sparks, R.S.J., Self., and Walker, G.P.L Wohletz, K.H., and Sheridan, M.F.
1973: Products of Ignimbrite Eruptions; Geology, Vol 1983: Hydrovolcanic Explosions II. Evolution of Basal
ume 1, p.115-118. tic Tuff Rings and Tuff Cones; American Journal
of Science, Volume 283, p.385-413.
Sparks, R.S.J., and Walker, G.P.L.
1973: The Ground Surge Deposit: A Third Type of Wright, A.E., and Bowes, D.R.
Pyroclastic Rock; Nature, Volume 241, p.63-64. 1963: Classification of Volcanic Breccias: A Discus
sion; Geological Society of America, Bulletin, Vol
Swanson, D.A. ume 74, p.79-86.
1973: Pahoehoe Flows from the 1969-1971 Mauna
Ulu Eruption, Kilauea Volcano, Hawaii; Geological Wright, J.V., Self, S., and Fisher, R.V.
Society of America, Bulletin, Volume 84, 1981: Towards a Facies Model for Ignimbrite-Forming
p.615-626. Eruptions; p.433-439 in Tephra Studies, edited by
S. Self and R.S.J. Sparks, D. Reidel, Holland.
Tasse, N., Lajoie, J., and Dimroth, E.
1978: The Anatomy and Interpretation of an Archean Wright, J.V., Smith, A.L, and Self, S.
Volcaniclastic Sequence, Noranda Region, Que 1980: A Working Terminology of Pyroclastic Deposits;
bec; Canadian Journal of Earth Sciences, Volume Journal of Volcanology and Geothermal Re
15, p.874-888. search, Volume 8, p.315-336.

40
Chapter 2

Stratigraphic Correlation Techniques


N.F. Trowell

CONTENTS ABSTRACT
Abstract .......................................................................... 41 Volcanic rocks are by nature complex, and have
Introduction 41 highly variable modes of eruption, physical and
The Nature of"'volcan'ic''stratigraph711IIIII 42 chemical attributes, and resultant landforms and sur-
, . . , . . , t. , face features. Observation of modern volcanic rocks
Examples of Stratigraphic Correlate from provjdes jnsjght jmo tnejr form and environmental
Archean Terra ins .. . ............................................ 43 settj ng but precise correlation, even in these rocks,
Stratigraphic Marker Horizons ...........,.................. 43 js difficult. Archean volcanic rocks vieweo only in
pedostratigraphic Correlation.............................. 43 two.dimens i 0ns . present many additional problems.
Statistical correlation ......... .............................. 44 For examp|e tne asymmetric, discontinuous, and
htravolcanic Sediments and Bio- variable shapes of volcanic units are further corn-
Correlation .................................................... 44 p|j cated by erosion, deformation, and metamorphism.
htravolcanic Iron Formation ................................... 45 Thjs coupled with generally discontinuous exposure.
Geophysical Correlation .....................,................. 45 makes such features as calderas and cauldrons ex-
Geochronology.......................................................... 45 treme | y difficult to recognize. Walking out stratig-
A Word About Scale ..................................................... 46 raphic units is generally impossible due to their len-
References ..................................................................... 47 ticular form and limited areal extent. Many rules that
_____________________________ apply to stratigraphic interpretation in sedimentary

2-' srntechniquesusedinthe——7S
TABLES

.................................................................
assemblages must be applied cautiously. Abrupt

correlation techniques used in Archean terrains differ


2.2 Stromatolite occurrences in Archean somewhat from those used in conventional stratig-
of Ontario .............................................................. 45 raphy.
2.3 Zircon uranium-lead geochronology Correlation can be made by use of stratigraphic
for Savant Lake-Crow Lake area ...................... 46 marker norizons such as variolitic flows, interflow
———————————————————————— chemical sediments, and distinctive tephra layers.
FIGUHbb-^—————-——^——————-^^———- Volcanic rocks can be assigned to specific chemical
2.1. Differential erosion of a sequence of suites. Recognition of komatiitic volcanic rocks in the
ash flows............................................................... 42 Abitibi Belt has allowed the correlation of both local
2.2 Differential erosion leading to and regional stratigraphic sequences. Volcanic rocks
inversion of relief 42 can be assigned to facies by delineating physical
o o C^KQ™O*;^ HiQrtrom'^'f'^wr^io'otio""""""""""" ar|d structural features related to distance from erup-
^no^fc frnrJf? vin^Tc A, tive centres. Flows commonly exhibit certain intrinsic
deposits from St. Vincents ................................. 42 geopnysical properties. it is possible to trace and
2.4 Schematic diagram of volcanic distinguish between high-Fe and high-Mg tholeiitic
deposits from St. Vincents showing f | OWS on tne basis of their magneti c signature.
different volcanic environments ....................... 43 . L
n r. ,, , . . .. . . , . Recently, radiometric ages have proven to be
2.5. Knee Lake area of Manitoba showing f , t *, both , d fj * , , stratigraphy and
distinctive marker horizons in regional correlation.
(porphyritic rocks) ............................................... 44 a
26 Mattaaami area of Oueber illu^tratina Tne imPortance of Stratigraphic studies to Ar-
i^iSta^^^ chean mineral ex P |oration can be demonstrated by
^onc^n
honzons m minir?
mineral ?v5nSt^n
exploration ......................... AA
44 analogy
are ^^ with the Kuroko stratigraphjc
IQ specjfjc base-metal deposits. These
fe^sic volcanjc
2.7. Sketch map showing broad sequences, and paleontological evidence suggests
lithostratigraphic relationships of that deposits as widely separate as 300 km formed
Savant Lake-Crow Lake area............................. 44 simultaneously.
2.8. Sketch map to show distribution of _____________________________
volcanic suites in the Savant Lake- INTRODUCTION
Crow Lake area.................................................... 44 —————————————————————————————
2.9. Measured section of pyroclastic ™ s chaPter wi " ? iscuss a few techniques used for
rocks in the Kirkland Lake area (after tnf correlation of volcanic rocks specifically with
o in Hyde
o u 1978)* y........................................................... 45 reference and application
phosed Archean terrains. to deformed and metamor-
2. 10. Schematic of first derivation vertical
aeromagnetic data over part of the Volcanic rocks are by their very nature complex.
Abitibi Belt illustrating how different As one 9oes further and further back in geologic
volcanic suites can be distinguished time ' if becomes increasingly difficult to:
on the basis of their magnetic 1. reconstruct volcanic sequences
character ............................................................... 46 2. correlate volcanic deposits

41
CHAPTER 2

Pyroclastic Deposits, St. Vincent (East Coast)

Figure 2.3. Schematic diagram of pyroclastic de


posits from St. Vincents.

3. determine the geologic setting in which they


were erupted.
One of the prime reasons for this lack of knowl
Figure 2.1. Differential erosion of a sequence of edge is the fact that volcanic rocks often form con
ash flows. structional topographic features which inevitably
leads to their relatively rapid destruction by erosion.
By contrast, the deposition of sedimentary rocks in
protected basins can preserve thick stratigraphic sec
tions, completely documenting geological events over
tens of millions of years.
Assuming that physical and chemical laws are
immutable, one should first look at examples of the
morphology of younger volcanoes and their products
to gain insight into the types of problems inherent in
correlating Archean strata. These examples are from
the subaerial environment, but beyond doubt, similar
processes operate subaqueously.

THE NATURE OF VOLCANIC STRATIGRAPHY""


Constrasting mechanical properties of volcanic rocks
often produce classic examples of differential ero
sion. An example of how an area could be misinter
preted after erosion is shown in Figure 2.1. A lower
ash flow unit (top illustration) has filled in the pre
existing topography, but was not extensive enough to
cover the ridge crests. The degree of compaction of
ash flows is a function of their thickness, and thus
will be greatest in areas of negative relief as the ash
flows "fill-in" the topography. Subsequent ash flows
(middle illustration) would tend to follow the same
paths, but erosion due to water and/or ice along the
valleys might completely scour out those deposits
leaving the situation seen in the bottom illustration.
Any volumetric calculations, stratigraphic sec
tions, and attempted correlations based on a limited
exposure of such terrain would be very misleading.
Figure 2.2 illustrates how erosion can cause an
inversion of relief. A basaltic lava flow (lined pattern)
that occupied a valley bottom is more competent and
thus less easily eroded than the underlying bedrock.
Because of this contrast, the final configuration after
stream erosion is a string of basalt-capped hills
(bottom illustration).
Figure 2.3 is a schematic diagram showing a
Figure 2.2. Differential erosion leading to inversion sequence of pyroclastic deposits from St. Vincents.
of relief. What significance does the steep erosional unconfor
mity have? It may in fact represent only a short
period of time during eruptive activity. Abrupt vari
ations in dip over short distances due to mantle

42
N.F. TROWELL

TABLE 2.1: CORRELATION TECHNIQUES IN THE


ARCHEAN.________________________

STRATIGRAPHIC MARKER HORIZONS


Glomeroporphyritic, variolitic flows
Interflow sediments/pyroclastics
CHEMOSTRATIGRAPHIC CORRELATION
STATISTICAL CORRELATION
INTRAVOLCANIC SEDIMENTS
detrital fan M)eoch deposits Stromatolites
subaqueous environment Iron Formation
Larakai Bay, St. Vincent
GEOPHYSICAL CORRELATION
GEOCHRONOLOGY

Figure 2.4. Schematic diagram of volcanic depos


its from St. Vincents showing different volcanic 70 km. It should be kept in mind, however, that it is
environments. not one individual flow that is being traced, but rather
a stratigraphic package wherein variolitic or
bedding are meaningful on only the local scale and glomeroporphyritic lavas are the dominant volcanic
have no structural significance. Of course, one never products. Since these flow types are not rare, caution
sees excellent exposures like this in Archean terrain. should always be exercised to ensure that it is the
This increases these problems of structural inter same stratigraphic package being correlated.
pretation several-fold. In the Mattagami area of Quebec (Figure 2.6 after
Figure 2.4, a schematic diagram, also of volcanic Costa et al. 1983), on the southern limb of the Allard
deposits from St. Vincents, illustrates how different Anticline, the lower Watson Lake Group consists of
volcanic environments and their product lithologies felsic flows and pyroclastic rocks. It is separated
can occur together in one relatively restricted area. from the overlying Wabasee Group of both mafic
Active erosion of constructional topographic features flows and felsic pyroclastic rocks by the "Key Tuf
is occurring as is shown by formation of the alluvial fite" horizon. The Key Tuffite horizon consists of
deposits. An Archean analogue in which a similar chemical sediment and airfall ash material. Not only
area was eroded, covered by younger deposits and is the Key Tuffite horizon important for correlation
then deformed, would obviously be very difficult to purposes, but it also overlies the orebodies of Mat
interpret, especially where only a two-dimensional tagami, Orchan, and Bell Allard, making it a prime
view is available. target in mineral exploration. Furthermore, its pres
The question of erosion is one of critical impor ence allowed Roberts (1975) to do a palimspastic
tance, specifically for pyroclastic rocks which tend to reconstruction of the paleotopography and paleoen
form constructional topographic land forms. As Ayres vironment of ore deposition. Recognition of the airfall
has recently pointed out (Ayres 1983), from 2x to 4x ash component of this unit is an example, albeit on a
the observed volume of felsic volcanic rocks in his local scale, of the more specialized correlation tech
study area of Archean rocks had been eroded to nique of tephrochronology.
provide detritus to subjacent sedimentary environ
ments. CHEMOSTRATIGRAPHIC CORRELATION
In many cases it may not be possible to do Volcanic rocks can be assigned to specific chemical
extended correlations in areas having only partial suites based on field and laboratory criteria.
volcanological records. In the Savant Lake-Crow Lake area of North
western Ontario (Figure 2.7), local stratigraphy was
EXAMPLES OF STRATIGRAPHIC deciphered and volcanic sequences were assigned
CORRELATION FROM ARCHEAN TERRAINS an approximate chemical composition on the basis of
Table 2.1 is a listing of some of the correlation field determination of mafic mineral content (Trowell
techniques used in Archean terrains. Discussion of et al. 1980). Subsequent chemical data allowed for
these techniques will be brief, but will provide an both the assignment of these sequences to their
introduction to more detailed descriptions in the ac respective chemical suites (Figure 2.8), and the rec
companying chapters of this volume. ognition of specific stratigraphic distribution patterns
based on those suites. Correlation of discontinuous
sequences in this area still relied, however, on other
STRATIGRAPHIC MARKER HORIZONS means, specifically, geochronology to demonstrate
Figure 2.5 from Green (1975) shows a distinctive the time relationships between these suites.
glomeroporphyritic horizon that can be traced for
several km in the Knee Lake area of Manitoba. Simi
larly, variolitic horizons in the Abitibi Belt of Ontario
and Quebec can be traced for distances in excess of

43
CHAPTER 2

MAGNESIAN THOLEIITIC FLOWS (MTF)

—— sediments y.
~ granitic rocks]- THOLEIITIC TO CALC ALKALINE FLOWS
AND PYROCLASTICS (TCFP)
•^ porphyritic rocks FE THOLEIITIC SIOUKiOOKOUT
felsic volcanic FLOWS (FTF)
mafic volcanic SEDIMENTS

FAULTS

IRON FORMATION

50 100 KM
CROW
(KAKAGlfLA~KE

Figure 2.5. Knee Lake area of Manitoba showing Figure 2.7. Sketch map showing broad lithostratig
distinctive marker horizons (porphyritic rocks). raphic relationships of Savant Lake-Crow Lake
area.

Matagarni

LOWER-MOST MAFIC FLOWS

——— FAULTS

v* — IRON FORMATION

ALLARD CROW
(KAKAGI) LAKE

Figure 2.8. Sketch map to show distribution of


volcanic suites in the Savant Lake-Crow Lake
area.
Intrusions
probability of one facies succeeding another in the
stratigraphic section.
Wabassee Group This method should prove to be very helpful in
the correlation of areas where exposure is poor, and
Watson Lake Group it could have applications for mineral exploration if,
for example, one particular facies is deemed to have
an high mineral potential.

Figure 2.6. Mattagami area of Quebec illustrating INTRAVOLCANIC SEDIMENTS AND


importance of stratigraphic marker horizons in BIO-CORRELATION
mineral exploration. While it probably can be said that the Archean record
does not abound in fossils, it is to the Archean that
STATISTICAL CORRELATION we must look for the earliest traces of life. At present,
During the process of analyzing volcanic rocks, sta stromatolites are the only abundant fossils recog
tistical manipulation of qualitative data is used to nized in the Archean rocks of Ontario that can be
predict stratigraphic relationships and correlations. In used for bio-correlation.
the Kirkland Lake area, Hyde (1978) has successfully Archean stromatolites are known to be present at
used Markov Chain Analysis, a statistical technique, several localities in Ontario (Table 2.2). More occur
in the study of the alkalic volcanic rocks of the rences are likely to exist. Attendant upon future finds,
Timiskaming Group. Figure 2.9 shows a measured detailed studies of their morphology may permit the
section of pyroclastic rocks that have been assigned recognition of specific assemblages, useful, not only
to their respective facies whether airfall, ash flow, or
reworked. Statistically, it is possible to estimate the

44
N.F. TROWELL

for purposes of correlation, but also for more detailed 9 -i


palaeoenvironment and paleogeography analysis.
Microfossils have been documented in rocks as B
old as the 3500 Ma year old Warrawoona Group of
Western Australia. Recently, laminated algal mats and 8 -
stromatolites have been identified in the Helen iron
formation at Wawa, suggesting that they may hold covered
some promise as a correlation tool of the future. The
chapter on the stratigraphy of the Western Uchi Sub-
province (Chapter 6, this volume) will discuss how
stromatolitic horizons might be used as potential cor
relation tools, and will illustrate some of the pitfalls
inherent in correlating apparently similar though
widely separate stromatolitic units. 6 -\
INTRAVOLCANIC IRON FORMATION
Due to their great lateral extent, intravolcanic iron
formations can be used to correlate separate and 5 -
discontinuous volcanic sequences. In the chapter on
the Wawa area (Chapter 4, this volume), an extended
discussion is given on the use of Michipicoten-type
iron formations in the correlation of volcanic se
quences in a region that has suffered extensive faul
:-:-:-:J
4 — .•.•.-.-.•.•.- i cB
ting.
Even though neither stromatolites nor iron forma C airfall
tions are volcanic rocks, for the purposes of regional
correlation, all the tools available should be used. 3 -
Even simply determining that two widely separated B
volcanic sequences are older or younger than a spe
cific, laterally continuous, intravolcanic sedimentary ash flow

m
unit is an important first step in refining regional
correlation within the Superior Province. 2 -
B
GEOPHYSICAL CORRELATION A reworked
One example of geophysical correlation is the use of
aeromagnetic data to distinguish and trace packages 1 — B
of volcanic rocks with distinct chemical and therefore A
physical characteristics over a part of the Abitibi Belt metres
B
straddling the Porcupine-Destor Break (see Letros et
al. 1983). 0— A
Figure 2.10 is a schematic diagram of a first
derivative vertical gradient map of aeromagnetic Figure 2.9. Measured section of pyroclastic rocks
data. Packages of rocks, in this case magnesian in the Kirkland Lake area (after Hyde 1978).
tholeiites and high-iron tholeiitic basalts, can be dis
tinguished on the basis of a particular geophysical
parameter, in this case magnetic susceptibility.

GEOCHRONOLOGY
Correlation of local Archean sequences on a regional
to geological subprovince- and province-wide scale
has, until the present, relied upon similarities in
lithologies and recognition of extensive sedimentary TABLE 2.2: STROMATOLITE OCCURRENCES
or tectonic events. Lithocorrelation is, however, re IN SUPERIOR PROVINCE OF ONTARIO.
stricted by the extent of the lithostratigraphic units in
question. This limits the reliability of such regional Woman Lake Uchi
correlations.
Recently, radiometric age determination methods Red Lake Subprovince
have proven to be powerful tools both in defining
local stratigraphy and regional correlation. The impor Steeprock Wabigoon
tance of geochronologic studies to Archean mineral Subprovince
exploration can be demonstrated by an analogy with
the Kuroko base-metal deposits. These deposits are Kirkland Lake? Abitibi-Wawa
confined to specific stratigraphic felsic volcanic se Wawa Subprovince
quences; both paleontological and paleomagnetic

45
CHAPTER 2

Figure 2.10. Schematic


of first derivation
vertical aeromagnetic
data over part of Abitibi
Belt illustrating how
different volcanic suites
can be distinguished on
the basis of their
magnetic character.

felsic intrusions
alkalic volcanics and clastic sediments
mafic-ultramafic intrusions
. ,. ,. . __ ,,w, i,, Branch of the
calc-alkalic volcanics ———— Porcupine-Destor Fault
iron-rich tholeiites -. - x -
magnesium tholeiites ~ ~ Porcup.ne-Destor Fault
komatiitic volcanics Munro Syncline

evidence suggests that deposits separated by as


much as 300 km. formed simultaneously (Scott 1980;
Ueno 1975). With this in mind, a geochronologic
study (Davis and Edwards 1982; Davis and Trowell
1982; Davis ef a/. 1982) was done in the Savant
Lake-Crow Lake area of Northwestern Ontario to TABLE 2.3: ZIRCON U/PB GEOCHRONOLOGY
bracket the time of formation of the Sturgeon Lake FOR SAVANT LAKE.
base-metal deposits, and to compare this age with
the ages of other volcanic sequences throughout the : i——t———; BERRY :CREEK COMPLEX i
belt (Table 2.3). This study is being continued by the \ ;-*- FELSIC TUFF, KAKAGI LAKE GROUP
private sector. : ; THUNDERCLOUD PORPHYRY ——i
—*—— TAYLOR ^LAKE STOCK \ : \ l
RHYOLITE TUFF NEAR TOP OF '-.
A WORD ABOUT SCALE CTTt .
o J. J-ii-i —*—
i BOYER LAKE VOLCANICS
:
j i -*- SABASKONG BATHOLITH j
When mapping at a scale of 1:15840, it is highly DASH LAKE STOCK -*- } \ ; :
fortuitous if individual flows or pyroclastic horizons i : GABBRO -—*—— BEIDELMAN BAY
can be traced for an appreciable distance. Under : i FELSIC TUFF: -*- CENTRAL VOLCANIC BELT
favourable conditions, however, packages of units DORE LAKE LOBE —*— ATIKWA BATHOLITH
can be correlated between traverse lines. A mineral CONTACT BAY RHYOLITE —*—— i ; ;
explorationist, for whom a 1/4 mile can represent the i EAGLE LAKE LOBE --*- ATIKWA BATHOLITH i
surface extent of a viable mineral deposit, may find it i : EAGLE LAKE i DACITE -*- i :
necessary to correlate to the outcrop scale. Hence, : : HANDY ; LAKE VOLCANICS -^ l ;

the precision required and attained in correlation de


pends very much on the purpose of the geologist
involved and the amount of time and effort he is
willing to expend.

46
N.F. TROWELL

Whatever the scale, it will be the education, Green, N.L.


experience, and skill of the field mapper that will 1975: Glomeroporphyritic Basalts; Canadian Journal
ultimately determine the quality of any stratigraphic of Earth Sciences. Volume 12, p. 1770-1784.
correlation. Hyde, R.S.
1978: Sedimentology, Volcanology, Stratigraphy, and
REFERENCES Tectonic Setting of the Archean Timiskaming
Ayres, LD. Group, Abitibi Greenstone Belt, Northeastern On
1983: Bimodal Volcanism in Archean Greenstone tario, Canada; Unpublished Ph.D. Thesis,
Belts Exemplified by Greywacke Composition, McMaster University, Hamilton, Ontario, 423p.
Lake Superior Park, Ontario; Canadian Journal of Letros, S., Strangway, D.W., Tasillo-Hirt, A.M., Geiss
Earth Sciences, Volume 20, p. 1168-1194. man, J.W., and Jensen, L.S.
Costa, U.R., Barnett, R.L, and Kerrich. R. 1983: Aeromagnetic Interpretation of the Kirkland
1983: The Mattagami Lake Mine Archean Zn-Cu Sul Lake-Larder Lake Portion of the Abitibi Green
phide Deposit, Quebec: Hydrothermal stone Belt, Ontario; Canadian Journal of Earth
Coprecipitation of Talc and Sulphides in a Sea- Sciences, Volume 20, p.548-560.
Floor Brine Pool Evidence from Geochemistry, Roberts, R.G.
18Q/16Q anc| Mineral Chemistry; Economic Geol 1975: The Geological Setting of the Mattagami Lake
ogy, Volume 78, p. 1144-1203. Mine, Quebec: A Volcanogenic Massive Sulphide
Davis, D.W., Blackburn, C.E., and Krogh, T.E. Deposit; Economic Geology, Volume 70,
1982: Zircon U-Pb Ages from the Wabigoon-Manitou p. 115-129.
Lakes Region, Wabigoon Subprovince, Northwest Scott, S.O.
Ontario; Canadian Journal of Earth Sciences, Vol 1980: Geology and Structural Control of Kuroko-Type
ume 19, p.254-266. Massive Sulphide Deposits; p.705-722 in The
Davis, D.W., and Edwards, G.R. Continental Crust and its Mineral Deposits, edited
1982: Zircon U-Pb Ages from the Kakagi Lake Area, by D.W. Strangway, Geological Association of
Wabigoon Subprovince, Northwest Ontario; Cana Canada, Special Paper Number 20, 804p.
dian Journal of Earth Sciences, Volume 19, Trowell, N.F., Blackburn, C.E., and Edwards, G.R.
p. 1235-1245. 1980: Preliminary Synthesis of the Savant Lake-Crow
Davis, D.W. and Trowell, N.F. Lake Metavolcanic Metasedimentary Belt, North
1982: U-Pb Zircon Ages from the Eastern Savant western Ontario, and Its Bearing Upon Mineral
Lake-Crow Lake Metavolcanic-Metasedimentary Exploration; Ontario Geological Survey, Miscella
Belt, Northwest Ontario; Canadian Journal of neous Paper 89, 30p. Accompanied by Chart A.
Earth Sciences, Volume 19, p.868-877. Ueno, Hirotomo
1975: Duration of the Kuroko Mineralization Episode;
Nature, Volume 253, Number 5491, p.428-429.

47
Part Two: Volcanic Stratigraphy in
Archean Greenstone Belts
Chapter 3

Stratigraphic Correlation of the Western Wabigoon


Subprovince, Northwestern Ontario
N.F. Trowell and G.W. Johns

CONTENTS ABSTRACT
Abstract .......................................................................... 50 The Savant Lake-Crow Lake metavolcanic-
Introduction 50 metasedimentary belt extends for 300 km within the
Chemostratigrap'hic"c'orrela'tion'II.r.'Ii:i"."r. 51 weste™ Part of the Wabigoon Subprovince. Correla-
n , L. T i o o i u r-n tion of stratigraphy in this area was initially made on
Long Bay-Lobstick Bay Stratigraphy........................ 52 the basjs ofy the following observations: 1) general
Local Geochemical Synthesis ,,.....,.,..,..,.,,.,...,. 54 inward facing of metavolcanic-metasedimentary se-
Regional Geochemical Synthesis............................... 55 quences; 2) thick basal mafic assemblages are all
Geochronology 55 situated at the outer edges of the belt; 3) overlying,
Stratigraphy and G^ld^ineralizati(^'I'III'"'I 58 mi*ed mafic to felsic sequences are more internal
and contain thick assemblages of mafic flows that
Heterences.................................................................... bo are most |y toward or at the top of these sequences,
Q——————————————————————— and in some places may be allochthonous; 4) associ-
rlCaURtb________________________ at j On Of clastic sedimentary rocks with mixed mafic
3.1. Sketch map showing broad to felsic parts of volcanic sequences; and 5) lateral
lithostratigraphic relationships and continuity of certain ironstone-bearing formations.
structural complexity of the Savant Recent mapping has extended the correlation of
Lake-Crow Lake area .......................................... 51 stratigraphy into the Gibi Lake and Lobstick Bay-Lake
3.2. Stratigraphic map of the Long Bay- of the Woods area.
Lobstick Bay area ................................................ 52 Local and regional geochemical studies support
3.3. Simplified stratigraphic sections the stratigraphic relationships outlined. Geochronol-
within the Long Bay Lobstick Bay ogy has also been used successfully to refine the
area ........................................................................ 54 stratigraphy.
3.4. Jensen cation plot for Jutten Local and regional mapping, combined with
volcanics. Northern volcanic belt, lithogeochemical syntheses and geochronological
and Wapageisi volcanics, showing studies have produced a much clearer picture of the
their tholeiitic, relatively magnesian geological evolution of this area. Future studies will
character .............................,................................ 55 allow placement of mineral deposits of this area into
3.5. Jensen cation plots for Rowan Lake this new tectonostratigraphic framework.
volcanics, Kakagi Lake volcanics, .^——--——-——-———.————--—-.—-————
Lower Wabigoon volcanics, Manitou INTRODUCTION
Lakes section, North and South ————-—————————-——————————————-
Sturgeon Lake volcanics, and A 300 km Ion9 metavolcanic-metasedimentary belt
Beckington Road and Morgan Island ( R 9 ure 3 - 1 )- stretching from Savant Lake in the east
sections of the Northeast Arm to the eastern part of Lake of the Woods in the west,
volcanics showing their calc-alkalic forms tne western end of the Wabigoon Subprovince
to tholeiitic character ,,.,,.,.,,.,,,,,,,.,,,,. 56 (Mackasey et al. 1974).
3.6. Jensen cation and AFM plots of Tne Wabigoon Subprovince is a major tec-
recent data from the Central Volcanic tonostratigraphic subdivision of the Superior Prov-
Belt Sioux Lookout area ,. .....,. ........ ............... 57 ince, consisting of belts of predominantly metavol-
3.7. Jensen cation plots for Brooks Lake cat™ r^ks and .subordinate metasedimentary rocks
volcanics, Katimagamak volcanics, intruded by granitoid bodies some of bathol.th.c d.-
Boyer Lake volcanics. Upper E8"! 10^'^8 bor6^ l0 th? ™rth and south by
Wabigoon volcanics, and Central he .^"^ * lver and Que ICO Subprov.nces, respec-
Sturgeon Lake volcanics, showing tlve! v' wh ' ch COR;slst m. ainljf of metasediments, m,g-
their tholeiitic, relatively iron-rich ma lte ' and 9ranitic rocks of both anatectic and mag-
character ,,,,,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,... 57 matlc or'9' n -
3.8. Jensen cation and AFM plots of the ln tne 1960s - Goodwin (1965) compared and cor-
Berry Creek Complex and Warclub related volcanic stratigraphic sections on the basis of
group, and Snake Bay formation...................... 58 tneir geochemistry and suggested a two-fold subdivi-
on ci^*^ ~,o,, ^ r^,., ^-otr^,,*^^ ^f slon of the volcanic sequences at Lake of the
3.9. Sketch map o show distr but.on o WoQds Goodwjn no^such evj(jence f
the three volcanic suites m the study f subdivision elsewhere in the eastern half of the
aica ,,,,,,,.,.,.,,.,.,,..,..,.,.,....,,.,.,,...,,.. ^^
op/3,0 ^M
area unc|er discussion: in this area he concluded that
3. 10. Zircon uranium-lead geochronology on |y tne lower subdivision was present.
for Savant Lake-Crow Lake area ...................... 59 |p ^ ^^ HDR m ^ ^ coworkers
(Wilson et al. 1974; Wilson and Morrice 1977; Morrice

50
N.F. TROWELL AND C.W. JOHNS

Figure 3.1. Sketch map


lowermost mafic flows showing broad
lithos fra tigraphic
mafic to felsic flows and pyroclastic rocks' relationships and
middle l upper mafic flows structural complexity of
the Savant Lake-Crow
sediments Lake area. Area "A" is
granitic rocks the recently mapped
Long Bay-Lobstick Bay
area.

faults
iron formation
facing direction

CROW , so 100
(KAKAGI) kilometres
LAKE

1977) studied the volcanic and sedimentary stratig CHEMOSTRATIGRAPHIC CORRELATION


raphy of the western Wabigoon Subprovince. These In any attempt at regional correlation based upon the
authors proposed a four-fold sequential model based chemical character of local stratigraphic sections, the
upon comparable sequences in Archean greenstone following reservations must be kept in mind. Firstly,
terrains of South Africa and Australia. They attempted the present state of detailed mapping is such that in
to apply this model to the area from Lake of the most cases individual sequences have not yet been
Woods to Sturgeon Lake on the basis of literature traced between geographic areas. Secondly, se
reviews and mapping of selected sections.
quences are disrupted, both by tectonism and by
In the 1970s, N.F. Trowell, C.E. Blackburn, and batholithic intrusion. Sense and movement on long
G.R. Edwards of the Ontario Geological Survey con faults are not well documented. Emplacement of
ducted a synoptic study of the metavolcanic se large granitic bodies have likely removed voluminous
quences from Crow (Kakagi) Lake to Savant Lake, amounts of volcanic rock by stoping, particularly from
emphasizing lithogeochemistry across recognized the basal parts of these volcanic sequences. Lastly,
stratigraphic sections. Among their conclusions, stratigraphic sequences in one geographic area, with
Trowell, Blackburn, and Edwards (1980) found that particular chemical affinities are not necessarily time-
the four-fold subdivision proposed by Wilson and equivalent to lithologic packages exhibiting similar
coworkers was not tenable, but that there was a chemical characteristics in other areas.
general succession of lithogeochemically distinct se Figure 3.1 (from Trowell, Blackburn, and Edwards
quences throughout the area. 1980) illustrates a tentative correlation of the main
A geochronological program carried out under part of the metavolcanic metasedimentary belt, while
the direction of D.W. Davis of the Royal Ontario Figure 3.2 outlines the recently interpreted stratig
Museum in the late 1970s and early 1980s, allowed raphy at the western end of the Wabigoon Sub
for refinement of correlation of volcanic sequences province in the Lake of the Woods area. These cor
throughout the belt (Davis, Blackburn, and Krogh relations were made based on tracing marker hori
1982; Davis and Trowell 1982; Davis and Edwards zons, and on general comparison of lithologic char
1982). acteristics prior to obtaining significant amounts of
Further work by Trowell, Logothetis, and Caldwell chemical data.
(1980), Trowell (in preparation), and Johns (1981, Five general observations are of paramount im
1982, 1983) has provided more detailed information portance in making this preliminary correlation. These
on the stratigraphy and lithogeochemistry of the east are:
ern part of the Lake of the Woods area. This chapter
1. Discounting the many reversals due to folding,
represents a synopsis of that work intended to show
doming due to batholithic emplacement, and
how lithogeochemistry and geochronology can be complications due to faulting, it can be noted that
used as correlation tools in deciphering Archean ter
sequences predominantly face inward toward the
rains. Wherever possible, the reader is referred to
axis of the belt. In particular, volcanic rocks near
previous publications for details of local stratigraphy. the contact with enclosing batholiths invariably
Since information on the eastern Lake of the Woods
face inward.
area is new and as yet unpublished, a more complete
description of that stratigraphy as interpreted from 2. In the lower stratigraphic sequences, thick suc
recent mapping by Johns and Richey (1982), Johns cessions of mafic flows are invariably situated at
and Davison (1983), Johns, Good, and Davison the margins of the belt.
(1984) is provided in this chapter. 3. Away from the margins of the belt, highly vari
able sequences of mafic to felsic flows and

51
CHAPTER 3

Gibi Lake Volcanics


intermediate intrusive rocks
Warclub Group
mafic intrusive rocks
metasediments and intermediate to felsic metavolcanics
intermediate to felsic metavolcanics
mafic metavolcanics
stratigraphic contact
lithologic contact 01 234 56 789 10
fault

Figure 3.2. Stratigraphic map of the Long Bay-Lobstick Bay area. The area is structurally complex due to
the intrusion of the Aulneau and Dryberry Batholiths and the Viola Lake Stock.

pyroclastic rocks predominate. Where thick accu LONG BAY - LOBSTICK BAY STRATIGRAPHY
mulations of mafic flows occur in these upper To date, there has been no detailed stratigraphic
volcanic sequences, they are found at or near subdivision of the Lake of the Woods part of the
the very top. Wabigoon Subprovince. Mapping carried out between
4. Thick sequences of clastic sedimentary rocks are Lake of the Woods and the area studied by Trowell,
associated both laterally and vertically with the Logothetis, and Caldwell (1980) at present permits a
volcanic sequences containing mafic to felsic preliminary stratigraphic synthesis. Elements of the
flows and pyroclastic rocks. In contrast, few sedi stratigraphy identified by Trowell, Blackburn, and Ed
mentary rocks are associated with the thick wards (1980) have been recognized and may be
mafic successions in either the lower or upper used to extend correlations into the Lake of the
sequences. Woods area. Further mapping is required, however, to
5. Iron formations, predominantly oxide facies, oc subdivide the supracrustal sequences in the rest of
cur discontinuously within the clastic sedimen the Lake of the Woods area.
tary zones. It is probable that within each sedi Figure 3.2 is a lithostratigraphic map of the Long
mentary zone, the iron formation units are correl Bay Lobstick Bay area. The Snake Bay volcanics,
ative. Populus volcanics, and Warclub sediments outlined
The general geology of the main part of this belt on Chart A in Trowell, Blackburn, and Edwards (1980)
was described previously (Trowell, Blackburn, and have been recognized in the Long Bay Lobstick Bay
Edwards 1980, p.2-6; Blackburn era/. 1982). Mapping area. This area was subdivided into several geologic
since then (Johns and Richey 1982; Johns and domains based upon their positions relative to the
Davison 1983; Johns, Good, and Davison 1984) has regional Pipestone Cameron Fault and, to date, cor
provided us with a more detailed and accurate relation has not been attempted between them.
knowledge of the far western part of the belt, and an Southwest of the Pipestone-Cameron Fault, the
expanded discussion on this subject is presented Snake Bay formation (Figure 3.2) is a north- to
below. northeast-facing mafic metavolcanic sequence of
fine-grained and medium-grained flows, fine-grained
pillowed flows, and coarse massive and pillowed
glomeroporphyritic flows. These flows are interdigitat-
ed with fine intermediate pyroclastic rocks in the

52
N.F. TROWELL AND C. W. JOHNS

western part of the area. The base of the Snake Bay area, Trowell (in preparation) interpreted the stratig
formation is in intrusive contact with the Aulneau raphic sequence to be mafic flows of the Dogtooth
Batholith, and the top may have been technically Lake volcanics, overlain by wackes of the northern
removed by the Pipestone-Cameron Fault. metasedimentary belt, overlain by the felsic and
Morrice (1977) was able to subdivide the Snake mafic pyroclastic rocks of the Gibi Lake volcanics.
Bay formation into lower and middle mafic groups. Mapping in the Long Bay-Lobstick Bay area has re
Morrice's lower mafic group is 3650 m thick and has vealed a similar stratigraphic succession in the vi
been subdivided into 12 formations. The middle cinity of Rat Lake (see Figures 3.2 and 3.3). Mafic
mafic group is 6350 m thick and consists of 10 dis flows of the Black Lake volcanics are overlain by a
tinct formations (Morrice 1977). In the Long Bay- thin wacke sequence which is overlain by felsic to
Lobstick Bay area, only the lower mafic group ap intermediate pyroclastic rocks. On the basis of
pears to be present. stratigraphic similarity one of the authors (GWJ) cor
relates the Black Lake volcanics with the Dogtooth
Northeast of the Pipestone-Cameron Fault, six Lake volcanics and equates the pyroclastic rocks at
stratigraphic subdivisions within the supracrustal Rat Lake with the Gibi Lake volcanics.
rocks may be discerned. These subdivisions are
shown on Figure 3.2 as the Point Bay group, Populus The Gibi Lake volcanics as defined by Trowell,
volcanics, Black Lake volcanics, Gibi Lake volcanics, Logothetis, and Caldwell (1980) occur in the north
and Warclub group which includes the Berry River western part of Figure 3.2. Here, they are composed
formation. of intermediate to felsic pyroclastic rocks overlain by
a mafic tuff unit. Within the Gibi Lake area (Trowell in
The presumed oldest supracrustal assemblage in preparation), the Gibi Lake volcanics consist of inter
the Long Bay Lobstick Bay area is the Point Bay calated fine to medium, intermediate pyroclastic
group. This group has been largely intruded and rocks, and fine mafic pyroclastic rocks. Around Rat
assimilated by the Dryberry Batholith and only rem Lake in the Long Bay-Lobstick Bay area, the felsic to
nants are found rimming the contact. The Point Bay intermediate pyroclastic rocks equated with the Gibi
group is a diverse assemblage of highly metamor Lake volcanics are predominantly fine.
phosed mafic volcanic rocks, intermediate volcanic
rocks, and metawackes intruded by thick, differen The Warclub group overlies all other stratigraphic
tiated ultramafic to mafic sills. South of Dryberry subdivisions. Blackburn (1978) documented the exis
Lake, the sequence is south facing, while west of the tence of pyroclastic rocks within the Warclub Series
lake, it occurs in the nose of a series of folds. Roof of metasediments of Burwash (1934) and the War
pendants, discontinuous remnants, and xenoliths of club sediments of Davies and Watowich (1958). Fel
this assemblage are found in the rocks of the sic to intermediate pyroclastic rocks are found inter
Dryberry Batholith and Berry Lake Stock. bedded with metasediments throughout the Long
Bay-Lobstick Bay area. Since the structure and
The Populus volcanics (Trowell, Blackburn, and stratigraphy of the metasediments and the interbed
Edwards 1980) are a largely northwest-facing se ded pyroclastic rocks is complex within the area, the
quence of massive and pillowed mafic flows, author (GWJ) has grouped all of these rocks into the
hyaloclastite, pillow breccia, and pyroclastic rocks Warclub group.
with some interbedded intermediate pyroclastic
rocks. These metavolcanics strike northeast from There are a number of different metasedimentary
Dogpaw Lake where they have been juxtaposed rock types within the Warclub group: thinly bedded
against the Snake Bay formation by the Pipestone - arenite and quartzose siltstone; interbedded arenite
Cameron Fault. The relationship between the Point and wacke; wacke and magnetite ironstone; and
Bay group and the Populus volcanics is unknown as wacke alone. These lithologies are found in a number
there is no direct contact between them, but it can be of stratigraphic positions:
assumed that the Populus volcanics are somewhat 1. Thinly bedded arenite and quartzose siltstone
younger than the Point Bay group. overlie the Gibi Lake volcanics north of Yellow
The Black Lake volcanics also bear an uncertain Lake.
relationship to the Point Bay group. The Black Lake 2. Interbedded arenite and wacke underlie the Gibi
volcanics, which consist primarily of massive and Lake volcanics north of Graphic Lake (Trowell,
pillowed mafic flows, occupy an anticlinal structure 1984, in preparation).
between Yellow Girl Bay and Bug Lake. Car (1980) 3. Interbedded arenite and wacke overlie the Gibi
completed a study in the western part of the Eastern Lake volcanics on Rat Lake.
Peninsula and hypothesized the existence of an Ar
chean composite cone in that area. In the Adams 4. Wacke and magnetite ironstone overlie the north
River Bay area, coarse mafic debris flows, fine mafic ern limb of the Black Lake volcanics at Bug Lake.
tuff, wacke, and mafic flows are interbedded. This 5. Wacke overlies the southern limb of the Black
clastic sequence represents the distal part of the Lake volcanics.
composite volcano hypothesized by Car (1980) over 6. Intermediate pyroclastic rocks and wacke overlie
lying and interdigitated with mafic flows of the Black the Point Bay group south of Dryberry Lake.
Lake volcanics. The Black Lake volcanics may repre
sent flank flows from this prograding volcano, for 7. Wacke overlies the Populus volcanics south of
ming a platform on which the composite volcano Dirtywater Lake.
continued to grow. 8. Interbedded wacke and arenite, and wacke over
Figure 3.3 shows simplified stratigraphic sections lie and underlie the Berry River formation.
in the Long Bay Lobstick Bay area. In the Gibi Lake

53
CHAPTER 3

1 Figure 3.3. Simplified


stratigraphic sections
- — — — — - Warclub within the Long
~--------- Group ------ Bay-Lobstick Bay area.
A ^ 3 V f Warclub The Gibi Lake section is
•7 •3 A ^7 Warclub Group
rt A *
* V \ •---.--r-----
Group from work by Trowell (in
^
A A •—---- Warclub Mafic preparation). Correlation
A V A
A y Group /* ^
•7* ^
Metavolcanics between the Gibi Lake
Gibi Lake V Gibi Lake VA V
A M < Metavolcanics
A
V A
*
Metavolcanics /'S and Rat Lake sections is
V V A y
A* 4 A C*
S V A
based on stratigraphic
Metasediments s V A Berry River similarity.
Meta- — — — **A*
s
^.^
4 V
V l/ sediments t- ±1 i-
* *
^ -7 TA* A A V 4 ^
V A*
t, -1
-7
^ -7
V ~r \ ^-^ 4 f

* "A-
T
-r ^ Dogtooth Lake A *- \
/l Metavolcanics Black Lake ^
-7
^
Black Lake
\1 Metavolcanics l'
W di LtlUU

v *-
-7
\ A A V Group
^ * <
\
-7
t". \ -1-7 h\-
y A -i -7
Point Bay
Group
GIBI LAKE RAT LAKE BLACK RIVER LONG BAY

North of Black Lake Metavolcanics South of Black Lake Metavolcanics

arenite T A 4 v) mafic pyroclastic rocks


wacke o^A^l felsic to intermediate pyroclastic rocks
v\ mafic flows -^--— stratigraphic tie lines not to scale

9. Wacke interdigitates with and is probably the also used 152 analyses from a previous study by
distal sedimentary equivalent of the Berry River Goodwin (1970) and 67 analyses by Morrice (1977).
formation northwest of Mist Inlet (see Figure 1.35, Jensen cation plots (Jensen 1976) of the lower
Chapter 1, this volume). most mafic volcanic sequences are shown in Figure
These lithologies, in their various stratigraphic 3.4. There is some scatter of the data, and no ob
positions, are commonly interbedded with intermedi vious trend from komatiitic to magnesian tholeiitic is
ate pyroclastic rocks. Numerous formations may ulti present. These sequences were previously designat
mately be defined within the Warclub group, and ed (Trowell, Blackburn, and Edwards 1980) as mag
much additional work will be required to determine nesian tholeiitic flows (MTF). Except for a few flows
their inter-relationships. At this time, no coherent with komatiitic chemistry, there is no evidence (for
stratigraphic model exists to explain this sequence. It example spinifex texture) to indicate the presence of
may be that within the Long Bay Lobstick Bay area, true komatiites.
this group represents the interfingering of several Mixed sequences of felsic to intermediate
sedimentary environments and periods of deposition. pyroclastic rocks and subordinate flows, and mafic
The Berry River formation has been dated at flows and subordinate pyroclastic rocks are
2713.9 Ma by Davis and Edwards (1982), and is volumetrically the predominant volcanic assemblages
assumed on the basis of its stratigraphic position to in the study area. Plots for each of nine sections are
be younger than the Black Lake volcanics, Gibi Lake given in Figure 3.5 (from Trowell, Blackburn, and
volcanics, and Point Bay group. South of Berry Lake, Edwards 1980). New data for the Central Volcanic
the Berry River formation is a south-facing homoclinal Belt is given in Figure 3.6 (from Blackburn ef at.
sequence within the Warclub group proper and over 1982). There is a considerable scatter of data points
lies part of that group with slight unconformity. with samples falling in both the calc-alkalic and
The Berry River formation has been subdivided tholeiitic fields, but predominantly the calc-alkalic
into volcanic facies (see Chapter 1, this volume). Two field. Because all suites contain samples that plot in
ages or events of deposition have been interpreted. the tholeiitic and calc-alkalic fields, these were des
A unit of quartz-feldspar porphyry associated with the ignated (Trowell, Blackburn, and Edwards 1980) as
younger age overlies rocks related to the older event. tholeiitic to calc-alkalic flows and pyroclastic rocks
The younger event is believed to be located at the (TCFP).
eastern extremity of the Berry River formation, south- Plots from 5 thick upper mafic sequences are
east of Berry Lake. shown on Figure 3.7 (modified after Trowell, Black
burn, and Edwards 1980). Data from Morrice (1977)
LOCAL GEOCHEMICAL SYNTHESIS for the Snake Bay volcanics are presented in Figure
3.8.
A first evaluation of major element analyses (Trowell,
Blackburn, and Edwards 1980) of more than 1000 Data presented by Morrice (1977) show that the
samples supports and augments the general stratig rocks of the lower mafic group exhibit little or no
raphic relationships outlined above. The authors have chemical variation; K20 content is very low, generally

54
N.F. TROWELL AND G.W. JOHNS

Figure 3.4. Jensen cation


plot for Jutten volcanics,
Northern volcanic Belt,
Northern and Wapageise
Volcanic Belt volcanics, showing their
92 points tholeiitic, relatively
magnesian character
(from Trowell,
Blackburn, and Edwards
1980).

AI 203 MgO

^.10 070 ; Ti02 content is O 070 ; while FeO (total) is and Edwards 1980) designated as Fe-tholeiitic flows
between 1007o and 13 070 . With increasing stratigraphic (FTF).
height in the middle mafic group, AI 2O3, CaO, and
MgO decrease in amount, while FeO (total), Ti02, REGIONAL GEOCHEMICAL SYNTHESIS
Na20, and P 205 increase.
The distribution of the three types of volcanic suites
Morrice's (1977) samples when plotted on the is shown on Figure 3.9. Some general trends are
AFM ternary diagram of Irvine and Baragar (1971) apparent.
and the AI-Fe-Mg cation plot of Jensen (1976) as
shown in Figure 3.8, show that the lower mafic group Lower mafic flow sequences are tholeiitic and,
and middle mafic group of flows are magnesium apart from Katimiagamak Lake and perhaps the mid
tholeiitic basalts and iron tholeiitic basalts, respec dle mafic section of the Snake Bay Volcanics, they
tively. tend to be predominantly magnesian tholeiites. Mid
dle mixed sequences of Figure 3.9 are highly vari
As noted previously (Trowell, Blackburn, and Ed able and in general show a distinct calc-alkalic trend.
wards 1980), the Katimiagamak Lake volcanics are at Upper mafic flow sequences are predominantly Fe-
the base of the sequence in the Kakagi Lake area tholeiitic.
(Figure 3.7). While the Katimiagamak volcanics were
then correlated with the entire Snake Bay formation, it
would appear that chemically (Figure 3.8) they only GEOCHRONOLOGY
compare with the middle mafic section of that forma In an attempt to test, and in many cases refine the
tion. The lower mafic section of the Snake Bay For correlations proposed in the study area, a radiometric
mation has not yet been correlated with any mafic dating program using precise uranium-lead zircon
metavolcanic suite in the immediate area. ages was initiated in the late 1970s under the direc
Figures 3.7 and 3.8 show that although there is tion of D.W. Davis of the Royal Ontario Museum,
considerable scatter of data, the majority of samples Toronto. Several publications in the early 1980s
fall in the tholeiitic field, with a tendency to be on the (Davis ei al. 1982; Davis and Trowell 1982; Davis and
high-Fe side of the high-Mg/high-Fe divider. Also, in Edwards 1982) have presented numerous ages for
contrast to magnesium tholeiitic flow sequences, various volcanic sequences and plutonic rocks
there is a tendency towards Fe enrichment. These throughout the study area. A summary of these ages
assemblages were previously (Trowell, Blackburn, is presented in Figure 3.10 (from Blackburn et al.
1982). As yet, none of the lower magnesian tholeiitic

55
CHAPTER 3

Figure 3.5. Jensen cation


Lower plots for Rowan Lake
Wabigoon volcanics, Kakagi Lake
Volcanics volcanics, Lower
154 points Wabigoon volcanics,
(82 from Manitou Lakes section,
Goodwin, North and South
1970) Sturgeon Lake
Rowan Lake
volcanics, and
Beckington Road and
47 points
(24 from
Morgan Island sections
\ Goodwin, of the Northeast Arm
1970) volcanics showing their
calc-alkalic to tholeiitic
character (from Trowell,
FeCH-Fe 2 O3*TiO Blackburn, and Edwards
1980).
\ Manitou
Section
98 points

Kakagi Lake
30 points
(18 from
Goodwin,
1970)

Handy Lake Volcanics


69 points

North Northeast Arm Volcanics


Sturgeon Lake (Beckington Road Section)
Volcanics 79 points
72 points

South Sturgeon Lake Volcanics


49 points A, Q
MgO
Northeast Arm Volcanics
(Morgen Island Section)
107 points

56
N.F. TROWELL AND C. W. JOHNS

Fe 2 O3*FeO*TiO 2 Fe 2 O3 *FeO*TiO 2 Figure 3.6. Jensen cation


and AFM plots of recent
data from the Central
Volcanic Belt, Sioux
Lookout area (from
Trowell etal. 1983),

AI 203 MgO AI 20 3 MgO

Figure 3.7. Jensen cation


Upper Wabigoon Volcanics
plots for Brooks Lake
volcanics, Katimagamak
34 points
(28 from Goodwin 1970), volcanics, Boyer Lake
volcanics, Upper
Wabigoon volcanics,
and Central Sturgeon
Lake volcanics, showing
their tholeiitic, relatively
Fe-rich character (from
Trowell, Blackburn, and
Edwards 1980).
Katimiagamak Volcanics
34 points

AI 2 O 3 MgO
Central Sturgeon Lake
Volcanics
70 points

Boyer Lake Volcanics


27 points
Brooks Lake Volcanics
61 points

57
CHAPTER 3

FeO sequences have been dated mainly because of the


(total) lack of zircon-bearing phases in them, so the total
time span of volcanism represented in the study area
is still unknown. Future uranium-lead zircon dating
programs and the use of new dating techniques
should resolve this problem. One of the youngest
volcanic sequence so far dated is the Berry River
formation situated in eastern part of the Lake of the
Woods area. Age dating in the Lake of the Woods
area proper will determine whether or not the appar
ent younging of volcanic sequences from Savant
Lake southwest to Kakagi Lake is in fact a valid
interpretation.

STRATIGRAPHY AND GOLD MINERALIZATION


A brief discussion of mineral deposits in the study
area was published previously (Trowell, Blackburn,
and Edwards 1980). Since that time, however, there
has been renewed interest in gold exploration. For
example, the Goldlund Deposit, southwest of Sioux
Lookout, is at present being mined; a new gold occur
rence has been discovered by Steep Rock Mines
Na 2OK 20 MgO Limited at Sturgeon Lake, and numerous other known
occurrences or past producers such as the St. An
thony Mine at Sturgeon Lake are being re-examined.
Berry River In a previous publication (Trowell, Blackburn, and
analyses from Morrice Formation
(1977) Edwards 1980), it was suggested that three broad
Snake Bay categories of gold occurrences can be recognized in
Formation the area: 1) those related to volcanic and subvol
canic stratigraphy, 2) those occurrences associated
with later felsic intrusions cutting the volcanic stratig
raphy, and 3) occurrences situated within quartz
veins having, as yet, no apparent relationship to
volcanic activity or igneous intrusions. These cate
gories were defined on the basis of lithologic control,
and were not meant to imply genetic relationships, or
to rule out the importance of structural control in the
localization of gold deposits. Additional categories
that could be added include gold occurrences in
carbonated, commonly silicified shear zones (for ex
ample, Cameron Lake), and gold occurrences situ
ated in mafic volcanic rocks at the greenschist am
phibolite metamorphic facies interface.
A guide to areas of gold potential could be the
recognition of favourable "packages" of lithologies.
Al Mg For example at Armit Lake west of Savant Lake, the
following lithologies are present: mafic volcanic
rocks, carbonatized ultramafic rocks (one komatiitic
flow), chert magnetite-iron silicate sulphide iron for
mation and intermediate to felsic tuffaceous rocks.
These lithologies suggest active volcanism, with qui
Figure 3.8. Jensen cation and AFM plots of the escent periods when deposition of iron formation and
Berry Creek Complex and Warclub group, and outpourings of mafic and ultramafic lava occurred; an
Snake Bay formation (analyses from Morrice environment which could be considered to be
1977). favourable for gold mineralization.
In the Long Bay-Lobstick Bay area, gold occurs
in silicified-carbonatized shear zones, feldspar por
phyry, and granitoid stocks. Probably the association
having the most economic potential is that of the
silicified carbonatized shear zones within mafic
metavolcanics. The most extensive shear zone is the
Pipestone-Cameron Fault. Within the Long Bay-Lob
stick Bay area a significant gold occurrence is found
within this fault zone between Regina Bay and Reed
Narrows. Here, the Wabigoon Fault and the

58
N.F. TROWELL AND G.W. JOHNS

tholeiitic to calc-alkalic flows and pyroclastic rod Figure 3.9. Sketch map
to show distribution of
magnesian-tholeiitic flows the three volcanic
iron-tholeiitic flows suites in the study area.

sediments
granitic rocks
iron formation
faults

WABIGOON SUBPROVINCE

O SABASKONG GNEISS

O HERONRY DIORITE

O STEPHEN LAKE STOCK (POST TECTONIC)

O KATIMIAGAMAK GABBRO
KAKAGI LAKE,
1———*—————— BERRY CREEK COMPLEX
ATIKWA LAKE
*-*-~ TUFF, TOP OF KAKAGI LAKE GROUP

'—*—— GABBRO, KAKAGI SILL

—*— SABASKONG BATHOLITH

-*- DACITE, DASH LAKE

— TAYLOR LAKE STOCK (POST TECTONIC!

1————*———————————————' TUFF, BOYER LAKE VOLCANICS MANITOU STORMY


LAKES
THUNDERCLOUD PORPHYRY •—9 — --
'——*——' ATIKWA BATHOLITH, DORE LAKE

'——*———- RHYOLITE. CONTACT BAY EAGLE WABIGOON


—*—' ATIKWA BATHOLITH, EAGLE LAKE LAKES
-*- DACITE, EAGLE LAKE .

O TUFF, ABRAM GROUP


SIOUX LOOKOUT
-*— TUFF. NEEPAWA GROUP

—9—— TUFF. TOP CYCLE, SOUTH STURGEON LAKE VOLCANICS

LOWER CYCLES, t-*-" SOUTH STURGEON LAKE VOLCANICS


STURGEON LAKE
1———*———' GABBRO, PIKE LAKE

preliminary data BEIDELMAN BAY PLUTON


O
published data, error bars represent a 9596 confidence E- HANDY LAKE
VOLCANICS
SAVANT LAKE

2690 2700 2710 2720 2730 2740 2750 2760

AGE (millions of years)

Figure 3.10. Zircon uranium-lead geochronology for Savant Lake-Crow Lake Area.

59
CHAPTER 3

Pipestone-Cameron Fault merge. Between Hope Lake Goodwin, A.M.


and the Kishquabik Lake Stock, recent discoveries of 1965: Preliminary Report on Volcanism and Mineral
gold have been made in smaller quartz-carbonate ization in the Lake of the Woods-Manitou Lake-
shear zones cutting the Populus volcanics. Gold has Wabigoon Region of Northwestern Ontario; On
also been noted near feldspar porphyries within the tario Department of Mines, Preliminary Report
Berry River formation and the Populus volcanics. 1965-2, 63p. Accompanied by Chart, scale 1:253
The Regina Bay Stock is a tonalite body intruding 440.
the Snake Bay formation. A past producer, the Regina 1970: Archean Volcanic Studies in the Lake of the
Mine, is situated on the south contact of the stock Woods-Manitou Lake Wabigoon Region of West
with the mafic metavolcanics where auriferous quartz ern Ontario; Ontario Department of Mines, Open
veins cross the contact. There is potential for addi File Report 5042, 47p.
tional occurrences in similar situations. Irvine, T.N., and Baragar, W.R.A.
1971: A Guide to the Chemical Classification of the
REFERENCES Common Volcanic Rocks; Canadian Journal of
Earth Sciences, Volume 8, p.523-548.
Blackburn, C.E.
1978: Populus Lake-Mulcahy Lake Area in Savant Jensen, L.S.
Lake Crow Lake Special Project, Districts of 1976: A New Cation Plot for Classifying Subalkalic
Thunder Bay and Kenora; p.28-44 in Summary of Rocks; Ontario Division of Mines, Miscellaneous
Field Work, 1978, by the Ontario Geological Sur Paper 66, 22p.
vey, edited by V.G. Milne, O.L White, R.B. Barlow, Johns, G.W.
and J.A. Robertson, Ontario Geological Survey, 1981: MacQuarrie McGeorge Townships Area, District
Miscellaneous Paper 82, 235p. of Kenora; p.22-25 in Summary of Field Work,
Blackburn, C.E., Breaks, F.W., Edwards, G.R., Poulsen, 1981, by the Ontario Geological Survey, edited
K.H., Trowell, N.F., and Wood, J. by John Wood, O.L. White, R.B. Barlow, and A.C.
1982: Stratigraphy and Structure of the Western Colvine, Ontario Geological Survey, Miscella
Wabigoon Subprovince and its Margins; Field Trip neous Paper 100, 255p.
Guidebook, Trip 3, Geological Association of 1982: Long Bay Area, District of Kenora; p. 15-18 in
Canada-Mineralogical Association of Canada Summary of Field Work, 1982, by the Ontario
Joint Annual Meeting, Winnipeg, Manitoba, 105p. Geological Survey, edited by John Wood, O.L.
White, R.B. Barlow, and A.C. Colvine, Ontario
Burwash, E.M. Geological Survey, Miscellaneous Paper 106,
1934: Geology of the Kakagi Lake Area; Ontario De 235p.
partment of Mines, Annual Report for 1933, Vol 1983: Long Bay Area, District of Kenora; p. 11-14 in
ume 42, Part 4, p.41-92. Summary of Field Work, 1983, by the Ontario
Car, D.P. Geological Survey, edited by John Wood, O.L
1980: A Volcaniclastic Sequence on the Flank of an White, R.B. Barlow, and A.C. Colvine, Ontario
Early Precambrian Stratavolcano Lake of the Geological Survey, Miscellaneous Paper 116,
Woods, Northwestern, Ontario; Unpublished Mas 313p.
ter of Science Thesis, University of Manitoba, Johns, G.W., and Davison, J.G.
111p. 1983: Precambrian Geology of the Long Bay-Lobstick
Davis, D.W., Blackburn, C.E., and Krogh, T.E. Bay Area, Western Part, Kenora District; Ontario
1982: Zircon U-Pb Ages from the Wabigoon-Manitou Geological Survey, Map P.2594, Geological Series
Lakes Region, Wabigoon Subprovince, Northwest Preliminary Map, scale 1:15 840 or 1 inch to 1/4
Ontario; Canadian Journal of Earth Sciences, Vol mile. Geology 1982.
ume 19, p.254-266. Johns, G.W., Good, D.J., and Davison, J.G.
Davis, D.W., and Edwards, G.R. 1984: Precambrian Geology of the Long Bay-Lobstick
1982: Zircon U-Pb Ages from the Kakagi Lake Area, Bay Area, Eastern Part. Kenora District; Ontario
Wabigoon Subprovince, Northwest Ontario; Cana Geological Survey, Map P.2595, Geological
dian Journal of Earth Sciences, Volume 19, Series-Preliminary Map, scale 1:15 840 or 1 inch
p. 1235-1245. to 1/4 mile. Geology 1982, 1983.
Davis, D.W., and Trowell, N.F. Johns, G.W., and Richey, Scott
1982: U-Pb Zircon Ages from the Eastern Savant 1982: Precambrian Geology of the MacQuarrie Town
Lake-Crow Lake Metavolcanic-Metasedimentary ship Area, Kenora District; Ontario Geological
Belt, Northwest Ontario; Canadian Journal of Survey, Map P.2498, Geological Series Prelimi
Earth Sciences, Volume 19, p.868-877. nary Map, scale 1:15 840 or 1 inch to 1/4 mile.
Davies, J.C., and Watowich, S.N. Geology 1981.
1958: Geology of the Populus Lake Area; Ontario Mackasey, W.O., Blackburn, C.E., and Trowell, N.F.
Department of Mines, Annual Report for 1956, 1974: A Regional Approach to the Wabigoon-Quetico
Volume 65, Part 4, 24p. Belts and its Bearing on Exploration in Northern
Ontario; Ontario Division of Mines, Miscellaneous
Paper 58, 30p.

60
N.F. TROWELL AND G.W. JOHNS

Morrice, M.G. Trowell, N.F., Logothetis, J., and Caldwell, G.F.


1977: Stratigraphic and Geochemical Evaluation of 1980: Gibi Lake Area, District of Kenora; p. 17-20 in
Archean Greenstone Belts, Lake of the Woods- Summary of Field Work, 1980, by the Ontario
Kakagi Lake Stormy Lake Regions Northwestern Geological Survey, edited by V.G. Milne, O.L
Ontario; Unpublished Report, Centre for Precam White, R.B. Barlow, J.A. Robertson, and A.C. Col
brian Studies, University of Manitoba. vine, Ontario Geological Survey, Miscellaneous
Trowell, N.F. Paper 96, 201 p.
In preparation: Geology of the Gibi Lake Area; Ontario Wilson, H.D.B., and Morrice, M.G.
Geological Survey. 1977: The Volcanic Sequence in Archean Shields;
Trowell, N.F., Bartlett, J.R., and Sutcliffe, R.H. p.355-376 in Volcanic Regimes in Canada, edited
1983: Geology of the Flying Loon Lake Area, District by W.R.A. Baragar, LC. Coleman, and J.M. Hall,
of Kenora; Ontario Geological Survey, Report 224, Geological Association of Canada, Special Paper
109p. Accompanied by Maps 2458 and 2477, Number 16, 476p.
scale 1:50 000 and one Chart. Wilson, H.D.B., Morrice, M.G., and Ziehlke, D.V.
Trowell, N.F., Blackburn, C.E., and Edwards, G.R. 1974: Archean Continents; Geoscience Canada, Vol
1980: Preliminary Synthesis of the Savant Lake-Crow ume 1, Number 3, p. 12-20.
Lake Metavolcanic Metasedimentary Belt, North
western Ontario, and its Bearing upon Mineral
Exploration; Ontario Geological Survey, Miscella
neous Paper 89, 30p. Accompanied by Chart A.

61
Chapter 4

Stratigraphic Correlation in the Wawa Area


R.P. Sage

CONTENTS ABSTRACT
Abstract.......................... 62 Strike-slip faulting and subsequent folding followed
Introduction .................... 62 by northwest left-lateral faulting created an unusually
General Geology ........... 62 complex structural pattern in the supracrustal rocks
of the Wawa area, Ontario. Stratigraphic correlation
Correlation Techniques 63 between faulted parts of the supracrustal sequence
Conclusions ................... 68 can be made based on the recognition of repeated
References ..................... 68 systematic compositional variation in the lithologic
package, facing directions, and a regionally continu
FIGURES ous band of iron formation. Rapid lithologic variation
in primary volcanic textures prevents correlation with
4.1. Sketch map showing location of the
Wawa supracrustal belt...................................... 63 in lithologic sections of similar composition.
4.2. Generalized geologic sketch map of Both gold and base-metal mineralization occur
mapped area of Wawa supracrustal within the first of four cycles of volcanism. Gold
belt................................................................... 64 mineralization is exclusively associated with the
fourth cycle of volcanism. Most known gold occur
4.3. Idealized composite stratigraphic rences which are located at roughly the same gen
section for the Ruth and Josephine eral position in the volcanic stratigraphy occur within
iron ranges ...................................................... 65 the thermal aureoles of granitic stocks, or within
4.4. Idealized schematic of facies in shallow-dipping shear zones or reverse faults dis
Michipicoten iron formation ......................... 65 playing carbonate and silica alteration. Except for a
4.5. Jensen cation diagram of oldest mafic to ultramafic stock which hosts disseminated
cycle volcanic rocks ..................................... 66 copper and nickel mineralization, most base-metal
4.6. Geologic sketch map of oldest cycle occurrences are quartz veins containing minor con
volcanic rocks ................................................ 67 centrations of base-metal sulphides.
Ontario Geological Survey mapping continues to
delineate areas of economic interest within the first
cycle volcanic rocks and to assess the economic
potential of later cycles of volcanism. An enhanced
understanding of stratigraphy in the supracrustal
rocks of the Wawa area will aid in the search for
additional deposits of gold and base metals.

INTRODUCTION
In 1979, the Ontario Geological Survey undertook a
program to map the main part of the structurally
complex Wawa supracrustal belt (Figure 4.1). Thus
far, six townships, totalling 560 km2, have been com
pletely mapped and mapping in parts of five others
has begun. Reports on this work are in preparation.
Before commencing mapping in 1979, examina
tion of previous work indicated a structurally complex
belt with a broad range of lithologies. in recognition
of the structural complexity, emphasis has been
placed on unravelling the framework of the supra
crustal sequences. Considerable time and effort has
been expended in determining facing directions with
in supracrustal sections, and in tracing fault zones
that subdivide the supracrustals into numerous
blocks. Mapping of this complex supracrustal pack
age is continuing.

GENERAL GEOLOGY
The Wawa supracrustal sequence consists of three
and possibly four cycles of volcanic rocks. Most of
the present mapping has been concentrated in the
first or oldest cycle of volcanism which is a north-
facing mafic-felsic sequence bounded beneath by

62
P.P. SAGE

Figure 4.1. Sketch map


showing location of the
l l granitic, migmatitic rocks
Hill metavolcanics, metasediments
Wawa supracrustal belt.
Sudbury Structure
sediments

the external granitic terrain and overlain by the lat base dikes, and minor post-dike deformation is lo
erally extensive Michipicoten iron formation. Within cally recognizable. In Late Proterozoic time, a car
the lower mafic part of the first cycle, a discontinu bonatite complex was emplaced within the Archean
ous sequence of intermediate to felsic volcanic rocks supracrustal rocks east of the town of Wawa (Figure
locally capped with minor iron formation defines an 4.2). Numerous lamprophyre dikes which cut the
internal subcycle. Wawa supracrustal rocks are probably the same age
Overlying the Michipicoten iron formation and as the carbonatite intrusion.
lying beneath clastic sedimentary rocks is approxi The structural complexity of the belt and the
mately 1000 m of intermediate to mafic volcanic broad spectrum of rock types present have made it
rocks which defines part of second cycle volcanism. very difficult to unravel its structural and stratigraphic
The clastic sediments consist of wacke, siltstone, relationships with certainty.
argillite, and conglomerate. These sediments are
most likely the detritus from the intermediate to felsic CORRELATION TECHNIQUES
volcanic rocks representing the upper part of second
cycle volcanism. A volcanic centre associated with Correlation between various fault-bounded lithologic
second cycle volcanism is represented by the rocks packages is difficult because of extensive strike-slip
north of the Magpie River. Lateral correlation of the and left-lateral faulting and folding. An iron formation
sedimentary and volcanic rocks is difficult due to unit has proven the most reliable lithologic marker
faulting and folding (Figure 4.2). Within incompletely horizon (Figure 4.2). The individual fault segments
mapped townships in the north-central part of the are named after the segment of iron formation con
belt, the clastic sedimentary rocks are overlain by tained within each faulted block: that is, the Lucy iron
intermediate to mafic volcanic rocks which may de range, Eleanor iron range, and Josephine-Bartlett iron
fine a third cycle of volcanism. range.
South of Wawa, a caldera-like structure, defined No single method of correlation by itself has
by the quartz diorite to granodiorite Jubilee Stock proven satisfactory in further refining the volcanic
enclosed in a partial ring of quartz-feldspar porphyry, stratigraphy of the area. Structure and stratigraphy
may represent a fourth cycle of volcanism (Sage must be used together to unravel the framework of
1979). Correlation of lithologic units across Wawa the belt. Marker horizons are absent within the mafic
Lake is difficult due to strike-slip faulting and possi and felsic volcanic sections. Few texturally distinctive
ble folding beneath Wawa Lake. lithologic units are present, this inhibits correlation
over short distances.
The supracrustal sequence at Wawa has been
subjected to strike-slip faulting, minor reverse fault Lithologic correlation can be best made on the
ing, and intense folding. The folding has become basis of rock composition rather than physical fea
recumbent, and in some areas of the belt such as in tures such as varioles, pumice, clast size or shape,
Chabanel and Musquash Townships, the stratigraphy or pillow morphology. Major lithological contacts are
is overturned. placed at rock compositional breaks which are not
necessarily time equivalent. Recognition of major
After strike-slip faulting and folding, the supra compositional breaks in combination with bedding
crustal sequence was broken into fault blocks by a and facing attitudes permit correlation within and
series of northwest-trending left-lateral faults. These between fault blocks.
northwest-trending faults have been intruded by dia

63
CHAPTER 4

granitic rocks
quartz feldspar porphyry
and felsic intrusive rocks
mafic intrusive rocks
carbonatite
felsic volcanic rocks
mafic volcanic rocks
sedimentary rocks
iron formation
T— fault zone
syncline
anticline
inclined bedding, top unknown
bedding, top (arrow) from grain
gradation (inclined, vertical)
lava flow, top (arrow) from pillows

Figure 4.2. Generalized geologic sketch map of mapped area of Wawa supracrustal belt.

64
P.P. SAGE

strike slip fault


100-300 iron formation
mafic volcanic rocks
T
A A
(main unit) argillite,
graphite, pyrite
300-400 felsic tuffs and breccia
chert,
0-70- ferruginous dolomite graphite, argillite
60-100 mafic breccia
0-150 iron formation chert, wacke
30-120 altered mafic volcanic —
rocks MI
-iron formation .j
0-500
-felsic tuffs and breccia ^
chert, magnetite
(subcycle) o
mafic intrusive rocks
chert, pyrite,
4800-5000 siderite
massive and pillowed
mafic volcanic rocks
massive pyrite,
minor siderite
felsic intrusive rocks

Hawk Lake
metres granite complex
siderite, pyrite
RUTH and JOSEPHINE IRON RANGE
STRATIGRAPHIC SECTION

Figure 4.3. Idealized composite stratigraphic sec


tion for the Ruth and Josephine iron ranges. massive siderite
Note the stratigraphic position of the ferrugin
ous dolomite and mafic breccia.
felsic volcanic rocks
The Michipicoten iron formation represents a pe MICHIPICOTEN TYPE
riod of chemical clastic sedimentation during a hiatus IRON FORMATION
between first and second cycle volcanism.
Within the central mafic part of the oldest cycle, Figure 4.4. Idealized schematic of facies in
a discontinuous zone of felsic volcanic rocks defines Michipicoten iron formation. Note sharp upper
an internal subcycle (Figure 4.3) which is locally and lower contacts and gradational internal
capped with iron formation. The felsic volcanic rocks contacts.
of the subcycle consist of tuffs, lapilli-tuffs, quartz-
feldspar-phyric crystal tuffs, and minor amounts of
breccia. The iron formation of the subcycle consists magnetite-bearing flows in the mafic part of the early
of a lower sulphide and upper chert member and is cycle and these could be used as geophysical mark
narrower and more discontinuous than the iron for er horizons.
mation that caps the major cycle. Carbonate facies The mafic breccia likely consists of more than
(that is, siderite) have not been observed in this iron one flow unit and contains considerable carbonate.
formation, and the chert-magnetite and graphite-argil- The clasts are rounded to angular and more felsic
lite facies are either absent or poorly developed. than the dark green to black matrix. They commonly
Carbonate facies iron formation has been reported to display both a reaction rim and a accretionary rim up
be present in the Kathleen iron range which is part of to 4 to 6 mm thick. The breccia unit, which displays
the internal cycle (Assessment Files Research Office, crude bedding and poor sorting, is locally polymictic
Ontario Geological Survey, Toronto (AFRO)). containing iron formation and sulphide clasts in addi
By contrast, within the Michipicoten iron forma tion to felsic volcanic clasts, some of which are
tion, a consistent facies variation has proven to be a vesicular and pumiceous.
reliable facing indicator. From bottom to top, the The ferruginous dolomite associated with the
commonly observed sequence is siderite, pyrite, mafic breccia is fine grained, massive, and rusty
chert-magnetite-wacke, chert-wacke, and argillite-py- weathered, with a thinly bedded base. The unit com
rite (Figure 4.4). One or more of these facies may be monly displays a random criss-crossing pattern of
absent in any given area, but where two or more are milky quartz stringers. The criss-crossing stringers of
present, facing direction can be determined. quartz and rusty weathering make this unit easily
A mafic breccia at the top of the intermediate to recognizable in the field.
mafic part of the oldest cycle and a ferruginous The volcanic rocks of the oldest cycle consist of
dolomite stratigraphically above the breccia have a lower sequence of massive to pillowed volcanic
proven to be reliable local marker horizons beneath rocks of iron tholeiite composition (Figure 4.5). The
the Lucy, Ruth, and Josephine-Bartlett iron ranges overlying felsic volcanic rocks consist of tuff, lapilii-
(see Figure 4.3). Mapping has disclosed numerous tuff, feldspar phyric crystal tuff, quartz-feldspar-

65
CHAPTER 4

FeOFe 2O3"TiO2 have not yet fully confirmed these reports of anoma
lous copper and gold.
The value of the Michipicoten iron formation is its
iron content only. Geochemically anomalous values
of copper, nickel, gold, and zinc have been reported
intermediate to felsic volcanic rocks (Assessment Files Research Office, Ontario Geologi
intermediate to mafic volcanic rocks cal Survey, Toronto; Collins and Quirke 1926; Richter
1952) but again, surface sampling during the recent
mapping has not indicated anomalous base-or
precious-metal contents.
The gold showings in the southeastern part of
the region (Figure 4.6) are in most cases quartz veins
associated with shearing and carbonatization at
lithologic contacts. These showings appear to occur
regionally where metamorphic grade is transitional
from greenschist to lower amphibolite. This transition
is recognized in the field by decreasing carbonate
content and the appearance of amphibole. The am
phibole has been altered to chlorite suggesting that it
has undergone retrograde metamorphism.
The same gold showings all occur at approxi
mately the same distance from the contact of the
Wawa Lower Cycle Volcanic Rocks (cation Hawk Lake granitic complex and may be related to
the thermal aureole of that complex. The possibility,
Figure 4.5. Jensen cation diagram of oldest cycle therefore, exists that 1 or more lithologic units once
volcanic rocks. Note strongly bimodal character
contained gold that has been remobilized and con
and big h- iron tholeiitic nature of mafic volcanic
centrated into veins or shear zones.
rocks.
Base-metal showings are nearly all sulphide-
bearing quartz veins of limited extent, and are re
phyric crystal tuff, spherulitic flows, and coarse brec stricted to the lower part of the oldest cycle. The
cias of rhyolite to dacite composition. The calc-al most significant base-metal mineralization in the
kalic and tholeiitic parts of the oldest cycle are com- mapped part of the belt involves disseminated cop
positionally strongly bimodal, implying no simple di per and nickel sulphides with platinum values in a
rect petrogenetic relationship (Figure 4.5). mafic intrusion cutting volcanic rocks of the oldest
The mafic and felsic volcanic rocks of the sec cycle. This body sharply crosscuts lithologic trends.
Immediately south of the disseminated copper and
ond cycle display primary structures similar to first nickel occurrence, a massive sulphide showing, 1 m
cycle rocks and are indistinguishable in the field in width, occurs along a contact between mafic vol
from first cycle volcanic rocks on the basis of ap canic rocks and a quartz porphyry intrusive rock.
pearance. Based on diamond drilling, this high grade copper,
The Hawk Lake granitic complex, which contains zinc, and silver occurrence does not appear to be
inclusions of the mafic part of the oldest cycle, has traceable laterally or to cjepth.
been dated by uranium-lead zircon techniques as A high grade silver, lead, and lead-bearing quartz
2888 ± 2 Ma (Turek 1983), and felsic tuffs imme vein is the only mineralization found in the felsic part
diately below the Michipicoten iron formation at the of the oldest cycle and in fact, occurs in a quartz
Helen iron range have been dated by uranium-lead diorite intrusion cutting the volcanic rocks. This
techniques as 2749 ± 2 Ma (Turek et al. 1982). showing lies below the Helen iron formation and
Hence, on the basis of these isotopic ages, the appears to be quite small. Grab samples from this
development of the oldest cycle exceeds 130 Ma. vein exceed 40 ounces silver per ton.
The felsic volcanic rocks of the second cycle have
been dated by uranium-lead techniques as 2696 ± 2 South of Wawa, an area of gold mineralization
Ma (Turek e t al. 1982). may be associated with the thermal aureole around
the Jubilee Granitic Stock which appears to be cen
Within the area mapped to the present, most tred within a caldera structure (Sage 1979; Figure
mineralization occurs in the oldest cycle (Figure 4.6). 4.6). The central stock is of dioritic to granodioritic
Gold mineralization, by itself without any other asso
composition, contains numerous blocks of volcanic
ciated economic mineralization, occurs in association rocks, and locally displays an intrusive breccia mar
with the epiclastic tuffs of Cycle Four that have been gin. The stock is exposed at a structurally high level.
intruded by the Jubilee Stock. An outer ring fracture is occupied by massive quartz-
On the basis of records on file in the Assessment feldspar porphyry that partly encloses the stock. The
Files Research Office, Ontario Geological Survey, To gold commonly occurs within quartz lenses that cut
ronto, anomalous levels of copper and gold occur in and are concordant with redeposited tuffaceous units
a minor iron formation unit overlying felsic volcanic of andesitic to dacitic composition, marginal to the
rocks within the mafic part of the oldest cycle. Sur granitic stock. These epiclastic tuffs are tentatively
face samples collected during the present survey interpreted to represent the fourth cycle of volcanism
in the Wawa area. Bedding in the tuffs dips away

66
P.P. SAGE

LAKE
GRANITE

granitic rocks
quartz feldspar porphyry
and felsic intrusive rocks
mafic intrusive rocks
carbonatite
felsic volcanic rocks
mafic volcanic rocks
JUBILEE
STOCK sedimentary rocks
iron formation
-—T- fault zone
syncline
anticline
mineral occurrence

Figure 4.6. Geologic sketch map of oldest cycle volcanic rocks with more prominent mineral occurrences
and former producing mines.

67
CHAPTER 4

from the stock and strikes parallel to the volcanic - CONCLUSIONS


plutonic contact. Lensoid in plan view, these In summary, geologic mapping in the Wawa area so
lithologic units occupy former topographic depres far has shown that major gold and base-metal min
sions on the flanks of the former volcano and repre eralization is largely restricted to one major mafic-
sent rapid subaqueous deposition of volcanic detritus felsic volcanic cycle and that a period of solely gold
from the volcanic edifice which existed above the mineralization occurs in the latest cycle of volcanism.
Jubilee Stock. Most base-metal occurrences are restricted to a
Early studies of the gold deposits south of Wawa broad zone that parallels stratigraphy. Gold mineral
classified the deposits as quartz veins (Frohberg ization occurs in discrete lithologic units, in a broad
1937; Gledhill 1927). These investigators recognized zone that is parallel to lithologic trends, and in the
at least two ages of veining. The gold mineralization thermal aureoles of granitic intrusions. Gold also oc
was said to be associated with the older quartz veins curs in early reverse faults in association with
that display a sugary texture and contain minor con silicification and carbonatization.
centrations of sulphide, principally pyrite and chal Due to the complex structure of the Wawa supra
copyrite. Later, coarsely crystalline quartz veins were crustal belt, much time consuming detailed mapping
described as barren with respect to gold and are is required to unravel the structure and stratigraphy
deficient in sulphides (Gledhill 1927; Frohberg 1935). and to trace zones of economic interest. Plans for the
Samples of coarsely crystalline barren quartz vein future are to continue mapping lower cycle volcanic
material collected during recent mapping generally rocks and to complete additional mapping and eco
confirmed these observations. nomic evaluation of the volcanic rocks of the later
Recently, a re-evaluation of several gold deposits cycles. The mapping program will ultimately provide
south of Wawa has been completed by Dunraine the data base to permit identification of areas of
Mines Limited under the direction of Mr. G. Harper greatest mineral potential.
and Dr. P. Studemeister, Consulting Geologists. At
least some of the gold-bearing veins are presently REFERENCES
referred to as lenses and are interpreted to be sugary
quartzites, or in some cases, recrystallized cherty Collins, W.H., and Quirke, T.T.
tuffs deposited within a sequence of redeposited 1926: Michipicoten Iron Ranges; Geological Survey of
tuffs on the flanks of a former volcano (H. Koza, Canada. Memoir 147, 173p.
Dunraine Mines Limited, personal communication, Frohberg, M.H.
1983). The lenses are limited in exposure and lack 1937: The Ore Deposits of the Michipicoten Area;
internal bedding and contain volcanoclastic frag Ontario Department of Mines, Annual Report for
ments. The gold deposits are considered to have 1935, Volume 44, Part 8, p.39-83.
formed either as subaqueous placers or as redeposit Gledhill, T.L
ed gold-bearing cherty tuffs. This interpretation is 1927: Michipicoten Gold Area, District of Algoma;
based on the presence of tuffs displaying good pri Ontario Department of Mines, Annual Report for
mary sedimentary structures above and below the 1927, Volume 36, Part 2, p. 1-49.
Parkhill gold-bearing lenses, the crudely conformable
nature of some lenses, and the presence of gold- Richter, D.H.
bearing siliceous tuff lenses within the epiclastic 1952: Mineralogy and Origin of the Michipicoten Iron
tuffs. Outlines of underground slopes on existing Formations; Unpublished Thesis, Queen's Univer
mine plans suggest the possibility that meandering sity, Kingston, Ontario, 97p.
streams may have influenced gold distribution. If this Sage, R.P.
model is correct, the source beds proximal to the 1979: Wawa Area, District of Algoma; p.48-53 in Sum
volcanic vent have likely been removed by erosion of mary of Field Work, 1979, by the Ontario Geologi
the former volcanic edifice above the Jubilee Stock, cal Survey, edited by V.G. Milne, O.L White, R.B.
however, the location of allocthonous deposits of Barlow, and C.R. Kustra, Ontario Geological Sur
economic significance may be possible. vey, Miscellaneous Paper 90, 245p.
Gold also occurs as lenzoid quartz bodies within Turek, A.
altered early shear zones. These zones possibly re 1983: The Evolution in Time of the Wawa-
present reverse faults that cut the Jubilee Stock. The Gamitagama Plutonic-Volcanic Terrains, Superior
nature of these quartz lenses is uncertain and some Province, Northern Ontario; Geological Associ
could be siliceous mineralized tuffs incorporated into ation of Canada, Mining Association of Canada,
the faults. The reverse faults and strike-slip faults are and Canadian Geophysical Union, Program with
the oldest recognized faults in the Wawa area and Abstracts, Volume 8, p.A70
are offset by northwest-trending left-lateral faults. In Turek, A., Smith, P.E., and Van Schmus, W.R.
addition to silicification, the shear zones are car 1982: Rb-Sr and U-Pb Ages of Volcanism and Granite
bonated and contain minor disseminated pyrite. Emplacement in the Michipicoten Belt, Wawa, On
tario; Canadian Journal of Earth Sciences, Vol
ume 19, p. 1608-1626.

68
Chapter 5

Mineralization and Volcanic Stratigraphy in the


Western Part of the Abitibi Subprovince
L.S. Jensen

CONTENTS ABSTRACT
Abstract .......................................................................... 69 The distribution of mineralization in the western part
Introduction 69 of tne Archean Abitibi Subprovince is closely related
Regional Stratigraphy 'and Structuri""!!!! ~ 70 to the volcacnic sedimentary stratigraphy of the sub-
-. f . , t , .,. t A,.-*-.-' province. Supergroups composed of komatiitic,
Petrogenesis of the Western Ab.t.b. tholeiitic, calc-alkalic, and alkalic volcanic groups de-
bubprovince................................................................... 72 veloped during cycles of volcanism. Separate superg-
Mineraiization ................................................................ 72 roups can be recognized in different parts of the
Introduction ................................................................ 72 area. Mineralization repeatedly occurs in the same
Tectono-stratigraphic Setting.................................. 74 nthologies at the same stratigraphic position in each
Massive Copper-Zinc-Lead Sulphide Of the supergroups. Massive copper-lead-zinc depos-
Deposits ..................................................................... 75 jts, Iron Formation, and stratiform gold mineralization
Iron Ore Deposits ...................................................... 77 occur in the calc-alkalic phases of at least two super-
Stratiform Gold Mineralization ................................ 78 groups. Massive nickel deposits, and asbestos, mag-
Nickel Sulphide Deposits ........................................ 81 nesite, and talc deposits are associated with the
Asbestos, Magnesite, and Talc Deposits .............. 83 komatiitic flows and related intrusions. Lode gold
Lode Gold Deposits .................................................. 83 deposits are concentrated near the Kirkland Lake-
Summary ........................................................................ 84 Larder Lake and Destor Porcupine Fault Zones and
References..................................................................... 85 are associated with late alkalic volcanism and intru-
_____________________________ sions of the youngest supergroup.
TABLES________________________ A knowledge of regional stratigraphy and struc-
5. 1 Types of mineralization occurring in tu. re in combination with a geological model of green-
the western part of the Abitibi stone belt development allows interpretation of env.-
. n Subprovince
.t ^ . •••••"•••••••••••••••"•••••••••••••••••••••••••••••••••- 70 ronments
jhe favourablemodel
megacauldron for mineral
suggestsdeposit formation.
that base-metal
5.2 Stratigraphy of the volcanic sulphide deposits, iron formations, and stratiform
sequence m the western part of the go|d mjnera | ization are preferentially located in the
AbitiDi Belt............................................................. 77 centra | vent area sne|f and outer sne|f margins of a
mature calc-alkalic pile, respectively. Nickel mineral-
ization occurs where komatiitic lavas onlap rocks of
5.1 Map of the Abitibi Subprovince ......................... 70 an older calc-alkalic pile, whereas asbestos, talc, and
5.2 Geological map of the Timmins- magnesite occur in peridotitic sills with olivine-rich
Kirkland Lake area 71 cumulates which have been penetrated by hydrous

5- 3 !sar^^^
resulting from volcan.c cycles ..........................
5.4 Geological map of the Timmins area ...............
72
72
73
where stratjform gO,d.Deari ng sedimentary rocks may
nave been deposited and buried by younger mafic
5.5 Geological map of the Kirkland Lake- volcanic rocks.
Larder Lake area ................................................. 74 _____________________________
5.6 Geological map of the Kirkland Lake- INTRODUCTION
Noranda area........................................................ 75 ———-—-————:————————;————-——
c- ~ . . . . 4 , . . ... L ... This chapter examines the general relationship be-
5.7 Geological map of the LaKe Abitibi tween various types of mineralization and volcanic
area ........................................................................ 7b stratigraphy in the western part of the Archean Abitibi
5.8 Regional stratigraphic correlation for Subprovince of the Canadian Shield (Figure 5.1). Six
the eastern part of the Abitibi principal types of mineralization occur in this part of
Subprovince.......................................................... 76 the Abitibi Subprovince (Table 5.1). Numerous au-
5.9 Development of a primary thors have long recognized the close spatial associ-
megacauldron above a mantle diapir............... 78 ation between specific kinds of mineralization and
5.10 Development of a secondary certain volcanic, sedimentary, and intrusive rock
megacauldron marginal to a primary types within mining camps (Goodwin 1965; Hutch-
meoacauldron south of Kirkland Lake ............. 79 inson 1973; Pyke 1976). However, attempts to inter-
5.11 Distribution of komatiites and general ^la(te minin9 famPs^haXe , met with, limited sV,cceSS
stratigraphy in the Timmins-Kirkland fC,olv,ne et al. 1984). On y recently has suf icient
Lake part of the Abitibi Subprovince................ 80 information become available about the volcan.c
stratigraphy in this region to permit discussion of the
relationship between mineral deposits in the various
mining camps and the overall volcanic stratigraphy.

69
CHAPTER 5

Figure 5.1. Map of the


Abitibi Subprovince.

suggest where in the western part of the Abitibi


TABLE 5.1: TYPES OF MINERALIZATION Subprovince similar mineralization could be present.
OCCURRING IN THE WESTERN PART OF THE Volcanic stratigraphy can be an important guide
ABITIBI SUBPROVINCE. for mineral exploration, both on regional and local
scales. On a local scale, volcanic stratigraphy has
MINERALIZATION ASSOCIATED ROCK played an important role in locating additional min
TYPES eralization in many of the mining camps and will be
increasingly important as Archean volcanism and
1. Massive Cu-Zn-Pb Proximal and central crustal development becomes better understood.
Deposits vent calc-alkalic
volcanic rocks On a regional scale, volcanic stratigraphy serves
several purposes in the field of mineral exploration. It
2. Iron Ore Deposits Distal calc-alkalic provides an essential panoramic view of the variety
felsic tuffs, turbidic of rocks and their distribution, which gives insight
sedimentary rocks ± into patterns of Archean volcanism, sedimentation,
mafic and ultramafic and plutonism in a given greenstone belt. This in
volcanic rocks formation, when applied to more general models of
3. Stratiform Gold Turbiditic and chemical Archean greenstone belt development, helps in the
Deposits sedimentary rocks ± recognition of favourable environments for mineral
mafic and ultramafic deposit formation by comparing existing Archean de
volcanic rocks posits with more recent examples of mineralization.
As well, the distinctive types of mineralization found
4. Massive Ni-Cu Ultramafic volcanic in widely separated mining camps within a green
Deposits rocks ± turbiditic stone belt can be put in perspective.
sedimentary rocks and
calc-alkalic felsic tuffs Jensen (1981 a) and Jensen and Langford (1985)
proposed that the rocks of the western part of the
5. Asbestos, Ultramafic intrusive Abitibi Subprovince were formed by a series of
Magnesite, and Talc and extrusive rocks megacauldrons originating above mantle diapirs. This
Deposits model can be applied to explain the volcanic stratig
6. Lode Gold Deposits Alkalic felsic intrusive raphy, structural features, and metamorphism found
and extrusive rocks in this part of the Subprovince. It is the author's
opinion that folding and faulting were contempora
neous with volcanic activity and exerted control on
the volcanic stratigraphy and environments favoura
Numerous petrogenetic theories and models ble to particular types of mineralization (Jensen
have been proposed to explain the types of min 1981a, 1981 b).
eralization listed in Table 5.1. No single model ade
quately explains all the features which are asso REGIONAL STRATIGRAPHY AND STRUCTURE"
ciated with any of these types of mineralization. In The volcanic and sedimentary rocks of the Timmins-
this paper, brief reference will be made to various Kirkland Lake Noranda part of the Abitibi Sub
models as they relate to the volcanic stratigraphy. No province form a large east-trending synclinorium
exhaustive attempt will be made to prove or disprove (Figure 5.2). Domal tonalitic to trondhjemitic
any particular model; instead, the aim will be to batholiths and gneissic terrains are present north,
identify the stratigraphic environment in which par south, and west of the central synclinorium. Two
ticular types of mineralization tend to occur, and to major fault zones, the Destor-Porcupine Fault Zone
and the Kirkland Lake-Cadillac Fault Zone, transect

70
LS. JENSEN

Figure 5.2. Geological


map of the Timmins-
K irk land Lake area.

ROUND
\ -h j -* -f
BATHOLI
4- -V -* -f
SOUTHERN 1

LEGEND

Proterozoic
Keeweenawan diabase (not shown) 7 7a, 7b, Kinojevis Group, 7c Kinojevis Group
12 Cobalt Group (Middle Fm., Tisdale Group)
Archean 6 6a Larder Lake Group, 6b Stoughton-
Matachewan diabase (not shown) Roquemaure Group, 6c Lower Fm., Tisdale
Granitic rocks Group
11 Granodiorite, monzonite, quartz 5 5c Porcupine Group
monzonite, syenite Lower Supergroups
10 Massive to gneissic quartz diorite, 4 4a Skead Group, 4b Hunter Mine Group,
tonalite, trondhjemite 4c Upper Fm., Deloro Group
Upper Supergroup 3 3a Catherine Group, 3c Middle Fm., Deloro
9 9a* Timiskaming Group, 9b* * Destor- Group
Porcupine Complex 2 2a Wabewawa Group, 2c Lower Fm., Deloro
8 8a, 8n, Blake River Group, 8c* * * Blake Group
River (Upper Fm., Tisdale Group) 1 1a Pacaud tuffs* ' * *

i refers to Kirkland Lake Area, south limb of synclinorium (Jensen 1978c, 1979).
*b refers to Kirkland Lake Area, north limb of synclinorium (Jensen 1976, 1978b).
* *c refers to Timmins Area (Pyke, 1980).
*** (Goodwin, 1965).

the northern and southern limbs of the synclinorium, The various supergroups are shown on Figures
respectively, and numerous small plutons of 5.4, 5.5, 5.6. and 5.7. They include: the Deloro Group
granodioritic to syenitic composition cut all the vol (Pyke 1982) south of Timmins (Figure 5.4), the top of
canic and sedimentary rocks. Diabase dikes varying which has been dated at 2725 ± 2 Ma (Nunes and
from Archean to Late Proterozoic in age occur Pyke 1980); the Wabewawa-Catherine-Skead Superg
throughout the area, and Proterozoic sedimentary roup south of Kirkland Lake (Figure 5.5), dated at
rocks of the Huronian Supergroup onlap the Archean 2710 ± 2 Ma (P.D. Nunes, formerly with Royal Ontario
rocks from the south. Regional metamorphism of the Museum, personal communication, 1982) and the Up
Archean rocks is subgreenschist facies (Jolly 1976, per Supergroup shown in Figure 5.6, the upper parts
1978; Gelinas era/. 1982). of which have been dated at 2703 ± 2 Ma (Nunes
A regional synthesis of the volcanic stratigraphy and Jensen 1980). The Upper Supergroup comprises
of the Abitibi Subprovince has recently been pub komatiitic flows of the Lower Tisdale Group (Figure
lished in Map 2484 (MERO-OGS 1983). The volcanic 5.4), Larder Lake Group (Figure 5.5), Stoughton-
rocks form a number of supergroups, which consist Roquemaure Group (Figure 5.7), and the Malartic
of a group of komatiitic flows at the base, overlain in Group (Figure 5.6) (MERQ-OGS 1984). These
turn by groups of tholeiitic lavas, calc-alkalic vol komatiitic successions are overlain by the tholeiitic
canic rocks, and in places, alkalic lavas (Figure 5.3). Kinojevis Group and calc-alkalic Blake River Group

71
CHAPTER 5

alkalic volcanic rock accumulated in the core of the


Alkalic volcanic Gr.
•*~ sedimentary rocks. megacauidron as the result of continued subsidence
and the simultaneous formation of volcanic edifices.
Calc-alkalic volcanic Gr. Ultimately, the partial melting of basal calc-alkalic
Volcanic ± sedimentary rocks.
volcanic rocks resulted in formation of trondhjemitic
Cycle
Supergroup
magmas which intruded the cores of the calc-alkalic
of a
megacauidron
Tholeiitic volcanic Gr. piles. Distal calcalkalic tuffs and sedimentary rocks
were deposited on the margins of these volcanic
Komatiitic volcanic Gr. piles. At depth, the garnet-bearing residuum from the
± sedimentary rocks. partial melting of the volcanic rocks sank farther into
the mantle.
Calc-alkalic volcanic Gr.
± sedimentary rocks,* alkalic In the older megacauldrons, where the calc-al
Volcanic '
volcanic rocks. kalic piles formed sufficiently large masses, the
Cycle Tholeiitic volcanic Gr. Supergroup growth of core trondhjemitic rocks resulted in com
posite batholiths. The low specific gravity of the
Komatiitic volcanic Gr, trondhjemitic rocks caused the rocks near surface at
i sedimentary rocks. the centres of the megacauldrons to stop subsiding.
Instead, the denser marginal volcanic and sedimen
tary packages subsided by their supporting rocks
Volcanic) Calc-alkalic volcanic Gr. /Super group
being drawn downward and inward under the batho
Cycle ± sedimentary rocks. lith to replace eclogitic rocks sinking below it. At
-H--H-
+ 4-H- Granitoid pluton surface, these marginal packages gradually tilted to
face away from the actual batholith. Marginal subsi
dence continued where accumulation of additional
Figure 5.3. Illustration of stratigraphic column re komatiitic and tholeiitic rocks from a newly develop
sulting from volcanic cycles. ing megacauidron nearby overlapped the rocks of the
older megacauldrons, and resulted in these rocks
forming thick outward-facing homoclinal successions.
For example, the Round Lake. Lake Abitibi, and
Kenogamissi Batholiths were primary megacauldrons
(Figure 5.6). Alkalic flows of the Timiskaming Group (see Figure 5.2). The calc-alkalic volcanic Pacaud
unconformably overlie the Kinojevis and Blake River Tuffs and Hunter Mine Group are all that remain of
Groups. The apparent stratigraphic thickness of the the volcanic phases from these primary megacaul
Wabewawa-Catherine-Skead Supergroup is 16 km drons (Figure 5.5 and 5.7). Succeeding megacaul
and the thickness of the Upper Supergroup is ^0 drons developed east of the Round Lake Batholith to
km. The Kidd Creek Rhyolites (2708 ± 2 Ma, Nunes form the east-facing homoclinal Wabewawa-
and Pyke 1980), Pacaud Tuffs, and Hunter Mine Catherine-Skead Supergroup (Figure 5.10). The De
Group (2710 ± 2 Ma, Nunes and Jensen 1980) are loro Group, and, north of Timmins, the Kidd Creek
considered to be the upper calc-alkalic parts of less Rhyolites (Figure 5.4) were formed east of the
well preserved supergroups (Figures 5.4, 5.5, and 5.7, Kenogamissi Batholith.
respectively). Regional correlation of the volcanic The youngest megacauidron developed in the
stratigraphy is presented in Figure 5.8 and Table 5.2. area is presently occupied by the Central Syn
clinorium (Figures 5.11 and 5.6). Initial komatiitic
PETROGENESIS OF THE WESTERN ABITIBI flows at the base of the Upper Supergroup lapped
SUBPROVINCE___________________ onto the rocks at the edges of the older megacaul
drons. Where these rocks are still preserved, they
Jensen (1981 a) and Jensen and Langford (1985) serve to outline the youngest megacauidron. As vol
proposed that each supergroup represented a vol
canism progressed, subsidence of the central
canic cycle related to the development of a komatiitic and succeeding volcanic rocks occurred in
megacauidron formed above a mantle diapir (Figure
the central part of the megacauidron, largely by
5.9). The first magmas to reach surface formed
downfolding and faulting along the Destor-Porcupine
komatiitic and tholeiitic lavas. As the accumulations
and Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake Fault Zone. The loca
of these flows thickened above the diapir, they sub
tion of these two fault zones is believed to approxi
sided by downfolding and faulting, particularly in the
mate the edges of the volcanic-sedimentary piles
central parts of the megacauidron. With depth, under
associated with the earlier megacauldrons. Downfol
increasing pressures and temperatures, the lower
ding and faulting also occurred in the core of the
core komatiites and tholeiites were transformed into
synclinorium during the accumulation of the calc-
more dense amphibolite, garnet granulite, and ec
alkalic Blake River Group (Figure 5.6).
logite which further promoted subsidence of the
overlying rocks. At lower crustal and upper mantle
depths, the komatiites and tholeiites which had been MTNERALIZATION
partly converted to eclogite began to undergo about INTRODUCTION
1007o partial melting. This resulted in the formation of
calc-alkalic magmas which then rose to the surface, Pyke (1982) concluded that much of the mineraliza
producing the observed change from tholeiitic to tion in the Timmins area occurred near the contact
calc-alkalic volcanism. A thick succession of calc- between the felsic volcanics and sedimentary rocks
of the older volcanic cycles (Deloro and Porcupine

72
L.S. JENSEN

Granodiorite. Monzonite
and Syenite
Tonalite and Trondhjemite

Upper Formation,
Tisdale Group
Middle Formation,
Tisdale Group
,' (] Lowei Formation,
Tisdale Group
Sedimentary Rocks
Porcupine Group

Lower Supergroup
Upper Formation,
Deloro Group
Middle Formation,
Deloro Group
Lower Formation,
Deloro Group

----Geological Boundary
Synclinal Axis
Anticlinal Axis
— — Fault
— — Township Boundary
-J— Stratigraphic Top
Scale
5 o 5 10 Km

Figure 5.4. Geological map of the Timmins area.

73
CHAPTER 5

----''' ---

GRANITOID INTRUSIONS
E3 Granodiorite, Monzonite, Syenite
E3 Tonalite and Trondhjemite
Upper Supergroup Stratigraphic Top
11 11 Timiskaming Group Geological Boundary
l l Blake River Group Syncline
EZ3 Kinojevis Group Anticline

^'•~^ l ^ Larder Lake Group (vole., sed.)


Fault
Township Boundary
Lower Supergroups
EH Skead Group
Scale
t"^-l Catherine Group
O 6 10
EH Wabewawa Group
H Pacaud Tulfs

Figure 5.5. Geological map of the Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake area.

Groups) and the komatiitic rocks of the younger vol the pile, where the shelves sloped steeply into neigh
canic cycle (Tisdale Group) (Figure 5.4). The deter bouring basins, stratiform gold deposits developed in
mination of the significance of this stratigraphic con association with deposition of chert, carbonate units,
tact is critical to the understanding of interrelation graphite, ironstone, and distal ash tuff. These min
ships between the gold, nickel, base-metal, talc, mag eralized sediments tend to be interlayered with tur-
nesite, asbestos, and iron ore deposits of the Tim biditic wacke, mudstone, and congiomerate eroded
mins area, as is an assessment of the degree of from the calc-alkalic volcanic pile. In the Abitibi Sub
stratigraphical control of mineralization. It is also im province, the stratiform gold-bearing sedimentary
portant to determine whether or not possible stratig rocks occur interlayered with komatiitic and tholeiitic
raphic controls also apply in other mining camps in flows that were laid down at the onset of volcanism
the Abitibi Subprovince. associated with the development of younger
megacauldrons in the neighbouring basins. Because
TECTONO-STRATIGRAPHIC SETTING of tectonic activity along the shelf-basin interface
and the emplacement of komatiitic and tholeiitic mag
Base-metal, iron ore, and stratiform gold deposits mas, the gold tends to be remobilized into fractures,
appear to have been closely associated with epi quartz and carbonate veins, and alteration zones. In
sodes of calc-alkalic volcanism and sedimentation this chapter, these types of lode gold deposits are
during the development of the megacauldrons. In the distinguished from lode gold mineralization closely
calc-alkalic volcanic piles, base-metal deposits are associated with late alkalic extrusive and intrusive
found in the proximal and near vent flows and tuffs. rocks.
Away from the vent areas, banded iron formation
tends to be interbedded with distal tuffs and tuff- Massive nickel sulphide deposits and asbestos,
breccias interlayered with sedimentary rocks com magnesite, and talc deposits are associated with the
posed of volcanic debris, chert, and in places, car komatiitic volcanic sequences of the megacauldrons.
bon and carbonate that likely formed in shelf areas The nickel mineralization is largely concentrated in
marginal to the calc-alkalic pile. Farther away from komatiitic flows that are in contact with sediments,

74
LS. JENSEN

^OTEROZOIC
B Cobalt
RCHEAN
Granitoid Intrusions
] Q ranod t M ds

El Quart! Gabbro and Diorite


Upper Supergroup
intamino Cad li d
__ Ouparquet Groups Lower Supergroup
[_J Blake River Group til Porcupine Group and
E3 Kino evis Grou Lois Formation
Larder Lake, Stoughton-Roquemaure 53 Skead and Hunter Mine Grou
and Malart.c Grou s E3 Catherine Grou
123 Wabewa.a Group

Figure 5.6. Geological map of the Kirkland Lake-Noranda area.

felsic tuffs, iron formation, and calc-alkalic lavas of (Bertrand and Hutchinson 1973) which maybe part of
the preceeding megacauldrons. Asbestos, magnesite, the Hunter Mine Group (2709 ± 2 Ma, Nunes and
and talc deposits are located in dunitic parts of Jensen 1980). These massive sulphide deposits have
peridotitic stocks, sills, and thick komatiitic lava flows accessory economic quantities of silver, gold, tin, and
that are found near the base of the komatiitic suc cadmium.
cession and intruding the older rocks of the preceed The most favoured model for the formation of
ing megacauldron. massive copper-zinc-lead sulphide deposits consists
Lode gold mineralization is also closely asso of hydrothermal solutions coming to surface and sub-
ciated with the final magmatic phase of a megacaul aqueously forming syngenetic sedimentary and near-
dron that typically produces alkalic felsic intrusive surface mineralization proximal to volcanic vents dur
and extrusive rocks. Gold is epigenetically concen ing periods of relative quiescence (Walker et al.
trated in quartz and quartz-carbonate veins, in frac 1975). Directly below the massive mineralization, the
ture fillings, in alteration zones and contact metamor older volcanic rocks exhibit "pipes" of alteration and
phic aureoles, and in the felsic rocks themselves. mineralization through which the hydrothermal solu
tions reached the surface. In the Noranda Mining
MASSIVE COPPER-ZINC-LEAD SULPHIDE DEPOSITS Camp, several massive sulphide deposits occur at
the same stratigraphic level, but others are situated
Massive copper-zinc-lead sulphide deposits are lo at different stratigraphic levels in the volcanic pile
cated in the proximal and central vent facies of calc- (Spence 1975).
alkalic volcanic rocks in the Lower Supergroups as
well as in the Upper Supergroup formed by succes The hydrothermal solutions responsible for the
sive megacauldrons. In the Upper Supergroup, the mineralization are thought to be a result of seawater
main massive sulphide deposits are in the Blake circulating through the volcanic pile and discharging
River Group (2703 ± 2 Ma, Nunes and Jensen 1980). near its core. Metals are leached from the surround
In the Lower Supergroup, they are located north of ing volcanic rocks and precipitated in the zone of
Timmins associated with the Kidd Creek Rhyolites discharge. Widespread leaching of copper, zinc, and
(2708 ± 2 Ma. Nunes and Pyke 1980) (Figure 5.4). In lead and associated alteration phenomena, however,
addition, the Normetal Mine, immediately northeast of has been difficult to detect in the volcanic rocks of
Lake Abitibi, is situated in calc-alkalic volcanic rocks the Noranda area.

75
CHAPTER 5

LEGEND
---- Geological Contact
ARCHEAN
-i— Syncline
Granitoids -J- Anticline
Granodiorite, Monzonite
[T] Tonalrte
Upper Supergroup
Blake River Group
Kinojevis Group
'J Stoughton-Roquemaure G

l\77r--*3^A -*
v:Mx/-"***-"
sH?^Slj tt&^Offi**^*
^V^;^:^:v^^^*SH^
J?--^'(,--S' **'** ' t" V/l/'vJ-^y ^

^: : ^^Y.'X'^^^^'^7,^^v^r'^R46l^E^/lLxE^^ .~l"
^M^Mi^f.r:!*M^
-*** xx
"x-' CENTRAL FAULT BLOCK

HARKER HOLLOWAY MARRI

Figure 5.7. Geological map of the Lake Abitibi area.

Figure 5.8. Regional


LEGEND
stratigraphic correlation
LV: Sedimentary Rocks for the eastern part of
Erd Alkalic Volcanic Rocks poorl the Abitibi Subprovince.
—— expos
L^J Calc-alkalic Volcanic Rocks
f—— Stoughton-Roquemaure Gr
~i Tholeiitic Volcanic Rocks l

\(L , Komatiitic Volcanic Rocks

PORCUPINE F.Z.
TIMMINS *
~ Timiskaming Group
-v. Blake River Group
2703±2Ma
Kinojevis Group

Upper F Uncxposed
LAKE F.Z.
Deloro Group -

LarderL;
A A Skead Group 27 lot 2 Ma
Catherine Group l
Wabewawa Group
Pacaud Tuffs

76
LS. JENSEN

TABLE 5.2: STRATIGRAPHY OF THE VOLCANIC SEQUENCE IN THE WESTERN PART OF THE ABITIBI BELT.
SOUTH OF TIMMINS NORTH OF TIMMINS LAKE ABITIBI QUEBEC KIRKLAND LAKE

Upper Fm Blake River Gr Blake River Gr


UPPER Tisdale Gr Blake River Gr
2703±2 2703± 2
SUPERGROUP 2703±2
Middle Fm
Kinojevis Gr Kinojevis Gr Kinojevis Gr
Tisdale Gr

Lower Fm Lower Fm Stoughton-


Roquemaure Gr Malartic Gr Larder Lake Gr
Tisdale Gr Tisdale Gr
r *~t—————-J2—-, (Sedimentary and

?- h-*-*" ~~*~t- -^-^^ Lois Fm


Volcanic Rocks)

Kidd Creek
Hunter Mine Gr Skead Gr
Rhyolite
LOWER
Porcupine Gr 2708 + 2 271012 2710 + 2
SUPERGROUP II
Catherine Gr

Wabewawa Gr
.^—————-^
II~^-7
Pacaud Tuffs
Upper Fm
Deloro Gr
LOWER
2725± 2 - - . ---?
SUPERGROUP 1 Middle Fm
Deloro Gr
- - - --?
Lower Fm
Deloro Gr
Pyke (1978a,1978b Pyke (1982) Jensen (1978b) Dimroth et al Jensen (1978c)
SOURCES OF 1982) (1982,1983a,1983b
Nunes and Pyke Nunes and Jensen Nunes, Pers. Comm.
INFORMATION Nunes and Pyke Nunes and Jensen
(1980) (1980) (1980) (1980) (1981)

An alternative model can be suggested if the has tilted sideways during its development (Figure
premise that calc-alkalic volcanic rocks are the prod 5.10), massive sulphide deposits would be more
uct of 10 0Xo partial melting of tholeiitic and komatiitic deeply buried and difficult to detect. Elsewhere, em
volcanic rocks of Jensen (1981 a) is accepted. Low placement of large tonalitic batholiths in the calc-
temperature melting components and most incompati alkalic core of a megacauldron would cause massive
ble elements tend to be extracted during the early sulphide deposits to be assimilated, and/or sloped
stage of partial melting and concentrated in the melt. away, or exposed and removed by erosion. This
For example, if the original partly melted mafic vol erosion would result in the dispersion of the base
canic rocks averaged 50 ppm copper, the generated metals, iron, and sulphur into sedimentary rocks de
calc-alkalic volcanic rocks should contain ^00 ppm posited on the margins of the calc-alkalic piles and in
copper rather than have an average of about 50 ppm more distal basins.
copper. It is probable that much of the copper and Areas favourable for further base-metal explora
other base metals are concentrated in the first 1 07o tion include the calc-alkalic volcanic rocks north of
partial melt, which separates as a sulphide-rich hy Timmins, the Shaw and Halliday Domes south of
drous solution from the silicate magma and is driven Timmins (Figure 5.4), the Hunter Mine Group south of
toward the surface by heat from the volcanism. Every Lake Abitibi (Figure 5.7), and the Blake River Group
10 km3 of mafic volcanic rock that was partly melted north of Kirkland Lake (Figure 5.6). Potential for
would contain enough base metal to from a large base-metal sulphides also occurs in the eastern
sulphide deposit for each 1 km3 of calc-alkalic rocks proximal facies of the Skead Group in Skead Town
formed. ship south of Kirkland Lake (Figure 5.5).
In a vertically subsiding calc-alkalic volcanic pile
such as the Blake River Group (Jensen 1981 b), mas IRON ORE DEPOSITS
sive sulphide deposits could readily form in a
"stacked" configuration at different stratigraphic lev At present, the only banded iron formation being
els, as well as occurring concentrated along specific exploited for iron ore occurs at the Adams Mine in
stratigraphic levels as described by Spence (1975). Boston Township south of Kirkland Lake (Figure 5.5).
In other megacauldrons where the calc-alkalic pile Here, iron formation is interbedded with cherty tuffs
and carbonaceous pyritic cherts near the base of the

77
CHAPTER 5

around the Shaw Dome and farther south (Pyke


LEGEND
1978b, 1982) (Figure 5.4). Here, it is interlayered with
K-rich granitic rocks calc-alkalic tuffs and grades into argillites and car
Trondhjemite rocks bonaceous sedimentary rocks of the Porcupine
Sedimentary rocks
Group. Iron formation is also intercalated with the
distal tuffs and cherts of the calc-alkalic volcanic
Calc-alkalic volcanic rocks
Hunter Mine Group (Dimroth et ai 1973; Jensen and
Dunite, pyroxenite and gabbro
Langford 1983) (Figure 5.7).
Tholeiitic volcanic rocks
Thin beds rich in magnetite occur in the turbiditic
Komatiitic volcanic rocks
sedimentary rocks of the Larder Lake, Pontiac, and
Primary crust-mantle Porcupine Groups. The deposition of banded iron
(carbonaceous chondrite)
formation and beds of magnetic clastic sediments
-Eclogite appear to require shelf and basinal environments
marginal to maturing calc-alkalic piles where periods
of local volcanic quiescence commonly occurred.
Iron formation and clastic sediments rich in mag
netite appear to be rare in volcanic successions
where distal felsic tuffs and sedimentary rocks asso
ciated with calc-alkalic volcanism are lacking. Iron
formation is limited to absent in the Stoughton-
Roquemaure Group (Figure 5.7), Wabewawa Group,
Catherine Group, the upper part of the Larder Lake
Group (Figure 5.5), and the Kinojevis Group (Figure
5.6), which suggests that the development of iron
Partial melting
of eclogite formation is not favoured during komatiitic and
tholeiitic volcanism. Banded iron formation is absent
in the Blake River Group calc-alkalic volcanic rocks
and in the proximal and central vent facies rocks of
the Hunter Mine Group and Skead Group. Hence, the
development of iron formation is largely limited to
marginal and basinal depositional facies of calc-al
kalic volcanic piles.
Granulite facies
Exhalative and sedimentary models have been
suggested to explain iron formation deposition. Alter
ation pipes which may be related to the development
of overlying iron formation from exhalative fluids oc
O 6
Garnet-rich residuums
cur in the Wawa Greenstone Belt (Goodwin 1966). In
the Timmins Kirkland Lake area, alteration pipes,
however, have not been identified for any of the
Figure 5.9. Development of a primary megacaul- numerous units of iron formation. Unlike massive
dron above a mantle diapir: a) Diapir above sulphide deposits which are lensoidal, banded iron
which komatiitic flows accumulate; b) Subsi formations tend to extend laterally for a km or more
dence of komatiitic flows and further accu with constant thicknesses and are interbedded with
mulation of tholeiitic flows; c) Partial melting of relatively carbonaceous chert, cherty tuff, and argil
komatiitic and tholeiitic rocks resulting in a lites which may or may not contain disseminated
calc-alkalic volcanic pile flanked by tuffs and sulphides. The absence of banded iron formation in
sediments; d) Partial melting of calc-alkalic vol the Blake River Group subaqueous proximal and near
canic rocks resulting in tonalitic intrusions. vent volcanic rocks suggests that iron formation
tends to be developed in more distal parts of calc-
alkalic piles as observed in the Skead and Hunter
Mine Groups (Jensen and Langford 1983).
The strong association of iron formation with the
Larder Lake Group (Jensen 1978c). Komatiitic and felsic tuffs and turbiditic sedimentary rocks favours
tholeiitic lavas directly overlie and underlie the de the model of Shegelski (1978) whereby iron forma
posit, respectively. This iron formation was formed on tions are deposited in basins marginal to eroding
the margins of the Skead volcanic pile shortly after volcanic piles. The silica and iron required for their
komatiitic and tholeiitic lavas of the next volcanic formation were possibly derived from a distant vol
cycle began to accumulate on its northern edge canic exhalative source in the proximal or vent parts
(Jensen and Langford 1985). Additional units of iron of calc-alkalic piles.
formation occur below the Larder Lake Group in the
marginal depositional facies of the Skead Group
STRATIFORM GOLD MINERALIZATION
(Jensen 1981 a) and at the base of the volcanic
succession in the Pacaud Tuffs (Figure 5.5). Stratiform gold deposits are those gold deposits and
In the Timmins area, iron formation occurs toward mines in which a significant part of their ore is
the top of the Upper Formation of the Deloro Group hosted by carbonaceous mudstones, wackes, tuffs,
cherts, iron formations and chemical carbonate-rich

78
LS. JENSEN

Trondhjemite Skead Group


stock
inal tuffs and basinal sediments

plex

t t Sinking eclogite
Komatiitic magmas masses
-Sinking eclogite C Initiation of calc-alkalic volcanism of the Skead Group by partial
masses melting of subsiding eclogitic komatiite and tholeiite flows
and cumulates.
a Initiation of komatiitic volcanism marginal to the calc-alkalic
volcano

Present erosional
Wabewawa Group surface
Catherine Group

\
x Cumulates of
fractionated
tholeiitic magma

b Development of the Wabewawa and Catherine Groups from mantle


derived magmas and the downward displacement of the Pacaud
"o/ Primary crust?
Y
VjL
tuffs and sedimentary rocks concomitant with the growth of the
Round Lake batholith.
d Cessation of calc-alkalic volcanism and later deposition of
Cobalt Group sedimentary rocks.

Figure 5.10. Development of a secondary megacauldron marginal to a primary megacauldron south of


Kirkland Lake: a) Initiation of komatiitic volcanism marginal to the calc-alkalic Pacaud volcano; b)
Development of the Wabewawa and Catherine Groups from mantle derived magmas and the downward
displacement of the Pacaud Tuffs and sedimentary rocks concomitant with the growth of the Round
Lake Batholith; c) Initiation of calc-alkalic volcanism of the Skead Group by partial melting of the
subsiding eclogitic komatiitic and tholeiitic flows and cumulates; d) Cessation of calc-alkalic volcanism
and later deposition of the Cobalt Group sedimentary rocks.

sedimentary rocks. These deposits include the Kerr Detritus from those older calc-alkalic volcanic piles is
Addison Mine and several smaller deposits in the also incorporated in the sedimentary rocks of the
vicinity of Larder Lake, and the Pamour, Hollinger, succession.
Owl Creek, and other major deposits in the Timmins Several models have been proposed for the gen
area. Also there is the recently discovered gold min esis of stratiform gold mineralization. These models
eralization east of Matheson in Holloway Township can be group into three main types:
(see The Northern Miner Press, December 27, 1984
issue). All of these deposits are located near, but not 1. Gold was deposited with clastic and chemical
directly on the Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake and Destor- sedimentary rocks (for example, Hinse 1984;
Porcupine Fault Zones. The gold-bearing sedimentary Jensen 1981 a).
rocks occur as interflow sediments to komatiitic and 2. Gold was precipitated at and near surface by
tholeiitic flows, or are interlayered with coarse mass hydrothermal solutions penetrating fractures
flow turbiditic sedimentary rocks composed mainly of along the major fault zones during the accumula
locally derived volcanic detritus. tion of volcanic and sedimentary rocks (for ex
The komatiitic and tholeiitic volcanic rocks of the ample, Fyon and Crocket 1983; Karvinen 1981).
Timmins and Larder Lake areas belong to the 3. Gold was concentrated epigenetically in the
komatiitic successions at the base of the Upper rocks along fault zones during late tectonism and
Supergroup. In the Timmins camp, the flows form part felsic igneous activity (Hodgson 1983; Colvine et
of the Lower Formation of the Tisdale Group (Pyke al. 1984).
1982) (Figure 5.4), which correlates with the Larder In the first model, the source of gold is an older
Lake Group in the vicinity of Larder Lake (Figure 5.8). eroding calc-alkalic volcanic pile where volcanism
In the Timmins and Larder Lake areas, the and fumarolic activity had occurred or was still oc
komatiitic and tholeiitic lavas and the interflow sedi curring and erosion of the pile was occurring. Gold
mentary rocks are part of volcanic sedimentary suc was transported in solution, and in colloidal and de
cessions deposited on the margins of older calc- trital forms across the shelf of the volcanic pile and
alkalic volcanic piles (Jensen and Langford 1985). selectively concentrated in sedimentary traps along
the tectonically unstable edges of the shelf at the

79
CHAPTER 5

.. .. 1^1 ".f* ^f-*-^Ui f I ft'^r^ D — _. .- ^T^*-Jj* .x. Z **-*L* \ *

Key
upper supergroup
volcanic rocks :
+\ 5 alkaline
Kenogamiss
4- + + + H 4 calc-a!kaline
Batholith M
* 'f -1- -t- +V V i
+V+I +
3 tholeiitic

* * A A -1
__ i l l S*f± + Round + Lake
+ •f + * + * +\ +V ^' /
V \/v , j———l n . 7-^- + + + + + + + + + -
•^ "^ * t *A 4-\ \ l * i WataLchewqn + + + + + + + + H-
+ + + +^+ X \ ' 1 s, + +~+ + + + •f + -^• + + ;
* * -1- \ V\ ^ \ /T + + + Batholith ^ + * ^
' ^ \ \ \ i S+. + + + + + + + + + 1 ' ^^^ 2 sedimentary rocks
\ \ \ l x^4- f + + + + + + + -^--
\ \ NV+.K * * -1- -1-
4- 4- 4- V
\ \ \ 'I++.+ + + + + + l calc-al kal ine and tholeiitic
\ volcanic rocks
\

50 km

Figure 5.11. Distribution of komatiites and general stratigraphy in the Timmins-Kirkland Lake part of the
Abitibi Subprovince (Jensen and Pyke 1982).

basin-shelf interface. The gold probably underwent form magnesite, dolomite, talc, and fuschite. Gold
several sedimentary reworkings prior to its final de and sulphides are concentrated along fractures and
position with carbonaceous muds, carbonates, cherts, quartz veins.
tuffites, and ferruginous sediments where sulphur- The Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake and the Destor-
rich reducing environments prevailed (see Springer Porcupine Fault Zones represent long-lived growth
1983). At the edge of the shelf, the gold-bearing faults (Jensen and Langford 1985). After the devel
sediments could be intercalated in a predominately opment of a calc-alkalic volcanic pile with sedimenta
sedimentary-tuffaceous succession as with other tion along its margins, komatiitic and tholeiitic vol
clastic sedimentary units as observed in the Hemlo canism related to the next volcanic cycle began in
deposits, or be interlayered with komatiitic and the adjoining basins. As this occurred, the basin
tholeiitic flows associated with a newly forming subsided with much of the displacement occurring
megacauldron as found in the Larder Lake and Tim along the basin-shelf interface where stratiform gold
mins area. deposits had formed. This deformation and asso
In stratiform gold deposits, much of the gold ciated metamorphism caused some of the gold to
occurs in quartz and quartz-carbonate veins and in migrate toward fractures (Jensen 1981 b). This model
shear zones which may have formed as a result of explains why stratiform gold deposits and the major
local komatiitic and tholeiitic volcanism and tectonic fault zones such as the Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake
movements. Huppert et at. (1984) pointed out that and Destor-Porcupine Fault Zones occupy the same
sedimentary rocks overridden by komatiitic magmas geological environment. A basin was present be
at 1400C to 17000C would be actively eroded and tween Timmins and Kirkland Lake with gold-bearing
assimilated by the komatiitic lava, resulting in exten sedimentary rocks being deposited at approximately
sive contamination and alteration of the lavas and the same time on its northern and southern margins
the overridden sedimentary rocks Silica, carbon, car (Figure 5.8). Subsequent filling of the basin with
bonate, alkalis, and water within the sediments would rocks of the Upper Supergroup caused subsidence;
be expected to strongly react with the magmas to much of the downward movement occurred along its

80
L S. JENSEN

northern and southern margins forming the two major the komatiitic flows must have occurred syn-
fault zones. genetically, definitely predating Timiskaming vol
In the second model, Fyon and Crocket (1983) canism and sedimentation. Chemical and detrital car
proposed that during the komatiitic volcanism and bonate units occur within the Larder Lake Group.
sedimentation, seafloor alteration occurred due to hy Some are conglomeratic containing both carbonatized
drothermal fluids consisting of modified seawater. and noncarbonatized, spinifex-textured komatiitic
These fluids penetrated upward via fractures asso clasts. Clasts of carbonatized komatiite commonly
ciated with the Destor-Porcupine and Kirkland Lake- occur in carbonate-poor conglomerates. These sedi
Larder Fault Zones and formed carbonate alteration mentary rocks are interlayered with carbonatized and
zones in the volcanic rocks. During intervals of vol noncarbonatized komatiitic lavas.
canic quiescence, exhalative action deposited aurif In the Timiskaming Group, extensive carbonatiza
erous cherty dolomite and pyritiferous graphite on the tion is rare. However, carbonate detritus can be
seafloor. Fyon and Crocket (1983) discounted the abundant in the basal conglomerates and in a few
quartz-feldspar porphyries and the komatiitic lavas as upper conglomeratic units higher in the Group, scat
being significant sources of the gold mineralization in tered carbonatized and noncarbonatized komatiitic
the Timmins Mining Camp. More recently, Fyon et pebbles can be easily recognized. Thus, this car
a/. 1983 have suggested that gold was mainly intro bonate material appears to have been derived by
duced epigenetically by C02-rich fluids rather than erosion of the earlier formed Larder Lake Group
during the deposition of the supracrustal rocks of the (Jensen and Langford 1983). Along the Kirkland
Timmins Mining Camp. Lake-Larder Lake Fault, carbonatized komatiitic lavas
Support for the proposals of Fyon and Crocket and carbonate sedimentary rocks are juxtaposed
(1983) and Fyon et al. (1983) comes from the abun against unaltered Timiskaming Group rocks.
dance of carbonatized komatiitic flows and Local carbonatization of komatiitic flows oc
carbonate-rich sediments located near the Destor- curred during the emplacement of syenite, monzonite,
Porcupine and Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake Fault and granodiorite bodies close to the Kirkland Lake-
Zones. Although komatiitic and tholeiitic flows under Larder Lake Fault Zone and the Destor-Porcupine
lie large areas of the Abitibi Subprovince, the car Fault Zone. In these places, the intrusive rocks also
bonatized komatiites and carbonate-rich sedimentary have carbonate-rich phases, and it is probable that
rocks are largely limited to the two major fault zones; they assimilated carbonate during their emplacement.
they are not extensively developed elsewhere. Away from the major fault zones felsic alkalic intru
Zones of carbonatized komatiitic flows with ex sive rocks and the associated carbonatization of the
tensive quartz veining are located in many places host komatiites sharply decreases; instead, talc and
along the length of the two major fault zones and are tremolite-rich rocks are formed where syenite, mon
not unique to the Timmins and Larder Lake Mining zonite, and granodiorite cut the komatiitic flows.
Camps. Many of these other zones of carbonatization The use of light stable isotopic evidence in sup
have been subjected to intense exploration with little port of the magmatic fluid model for gold deposits
success, which suggests that factors other than just can be also questioned. Seawater during the Archean
carbonatization and alteration must be critical to the was buffered by mantle-derived volcanic rocks unlike
development of auriferous rocks in the vicinity of the present-day seawater which is buffered by continen
Destor-Porcupine and Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake tal rocks (Veizer et al. 1982, Veizer, 1984). Light
Fault Zones. stable isotope abundances in Archean seawater
The epigenetic concentration of gold during late would be difficult to distinguish from those of mag
tectonism and felsic igneous activity forms the basis matic origin derived from mantle and lower crustal
of the third group of models, and applies mainly to sources. The mantle is poor in gold relative to other
lode gold deposits discussed later in this paper. Hod metallic elements, and, would probably have been
gson (1983) and Colvine et al. (1984) have sug depleted in gold by earlier melting episodes to form
gested that all the gold mineralization formed during the host supracrustal rocks. Erosion of calc-alkalic
a late stage cratonic stabilization of the Superior volcanic piles would serve to further concentrate gold
Province marked by felsic alkaline volcanism and in restricted sedimentary environments of the crustal
intrusion and that gold was introduced by magmatic rocks.
hydrothermal C02-dominated fluids. Support for this
model comes from the close association between NICKEL SULPHIDE DEPOSITS
felsic intrusions and gold mineralization in lode de In the western part of the Abitibi Subprovince, nickel
posits and the fact that gold in stratiform deposits is sulphide mineralization occurs mainly near the base
strongly associated with quartz veining. carbonate of the komatiitic Lower Formation of the Tisdale
alteration, and tectonic deformation. Stable light iso Group in the Timmins area (Pyke 1982) (Figure 5.4).
tope data suggest magmatic sources have influenced The largest and best studied deposits include the
the mineralizing hydrothermal fluid in the deposits Langmuir, Texmont, McWalters, Hart, Alexo, and Soth
considered to be stratiform. Colvine et al. (1984) man Deposits (Coad 1979). Similar nickel mineraliza
discounted sedimentary processes for concentrating tion occurs in Lamotte Township, Quebec (Marbidge
gold and instead, suggested that chemical sediments Deposit) in the komatiitic flows of the Malartic Group,
such as carbonaceous rocks selectively collected and in the komatiitic flows and intrusions south of
gold during hydrothermal activity. Kirkland Lake and in the Munro Township area.
Several features of the epigenetic model conflict Disseminated low grade nickel mineralization is
with field data. Much of the carbonatization found in present in many of the large gabbroic sills north of

81
CHAPTER 5

Timmins, particularly in the Kamiskotia Gabbroic flowed over calc-alkalic volcanic and sedimentary
Complex (Wolfe 1970). These sills, although tholeiitic rocks (Coad 1979). In the Timmins area, the
in composition (Coad 1979), appear to be closely komatiitic flows overlie calc-alkalic volcanic rocks of
associated with the komatiitic and tholeiitic flows of different ages. South of Timmins, the calc-alkalic
the Lower Formation of the Tisdale Group (Pyke rocks are tuffs and tuff-breccias that grade into car
1982). bonaceous argillites and iron formation deposited at
The Lower Formation of the Tisdale Group and the edges of volcanic piles represented by the Upper
Malartic Group are correlated with the Stoughton- Formation of the Deloro Group dated at 2725 ± 2 Ma
Roquemaure Group and Larder Lake Group (Figures (Jensen 1981 b). During the calc-alkalic volcanism,
5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7 and 5.8) (MEQ-OGS 1984). All four tuffs and turbiditic sediments of the Porcupine Group
groups are considered to represent the komatiitic (Figure 5.8) were being deposited in basins to the
base of the Upper Supergroup formed during the east of the Shaw Dome (Jensen and Langford 1983).
development of the youngest megacauldron. These Later, a second calc-alkalic volcanic pile developed
komatiitic lavas extended to overlap sedimentary and north of Timmins (Kidd Creek Rhyolites, 2708 ± 2 Ma,
tuffaceous rocks deposited on the margins of calc- Nunes and Pyke 1980), and more sediments were
alkalic volcanic piles formed by earlier megacaul- deposited in the areas to the southeast (Porcupine
drons. Group, Figure 5.4). A volcanic pile represented by the
Halliday Dome also developed to the west of
Sulphide mineralization consists of massive to Matachewan. Following this calc-alkalic volcanism
disseminated pyrrhotite, pyrite, pentlandite, and minor and sedimentation, widespread komatiitic volcanism
chalcopyrite. Magnetite and chromite are common was initiated in the basins between these calc-alkalic
and millerite, violarite, heazlewoodite, and sphalerite volcanoes. Komatiitic magmas cut through the calc-
can be present (Coad 1979). In the volcanogenic alkalic volcanic and sedimentary rocks forming
deposits, mineralization, particularly where massive, stocks and sills and komatiitic flows (Pyke 1982). In
tends to be concentrated as nonconcordant lenses places, nickel mineralization appears to have formed
near the base of peridotitic komatiitic flows. In some in the peridotitic komatiitic lavas as they came in
deposits, mineralization extends upward into the mid contact with the various older rocks.
dle and upper parts of the host komatiite unit; in
others, mineralization locally crosscuts the base of Sulphur-poor peridotitic lavas contain from 1500
the host komatiite and extends into the underlying to 2500 ppm nickel which is concentrated in the
rocks which are commonly calc-alkalic tuffs and tuff- lattice of silicate minerals. Sulphurization of the basal
breccias and carbonaceous mudstones with asso peridotitic flows overriding pyrite-rich sedimentary
ciated iron formation. and volcanic rocks appears to best explain the
stratigraphic location of the nickel sulphide deposits.
Four genetic models have been proposed to ex In many areas, particularly south of Kirkland Lake,
plain volcanogenic nickel sulphide mineralization peridotitic komatiites, however, can be observed di
(Coad 1979). Naldrett (1966) proposed a sulphuriza- rectly overlying pyritiferous sediments and felsic tuffs
tion model, whereby a reaction occurred between without the development of nickel sulphides.
sulphur from an external source and nickel-bearing
silicates. Sulphur could be introduced through melting The immiscible liquid model does not easily ac
of pyritiferous sedimentary and volcanic rocks by count for the restriction of the largest sulphide de
very hot (14000 to 17000C) with much komatiitic lava posits to the base of the komatiitic successions. This
(Huppert et al. 1984). model requires that the initial magmas formed by
partial melting of the mantle and incorporated most of
In a second model, Naldrett (1973) suggested the available sulphide liquid, leaving very little for
that magmatic sulphides formed liquid droplets im subsequent magma batches.
miscible in the komatiitic magma brought up from
depth. As the lava flowed out on surface, the The magmatic textures and the restriction of
droplets rapidly settled toward the base of the flow, nickel sulphides to the base of the komatiitic succes
concentrating close to the feeder. sion poses problems for the exhalative model and for
hydrothermal emplacement models that have been
To explain certain features of the Kambalda De suggested. Even though some alteration is present
posits in Western Australia not adequately covered near some nickel deposits, it is not as extensive as
by Naldrett's second model, Ross and Hopkins can be found elsewhere in the komatiitic succession,
(1975) proposed that a sulphide magma could sepa such as in zones around gold deposits and asbestos-
rate ahead of the komatiitic flow, and later be over magnesite deposits. The exhalative model would re
ridden by the flow. quire nickel-bearing solutions reaching the surface to
Lusk (1976) proposed a volcanic exhalative precipitate as nickel sulphides on the seafloor prior
model to explain the abundance of pyrite and the to the extrusion of komatiitic lavas. As the peridotitic
presence of other base-metal sulphides in nickel sul komatiite lavas flowed over the sulphides, they would
phide deposits and in the underlying carbonaceous have to incorporate the sulphides to produce the flow
sedimentary rocks and iron formation which com to result in the observed magmatic textures.
monly form the footwall rocks. The exhalative model Regardless of the model selected to explain sul
fails to explain the magmatic textures found in many phide mineralization, the most favourable environ
of the deposits (Coad 1979). ment, seems to be the lower contact of the komatiitic
Both the Abitibi and the Australian volcanogenic flows with iron formation, carbonaceous sediments,
nickel sulphide deposits tend to occur in an environ and/or calc-alkalic tuffs and flows. In the Timmins
ment where the host peridotitic komatiites have area, this environment is represented by the

82
L S. JENSEN

komatiitic flows of the Tisdale Group where they are ing of peridotitic komatiite flows, both near alkali
in contact with calc-alkalic volcanic rocks and asso felsic intrusive bodies and along faults, particularly
ciated sedimentary rocks of different ages. the Destor-Porcupine and Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake
Similar stratigraphic settings occur in the Kirkland Fault Zones. Chlorite, actinolite, quartz, and antigorite
Lake area (Figure 5.5) and the Lake Abitibi area are associated with the mineralization. Along the fault
(Figure 5.7). South of Kirkland Lake, peridotitic zones, iron-dolomite, calcite, fuchsite, and in a few
komatiitic flows of the Larder Lake Group and the places, gold and sulphide mineralization can also be
Wabewawa Group are in contact with calc-alkalic formed. However, gold and sulphide mineralization
tuffs, sedimentary rocks and tuffs of the Skead are notably absent in the major deposits of talc,
Group and Pacaud Tuffs, respectively. In the Lake magnesite, and asbestos, which again suggests that
Abitibi area, Stoughton-Roquemaure peridotitic factors other than C0?-rich hydrothermal fluids were
komatiites overlie the calc-alkalic volcanic rocks, responsible for gold mineralization.
sedimentary rocks and iron formation contained in Peridotitic sills with olivine cumulates occur with
the Hunter Mine Group. numerous other small subcircular unfractionated peri
dotite plugs and stocks cutting the lower parts of the
ASBESTOS, MAGNESITE, AND TALC DEPOSITS komatiitic succession of the Upper Supergroup and
the underlying calc-alkalic rocks of the Lower Super
In the western part of the Abitibi Subprovince, asbes groups (Figures 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, and 5.7). They probably
tos, magnesite, and talc deposits occur in ultramafic served as feeders to the komatiitic flows throughout
rocks associated with komatiitic volcanism at the the western part of the Abitibi Subprovince. From
base of the Upper Supergroup (Pyke 1982). The ma their distribution, they do not appear to have intruded
jor asbestos deposits are in Munro and Garrison along any particular fracture zone. There seems,
Townships south of Lake Abitibi, in Penhorwood however, to be greater potential for asbestos, talc,
Township west of Timmins, and in Midlothian Town and magnesite in large layered sills with olivine cu
ship near Matachewan (Figures 5.2, 5.4, and 5.7). mulates in close proximity to major fault zones such
Magnesite and talc deposits in Deloro Township as the Destor-Porcupine Fault Zone and the Kirkland
south of Timmins (Pyke 1982) occur in large peri Lake-Larder Lake Fault Zone.
dotitic sills which have extensive cumulates of
olivine toward their base.
LODE GOLD DEPOSITS
Many peridotitic-gabbro sills in the western part
of the Abitibi Subprovince were explored in the 1950s Several gold deposits in the western part of the
and 1960s and were found to contain only minor Abitibi Subprovince appear to be epigenitically asso
amounts of asbestos. The main difference between ciated with the emplacement of late alkalic to subal
economic and noneconomic sills appears to be the kalic felsic porphyritic to granitic textured intrusions
degree and type of alteration that took place during (Colvine et al. 1984). Gold mineralization is restricted
or subsequent to their emplacement. Pods and dikes to veins, fractures, alteration zones and metamorphic
of rodingite characterize the economic asbestos de aureoles around these intrusions. In places, mineral
posits. Zones of pervasive carbonatization can occur ization can be in the late granitic rocks themselves,
near and in contact with the asbestos mineralization either as disseminated gold, or gold concentrated in
(Satterly 1952). veins, fractures, and alteration zones. Included in this
group of gold deposits are the gold mines located
Asbestos cross-fiber occurs in closely spaced, along the Kirkland Lake "Main Break" (Thomson
generally polygonal fractures associated with mag 1950), the Ross Mine, Golden Arrow Mine, New
netite in massive serpentinitized dunites. The frac Keloro Mine located near Matheson, the Young Da
tures may have been cooling fractures, along which vidson Mine at Matachewan, and the mineralization
hydrous fluids penetrated shortly after solidification, of the Garrison Stock in Garrison Township. The num
or later, during subsequent hydrothermal events. The ber of major economic gold discoveries directly asso
asbestos deposits are located near, but not on the ciated with these late felsic intrusions; however, is
Destor-Porcupine and Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake small relative to the total number and volume of
Fault Zones which may have have been the foci of these intrusions, and most of the discoveries to date
extensive fluid movement. The deposits contain are limited to intrusions proximal the Destor-Porcu
footwall felsic tuffs and sedimentary rocks that may pine and Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake Fault Zones.
have once contained trapped pore fluids. These
fluids percolated into the peridotitic sills because The late alkalic to subalkalic felsic intrusions are
these footwall rocks underwent compaction and in part of a large suite of intrusive and extrusive rocks
creased temperatures associated with the emplace that is extremely variable in composition, texture, and
ment of the sills. distribution. The felsic end members consist of
granodiorite, monzonite, quartz monzonite, syenite,
In talc and magnesite deposits, the dunites and and sodium-rich syenodiorite, but ultramafic, mafic,
peridotites, instead of being serpentinized, have been and intermediate phases including several varieties
transformed into talc and magnesite ± quartz by of lamprophyre are common. The extrusive equiv
pervasive penetration of C02-rich hydrous solutions alents show a similar range in composition.
(see Pyke 1982). The talc and magnesite deposits
are hosted by strongly carbonatized mafic and ul The late felsic intrusive rocks differ substantially
tramafic volcanic rocks. from rocks of the Round Lake and Lake Abitibi
Batholiths. The late felsic intrusive rocks tend to be
Limited amounts of talc, magnesite, and serpen richer in alkalis, particularly potassium, and have
tine slip-fiber are formed by the alteration and shear more numerous inclusions of country rock than the

83
CHAPTER 5

batholiths. Also the gneissic textures of the tonalitic- Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake Fault Zones. The distribu
trondhjemitic batholiths is lacking in the late felsic tion of lode gold deposits closely coincides with
intrusive rocks. The batholiths form domal structures areas favourable for stratiform gold mineralization in
at the base of the volcanic succession, whereas the the vicinity of the major fault zones (see Stratiform
late felsic intrusions tend to crosscut the rocks in all Gold Mineralization). Lode gold deposits tend to oc
parts of the succession without appreciably doming cur on the downfaulted side of the major fault zones,
the surrounding rocks. and stratiform gold deposits tend to occur on the
The distribution pattern of the late alkalic intru upsides, where the older rocks are still exposed. For
sions does not suggest preferential intrusion along example, along the southern side of the Kirkland
fault systems. The largest volume of these rocks Lake-Larder Lake Fault Zone are the stratiform Larder
occurs between the Destor-Porcupine Fault Zone and Lake Camp gold deposits; the Kirkland Lake Camp
the Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake Fault Zone southeast lode deposits occur on the northern downfaulted side
of Timmins. The Watabeag Batholith composed of (Jensen 1981 a; Jensen and Langford 1985). Simi
syenite and granodiorite, forms part of this group of larly, along the northern side of the Destor-Porcupine
intrusions. The second largest concentration is be Fault there are the stratiform Timmins Camp deposits;
tween the Round Lake Batholith and Kirkland Lake- the Golden Arrow, Ross, and Garrison lode deposits
Larder Lake Fault Zone, and another concentration are found on the southern downfaulted side.
occurs along the southern edge of the Destor-Porcu Careful study of the volcanic stratigraphy is re
pine Fault Zone from Timmins eastward to Harker quired to predict the location of possible lode gold
Township (Figure 5.2). Alkalic intrusive rocks are deposits. First, it is necessary to reconstruct the sedi
rare, both north of the Destor-Porcupine Fault Zone mentary facies relationship on the flanks of the older
and in the area underlain by the Blake River Group calc-alkalic volcanic piles, particularly where the
(Figures 5.6 and 5.7). more distal, gold-bearing shelf and basinal sedimen
Alkalic volcanic rocks are abundant along the tary rocks may have been deeply buried by younger
Kirkland Lake-Larder Fault Zone and along the ultramafic and mafic volcanic rocks. Second, it is
Destor-Porcupine Fault Zone. They are interlayered necessary to look for structural discontinuities cros
with Timiskaming clastic sedimentary rocks, cut by scutting the younger volcanic and sedimentary rocks
the alkalic intrusive rocks. Porphyry clasts derived and younger discordant intrusions which may have
from the intrusions are found within the sedimentary caused the remobilization of gold and allowed it to
rocks, further suggesting that the alkalic volcanic reach near surface along dilatant fracture zones. The
rocks and intrusive rocks are directly related. Destor-Porcupine and Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake
Fault Zones become broad dilatant zones near sur
Studies on the alkalic intrusive and extrusive face, and formed graben structures in which late
rocks in the Kirkland Lake area (Watson and Kerrich Timiskaming sedimentary and volcanic rocks accu
1983; Kerrich and Watson 1984) and in other Ar mulated and were preserved (Jensen and Langford
chean terrains (Arth and Hanson 1975), suggest that 1985).
these rocks were derived from the partial melting of
sediments at crustal depths. The distribution of the
alkalic intrusive and extrusive rocks corresponds SUMMARY
closely to the areas of deposition and deep burial of Mineralization in the western part of the Abitibi Sub-
thick wedges of sedimentary rocks derived from the province is controlled, in large part, by volcanic and
erosion of calc-alkalic volcanic piles (Jensen and sedimentary stratigraphy. Specific suites of volcanic
Langford 1985) (see Figure 5.9). Before partial melt rock are favourable to certain types of mineralization.
ing occurred, these rocks underwent deep burial Massive copper-zinc-lead deposits, iron formations,
caused by the younger accumulation of the 16 km and stratiform gold mineralization are associated with
thick Wabewawa-Catherine-Skead Supergroup and calc-alkalic volcanism; nickel deposits and asbestos,
the 30 km thick Upper Supergroup (Jensen and Lang talc, and magnesite are associated with komatiitic
ford 1983). volcanism; and lode gold deposits are associated
With the exception of the Kirkland Lake "Main with late alkalic to subalkalic felsic volcanism and
Break" zone and the Ross Mine, a very small propor intrusion. These suites of rocks occupy discrete posi
tion of the total number of alkalic intrusive bodies tions in the stratigraphic column.
explored have yielded mineable tonnages of gold Mineralization is obviously not present every
ore. Numerous small occurrences are present where within each of these favourable suites. Depo
(Hodgson 1983) as would be expected if the alkalic sitional environments conducive to the formation of a
intrusive and extrusive rocks were derived from the certain type of mineralization must be present while
partial melting of sedimentary rocks with normal to these rocks were being laid down, and these environ
slightly higher than normal background levels of gold ments must since have been preserved close to the
and other elements Reimer (1984). The distribution of present bedrock surface for the mineralization to be
large mineable lode gold deposits associated with of economic value.
the alkalic magmatism suggests either that gold oc To recognize environments favourable to min
curred in anomalous quantities in isolated parts of eralization, the explorationist must combine stratig
the precursory succession of sedimentary packages raphic and structural data with a geological model
that were dehydrated and partly melted, or that gold concerning greenstone belt development. The
was in anomalous concentrations in some of the megacauldron model of Jensen and Langford (1983)
rocks encountered by the alkalic magmas enroute to serves to show that base-metal, iron formation, and
surface in the vicinity of the Destor-Porcupine and stratiform gold deposits occur, respectively, in the

84
LS. JENSEN

depositional proximal, shelf, and basin edge environ Colvine, A.C., Andrews, A.J., Cherry, M.E., Durocher,
ments of a maturing calc-alkalic pile, whereas, mas M.E., Fyon, A.J., Lavigne, M.J., Jr., Macdonald, A.J.,
sive nickel deposits are formed where komatiitic Marmont, S., Poulsen, K.H., Springer, J.S., and Troop,
flows lapped onto sedimentary and tuffaceous rocks D.G.
associated with older calc-alkalic piles. Asbestos, 1984: An Integrated Model for the Origin of Archean
talc, and magnesite deposits occur in olivine cu Lode Gold Deposits; Ontario Geological Survey,
mulates of sills near the base of the basal komatiitic Open File Report 5524, 98p.
successions where they could be penetrated by intro Dimroth, E., Boivin, P., Goulet, N., and Larouche, M.
duced C02-rich and CO2-poor hydrous fluids. Lode 1973: Preliminary Report on Tectonic and Volcanolog-
gold deposits are preferentially located near major ical Studies in Rouyn-Noranda Area: Quebec De
fault zones associated with late felsic intrusive and partment of Natural Resources, Open File Report
extrusive rocks. Their gold may be derived from G.M. 28491.
deeply buried gold-bearing sedimentary and tuf
faceous rock, originally deposited at the unstable Dimroth, E., Imreh, L., Rocheleau, M., and Goulet, N.
shelf edge of a calc-alkalic pile. 1982: Evolution of the South-Central Part of the Ar
chean Abitibi Belt, Quebec. Part l: Stratigraphy
Environments favourable for different types of and Paleogeographic Model: Canadian Journal of
mineralization commonly overlap, as observed in the Earth Sciences, Volume 19, p. 1729-1758.
Timmins area by Pyke (1982). Calc-alkalic piles were
developed both north and southwest of Timmins, Dimroth. E., Imreh, L., Goulet, N., and Rocheleau, M.
making the area favourable for base-metal, iron for 1983a: Evolution of the South-Central Segment of the
mation, and gold deposits. Komatiitic lavas and peri- Archean Abitibi Belt, Quebec. Part II: Tectonic
dotitic intrusions lapped onto the edges of these Evolution and Geomechanical Model: Canadian
calc-alkalic piles, and allowed massive nickel sul Journal of Earth Sciences, Volume Two,
phide as well as talc and magnesite deposits to be p. 1355-1373.
formed. 1983b: Evolution of the South-Central Segment of the
Archean Abitibi Belt, Quebec, Part III: Plutonic
In the Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake area, two calc- and Metamorphic Evolution and Geotectonic
alkalic piles developed in succession south of Kir Model: Canadian Journal of Earth Sciences, Vol
kland Lake. Iron formation and gold-bearing sedi ume Two, p. 1374-1388.
ments were deposited on the northern shelves and
basins followed by komatiitic volcanism and major Fyon, J.A., and Crocket, J.H.
faulting along the shelf edges of the volcanic piles. 1983: Gold Exploration in the Timmins Area Using
As a result, both stratiform and lode gold deposits Field and Lithogeochemical Characteristics of
are found in these areas along with iron ore deposits. Carbonate Alteration Zones; Ontario Geological
Potential for base-metal deposits occurs in the near Survey, Study 26, 56p. Accompanied by two
vent and proximal calc-alkalic volcanic rocks in the charts and two maps.
Blake River Group north of Kirkland Lake. Fyon, J.A., Crocket, J.H., and Schwarcz, H.P.
Environments favourable for the formation of Ontario Geoscience Research Grant Program, Grant
base-metal, gold, nickel, and asbestos deposits simi No.49 Application of Stable Isotope Studies to
lar to those of Timmins and Kirkland Lake are present Gold Metallogeny in the Timmins-Porcupine
along the Destor-Porcupine Fault Zone east of Camp, Ontario Geological Survey Open File Re
Matheson, south of Lake Abitibi, and along the Kir port 5464, 182p., 9 Tables, 23 Figures, and 16
kland Lake-Larder Lake Fault Zone in the Maps in back pocket.
Matachewan area. Gelinas, L., Mellinger, M., and Trudel, P.
1982: Archean Mafic Metavolcanics from the Rouyn-
REFERENCES Noranda District, Abitibi Greenstone Belt, Quebec
1. Mobility of the Major Elements; Canadian Jour
Arth, J.G., and Hanson, G.N. nal of Earth Sciences, Volume 19, p.2258-2275.
1975: Geochemistry and Origin of the Early Precam
brian Crust of North Eastern Minnesota; Goodwin, A.M.
1965: Mineralized Volcanic Complexes in the
Geochimica et Cosmochimica Acta. Volume 39, Porcupine-Kirkland Lake Noranda Region,
p.325-362.
Canada: Economic Geology, Volume 60,
Bertrand, C., and Hutchinson, R.W. p.955-971.
1973: Metamorphism at the Normetal Mine, North 1966: The Relationship of Mineralization to Precam
western Quebec; Canadian Institute of Mining brian Stratigraphy in Certain Mining Areas of On
and Metallurgy Transactions, Volume 76, tario and Quebec; Geological Association of
p.226-234. Canada, Special Paper Number 3, p.57-73.
Coad, P.R. Hinse, G.J.
1979: Nickel Sulphide Deposits Associated With Ul 1984: Gold Environment of the Larder Lake-Vir-
tramafic Rocks of the Abitibi Belt and Economic giniatown Area, Ontario: p.86-114 in Geological
Potential of Mafic-Ultramafic Intrusions; Ontario Association of Canada Field Trip Guidebook 4,
Geological Survey, Study 26, 84p. Joint Annual Meeting, London, Ontario.
Hodgson, C.J.
1983: Preliminary Report on the Timmins-Kirkland
Lake Area Gold Deposits File; Ontario Geological
Survey, Open File Report 5464, 238p.

85
CHAPTER 5

Huppert, H.E., Sparks, R.S.J., Turner, J.S., and Arndt, Kerrich, R., and Watson, G.P.
N.T. 1984: The Macassa Mine Archean Lode Gold Depos
1984: Emplacement and Cooling of Komatiite Lavas; its, Kirkland Lake, Ontario; Geology, Patterns of
Nature, Volume 309, p. 19-22. Alteration and Hydrothermal Regimes; Economic
Hutchinson, R.W. Geology, Volume 79, p. 1104-1130.
1973: Volcanogenic Sulphide Deposits and Their Lusk, J.
Metallogenic Significance; Economic Geology, 1976: A Possible Volcanic-Exhalative Origin for Len
Volume 68, p. 1223-1246. ticular Nickel Sulphide Deposits of Volcanic As
Jensen, LS. sociation with Special Reference to Those in
1978a: Geology of Thackeray, Elliott, Tannahill, and Western Australia; Canadian Journal of Earth Sci
Dokis Townships, District of Cochrane: Ontario ences, Volume 13, p.451-458.
Geological'Survey, Report 165, 71 p. MERQ-OGS
1978b: Geology of Stoughton and Marriott Townships, 1983: Lithostratigraphic Map of the Abitibi Sub-
District of Cochrane: Ontario Geological Survey, province; Ontario Geological Survey/Ministere de
Report 173, 73p. I'Energie et des Ressources, Quebec; catalogued
1978c: Archean Komatiitic, Tholeiitic, Calc-Alkalic as Map 2484 in Ontario and D.V. 83-16 in Que
and Alkalic Volcanic Sequences in the Kirkland bec, Scale 1:500 000.
Lake Area; p.237-259 in Toronto '78 Field Trips Naldrett, A.J.
Guidebook, edited by A.L. Currie and W.O. Mac 1966: The Role of Sulphurization in the Genesis of
kasey, Geological Society of America-Geological Iron-Nickel Sulphide Deposits of the Porcupine
Association of Canada-Mineralogical Association District, Ontario, Canadian Institute of Mining and
of Canada, 361 p. Metallurgy Transactions, Volume 69, p. 147-155.
1981 a: Gold Mineralization in the Kirkland Lake-Lar 1973: Nickel Sulphide Deposits-Their Classification
der Lake Area; p.59-65 in Genesis of Archean, and Genesis with Special Emphasis on Deposits
Volcanic-Hosted Gold Deposits, Symposium held of Volcanic Association, Canadian Institute of
at the University of Waterloo, March 7, 1980, Mining and Metallurgy, Transactions, Volume 76.
Ontario Geological Survey, Miscellaneous Paper p. 183-201.
97, 175p.
1981 b: A Petrogenetic Model for the Archean Abitibi Nunes, P.D., and Jensen, L.S.
Belt in the Kirkland Lake Area, Ontario; Un 1980: Geochronology of the Abitibi Metavolcanic Belt,
published Ph.D. Thesis, University of Saskatch Kirkland Lake Area Progress Report p.34-38 in
ewan, Saskatoon, Saskatchewan. Summary of Geochronology Studies, 1977-1979,
edited by E.G. Pye, Ontario Geological Survey,
Jensen, L.S., and Langford, F.F. Miscellaneous Paper 92, 45p.
1983: Geology and Petrogenesis of the Archean Ab
itibi Belt in the Kirkland Lake Area, Ontario: On Nunes, P.D., and Pyke, D.R.
tario Geological Survey, Open File Report 5455, 1980: Geochronology of the Abitibi Metavolcanic Belt,
512p. Timmins Matachewan Area-Progress Report,
1985: Geology and Petrogenesis of the Archean Ab p.34-38 Summary of Geochronology Studies,
itibi Belt in the Kirkland Lake Area, Ontario; On 1977-1979, edited by E.G. Pye. Ontario Geologi
tario Geological Survey, Miscellaneous Paper cal Survey Miscellaneous Paper 92, 45p.
123, 130p. Accompanied by Maps P.2434 and Pyke, D.R.
P.2435, scale 1:63 360 or 1 inch to 1 mile and 1976: On the Relationship Between Gold Mineraliza
sheet of microfiche. tion and Ultramafic Volcanic Rocks in the Tim
Jensen, L.S., and Pyke, D.R. mins Area, Northeastern Ontario; Canadian In
1982: Komatiites in the Ontario Portion of the Abitibi stitute of Mining and Metallurgy Bulletin, Volume
Belt; p. 147-157 in Komatiites, edited by N.T. Arndt 69, p.79-87.
and E.G. Nisbet, published by George Allen and 1978a: Geology of the Redstone Area, District of
Unwin, London, 526p. Timiskaming; Ontario Division of Mines, Geologi
cal Report 161, 75p. Accompanied by Maps 2363
Jolly, W.T. and 2364, scale 1:31 680 or 1 inch to 1/2 mile.
1976: Metamorphic History of the Archean Abitibi 1978b: Geology of the Peterlong Lake Area, Districts
Belt; P.409-412 in Report of Activities, Part A, of Timiskaming and Sudbury; Ontario Geological
Geological Survey of Canada, Paper 76-1 A. Survey Report 171, 53p. Accompanied by Map
1978: Metamorphic History of the Archean Abitibi Belt 2345, scale 1:50,000.
in Metamorphism in the Canadian Shield; Geo 1982: Geology of the Timmins Area, District of Coch
logical Survey of Canada, Paper 78-10, p.63-78. rane; Ontario Geological Survey, Report 219,
Karvinen, W.O. 141p. Accompanied by Map 2455, Scale 1:50
1981: Geology and Evolution of Gold Deposits, Tim 000, 3 charts, and 1 sheet Microfiche.
mins Area, Ontario; p.29-46 in Genesis of Ar Reimer, T.O.
chean, Volcanic-Hosted Gold Deposits, Sympo 1984: Alternative Model for the Derivation of Gold in
sium Held at the University of Waterloo, March 7, the Witwatersrand Supergroup, Journal of the
1980, Ontario Geological Survey, Miscellaneous Geological Society of London, Volume 141,
Paper 97, 175p. p.263-272.

86
LS. JENSEN

Ross, J.R., and Hopkins, G.M.F. Thomson, J.E.


1975: Kambalda Nickel Sulphide Deposits: p.100-121 1950: Geology of Teck Township and the Kenogami
in Economic Geology of Australia and Papau New Lake Area, Kirkland Lake Gold Belt, Timiskaming
Guinea, Metals Volume 1, edited C.L. Knight, District; Ontario Department of Mines, Annual Re
Monograph Series, Number 5, Australasian In port for 1948, Volume 57, Part 5, p. 1-29.
stitute of Mining and Metallurgy, Victoria Austra Veizer, J.
lia, 1126p. 1984: Geological Evolution of Archean-Early Prot
Satterly, J. erozoic Earth p.240-259 in Earth's Earliest Bio
1952: Geology of Munro Township: Ontario Depart sphere, Its Origin and Evolution, edited by J.W.
ment of Mines, Annual Report for 1951, Volume Schopf, 543p.
60, Part 8, 60p. Veizer, J., Compston, W., Hoefs, J., and Nielsen, H.
Shegelski, R.J. 1982: Mantle Buffering of the Early Oceans; Naturwis-
1978: Stratigraphy and Geochemistry of Archean Iron senschaften, Volume 69, p. 173-480.
Formations in the Sturgeon Lake-Savant Lake Walker, R.R., Matulich, A., Amos, A.C., Watkins, J.J.,
Greenstone Terrain, Northwestern Ontario; and Mannard, G.W.
Ph.D.Thesis, University of Toronto, 251 p. 1975: The Geology of the Kidd Creek Mine; Economic
Spence, C.D. Geology, Volume 70, p.80-89.
1975: Volcanogenic Features of the Vauze Sulfide Watson, G.P., and Kerrich, R.
Deposit, Noranda, Quebec: Economic Geology, 1983: Macassa Mine, Kirkland Lake, Production His
Volume 70, p. 102-114. tory, Geology, Gold Ore Types and Hydrothermal
Springer, J. Regimes; p.56-74 in The Geology of Gold in On
1983: Invisible Gold; p.240-250 in The Geology of tario, edited by A.C. Colvine, Ontario Geological
Gold in Ontario, edited by A.C. Colvine, Ontario Survey, Miscellaneous Paper 110, 278p.
Geological Survey, Miscellaneous Paper 110, Wolfe, W.J.
278p. 1970: Distribution of Copper, Nickel, Cobalt and Sul
phur in Mafic Intrusive Rocks of the Kamiskotia-
Whitesides area, District of Cochrane: Ontario
Department of Mines and Northern Affairs, Mis
cellaneous Paper 44, 28p.

87
Chapter 6

Developments in Stratigraphic Correlation: Western


Uchi Subprovince
H. Wallace , P.C. Thurston 1 , and F. Corfu2
Supervising Geologist, Ontario Geological Survey, Toronto
2Geochronologist. Royal Ontario Museum, Toronto

CONTENTS 6.3. The first zone of pervasive


Abstract....................................... . 89 hydrothermal alteration identified in
the eastern part of the Red Lake Belt
Introduction ................................. . 89 relative to major gold deposits and
Background: Two Solitudes .. . 89 stratigraphic contacts.......................................... 90
Missing Links .......................... . 91 6.4. Stratigraphic sections in the Uchi-
A Second Look ....................... . 91 Confederation Lakes area.................................. 92
New Geochronology Data . 91
New Geochemical Data .... . 94 6.5. Geological map of the Uchi-
Confederation Lakes area.................................. 92
Revised Red Lake Stratigraphy ................. , 96
6.6. Geological map of the Red Lake Belt............... 93
Economic Significance of Regional
Correlations .................................................. . 97 6.7. Stratigraphic map of the Red Lake
Further Regional Comparisons and Their Belt......................................................................... 93
Implications ................................................... . 99 6.8. Original regional stratigraphic
Summary ....................................................... . 99 correlation map of the western Uchi
Subprovince.......................................................... 94
References .................................................... 100 6.9. Geological map of the Red Lake Belt
— showing all geochronological data
TABLE _ available in 1983 ................................................. 95
6.1 Geochronology of the Western Uchi 6.10. Distribution of zones of pervasive
Province ................................................ 95 alteration in the Red Lake Belt
— relative to major gold deposits,
FIGURES _ based on data available in 1983 ...................... 96
6.1. Location map showing the 6.11. Location of deformation zones within
distribution of supracrustal belts the Red Lake Belt ................................................ 97
within the Uchi Subprovince of 6.12. Stratigraphic map of the Red Lake
Northwestern Ontario ................... 89 Belt, 1983.............................................................. 98
6.2. Stratigraphic interpretation of the Red 6.13. Schematic cross-sections through
Lake Belt ................................................. 90 parts of the Red Lake Belt.................................. 98
6.14. Stratigraphic map of the western
Uchi Subprovince, 1983 ..................................... 99

88
H. WALLACE ETAL

ABSTRACT examine some of the problems inherent in attempting


The Red Lake and Uchi-Confederation Lakes Belts stratigraphic correlation and analysis in the Superior
Province. This chapter represents a case study of
together form the western Uchi Subprovince, part of attempts by the authors to correlate between the Red
the Superior Province in Northwestern Ontario. In Lake and Uchi-Confederation Lakes greenstone belts
1981, for the first time, geological mapping and
(Figure 6.1), and to interpret relationships between
radiometric dating permitted correlation of stratig stratigraphy and mineral deposits of the western Uchi
raphy between these two Archean supracrustal belts. Subprovince. The evolution of the stratigraphic
A three-fold stratigraphic subdivision of volcanic scheme devised by the authors between 1981 and
rocks (Cycles l, II, and III), previously established in 1984 and the accumulation of new and more refined
the Uchi-Confederation Lakes area, was extended
into the Red Lake Belt. Subsequent geological, geo geological, geochronological, and geochemical data
illustrate the need to carefully test fundamental as
chemical, and geochronological tests of this correla sumptions upon which such interpretations are
tion scheme, however, showed that some assump
tions made in the first comparison of the two belts based. This history of incremental "improvement" in
our understanding of the regional geology also sug
were invalid, and led to extensive revision of the gests that the stratigraphic picture proposed later in
regional stratigraphic interpretation.
this chapter should be viewed as only one more step
Base-metal deposits in the Uchi-Confederation in a long, intriguing process.
Lakes area, and gold deposits in both of these belts
are believed to be. at least in part, stratigraphically BACKGROUND: TWO SOLITUDES
controlled. The regional correlation presented allows
the application of mineral exploration criteria devel Both the Red Lake and Uchi-Confederation Lakes
oped in one belt, to the other, and calls attention to Belts have long histories involving mineral explora
parts of the belts which have seen little prospecting tion activity and government-sponsored geological
activity in recent years. surveys. The Red Lake Belt, the site of one of
Canada's richest gold camps, has seen almost con
Current mapping and research will determine tinuous Ontario Department of Mines-Ontario Geologi
whether the general stratigraphic scheme developed cal Survey mapping since the 1950s, and has been
in this chapter can be applied to other supracrustal explored for gold since the mid-1920s. However, the
belts in the Uchi Subprovince, and to northern only comprehensive survey of the entire area was
"greenstone" belts where mapping and preliminary done by Horwood (1945). The many township-sized
geochronological data suggest comparable patterns maps and reports published more recently are by
of episodic volcanism.
several authors (Chisholm 1954; Ferguson 1965,
1966, 1968; Riley 1975, 1976, 1978a, 1978b; Pirie
INTRODUCTION and Sawitzky 1977a, 1977b; Pirie and Grant 1978a,
Several chapters in this Volume (Sage, Chapter 4; 1978b; Pirie and Kita 1979a, 1979b, 1979c). none of
Jensen, Chapter 5; Trowell and Johns, Chapter 3) whom completed work on more than half of the 18
describe successful application of correlation tech townships which make up the belt. This patchwork of
niques outlined by Trowell (Chapter 2) and Easton geological information reflecting changes and refine
and Johns (Chapter 1). It is also useful, however, to ments in geological mapping and interpretation over

Lake St.Joseph-Pashkokogan Lake

W ENGLISH RIVER

Figure 6.1. Location map showing the distribution of supracrustal belts (shaded areas) within the Uchi
Subprovince of Northwestern Ontario.

89
CHAPTER 6

Figure 6.2. Stratigraphic


interpretation of the Red
GRAVES CALC-ALKALIC SEQUENCE Lake Belt (after Pirie
1981).
RED LAKE AREA
VOLCANIC SEQUENCES

BALL KOMATHTIC)
CALC-ALKALIC
ViiSEQUENCE

the last 25 years, has made correlation within the


belt difficult. Structural and stratigraphic patterns
within the belt are still being unravelled.
Pirie (1981) made the first modern attempt to
explain the gross tectonostratigraphic features of the
Red Lake area based on his detailed mapping of the
eastern part of the belt, reconnaissance mapping
elsewhere, lithogeochemical data, and aeromagnetic
patterns. According to Pirie (1981), the belt consists
of two predominantly volcanic successions, a lower
tholeiitic to komatiitic sequence underlying the axial
portion flanked by calc-alkalic sequences occupying
the northeastern, southeastern, and northwestern cor
ners of the belt (Figure 6.2). These sequences were
believed to form an anticlinorium, but in fact, few
unequivocal facing directions and other structural
data were available for most parts of the belt.
The other notable conclusion emphasized by Pir
ie (1981) was the spatial association between highly
altered rocks in the lower tholeiitic to komatiitic se
quence and most gold deposits in the eastern part of
the Red Lake Belt (Figure 6.3).
By 1980, the southern part of the Uchi-Confed-
eration Lakes area had been mapped in detail,
thanks in large part to the discovery and develop
K\\\\\V4zone of intense hydrothermal alteration
ment of the major copper-zinc deposits at South Bay
* major gold deposits n 111 n calc-alkalic sequence on Confederation Lake in 1968. In the hope of finding
i -t- -H felsic plutonic rocks l ~l lower mafic sequence more such deposits, the area was examined inten
sively by both government and exploration geologists
between 1968 and 1980. Detailed published maps of
the area include those by Pryslak (1970a, 1970b;
Figure 6.3. The first zone of pervasive hydrother 1971a, 1971b; 1972), Thurston et al. (1974; 1975a,
mal alteration identified in the eastern part of 1975b, 1975c), Thurston and Jackson (1978), and
the Red Lake Belt relative to major gold depos Johns and Falls (1976a, 1976b). The results of these
its and stratigraphic contacts (Pirie 1981). surveys allowed Thurston (1981 a) to develop a com
prehensive stratigraphic synthesis of this belt. Build
ing on the work of Goodwin (1967) and Pryslak
(1971 a). Thurston recognized three volcanic cycles
(Figure 6.4; Thurston 1981 a). The overall structure of

90
H. WALLACE ETAL

the belt proved to be a simple synclinorium (Figure stromatoiitic marble unit overlying Cycle II volcanic
6.5; Thurston and Jackson 1978). Base-metal depos rocks at Woman Lake in the Uchi-Confederation
its of the South Bay-type are restricted to the upper Lakes Belt; the felsic volcanic rocks below these
most cycle, and are related to resurgent volcanism carbonate beds have been dated at 2840 Ma (Corfu,
following the formation and subsequent collapse of a unpublished data). At Red Lake, thick carbonate se
major caldera centred in that area (Thurston 1981 a). quences occur in two places (Figure 6.6). In the
Detailed lithogeochemical studies in the Uchi- central part of the belt, on northern McKenzie Island,
Confederation area showed that volcanic cycles are a massive sequence of dolomitic marble at least 100
far from simple entities. The three cycles follow the m thick occurs. This is immediately underlain by
classical mafic to intermediate to felsic trend de felsic to intermediate, heterolithic and monolithic
scribed by Goodwin (1968). As in the Red Lake area, pyroclastic beds, one of which was dated at 2830 Ma
the overall trends are toward more fractionated vol (Corfu and Wallace 1985). Hence, the McKenzie Is
canic products with time, however, both major and land and Woman Lake carbonates appeared to oc
trace element patterns indicate the operation of a cupy similar time-stratigraphic positions.
variety of complex magma-generating processes At the western end of Red Lake, another car
(Thurston and Fryer 1983). bonate unit is exposed at and east of Pipestone Bay
At the top of the second cycle there is a distinc (Figure 6.6). North of the bay, these rocks have been
tive chemical metasedimentary sequence including metamorphosed to massive diopside-tremolite-
stromatoiitic carbonate on Woman Lake (Thurston grossuiarite-bearing skarns. but elsewhere the car
and Jackson 1978; Hofmann et al. 1985). Nunes and bonate units commonly exhibit fine layering and oth
Thurston (1980) determined the ages of these cycles er sedimentary structures, which in several places
by applying the uranium-lead dating techniques of were positively identified as stromatolites (Riley 1972;
Krogh (1973, 1982a, 1982b) to zircons from the felsic Hofmann ef al. 1985). Since stromatolite occurrences
rocks near the top of each cycle. The results (Figure in the Archean rocks of the northern hemisphere are
6.4), show that the difference in age between the extremely rare, correlation between the Woman Lake,
youngest volcanic products in consecutive cycles is McKenzie Island, and Pipestone Bay carbonate se
on the order of 100 to 130 Ma. The duration of quences seemed a safe conclusion. Hence, the cor
individual cycles and the length of the hiatuses be relation of carbonate sequences formed the back
tween cycles is unknown. This is a reflection of the bone in of the regional stratigraphic scheme outlined
paucity of dateable felsic volcanic material in the by Thurston ef al. (1981) (Figure 6.8).
lower parts of individual cycles. A second point used in the correlation was based
on the assumption that the "mini cycles" defined by
MISSING LINKS Thurston (1981 a) in Cycle II at Confederation Lake as
60 to 120m thick, mafic to felsic sequences each
On existing Ontario Geological Survey compilation capped by chert and magnetitic iron formation, had
maps of the western Uchi Subprovince, the area stratigraphic equivalents in the Red Lake Belt. For
between Red Lake and Confederation Lake is largely example, on the southern side of Hoyles Bay, mafic,
uncoloured (Ferguson ef al. 1970). Exposure is poor intermediate, and felsic volcanic units are intercalat
because of the thick glaciolacustrine silt-clay over ed with chemical and clastic metasediments over
burden, and most of the few known outcrops are of comparable stratigraphic intervals. These sequences
high metamorphic rank. These problems prevented appear to be roughly on strike with the carbonates on
effective stratigraphic correlation between the two McKenzie Island, assuming no major intervening
belts until 1981. structural dislocations. In the area west of Pipestone
During the 1981 field season, Thurston (1981 b) Bay, there is a similar rapidly alternating succession.
succeeded in tracing volcanic units of Cycles II and Taken together the carbonate and mini cycle correla
III from Confederation Lake into the Gullrock Lake tions led to the conclusion that much of the western
part of the Red Lake Belt (Figure 6.6), using detailed and central parts of the Red Lake Belt were underlain
mapping, diamond-drill log data, and geophysical in by rocks equivalent in age, and possibly genetically
formation made available by Selco Inc. In the same related to Cycle II at Confederation Lake.
year, four uranium-lead ages on zircons from felsic
volcanic rocks in the Red Lake Belt were determined A SECOND LOOK
(Thurston et al. 1981; Corfu and Wallace 1985).
These four ages, 2982, 2830, 2739, and 2733 Ma, New Geochronology Data
were originally obtained to test the tectonostratig- In 1982, a second series of age determinations were
raphic model that Pirie (1981) had proposed for the made to test the proposed correlation pattern. The
Red Lake Belt, and indeed they did corroborate the results of this series are summarized in Table 6.1
anticlinal nature of the belt (Figure 6.7). The very and Figure 6.9, and are obviously at odds with the
close agreement between these dates and those in authors' first stratigraphic interpretation of the Red
the Uchi-Confederation Lakes belt, however, was Lake area. Although the new dates (column C, Table
quite unexpected, and suggested that a three-fold 6.1) fall roughly in the same age groups as the
subdivision of volcanic stratigraphy might apply original Red Lake and Confederation Lake data
across the region. (columns B and A, Table 6.1), the spatial distribution
In order to extend this temptingly simple correla of the dated rocks clearly shows that the areas in the
tion framework through the Red Lake Belt, a number Red Lake Belt inferred to be of Cycle II age are much
of assumptions were made. The most convincing of older, roughly equivalent in fact to the oldest cycle
these, at the time, pertained to carbonate units. A (2900 to 3000 Ma).

91
CHAPTER 6

A F Figure 6.4. Stratigraphic


^S?^? *-2840 G,.^^^ sections in the Uchi-
iiiiiiii my ~^^^
; J
Con federa tion L akes
c area (adapted from
D Thurston 1981 a).
^
^'J,V-N'^
pijl Section lines are shown
D
Plifer Mlni-Cvcle II :- 'r.'-.- in Figure 6.5.
J " " HT t\"0\yv^j
X
J
2^{?.i*, M my
''
Cycle 1
L'-~v1-'I.""' Cycle III

':-'i['^f:(
' C
k B, ^-2959
my L- V I,;-\|
J.-j'T'-V;' rnafic m

[::;:;:;:;|||:i|| interme
^ ^r^jjj^
i)^ v ^^^ felsic m

x
J
i | llllil lil ! c|astic
2 L- —••"l chemica
0 ,..........

HI
Ij::!:!:-:!^ granodiorite
granodi( and quartz feldspar porphyry
r ["•"•"•"l granitic
f A*

Figure 6.5. Geological


map of the Uchi-
Con federa tion Lakes
area (after Thurston e t
al. 1978). Cross-sections
are shown in Figure 6.4.
Map legend identical to
Figure 6.4.

92
H. WALLACE ET AL.

Figure 6.6. Geological


TTj felsic plutonic and intrusive rocks \-\\\\\\****^ map of the Red Lake
mafic intrusive rocks \\^\\ Belt
metasedimentary rocks ,\\\\
felsic metavolcanic rocksV
intermediate metavolcanic rocks +
mafic metavolcanic rocks \\\\
chemical sediments \\\\\\*

Figure 6.7. Stratigraphic


::::;: VOLCANICS CYCLE i:. :H. WALLACE, 1981:; map of the Red Lake
VOLCANICS CYCLE Belt (Thurston et a/.
VOLCANICS CYCLE 1981). This
CLASTIC SEDIMENTS:;: interpretation was
based in part on four
INTRUSIVE ROCKS X : : : : :: uranium-lead zircon age
•••-....•" | CHEMICAL SEDIMENTS determinations
U/Pb ZIRCON AGE performed in 1981.

In the western part of the Red Lake Belt, felsic In fact, no additional ages comparable to Cycle II
pyroclastic units just above and below the were obtained. The 2830 Ma date from northern
stromatolitic carbonate unit were dated at 2925 and McKenzie Island was then severely scrutinized to
2940 Ma, respectively. These dates closely bracket determine whether this unique age could be ex
the age of this marble, and discredit the assumption plained by the mixing of two generations of zircons,
that it is time equivalent to the McKenzie Island and that is, from Cycle l (2900 to 3000 Ma) and Cycle III
Woman Lake carbonates. Stromatolite-building organ (2730 to 2750 Ma) rocks. Petrographic study con
isms must have thrived in this region during two firmed that the dated rock is of heterolithic character;
periods: between 2925 and 2940 Ma as around all of the fragments are of felsic to intermediate
Pipestone Bay, and again after 2840 Ma at Woman volcanic origin. Age determinations were then made
Lake. on several carefully separated, morphologically dis
The date of 2992 Ma from felsic pyroclastic crete populations of zircons from that rock. In all,
rocks on the southern side of Hoyles Bay prove that eight determinations were made, all of which in
the mini cycles there cannot be of Cycle II age. dicated apparent ages between 2800 and 2835 Ma

93
CHAPTER 6

Cycle l
CIEZZZl Cycle II
Cycle III
U/Pb (my) zircon age

Figure 6.8. Original regional stratigraphic correlation map of the western Uchi Subprovince (Thurston et a/.
1981), integrating local interpretations shown in Figures 6.5 and 6.7.

(Corfu and Wallace 1985). Clearly, the original vol Of prime importance was the realization that the
canic rocks from which this heterolithic volcaniclastic major and trace element compositions of volcanic
unit was formed had crystallized at a time roughly rocks in the western part of Red Lake, in the north-
equivalent to the Cycle II rocks at Confederation central part of the belt, and in Baird Township, were
Lake. In fact, the spread of ages found may reflect quite similar to those documented in the Balmertown-
the duration of Cycle II volcanism on a regional Cochenour area (Pirie 1981). Komatiitic rocks and
scale. primitive tholeiitic basalts are the predominant
Another notable discrepancy between the au lithoiogies in all of these areas. Rocks previously
thors original stratigraphic interpretation and the new mapped as intermediate, calc-alkalic volcanic rocks
geochronological data was evident south of Balmer- in nearly all cases proved to be altered tholeiites. For
town. A sample from a sequence of felsic pyroclastic example, in the western part of the belt ,the Ball
rocks, previously assumed to be of Cycle II age, was calc-alkalic sequence of Pirie (1981) in fact consists
dated at 2748 Ma. That sample was collected OOO m of a bimodal succession of tholeiitic basalts and
from two sample sites to the north which gave an calc-alkalic rhyolites, a fairly common Archean asso
age of 2964 Ma. (The preliminary age of 2982 Ma ciation (Thurston, Chapter 7, this volume).
reported by Thurston ef at. (1981) was later shown to Basalts and rhyolites have been altered to vary
be too old due to the incorporation in the rock of ing degrees. In the case of the rhyolites, there is
inherited zircon; new determinations yield an age of commonly little visible change with alteration, but
2964 Ma for the unit (Corfu and Wallace 1985)). A chemically, sodium depletion, carbonatization, and
swamp between the two dated volcanic sequences both potassium depletion and addition are quite ob
precludes direct examination of the intervening vious. On the other hand, the mafic, and in some
stratigraphy; however, diamond-drill information sug cases ultramafic volcanic rocks can be radically
gests that they are separated by chemical and clastic changed in appearance by pervasive alteration. On
metasediments. There is no evidence of Cycle II the basis of hand specimen examination alone, al
volcanic rocks in that area. An age of 2744 Ma was tered rocks are readily mistaken for andesites or
also obtained from a rhyolitic unit at or near the top dacites. In some cases, however, sodium depletion in
of the tholeiitic to komatiitic sequence in Madsen such rocks gives rise to aluminous metamorphic as
(Corfu, unpublished data). The gap in time of at least semblages commonly containing garnet and/or an
200 Ma over such a small stratigraphic interval can dalusite. In most such rocks, chemical criteria based
only be explained by the presence of a major break, on relatively immobile elements such as nickel and
either a fault or an unconformity, between the two chromium clearly identify the mafic progenitors of
volcanic sequences (that is, of Cycle l and Cycle III these altered rocks. Their tholeiitic affinity can be
age). assumed from their close spatial association with
unaltered mafic volcanic rocks along strike and by
New Geochemical Data their low yttrium and zirconium contents comparable
to adjacent tholeiitic and komatiitic volcanic rocks.
In 1982, chemical analyses from several areas of the
Red Lake Belt became available, shedding new light Regional mapping suggests that the alteration
on stratigraphic problems, and on the relationships zones are sub-conformable in the areas south and
between stratigraphy, alteration, and gold mineraliza east of Pipestone Bay (Figures 6.6 and 6.10). These
tion. alteration zones include nearly all of the significant
gold deposits and prospects found in this part of the
belt so far. This spatial relationship and the general

94
H. WALLACE ETAL.

TABLE 6.1: GEOCHRONOLOGY OF THE WESTERN UCHI SUBPROVINCE (U-Pb ZIRCON AGES IN MILLIONS
OF YEARS).
RED LAKE
UCHI-
CYCLE CONFEDERATION 1981 1983
2959±2 1 (2982)3"5 2992 + 20/-9 4
2964 + 5/-1 4
2940±2 4
2925±34
2894+1 4
2840 2 2830±153
2738 + 5/-2 1 2739±33 2748+10/-54
2733±1 3 2744±1 2
NOTES:
1 Nunes and Thurston 1980
2Corfu unpublished data 1985
thurston ei al. 1981
4Corfu and Wallace 1985
5age too old due to incorporated inherited zircon; new determinations = 2964 Ma.

Figure 6.9. Geological


*. \ ".[ felsic plutonic and intrusive rocks ^* t ^U7Pb ^my) zircon map of the Red Lake
mafic intrusive rocks Belt showing all
metasedimentary rocks geochronological data
felsic metavolcanic rocks'-^
available in 1983.
intermediate metavolcanic rocks t
mafic metavolcanic rocks
chemical sediments \' t '

2894 : vBalmertown
2964

style of alteration are reminiscent of the situation and occur near the top of the lower tholeiitic-
described by Pirie (1981) within the "highly altered komatiitic sequence. They do, however, appear to
zone" around Cochenour-Balmertown (Figure 6.3). crosscut stratigraphy northeast of Madsen.
In the Madsen area, detailed mapping and One interpretation of the distribution of alteration
lithogeochemical studies by Durocher (1983) have zones throughout the belt is that they are controlled
shown that auriferous units, which were long as by a conjugate set of large northeast- and west-
sumed to be intermediate pyroclastic rocks, are in northwest trending deformation zones (Figure 6.11;
fact highly altered and deformed tholeiitic basalts. Andrews and Durocher 1983). These deformation
These rocks are similar, in terms of their trace ele zones appear restricted to the older (Cycle l)
ment contents, to tholeiitic and komatiitic volcanic tholeiitic-komatiitic sequence; only the Pipestone Bay-
rocks elsewhere in Baird Township (Figure 6.11). St. Paul Bay Deformation Zone (Andrews and
Although differing in detail from the alteration in the Durocher 1983) clearly transects stratigraphy.
Cochenour-Balmertown and Pipestone Bay areas, the On the southern limb of the Red Lake anti
general characteristics of all these zones are very clinorium, that is, south of Madsen and Balmertown,
similar. Again, the zones are crudely conformable

95
CHAPTER 6

Figure 6.10. Distribution


Cycle l volcanics of zones of pervasive
cle II volcanics alteration in the Red
Cycle III volcanics Lake Belt relative to
clastic sediments major gold deposits,
intrusive rocks based on data available
highly altered zones in 1983.
gold producer, major prospect

two distinct tholeiitic sequences can be recognized. for later tectonic movement which created the
To the north, tholeiitic and komatiitic basalt flows of "deformation zone" evident in the Madsen area.
Cycle l age have primitive chemistry; the southern
2750 Ma old sequence includes variolitic basalts and REVISED RED LAKE STRATIGRAPHY
andesites. On the basis of major element chemistry,
this sequence is clearly tholeiitic, yet is highly On the basis of data collected in 1982 and 1983, the
evolved being characterized by zirconium and yttrium authors' stratigraphic interpretation of the Red Lake
levels much higher than in the older tholeiites, and Belt was revised to that shown in Figures 6.12 and
comparable to levels in the overlying calc-alkalic 6.13, and in the regional correlation map (Figure
sequence. The younger tholeiitic sequence is similar, 6.14). The main change with respect to the 1981
but measurably older than the predominantly calc- versions (Figures 6.7 and 6.8) is the restriction of
alkalic volcanic rocks which underlie most of Heyson Cycle II to the area of McKenzie Island, and the
Township. The younger tholeiites may represent a expansion of Cycle l to occupy roughly 70 07o of the
discrete stratigraphic package, or one gradational Red Lake Belt.
into the calc-alkalic rocks to the south. Cycle l, as shown in the new interpretation, in
On the northern limb of the Red Lake anti cludes rocks varying in age by almost 100 Ma (2992
clinorium no sequence comparable to the younger to 2894 Ma). Clearly it constitutes a very complex
tholeiites, described above, has been identified. The stratigraphic sequence. It is doubtful that this pack
calc-alkalic volcanic rocks north of Red Lake are age can be stratigraphically subdivided across the
separated from the lower tholeiitic to komatiitic se belt without much more geochronological work. The
quence by a thick unit of clastic metasediments. In main reason for this is the strong probability that
general terms, these metasediments grade from Cycle l and Cycle II rocks were subject to two major
wacke-mudstones, with intercalated polymictic con folding events. Cross folding is suggested in some
glomerate containing clasts of mixed volcanic origin, areas by overturned minor folds, curving axial traces,
into a sequence of more mature arkosic sandstone aeromagnetic patterns, and, in a few cases, by the
and conglomerate beds with mostly clasts of felsic configuration of marker horizons. As previously dis
intrusive rocks. Although these rocks require much cussed, a major folding event prior to Cycle III vol
more careful study, the sequence appears to reflect a canism is required to explain formation of the thick
prolonged period of erosion of a complex volcanic sedimentary sequence between Cycles l and III north
terrain during which underlying batholiths were even of Red Lake, and the apparent unconformity south of
tually exposed. This was presumably the result of a Balmertown.
major tectonic event following the tholeiitic-komatiitic The isolation of the small block of Cycle II
(Cycle l) volcanism and prior to calc-alkalic (Cycle III) pyroclastic and derived sedimentary rocks on McKen
volcanic activity. zie Island may be explained in a number of ways;
The existence of this metasedimentary package original stratigraphic and/or structural boundaries of
suggests that the structural break inferred from the block have been obscured by the Dome Stock
geochronological and geochemical data south of Bal- and the waters of Red Lake, so it is difficult to
mertown and Madsen is an unconformity. Because of evaluate these possibilities. The block may have
its inherent weakness, this unconformity was a locus been downfaulted or infolded into Cycle l, assuring

96
H. WALLACE ETAL

1. Cochenour Mine l—T—l


li_±J Felsic Intrusive Rocks
2. Campbell Mine
l___l Volcanic i Sedimentary Rocks
3. A.W. White Mine
4. Howey Mine ; D.Z. Deformation Zone * *-
5. Hasaga Mine B Mine
6. Buffalo Mine A Occurrence
7. Madsen Mine (A) McKenzie Channel
8. Starratt-Olsen Mine (B) McKenzie Stock
9. Lake Rowan Mine (C) Dome Stock
10. Keeley-Frontier Mine

Figure 6.11. Location of deformation zones within the Red Lake Belt (after Andrews and Durocher 1983).

preservation while erosion removed all other traces In the case of South Bay-type copper-zinc depos
of Cycle II rocks in the Red Lake area. Major strata- its in the Uchi-Confederation Lakes area, the relation
parallel faults, shown as the Post Narrows Deforma ship between mineralization and stratigraphy is easily
tion Zone on Figure 6.11, probably form the northern documented and explainable on the basis of the
boundary of this block, and explain why older rocks Smith and Bailey (1968) caldera cycle. The deposits
on the northern side of Red Lake appear to overlie are believed to have formed syngenetically, at and
the Cycle II sequence. near the rock-shallow water interface, during late
A variety of felsic to intermediate lithic and stage hydrothermal activity within a collapsed cal
pumiceous clasts and chert fragments are the main dera structure (Thurston 1981 a). The mineralizing
clast types in the volcaniclastic units on McKenzie fluids were restricted to( and were concentrated in
Island. Similar rock-types form the subaerial and relatively small topographic features, the caldera it
shallow water pyroclastic deposits (Thurston 1981 a) self, and adjacent grabens. Careful mapping, and
on the western limb of the Uchi-Confederation Belt. facies analysis must be carried out to find these
Lithogeochemical evidence linking rocks from these small, high potential, exploration targets in such com
two areas is as yet unavailable. plex volcanic environments.
Although rocks of Cycle III age and character are Rocks comparable in age, stratigraphic position,
traceable between belts, the continuity of individual and major element composition to the South Bay
units or formations is difficult to determine because Mine sequence are now known to occur on both the
of poor exposure and the high metamorphic grade of northern and southern flanks of the Red Lake Belt. In
supracrustal sequences between the belts. The Cycle light of this, these rocks should be evaluated
III volcanic rocks in the Red Lake area may, in fact, geochemically to assess their genetic relationship
be products of a separate but similar eruptive centre. with the South Bay Mine sequence. Comparison of
trace element characteristics, combined with volcanic
facies analysis between the two belts will perhaps
ECONOMIC SIGNIFICANCE OF REGIONAL determine whether similar mineralization can be ex
CORRELATIONS———^—-—^^—-—— pected around Red Lake. If the Red Lake rocks are
Stratigraphy appears to be one controlling factor in distal, and were formed well outside the caldera
the localization of base-metal deposits in the Uchi- environment, or if they prove to be products of an
Confederation Lakes Belt, and gold deposits in the entirely different volcanic complex, then the chances
Red Lake camp. of finding South Bay-type deposits are diminished.

97
CHAPTER 6

Cycle l volcanics
Figure 6. 72.
Cycle II volcanics
Stratigraphic map of the
Cycle III volcanics
Red Lake Belt, 1983.
clastic sediments
Interpretation based on
intrusive rocks
geochronological,
iron formation (chemical
geochemical, and
marble (sediments geological data
U/Pb zircon age (my)\* t
accumulated between
1981 and 1983.

^^2925
+Y ' ' **^.X\ s
^

On the other hand, in more modern volcanic terrains,


RED LAKE STRATIGRAPHY calderas tend to occur in "fields" in which several
calderas follow similar patterns of evolution, and de
283oU7Pb zircon age (my) velop in close proximity at roughly the same time.
intermediate metavolcanics Rocks of comparable age and chemistry throughout
the region should be examined with this in mind.
felsic metavolcanics^E The relationship between gold deposits and
felsic intrusives stratigraphy in the Red Lake Belt is less precise than
clastic sediments for base-metal deposits in the Uchi-Confederation
Lakes area. Empirically, a rather loose spatial correla
iron formation tion between Cycle l volcanic rocks, major zones of
calc-alk basalt ( c ) alteration, and gold deposits seems to apply in all
tholeiitic basalt (t) parts of the Red Lake area. Conversely, very few
deposits, and none of proven economic importance,
have been found in areas underlain by Cycle II and
2739 III rocks, which constitute roughly 30 0Xo of the supra
crustal belt.
2830
2748 At the detailed scale, the dominant factor control
ling the location and character of ore zones in the
2894 area's past and presently producing mines is struc
2964
ture. The ore zones occur where deformation created
volumes of rock in which low fluid pressures and
high permeability permitted the easy movement of
mineralizing solutions. Determination of the nature of
these fluids, their source(s), the origin of the gold,
and the reasons they preferentially affect rocks of
Cycle l age are problems of considerable importance
and controversy. They are not, however, easily re
solved on either theoretical or empirical grounds, and
will not be considered here. The authors, however,
do suggest, based on the spatial association noted
above, that some factor inherent in the stratigraphic
make-up of Cycle l is particularly conducive to the
Figure 6.13. Schematic cross-sections through formation of gold deposits. Hence, the identification
parts of the Red Lake Belt. Lines of sections of Cycle l rocks in other parts of the region is of
are shown in Figure 6.6. economic significance.
Cycle l rocks in all parts of the Red Lake Belt
continue to be prime targets for gold exploration. In
the Uchi-Confederation Lakes area, these rocks are

98
H. WALLACE ETAL

Cycle l
Cycle II
Cycle
U/Pb (my) zircon age

Figure 6.14. Stratigraphic map of the western Uchi Subprovince, 1983.

on the flanks of the belt. On the west, they occur It is unlikely that the stratigraphic patterns in
north and south of Corless Lake, while on the eastern these widely separated areas will ever be correlated
side of the belt they are found north and south of the directly. In many places once continuous supracrustal
Perrigo Lake Intrusion. In the Birch Lake area, Cycle l sequences have been completely dissected by
rocks have tentatively been identified around Seag plutons, and even where this has not occurred, the
rave Lake, and may occur elsewhere in the northern scarcity of outcrop makes it impossible to trace in
part of the belt. None of these areas has been dividual stratigraphic units. Hence, the only viable
intensively explored for gold in the past. Although approach to long-range stratigraphic correlation is to
gold has been mined in several parts of the Birch- compare these isolated, relatively well exposed and
Uchi-Confederation Lakes area, these previously understood areas using geochronological data. Such
known deposits are found in Cycle II and III rocks dating programs are currently underway, but no re
which occupy the core of the belt. sults are yet available.
To the north, in the Sachigo Subprovince, geoch
FURTHER REGIONAL COMPARISONS AND ronological studies have already been completed fol
THEIR IMPLICATIONS________________ lowing detailed mapping in the North Spirit Lake
(Nunes and Wood 1980) and Favourable Lake Belts
In parts of the central and eastern Uchi Subprovince (Corfu ef a/. 1981). Results of these studies are
(Figure 6.1) detailed geological mapping has also led
to the recognition of polycyclic volcanism. In the surprisingly similar to those from the western Uchi
Subprovince. Major episodes of volcanic activity be
Bamaji-Fry Lakes area, Wallace (1980) documented tween 2910 and 3020 Ma and again between 2720
three lithologically and chemically distinct volcanic and 2740 Ma are common to these areas. The signifi
sequences. As in the Red Lake Belt, the youngest
cance of these similarities is a matter of conjecture. It
sequence appears to be separated from the older seems likely that a large part of the Superior Province
cycles by a marked unconformity. Geochemically,
however, the patterns are quite different. Whereas was affected by a common sequence of magmatic
events, the periodicity of which was governed by
chemical affinities in the Red Lake area change from some first-order tectonic process. If such characteris
dominantly tholeiitic-komatiitic to calc-alkalic with
time, the sequence in the Bamaji-Fry Lake Belt is tics are common, exploration criteria developed in
from calc-alkalic to tholeiitic, and finally to rocks of any one area on the basis of lithological, primary
alkalic composition. In the Meen-Dempster Lakes geochemical and stratigraphic factors may be much
Belt, Stott (1982; Stott and Wallace 1984) recognized more widely applicable.
at least two, and possibly three volcanic cycles on
the basis of relative superposition. These sequences, SUMMARY
not as yet geochemically characterized, may be The structural and stratigraphic complexity of Ar
traceable northeastward into the Pickle Lake area. In chean supracrustal terrain makes correlation be
the southern part of the Subprovince, Berger (1981) tween, and even within, individual greenstone belts
identified complex volcanic stratigraphy around the difficult and uncertain. Tentative points of correlation
western end of Lake St. Joseph. Much farther to the based on lithological or chemical similarities must be
east, Wallace (1981) reported at least three major tested carefully using independent criteria before
volcanic sequences in the Miminiska Lake area. The marker horizons, such as rare carbonate units, can
second and third sequences are separated by an be relied upon.
unconformity and a thick package of turbiditic
metasediments. On the basis of geochronological comparison,
the authors have correlated major stratigraphic pack-

99
CHAPTER 6

ages between the Red Lake and Uchi-Confederation 1966: Geology of Dome Township; Ontario Depart
Lakes Belts. Volcanic stratigraphy (Cycle III) can be ment of Mines, Geological Report 45, 98p. Ac
traced between these areas; however, interbelt cor companied by Map 2074, scale 1:12 000.
relation of older units (Cycle l and Cycle II) remains 1968: Geology of the Northern Part of Heyson Town
tentative. Although volcanic sequences of broadly ship, District of Kenora; Ontario Department of
similar age occur within the two belts, much work Mines, Geological Report 56, 54p. Accompanied
must be done to determine how, or indeed whether by Map 2125, scale 1:12 000.
these rocks are related genetically. Ferguson, S.A., Brown, D.D., Davies, J.C., and Pryslak,
If the Red Lake and Uchi-Confederation Lakes A.P.
areas share a common stratigraphic development, 1970: Red Lake-Birch Lake Sheets, Kenora District;
and if interbelt correlation can be refined, geologists Ontario Department of Mines, Geological Com
can apply this concept as a powerful exploration tool. pilation Series, Map 2175, scale 1 inch to 4 miles.
Exploration criteria developed here may also be ap Goodwin, A.M.
plicable in other parts of the Uchi Subprovince to the 1967: Volcanic Studies in the Birch-Uchi Lakes Area
east, and in supracrustal belts to the north where of Ontario: Ontario Department of Mines, Mis
similar patterns of polycyclic volcanism are known or cellaneous Paper 6, 96p.
suspected. 1968: Archean Protocontinental Growth and Early
The strong possibility that cyclic volcanism oc Crustal History of the Canadian Shield; p.69-81 in
curred in synchronous fashion over a wide area of Proceedings of Session 1 (Upper Mantle Geologi
the Superior Province is fundamentally significant cal Processes), International Geological Con
when considering theories of Archean tectonics and gress, 23rd Session, Prague.
crustal development. Hofmann, H.J., Thurston, P.C., and Wallace, H.
1985: Archean Stromatolites from Uchi Greenstone
REFERENCES Belt, Northwestern Ontario; p. 125-132 in Evolution
Andrews, A.J., and Durocher, M. of Archean Supracrustal Sequences, edited by
1983: Gold Studies in the Red Lake Area; p.207-210 L.D. Ayres, P.C. Thurston, K.D. Card, and W. We
in Summary of Field Work, 1983, by the Ontario ber, Geological Association of Canada, Special
Geological Survey, edited by John Wood, Owen Paper 28, 380p.
L White, R.B. Barlow, and A.C. Colvine, Ontario Horwood, H.C.
Geological Survey, Miscellaneous Paper 116, 1945: Geology and Mineral Deposits of the Red Lake
313p. Area; Ontario Department of Mines, Annual Report
Berger, B.R. for 1940, Volume 49, Part 2, 231 p. Accompanied
1981: Stratigraphy of the Western Lake St.Joseph by 8 maps.
Greenstone Terrain, Northwestern Ontario; Un Johns. G.W., and Falls, R.M.
published M.Sc.Thesis, Lakehead University, 1976a: Honeywell Township, District of Kenora
Thunder Bay, Ontario, 117p. (Patricia Portion), Ontario; Ontario Division of
Chisholm, E.O. Mines, Preliminary Map P. 1066, scale 1:15 840.
1954: The Geology of Balmer Township, Ontario; On 1976b: McNaughton Township, District of Kenora
tario Department of Mines, Annual Report for (Patricia Portion), Ontario; Ontario Division of
1951, Volume 60, Part 10, 62p. Mines, Preliminary Map P. 1067, scale 1:15 840.
Corfu, F., Nunes, P.D., Krogh, T.E., and Ayres, L.D. Krogh, T.E.
1981: Comparative Evolution of a Plutonic and Poly 1973: A Low-Contamination Method for Hydrothermal
cyclic Volcanic Terrain Near Favourable Lake, Decomposition of Zircon and Extraction of U and
Ontario, As Inferred from Zircon U-Pb Ages; Ab Pb for Isotopic Age Determinations; Geochimica
stract, Geological Association of Canada, Ab et Cosmochimica Acta, 37, p.485-494.
stracts, 6, P. A-11. 1982a: Improved Accuracy of U-Pb Zircon Ages by
the Creation of More Concordant Systems Using
Corfu, F., and Wallace, H. an Air Abrasion Technique; Geochimica et Cos
In Press: U-Pb Zircon Ages for Magmatism in the Red mochimica Acta, 46, p.637-649.
Lake Greenstone Belt, Northwestern Ontario; 1982b: Improved Accuracy of U-Pb Dating by Selec
Canadian Journal of Earth Sciences. tion of More Concordant Fractions Using a High
Durocher, M.E. Gradient Magnetic Separation Technique;
1983: The Nature of Hydrothermal Alteration Asso Geochimica et Cosmochimica Acta, 46,
ciated with the Madsen and Starratt-Olsen Gold p.631-636.
Deposits, Red Lake Area; p. 123-140 in The Geol Nunes, P.D., and Thurston, P.C.
ogy of Gold in Ontario, edited by A.C. Colvine, 1980: Two Hundred and Twenty Million Years of Ar
Ontario Geological Survey, Miscellaneous Paper chean Evolution: A Zircon U-Pb Age Stratigraphic
110, 235p. Study of the Uchi-Confederation Lakes Green
Ferguson, S.A. stone Belt, Northwestern Ontario; Canadian Jour
1965: Geology of the Eastern Part of Baird Township, nal of Earth Sciences, 17, p. 710-721.
District of Kenora; Ontario Department of Mines,
Geological Report 39, 47p. Accompanied by Map
2071, scale 1:12000.

100
H. WALLACE ETAL.

Nunes, P.O., and Wood, J. 1976: Mulcahy Township, District of Kenora (Patricia
1980: Geochronology of the North Spirit Lake, District Portion); Ontario Division of Mines, Map 2295,
of Kenora—Progress Report; p. 7-14 in Summary scale 1:12000.
of Geochronological Studies 1977-1979, edited 1978a: Todd Township, District of Kenora (Patricia
by E.G. Pye, Ontario Geological Survey, Miscella Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Map 2406,
neous Paper 92, 45p. scale 1:12 000.
Pirie, James 1978b: Fairlie Township, District of Kenora (Patricia
1981: Regional Setting of Gold Deposits in the Red Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Map 2407,
Lake Area, Northwestern Ontario; p. 71-93 in Gen scale 1:12 000.
esis of Archean Volcanic-Hosted Gold Deposits, Smith, R.L, and Bailey, R.A.
Symposium Held at the University of Waterloo, 1968: Resurgent Cauldrons; p.613-662 in Studies in
March 7, 1980, Ontario Geological Survey, Mis Volcanology, edited by R.R. Coats, R.L Hay and
cellaneous Paper 97, 175p. C.A. Anderson Geological Society of America,
Pirie, J., and Grant, A. Memoir 116, 679p.
1978a: Balmer Township Area, District of Kenora Stott, G.M.
(Patricia Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Pre 1982: Meen Lake Area, District of Kenora (Patricia
liminary Map P.1976A, scale 1:12 000. Portion); p. 10-14 in Summary of Field Work, 1982,
1978b: Bateman Township, District of Kenora (Patricia by the Ontario Geological Survey, edited by John
Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Preliminary Wood, Owen L. White, R.B. Barlow, and A.C. Col
Map P.1569A, scale 1:12 000. vine, Ontario Geological Survey, Miscellaneous
Pirie, J., and Kita, J.H. Paper 106, 235p.
1979a: Ranger Township, District of Kenora (Patricia Stott, G.M., and Wallace, H.
Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Preliminary 1984: Regional Stratigraphy and Structure of the Cen
Map P.2212, scale 1:12000. tral Uchi Subprovince: Meen Lake-Kasagiminnis
1979b: Byshe Township, District of Kenora (Patricia and Pashkokogan Lake Sections; p.7-13 in Sum
Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Preliminary mary of Field Work, 1984, by the Ontario Geologi
MapP.2213, scale 1:12 000. cal Survey, edited by John Wood, Owen L. White,
1979c: Willans Township, District of Kenora (Patricia R.B. Barlow, and A.C. Colvine, Ontario Geological
Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Preliminary Survey, Miscellaneous Paper 119, 309p.
MapP.2214, scale 1:12000. Thurston, P.C.
Pirie, J., and Sawitzky, E. 1981 a: Volcanology and Trace Element Geochemistry
1977a: Graves Township, District of Kenora (Patricia of Cyclic Volcanism in the Archean Confeder
Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Preliminary ation Lake Area, Northwestern Ontario; Un
Map P. 1239, scale 1:12 000. published Ph.D. Thesis, University of Western
1977b: McDonnaugh Township, District of Kenora Ontario, London, Ontario, 553p.
(Patricia Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Pre 1981 b: Western Uchi Subprovince Synoptic Survey;
liminary Map P. 1240, scale 1:12 000. p.8-11 in Summary of Field Work, 1981, by the
Pryslak, A.P. Ontario Geological Survey, edited by J. Wood,
1970a: Dent Township, District of Kenora (Patricia O.L White, R.B. Barlow,,and A.C. Colvine, Ontario
Portion); Ontario Department of Mines, Prelimi Geological Survey, Miscellaneous Paper 100,
nary Map P.592, scale 1:15 840. 255p.
1970b: Mitchell Township, District of Kenora (Patricia Thurston, P.C., and Fryer, B.J.
Portion); Ontario Department of Mines, Prelimi 1983: The Geochemistry of Repetitive Cyclical Vol
nary Map P.593, scale 1:15 840. canism from Basalt Through Rhyolite in the Uchi-
1971 a: Corless Township, District of Kenora (Patricia Confederation Greenstone Belt, Canada; Contri
Portion); Ontario Department of Mines and North butions to Mineralogy and Petrology, 83,
ern Affairs, Preliminary Map P.634, scale p.204-226.
1:15840. Thurston, P.C., and Jackson, M.C.
1971 b: Knott Township, District of Kenora (Patricia 1978: Confederation Lake Area, District of Kenora
Portion); Ontario Department of Mines and North (Patricia Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Pre
ern Affairs, Preliminary Map P.635, scale liminary Map P. 1975, scale 1:15 840.
1:15840.
1972: Goodall Township, District of Kenora (Patricia Thurston, P.C., Raudsepp, M., and Wilson, B.C.
Portion); Ontario Department of Mines, Prelimi 1974: Earngey Township and Part of Birkett Town
nary Map P.763, scale 1:15 840. ship, District of Kenora (Patricia Portion); Ontario
Division of Mines, Preliminary Map P.932, scale
Riley, R.A. 1:15840.
1972: Ball Township, District of Kenora (Patricia Por
tion); Ontario Division of Mines, Preliminary Map Thurston, P.C., Wallace, H., and Corfu, F.
P.792, scale 1:12000. 1981: Tentative Stratigraphic Correlation of the Birch-
1975: Ball Township, District of Kenora (Patricia Por Uchi and Red Lake Belts (Abstract); p. 14/n Geo
tion); Ontario Division of Mines, Map 2265, scale science Research Seminar, December 9-10, 1981,
1:12000. Abstracts, Ontario Geological Survey, 15p.

101
CHAPTER 6

Thurston, P.C.. Wan, J., Squair, H.S., Warburton, A.F., 1975b: Birkett Township, District of Kenora (Patricia
and Wierzbicki, V.W. Portion); Ontario Division of Mines, Preliminary
1978: Volcanology and Mineral Deposits of the Uchi- Map P. 1058, scale 1:15 840.
Confederation Lakes Area, Northwestern Ontario; 1975c: Costello Township, District of Kenora (Patricia
p.302-324 in Toronto '78 Field Trips Guidebook, Portion); Ontario Division of Mines, Preliminary
edited by A.L Currie and W.O. Mackasey, Geo- Map P.1057, scale 1:15840.
logical Society of America-Geological Association wallace, H.
of Canada-Mineralogical Association of Canada, 1 980: Geology of the Slate Falls Area; District of
Joint Annual Meeting, Toronto, 361 p. Kenora (Patricia Portion); Ontario Geological Sur-
Thurston, P.C., Waychison, W., Falls, R., and Baker, vey, Open File Report 5314, 145p., 8 figures, 5
D.F. tables, 8 photographs. 4 maps.
1975a: Agnew Township, District of Kenora (Patricia 1981: Geology of the Miminiska Lake Area, Districts
Portion); Ontario Division of Mines, Preliminary of Kenora (Patricia Portion) and Thunder Bay;
Map P. 1056, scale 1:15840. Ontario Geological Survey, Report 214, 96p. Ac
companied by Maps 2416 and 2417, scale
1:31 680.

102
Part Three: Volcanic Lithogeochemistry
and Mineral Exploration
Chapter 7

Volcanic Cyclicity in Mineral Exploration; the Caldera


Cycle and Zoned Magma Chambers
P.C. Thurston

CONTENTS 7.4. CaO-AI 203 -MgO (wt7o) with


komatiitic rocks of the Munro
Abstract........................................................ 105 Township area........................................ 109
Introduction .................................................. 105 7.5. Histogram of about 2300 analyses of
Definitions ................................................ 105 Blake River Group volcanic rocks ......., 109
Scale of Cyclicity ........................................ 105 7.6. Histogram of volcanic classes Lake
Types of Cyclicity ....................................... 106 of the Woods-Wabigoon Subprovince, 109
Komatiitic Cycles .................................... 107
7.7. Na20 -i- K2O -FeO + Fe203-MgO
Komatiitic, Tholeiitic, Calc-Alkalic,
Alkalic Cycles ......................................... 107 (AFM) diagram in wt 07o of the Yoke
Lake volcanic rocks .............................., 110
Tholeiitic Basalt to Calc-Alkalic Felsic
Volcanic Rocks........................................ 108 7.8a. Schematic stratigraphic section
Bi-Modal Type ..................................... 109 Cycle III Confederation Lake ............... 110
Full-Fractionation Type ...................... 109 7.8b. A similar cycle at Flin Flon, Manitoba 110
Tholeiitic Basalt-Calc-Alkalic Basalt- 7.9. Schematic cross section of the
Rhyolite-Alkalic Volcanic Rocks ........... 110 Batchewana area with the lower
Calc-Alkalic Basalt-Rhyolite .................. 111 tholeiitic unit overlain by calc-alkalic
Tholeiitic Basalt-Calc-Alkalic Felsic felsic pyroclastic rocks or clastic
Volcanic Rocks-Tholeiitic Basalt.......... 111 metasediments ....................................... 111
Tholeiitic Basalt-Metasediments .......... 111 7.10. Iron enrichment cycle within the
Cyclicity Within Major Units ...................... 111 basalts of Cycle II Confederation
Cyclicity in Mafic Rocks ........................ 111 Lake .................................................. 111
Cyclicity in Felsic Sequences............... 112 7.11. Schematic cross section of the
Mega-scale Cyclicity.......................... 112 Redstone Nickel deposit................. 112
Meso-scale Cyclicity .......................... 113
Micro-scale Cyclicity .......................... 113 7.12. Compositional zonation within the
upper felsic part of Cycle III
Hiatus............................................................ 113 Confederation Lake......................... 112
Depositional Unit Scale.......................... 114
7.13. Schematic cross section of an
Iron-Enrichment Cycle Scale................. 114
Hiatuses in Felsic Sequences .............., 115
individual mafic flow at the Maybrun
Mine with large pillows at the base of
Magma Clan Transitions ........................ 116
the flow, small pillows toward the
The Caldera Cycle....................................... 116 top, and fine-grained tuff at the top .... 113
Zoned Magma Chambers ........................... 118 7.14a. Schematic cross section of barite-
Applications to Exploration..................... 119 bearing units in the North Pole area,
Summary ....................................................... 119 Pilbara Block, Western Australia .......... 114
References .................................................... 119 7.14b. Schematic cross section of the
Hemlo area .............................................. 114
TABLES 7.15. Minor scale cycles within the upper
7.1. Styles of Archean cyclical volcanism 108 part of Cycle II Confederation Lake ... 115
7.2. Types of Archean cyclical volcanism 108 7.16. Schematic cross section of a typical
ash-flow .................................................. 115
FIGURES 7.17. Cycle III Confederation Lake-
schematic cross section of the Selco
7.1. Minor cycle scale cyclical volcanism
copper-zinc-silver orebody .................. 116
in Cycle II at Confederation Lake,
stratigraphic section.......................................... 106 7.18. The caldera Cycle ................................. 117
7.2. Major cycle scale cyclical volcanism 7.19. Schematic cross section of a
in the Gamitagama Lake Setting Net compositionally zoned magma
Lake area, Gods Lake Subprovince ............... 107 chamber.................................................. 118
7.3. Super cycle scale cyclical volcanism
in the Abitibi Subprovince ................................ 107 PHOTOGRAPH
7.1. Compositionally zoned ash-flow from
Cycle III Confederation Lake ........................... 106

104
P.O. THURSTON

ABSTRACT Field and chemical evidence for zoned magma


Volcanic cyclicity pertains to the cyclic repetition of chambers consist of: 1) mafic pumice toward the top
of rhyolitic ignimbrites; 2) zonation in phenocryst type
rock units. In the Archean, this has meant the repeti
and abundance in felsic sequences; 3) the presence
tion of mafic to felsic volcanism. Cyclicity occurs on
of minor cycles of basaltic andesite and rhyolite, with
several scales including 1) mini-cycles within single
each rock type being of two distinct chemical types
beds; 2) minor-cycles within 10s to 100s of m; 3)
not inter-related by fractionation; 4) compositional
major-cycles within a few 100s to 1000s of m and, 4)
super-cycles operative on the scale of 1000s of m. zonation of stratigraphic sequences, for example at
Confederation Lake Cycle III.
The types of volcanic cycles commonly observed
in the Archean are listed as follows: 1) Komatiite
suite, peridotitic komatiite-peridotitic basalt komatiitic
INTRODUCTION
dacite; 2) Tholeiitic basalt-tholeiitic rhyolite; 3) This chapter treats the relationships between cyclicity
Tholeiitic basalt-calc-alkalic felsic; 4) Tholeiitic in Archean volcanic stratigraphy, and the localization
basalt-calc-alkalic felsic tholeiitic basalt; 5) Komatiite of mineral deposits by discussing:
suite peridotitic komatiite; 6) Tholeiitic basalt-calc- 1. volcanic cyclicity; the definition of the term, the
alkalic rhyolite-alkalic volcanic rocks; 7) Calc-alkalic various types of cyclicity found in "greenstone
basalt-calc-alkalic rhyolite. belts", the economic applications of various
Within these units are Fe and Mg enrichment and types of cyclicity, that is, location of mineral
depletion cycles in komatiites and mafic rocks, and deposits in terms of volcanic cyclicity and a
depositional and compositionally zoned cycles in fel degree of stratigraphic control of some appar
sic rocks. Geochemical data indicate the above cy ently epigenetic deposits.
cles rarely represent continuous fractionation se 2. the caldera cycle; how the complexities of
quences. Therefore, hiatuses represented by clastic stratigraphy can be analyzed in terms of the
and chemical sediments occur frequently within Smith and Bailey (1968) caldera cycle which
them. involves large Plinian eruptions, collapse of an
Volcanologically, gold can be related to iron en edifice forming a caldera, and renewed or resur
richment cycles in basalts and associated hiatuses. gent volcanism. The caldera cycle and its reflec
In addition, gold can be related as well to volcanic- tion in regional stratigraphy permits the separa
hydrothermal events involving hydro-fracturing of tion of felsic volcanic successions into those
cherts and production of sedimentary barite units. with high and low mineral potential with respect
Early epithermal veins directly relatable to volcanism to volcanogenic copper-zinc massive sulphide
are found in modern terrains, but not in the Archean. mineralization.
Most precious metal epithermal veins are related in 3. chemically zoned magma chambers; their role in
directly in terms of volcano collapse and so on, the genesis of massive sulphide mineralization
producing fracture sets or hiatuses in volcanism and gold-silver deposits.
which allow the development of impermeable sedi
This chapter attempts to demonstrate that an
mentary caprocks.
appreciation of volcanic eruption processes and their
Geochemical and volcanological observations al products, the temporal succession of eruption types,
low ordering of many of the types of cycles and the and the character of the magma chamber from which
chemically zoned magma chamber genetic hypo the rocks are produced, can lead to a better under
theses for volcanic sequences into the caldera cycle. standing of mineralization in volcanic stratigraphy,
The caldera cycle was developed to explain the and hence, and improved ability to evaluate mineral
sequence of events in caldera development. The sev potential and locate mineral deposits.
en stages of the cycle are: 1) regional tumescence
and generation of ring fractures; 2) caldera forming DEFINITIONS
eruptions; 3) caldera collapse; 4) pre-resurgence vol
A cycle is defined as (AGI 1972): "A series of events
canism and sedimentation; 5) resurgent doming; 6)
or changes that are normally, but not inevitably, con
major ring fracture volcanism; 7) terminal solfataric
and hot-spring activity. sidered to be recurrent and to return to a starting
point, that are repeated in the same order several or
Volcanogenic massive sulphides are often asso many times at more or less regular intervals and that
ciated with volcanic domes produced in stages 5 and operate under conditions which, at the end of the
6 with some involvement of stage 7 fluids. This series, are the same as they were at the beginning."
simplistic analysis does not explain the presence of Cyclical volcanism pertains to the repetition of vol
basalts in mineralized felsic sequences or the unique canic rocks. In the classical Archean context, this
heavy rare earth enriched character of copper-zinc has generally referred to the repetition of sequences
mineralized rhyolites. progressing from mafic to felsic (Goodwin 1967,
These features are explicable by invoking a 1968).
chemically zoned magma chamber with a rhyolitic
upper part in which large trace element gradients SCALE OF CYCLICITY
occur, and a basaltic lower part which is often erupt
ed late in the eruptive sequence, yielding an associ Anhaeusser (1971) examined cyclicity in Archean
ation of high Fe tholeiites with copper-zinc mineral volcanic rocks and described its occurrence on four
ized rhyolites. scales:

105
CHAPTER 7

1. mini-cycles: measured in cm or parts thereof, for somewhat arbitrary process. Glikson and Jahn (1984)
example, wacke-mudstone couplets or felsic tuff- have summarized investigations which have shown
chert couplets (Photo 7.1). there is a compositional gap between komatiites
2. minor cycles: measured in m, 10s of m, 100s of (peridotitic, pyroxenitic, and basaltic) and the so-
m, for example, parts of Cycle II at Confederation called high-Mg basalts. However, Johnson et al.
Lake where basaltic andesite to rhyolite cycles (1978) have shown that a complete gradation exists
take place over about 150 m intervals (Thurston between volcanic rocks of tholeiitic and calc-alkalic
1981 b) (Figure 7.1). affinity. Therefore, in the following review of types of
chemical cyclicity in Archean volcanism, the reader
3. major cycles: "a few hundred to many thousands should realize that classification on the basis of an
of metres" thick, for example, the cyclical vol AFM or AFTM (Jensen 1976) diagram (that is, relative
canism of Ayres (1977) or Thurston (1981 b) to a line separating rocks of two affinities) is not
(Figure 7.2). Cyclicity on this scale occurs in the appropriate; rather, the presence or absence of the
Norseman area of Western Australia (Doepel
1965; quoted by Glikson 1976) and in the
Bulawayan Group of Zimbabwe (Bliss and
Stidolph 1969).
4. super cycles: include the whole of a volcanic
sedimentary to calc-alkalic to alkalic volcanic
Confederation Lake Area
cycle and constitute 1000s of m of stratigraphy.
In the Abitibi Subprovince, Pyke (1978) and Jen chert A
sen (1978a) described the three-fold recurrence felsic tuff y
of a volcanic super cycle involving basaltic and ^Intermediate flow in
peridotitic komatiite succeeded by high-Fe and \felsic tuff
high-Mg tholeiitic basalt through tholeiitic rhyolite
mafic pillow o
to calc-alkalic basalt through rhyolite (Figure
7.3). Volcanic cycles of this magnitude appear to breccia o
be unusual in their stratigraphic thickness and
chemical variety. A further compilation of exam cc
ples of the various scales of volcanic cyclicity is mafic flow
o
listed in Table 7.1. z
TYPES OF CYCLICITY
Six major types of volcanic cyclicity recognized in
the Ontario Archean based upon magma clan affinity ^felsic tuff
are shown in Table 7.2. Three major magma clans -*mafic flow
are represented: komatiite, tholeiite, and calc-alkalic.
Classification into these clans is. of necessity, a
22 -•-felsic tuff
LLJ
—l
O
>
o
cc
o
60 -^gabbro

felsic tuff

Figure 7.1. Minor cycle scale cyclical volcanism in


Photo 7.1. Compositionally zoned ash-flow from Cycle II at Confederation Lake, stratigraphic
Cycle III Confederation Lake. Rhyolite frag section. The cycle progresses from mafic
ments at base are shown by arrow. The unit (basaltic andesite) flows to rhyolite tuffs and
grades upward to mostly andesitic pumice. chemical sediments at the top.

106
P.O. THURSTON

25-
GAMITAGAMA LAKE GREENSTONE BELT
SW NE SUPER-CYCLE SCALE
VOLCANISM
V.
Q)

20-
Q)
metavolcanics;
mafic metavolcanics^
mafic metavolcanics;
^metasedimentary formation///

Figure 7.2. Major cycle scale cyclical volcanism in 15- tholeiitic felsic rocks
the Gamitagama Lake-Setting Net Lake area,
Gods Lake Subprovince. Cyclicity is on the
scale of 102 to 1C? m (Ayres 1969).

calcalkalic rocks
hallmark of tholeiitic affinity, the iron enrichment
trend must be tested for.
10- Q)
KOMATIITIC CYCLES
Within the komatiite class, Arndt (1975), Arndt et at. tholeiitic rocks
(1977), and subsequent workers (Nisbet 1982) have
demonstrated that a fractionation (fractional crystalli
zation) relationship exists between a parental magma
of peridotitic komatiite through pyroxenitic komatiite,
and that a hiatus in nickel, chromium, aluminium, and komatiitic rocks
rare earth element data exists relative to high-Mg
basalts of undoubted komatiitic affinity. The gap is 5 -
explained by a model involving convection in a 0)
chemically zoned magma above primitive, freshly
mantle-derived peridotitic komatiite (Nisbet 1982).
(O
The high-Mg basalts are the predominant units in 0 *- o
i.
these successions. *-
(D
•o
Q) S
Field and chemical studies of cyclicity within
these successions are important in that Arndt (1978) E
o
has observed that syngenetic nickel mineralization,
exsolved immiscibly out of komatiitic liquids, is re
stricted to the Mg-rich part of the cycle as shown in
Figure 7.4. Tholeiitic basalts and calc-alkalic Figure 7.3. Super cycle scale cyclical volcanism in
pyroclastic rocks are intercalated within nominally the Abitibi Subprovince. Jensen (1978a) pos
komatiitic major stratigraphic units in the Abitibi Sub tulated the existence of two super-cycles 10*
province and at Red Lake. The origin of these units m thick ranging from a komatiitic base through
which mark the cessation of komatiitic volcanism is tholeiitic rocks, a calc-alkalic unit, to an alkalic
obscure; Glikson and Jahn (1984) suggested the volcanic top. This is a generalized cross sec
units may have originated by partial melting of tion of Cycle II (after Jensen 1978b).
komatiites.

KOMATIITIC, THOLEIITIC, CALC-ALKALIC, ALKALIC


CYCLES enrichment cycles, some of which evolve by frac
tional crystallization (Thurston 1981 a) to rare tholeiitic
Jensen (1978a) and Pyke (1978) have described rhyolite tuffs. The calc-alkalic unit consists of basalt
cyclicity in the Abitibi Subprovince in which 2 super through rhyolite characterized by lath-like plagioclase
cycles have a komatiitic unit at the base surmounted phenocrysts. Jensen (1984) suggested that rock
by a tuff-chemical sediment unit together totalling 10 types of this unit represent fractional crystallization
000 m in thickness, succeeded upward by a 6000 to from a calc-alkalic basalt parent magma.
10 000 m thick tholeiitic unit, then a 7500 to 10 000
m thick calc-alkalic unit. The tholeiitic unit consists These cycles are characterized by large scale
(Letros et al. 1983) of several minor-cycle-scale iron cyclicity, that is, from komatiite through tholeiite to

107
CHAPTER 7

TABLE 7.1: STYLES OF ARCHEAN CYCLICAL VOLCANISM.


AREA UNITS REPRESENTED SCALE OF CYCLICITY REFERENCE
(AFTER WILSON ET AL. (AFTER ANHAEUSSER
1974) 1971)
S. Africa (Onverwaacht Lower basic, middle basic Super cycle, major cycle Anhaeusser 1971
Grp.)
Rhodesia (Bulawayan) Lower basic, middle basic, Super, major, minor, Bliss and Stidolph 1969
upper felsic mini-cycles
W. Australia Lower basic, middle basic, Super, major, minor,
(Kalgoorlie) middle felsic mini-cycles
(Norseman) Lower basic, middle basic, Major, mini, minor cycles Doepel 1965
middle felsic
Canada
Gods Lake Subprovince Upper cyclic Major, minor, mini-cycle Hubregtse 1976; Ayres
1977
Wabigoon Subprovince Lower basic, middle basic, Super cycle, minor, and Blackburn, Trowell, and
middle felsic, upper mini-cycle Edwards 1978
cyclic, alkalic
Abitibi Subprovince Lower basic, middle basic, Super, minor, mini-cycle Pyke 1978; Jensen 1976,
middle felsic, upper 1978a, 1978b,
cyclic, alkalic
Uchi Subprovince Lower basic, middle basic, Super, major, minor, This work; Wallace,
middle felsic mini-cycles personal communication,
1978

calc-alkalic volcanic rocks. Within each of these ma


jor magma clan units, there is minor scale cyclicity,
particularly in the lower part of the super cycle.
Within Quebec, in the upper part of Cycle III
(MERQ/OGS 1984), Gelinas el al. (1984) have ob
served minor scale cyclicity within the nominally
calc-alkalic Blake River Group. This cyclicity consists
of cycles, each 100s of m thick that have mafic
bases of either tholeiitic or calc-alkalic affinity and
progress upward to rhyolite. In fact, within the Duprat-
Montbray Complex or cycle, four small scale basalt to TABLE 7.2: TYPES OF ARCHEAN CYCLICAL
rhyolite cycles exist (Thurston et at. 1984). VOLCANISM.
________TYPES OF CYCLICITY________
The minor scale cyclicity within the Blake River
Group shows that small scale cyclicity exists within
large scale cycles. The seemingly random alterations 1) KOM perid kom — dacite
between tholeiitic and calc-alkalic affinity for the
basaltic rocks of the Group (Gelinas et al. 1984) 2) KOM perid kom — TH bas — rhy
suggest that the Gelinas and Ludden (1984) hypoth
esis involving variable degrees of contamination as — CA bas — rhy — alk
the explanation for the varying magma clan affinity of
these units may be valid. 3) TH bas — andes — TH andes — CA dac
— rhy
THOLEIITIC BASALT TO CALC-ALKALIC FELSIC
VOLCANIC ROCKS 4) TH bas — andes — CA bas — rhy — alk
This type of cyclicity is probably the most common 5) CA bas — rhy
type in the Canadian Shield, according to surveys of
Goodwin (1982) and Goodwin et al. (1982). This 6) TH bas — CA dac — rhy — TH bas
cyclicity consists of basal tholeiitic basalts and an-
desites succeeded upwards by calc-alkalic felsic vol KOM:komatiitic TH:tholeiitic — fractionation
canic rocks. Examples of such cyclicity include: Con
federation Lake (Thurston 1981 b; Thurston and Fryer CA:calc-alkalic alk:alkalic — no
1983), Red Lake (Wallace et al. 1984; Pirie 1981), fractionation
vast parts of the Wabigoon Subprovince (Trowell et

108
P.O. THURSTON

MgO 15- L~U ABITIBI


mineralized komatiites EOCYCLE II nM06
0 non-mineralized EZ3CYCLE III nM33
komatiites 10-

* tholeiites
5-

60 70
SiO2 (wt

Figure 7.5. Histogram of about 2300 analyses of


Blake River Group volcanic rocks (after Thur
ston e t a l. 1985). Vertical axis number of sam
ples; horizontal axis-volatile-free wf/o SiO^.
The bimodal distribution of Si02 values is quite
evident, clustered at andesite and rhyolite.
CaO ALO
2^3

60 —
Figure 7.4. CaO-A!2 O3-MgO (wf/o) with komatiite
rocks of the Munro Township area (after Arndt
1978). The diagram illustrates the lack of ma 50 — Manitou Lake
jor element discontinuities in this sample suite,
the round filled symbols are komatiites with
associated nickel deposits. Uchi Lake
~ 40 —

a/. 1980), and the Favorable Lake area (Ayres 1977).


This type of cyciicity may be subdivided into two o
such types: a) bi-modal basalt-rhyolite type, and b) a 2
CT —
full fractionation type. d)
"20 —
Bi-Modal Type ——
Thurston ef at. (1985) showed that the Blake River
Group in the upper part of Cycle III in the Abitibi 10 —
Subprovince was clearly bi-modal, based upon 2300
analyses in the Quebec part of the unit. The two end - '

members are andesite and rhyolite (Figure 7.5). Bi


modal volcanic cycles with basalt and rhyolite end
members are more common, with numerous exam basalt andesite dacite rhyolite
ples being cited by Thurston ef a/. (1985).
This type of bi-modal volcanism must be recon Figure 7.6. Histogram of volcanic classes Lake of
ciled with the data (Figure 7.6) obtained in a survey the Woods-Wabigoon Subprovince (after Good
by Goodwin (1977). This compilation shows a de win 1977). Vertical axis-weighted mean abun
creasing volume 07o from basalt to rhyolite for the dance based upon stratigraphic thickness; hori
Confederation area and part of the Wabigoon Sub zontal axis-generalized rocks types.
province. These data are consistent with an origin of
the sequence by fractionation from a basaltic parent
magma. Thurston and Fryer (1983) have shown that
intermediate compositions in Cycle II at Confeder selvages, or the inclusion of several fragment types
ation Lake are produced by magma mixing of in the sample.
tholeiitic basalt and trondhjemite, crystallization from
primary andesite melts, and fractionation of basaltic Thurston et al. (1985) have shown that bi-modal
liquids. The available evidence shows that while ba basalt rhyolite volcanism is the most frequently de
saltic liquids fractionate to andesites, more felsic scribed type of volcanism in the Superior Province,
differentiates are not produced. The apparent greater based upon sedimentologic, volcanologic, and geo
abundance of andesites in Goodwin's (1977) com chemical evidence.
pilation may have been produced by sampling of
heterolithic pyroclastic rocks, or by the practice of Full-Fractionation Type
chip sampling which can incorporate altered pillow This type of cycle is represented by calc-alkalic
volcanic rocks ranging in composition from basalt to

109
CHAPTER 7

FeO*0.8998Fe 0O,
A. flows (mafic)
metres
45 debris flows_____
150 -and air fall (felsic)
A
A
A
tuff to (andesite)
tuff breccia (rh ;o0lite)
A

dome, flows (felsic)

ash flows (dacite)

A
A A A
MgO

Figure 7.7. Na2 0 * K2 0-FeO -f Fe2 O3-MgO (AFM) J5


flows (mafic)
diagram in wf/o of the Yoke Lake volcanic
rocks (after Thurston et al. 1984). The Yoke
Lake sequence is of calc-alkalic affinity and is
the youngest sequence in the Straw Lake area
of the Wabigoon Subprovince. A complete data CYCLE III
set would show a lack of compositional gaps in
the suites. CONFEDERATION LAKE

rhyolite with no gaps in major element compositions.


Trace element data exist for only a few suites, mak
ing petrogenetic conclusions tentative. Giles (1982),
Giles and Hallberg (1982) and Hallberg et al. (1976) INTRUSIVE CONTACT

have shown that some of these complexes are pro ••. .".''-.'••7 i ''; .i :^'v'.'''.''.''."''-',r-/, 1"' dacite
duced by the melting of a mafic source in the lower ;:'-'-,;".'-:.' '."•, l V-,:} O;.::;':' ',.- r ;
andesitic carbonate-bearing sediment
intermediate tuff

crust, followed by fractionation in a high level magma : mudstone, tuff, chert


chamber. Sparse data on Canadian examples sug rhyolite crystal tuff
gest that the sequence at Yoke Lake in the Wabigoon
Subprovince may be similar (G.R. Edwards, Professor, massive rhyolite lobes,
York University, personal communication, 1983). rhyolite breccia,
microbreccia ^-,
massive sulphides
^_andesitic
heterolithic breccia dacite tuff,
pumice-bearing tuff
THOLEIITIC BASALT-CALC-ALKALIC BASALT-
RHYOLITE-ALKALIC VOLCANIC ROCK
This type of volcanic cycle, with an uppermost unit of basaltic andesite
alkalic volcanic rocks has been viewed as being
relatively uncommon with the major example cited :INLET ARM FAULT:
-6.4 km"
being Cycle III in the Abitibi Subprovince capped by
the Timiskaming Group alkalic volcanic rocks
(MERQ/OGS 1984). Jensen (1984) has noted, how
ever, that the top of Cycle li in the Abitibi includes
conglomerate with trachytic clasts. Other examples of Figure 7.8. a. Schematic stratigraphic section,
this type of cyclicity include: the Wawa Subprovince Cycle III, Confederation Lake. The cycle con
west of Thunder Bay (Shegelski 1980); the Wabigoon sists of a tholeiitic base, a calc-alkalic upper
Subprovince south of Dryden (Blackburn et al. 1984); part with the uppermost unit being mafic
the Birch Lake area of the Uchi Subprovince; and tholeiitic flows.
Oxford Lake Manitoba (Brooks et al. 1982). A number b. A similar cycle at Flin FIon, Manitoba (after
of gold deposits occur in the Kirkland Lake area that Syme et al. 1982).
are spatially associated with plutonic equivalents to
these volcanic rocks (Ploeger 1980); a spatial associ
ation of late volcanic rocks and gold also occurs at
Shebandowan (Stott and Schnieders 1983).

110
P.O. THURSTON

BATCHEWANA AREA

0K; :/'j ^""X"1


— — — — —d '' VV--M 4 -
.————.
~—"~—~—-^———- •^ iYu-V:; mixed
— — — — — basinal
; -~ ^"~,\'^,\^ felsic calcalkalic Cycle II Basalts
--------~-- sedimentary volcanic tholeiitic
—---—-L-—L.-
rocks rocks pillow basalts Confederation Lake Area
— — — — —
Z—Z—~—~—~-
sX'./'1 ^
!5
•*~*
banded iron formatio n /flows I *- 2
.C
*tuff "53
O)

1 JC

tholeiites
* interflow wack.es:;:;
I
x BASAL SEQUENCE
ttuff
i
10 15 20
Figure 7.9. Schematic cross section of the FeO* (wt
Batchewana area based upon relations de
scribed in Grunsky (1983), with the lower Figure 7.10. Iron enrichment cycle within the ba
tholeiitic unit overlain by calc-alkalic felsic salts of Cycle II Confederation Lake. Vertical
pyroclastic rocks or clastic metasediments. axis-wf/o FeO (?); horizontal axis stratigraphic
height above an arbitrary datum at the base of
Cycle II in the area of Narrow Lake.
Recognition of these sequences in the field can
be difficult. At Kirkland Lake, the alkalic volcanic
rocks vary from being undersaturated to oversaturat This type of cyclicity has spatial and genetic
ed, even within individual flows, however, trachytic association with volcanogenic copper-zinc massive
textures and unusual colours, ranging from red to sulphides (Thurston and Hodder 1982); a relationship
green to yellow, aid in their identification. High potas which will be more fully described in a later section.
sium and uranium contents in biotite-rich mafic rocks
at Sunshine Lake in the Wabigoon Subprovince, give THOLEIITIC BASALT-METASEDIMENTS
those rocks distinctive radiometric expressions.
This type of cyclicity, in which basal tholeiitic basalts
CALC-ALKALIC BASALT-RHYOLITE with or without komatiitic units are overlain by clastic
and/or chemical sediments, is of regional impor
Cyclicity which results in a sequence with a com tance. These basalts underlie vast parts of the Supe
positional range from calc-alkalic basalt to rhyolite is rior Province. As shown in Figure 7.9, this type of
reported to comprise the upper part (immediately be cycle can be explained by the effects of regional
low the alkalic volcanic rocks) of the super-cycles of facies variation. In the east, a basalt-sediment cycle
the Abitibi Subprovince (Jensen 1984). This type of occurs, but in the west, the cycle is a basalt-calc-
cyclicity also occurs in the Yoke Lake area of the alkalic felsic volcanic cycle. This is interpreted (E.
Wabigoon Subprovince (Edwards 1984) and Figure Grunsky, Geologist, Ontario Geological Survey, per
7.7. The main feature of this type of cyclicity is that it sonal communication, 1984) as a proximal volcanic
usually represents fractional crystallization of a ba environment in the west giving way eastward to a
saltic parent liquid, and therefore compositional gaps more distal sedimentary environment.
are not common (Giles 1982; Giles and Hallberg
1982).
CYCLICITY WITHIN MAJOR UNITS
THOLEIITIC BASALT-CALC-ALKALIC FELSIC As discussed above, volcanic cycles occur on vary
VOLCANIC ROCKS-THOLEIITIC BASALT ing scales, however, cyclicity of several types occurs
within the various units of the cycles, that is, within
In this type of cycle, basal tholeiitic basalts are mafic and felsic volcanic units.
overlain by calc-alkalic felsic volcanic rocks ranging
from andesite to rhyolite in composition. The felsic
CYCLICITY IN MAFIC ROCKS
volcanic rocks range from proximal flows and domes
to proximal and more distal pyroclastic rocks with In basaltic sequences, Fe-enrichment cycles pro
intercalated sediments. The cycle is capped by gressing from iron-poor units (67o to 87o FeO*) at the
tholeiitic flows. This type of stratigraphy occurs in base to Fe rich (187c to 2070 FeO*) at the top, are
Cycle III at Confederation Lake (Thurston and Hodder common. In the example shown in Figure 7.10, ba
1982 and Figure 7.8). It may also occur in parts of salts low in the iron-enrichment cycle have 87o to
Cycle III in the Abitibi (Gelinas et al. 1984) and is 107o FeO*, increase to higher FeO* values, and are
known in the Proterozoic succession at Flin Flon often followed by chemical or clastic sediments suc
(Syme et al. 1982). ceeded upward by two additional iron-enrichment cy
cles. Thurston and Fryer (1983) have interpreted
these cycles to represent an initial mantle-derived

111
CHAPTER 7

Cycle III Confederation Lake

basalt
mafic flows
andesite
felsic debris flows
and air fall tuff

tuff

massive breccia

banded tuff

1500
layered breccia rhyolite
hyalotuff
massive flow
rhyolite dome

l diabase Deloro Group


i monzonite to granodiorite
Figure 7.12. Compositional zonation within the up
Tisdale Group J intrusive rocks per felsic part of Cycle III, Confederation Lake.
K^^i komatiitic flows s sulphide/silicate In a regional sense, this unit is the upper felsic
KNNN komatiitic peridotite flows ! iron formation part of the cycle, however, note that the upper
k—HFe-Ni layer ] dacite tuffs
i disseminated and net- l dacite tuffs/
unit changes gradationally from rhyolite to an
textured sulphides J quartz feldspar porphyry desite bulk composition. The diagram consists
of proximal facies on the left and more distal
units on the right.
Figure 7.11. Schematic cross section of the Red
stone Nickel deposit (after Robinson and
Hutchinson 1982).
Cyclicity in komatiites has been little studied, but
Arndt (1978) has noted the association of komatiite-
hosted Ni deposits with the high-MgO parts of
tholeiitic liquid which evolved by open-system crystal komatiite units (Figure 7.11) in Ontario and Western
fractionation (O'Hara 1977) of olivine and plagioclase Australia. Beyond a general spatial association with
with late crystallization of clinopyroxene. In this type high MgO-komatiites, no particular type of komatiite
of system, the magma chamber is an open system in unit appears to be favoured as the locus for nickel
the sense that it is periodically refilled with batches mineralization. The ores occur in the basal part of
of new magma while fractional crystallization contin individual flows, and most authors suggest the nickel
ues. sulphides occur there as a result of sulphide droplets
The deposition of chemical sediments in Cycle III settling out of the silicate magma due to immiscibility.
at Confederation Lake (Thurston 1981 b) at the top of Robinson and Hutchinson (1982) ascribe a
the Fe-enrichment cycles has been interpreted to volcanogenic-exhalative origin to the Redstone nickel
mark the closing down of a magma chamber system. deposit south of Timmins. The deposit of nickel sul
The chemical sediments have economic significance. phides occurs above a calc-alkalic dacite tuff as
At Confederation Lake, a sulphide facies iron forma massive iron-nickel sulphides which grade along
tion in Cycle III above the lowest iron-enrichment strike into sulphide facies iron formation. This unit,
cycle, has an above background (170 to 200 ppb) interpreted to be composed of chemical metasedi-
gold content (Thurston 1981 b). The elevated gold ments, is capped by komatiitic flows. In terms of
content may have been derived from pervasive pre- cyclical volcanism, then, the deposit occurs at a
metamorphic hydrothermal introduction of calcium. stratigraphic level representing a volcanic hiatus. The
This event is marked by epidotization of the pillowed deposit originated by hydrothermal fluids circulating
basalts. Epidotization is most intensely developed through underlying komatiites and depositing Ni sul
beneath the chemical sediment unit and is marked phides at the rock-water interface.
by pervasive alteration of the flows, giving way
downward to epidotization concentrated around the
CYCLICITY IN FELSIC SEQUENCES
interpillow space.
An association of gold mineralization occurs at Cyclicity in felsic volcanic sequences occurs on
Red Lake and Confederation Lake with high Fe ba scales ranging from the macro (103 m) through the
salts (Pirie 1981; Thurston 1982). The gold mineral meso scale (102 m) to the micro scale (m to cm).
ization is generally associated with late vein systems Only selected examples of each type wil! be de
(McGeehan and Hodgson 1981). If gold is at least in scribed.
part transported by the thio complex (HS'), then the
above spatial association may mean gold is in part Mega-Scale Cycles
fixed by pyrite-forming reactions in iron-rich rocks. At Confederation Lake Cycle III, the youngest cycle,
can be subdivided (Figure 7.12) into a mafic base

112
P.O. THURSTON

felsic tuff Meso-Scale Cyclicity


Formation M is the uppermost unit of Cycle III at
Confederation Lake. The formation consists of a
rhyolitic endogeneous dome with lenticular deposits
of collapse debris and about 1500m of overlying
felsic flows. These flows are succeeded by 1000 m
of felsic tuff-breccia to lapilli-tuff which grades
gradually to an andesitic composition. This is fol
lowed by 150m of felsic debris flows, air-fall tuffs,
and 45 m of pillowed mafic flows (Figure 7.12). The
cyclicity within this sequence is two fold: 1) eruption
type and products and 2) compositional cyclicity. The
sequence progresses from quiescent extrusion of
flows through violent eruption of coarse pyroclastic
rocks to quiescent eruption of mafic flows. Com-
positionally, this 1000 m thick sequence grades from
rhyolite at the base to andesite at the top. In the area
of southern Fly Lake (Thurston 1981 b), a single de
positional unit of ash-flow contains predominantly
essential fragments of dacite with some rhyolite frag
ments at the base and andesite fragments at the top
(Thurston and Hodder 1982). This single com-
positionally zoned unit and the overall compositional
zonation of formation M have been ascribed by Thur
ston and Hodder (1982) to eruption from a com-
positionally zoned magma chamber.

Micro-Scale Cyclicity
Ash-flows ranging in thickness from 1 to 5 m occur in
formation M at Confederation Lake (Thurston and
Figure 7.13. Schematic cross section of an individ Hodder 1982). These rocks are poorly bedded lapilli-
ual mafic flow at the Maybrun Mine with large tuff to tuff units displaying normal density and re
pillows at the base of the flow, small pillows verse size grading of ash, pumice, and lithic frag
toward the top, and fine-grained tuff at the top ments. The clast-types, geometry, and vertical se
(after Setterfield et at. 1983). quence of primary structures (compare Sparks et al.
1973, Figure 7.13) suggest an ash-flow origin
(Thurston 1981 b). The concentrations of pumice have
been flattened, extensively silicified, and epidotized
(formation K) above which are dacitic pyroclastic during vapour-phase recrystallization shortly after de
rocks of formation L and formation M, a rhyolitic position. The mobility of sulphides is economically
dome, and correlative flows and pyroclastic rocks. In significant in this regime. Pyrite has partly replaced
a regional sense, formations L and M together form pumice fragments at the top of each thin ash-flow
the felsic upper part of Cycle III. However, formation depositional unit, creating areas of pyrite, minor pyr
L is composed of dacitic lapilli-tuff to tuff-breccia rhotite, and traces of sphalerite forming up to 30 07o to
with abundant shards, and broken phenocrysts. Also, 40 07o of the rocks over thicknesses of 15cm. This
some evidence of welding which led Thurston phenomenon produced anomalous geophysical re
(1981 b) to interpret it as an ash-flow is present in this sponse (Assessment Files Research Office, Ontario
formation. Formation M (above formation L) is inter Geological Survey, Toronto) which was subsequently
preted to be composed of dome-related flows and drilled. This type of sulphide occurrence, however,
less extensive pyroclastic units than in formation L. has limited economic potential.
These rocks accumulated in a fault-bounded trough.
Violent, extensive eruption of ash-flows (formation L), HIATUSES
followed by dome-related siliceous volcanism, has Stratigraphic hiatuses in volcanic sequences are of
been interpreted as a Plinian eruption followed by
ten marked by interflow units of clastic sediment,
caldera collapse; namely, formation of a sector
chemical sediment, or fine-grained distal facies tuffs.
graben occurred. This represents major scale cyclic- By virtue of their generally fine grain size, interflow
ity of volcanic processes and products. In younger units can form the impermeable cap of Hodgson and
terrains, this type of cyclicity has been explained in
Lydon (1977) beneath which hydrothermal activity
terms of the caldera cycle (Smith and Bailey 1968; produces mineral deposits at scales ranging from
Smith 1979). Other Precambrian examples are at
single depositional units to meso-scale cycles.
Noranda (Dimroth et al. 1982), the Setting Net Lake
area (Ayres 1977), and Flin Flon, Manitoba (Syme et
al. 1982).

113
CHAPTER 7

NORTH POLE BARITE volcanic rocks


sedimentary rocks
felsics volcaniclastics
barite±chert
basalts and quartz-feldspar
komatiites schist
sediments
chert Playter
Harbour
flows ——A~~ A ——— A Group
chert A A AA
pillowed flows A
pyroclastic rocks
BaSO4 and chert A
A A

Lower
Warrawoona mafic flows
Group
HEMLO
COMPOSITE
SECTION
Figure 7.l4a. Schematic cross section of barite-
bearing units in the North Pole area, Pilbara Figure 7.14b. Schematic cross section of the
Block, Western Australia (after Hickman et al. Hem lo area (after Muir 1982 and Patterson
1980). 1984).

DEPOSITIONAL UNIT SCALE Bobjo Prospect where sulphide facies ironstone over
At the Maybrun Mine south of Kenora, Setterfield et lies variolitic iron-rich basalt in Formation K of Cycle
al. (1983) described mafic flows with minor interflow III at Confederation Lake/There, Thurston (1982) de
cherty tuffs or zones of collapsed pillows sealing the scribed the presence of above background (170 to
top of individual flows. Copper-gold mineralization is 200 ppb) levels of gold in chemical sediments above
preferentially concentrated toward the top of individ hydrothermally altered, epidotized tholeiitic basalts.
ual flows because interpillow space increases up Hydrothermal alteration with substantial seawater
ward in each flow as pillows become smaller and input is involved in the production of sedimentary
more loosely packed (see Figure 7.13). barite in South Africa (Heinrichs and Reimer 1977)
and Australia (Hickman et al. 1980) (Figure 7.14a).
FE-ENRICHMENT CYCLE SCALE These Archean barite occurrences represent both
veins and barite-rich sedimentation during a hiatus in
We noted earlier that gold deposits at Red Lake, volcanism. Given the fact that barium and gold are
Timmins, and Western Australia (Groves and Gee spatially associated, and the fact that the major
1980) tend to be spatially associated with the iron- source of barium is seawater (Heinrichs and Reimer
rich top of tholeiitic sequences, the iron-rich basalts 1977), and the major source of gold is the surround
are often overlain by auriferous chemical sediments, ing volcanic rocks (Fyfe and Kerrich 1984), a hy
usually ironstone. A non-economic example is the drothermal system is probably the source of this

114
P.O. THURSTON

Confederation Lake Area v L a y e r 1 |^f|g||jgS fine ash-fall


deposit
chert i
pumice c?
^intermediate LLJ clasts
o
felsic ^
1 Layer 2;^0 ,^ o;
^
o p 0 0..o. o D
lithic . 0o'.'Q-,?-.'0 ?. one flow unit
"fr cc clasts no 9.9^0c
--mafic o
::::: i ::::

u ir
--felsic t\ ground surge
•iiiiiSiiii-i
M
-mafic vLayer 3 deposit

Plinian ash-fall
felsic deposit
LLJ
-J Figure 7.16. Schematic cross section of a typical
O ash-flow (after Sparks et a l. 1973). Layer 1
> consists of crossbedded tuffs of base surge
O o origin. Layer 2 is lapilli-tuff to tuff-breccia,
O) poorly sorted, showing reverse size grading,
cc that is, concentration of pumice fragments in
III
o the upper part and normal density grading with
mafic denser lithic fragments toward the base. This
B IIH unit is produced by gravitational collapse of
the eruption column. Layer 3 is poorly sorted,
poorly and generally thin bedded tuff deposited
from the ash cloud.
CO
0)

mal activity beneath the immpermeable chert cap


felsic leading to steam-driven brecciation of the chert. Gold
prospects are associated with this unit (Edwards and
Figure 7.15. Minor scale cycles within the upper Hodder 1981).
part of Cycle H Confederation Lake. This is a Minor scale chemical cycles in volcanism are
generalized overview to permit an appreciation important in Au deposition at the Hill-Sloan-Tivey
of the gross features of this scale of cyclicity. quartz horizon east of Confederation Lake (Thurston
Please see Figure 7.1 for greater detail. 1982). Four minor cycles, each above 150 m thick,
occur in Cycle II. These cycles consist of basal
basaltic "andesites overlain by rhyolite and chemical
sediment (Figure 7.15). The chemical sediment units
mineralization type. The accumulation of gold in represent hiatuses in volcanism, terminating some of
chemical sediments such as barite in some occur the minor scale cycles. Based upon chemical evi
rences (Heinrichs and Reimer 1977) suggests that dence, Thurston and Fryer (1983) suggested these
perhaps the barium-gold mineralization at Hemlo cycles were the product of eruption from a chemi
(Patterson 1984) may be related to a hiatus in vol cally zoned magma chamber. Gold mineralization oc
canism (Figure 7.14b). This very premature sugges curs in the chemical sediments at the top of one of
tion is subject to verification in the field. the minor cycles (Thurston 1982) and in vein systems
Chert fragment-rich conglomerates with angular cutting these units.
chert fragments occur above the basalt in the
Phinney-Dash Lakes area (Edwards and Hodder HIATUSES IN FELSIC SEQUENCES
1981). These authors suggest the chert represents Hiatuses in felsic volcanism may be produced by the
chemical sedimentation during a hiatus in basaltic catastrophic emptying of the magma chamber during
volcanism. Brecciation and slumping of the chert to a Plinian eruption, that is the production of ignim-
form the conglomerate was produced by hydrother-

115
CHAPTER 7

South Bay Mine 1050 foot level qQFP-1


.j i_j dacite breccia
jQFP-2 incipient ^felsite dike
QFP-2 \lllh orebody
rhyolite

Figure 7.17. Cycle III Confederation Lake-schematic cross section of the Selco Cu-Zn-Ag orebody (after
Thurston et al. 1978).

brites. A cross section of a typical ignimbrite is sition from one magma clan to another. This provides
shown in Figure 7.16. the opportunity for chemical or clastic sedimentation
As described above, the top of formation L in of marble, barite, ironstone, and so on, with or with
Cycle III at Confederation Lake marks the cessation out gold mineralization. Examples of mineralized
of Plinian eruptive activity and the onset of caldera magma clan transition include the Adams Mine, a
collapse. The collapse is the sagging of the magma komatiitic tholeiite transition (MERQ/OGS 1984), and
chamber roof which may founder piecemeal or as a the Sherman Mine, a tholeiite calc-alkalic transition
unit. The cause of the collapse is the catastrophic (Bennett 1978). Both are iron deposits. Gold occurs at
emptying of the magma chamber. This is represented the tholeiite-calc-alkalic transition in Cycle II at Con
in stratigraphic terms by a hiatus in volcanism, where federation Lake (Thurston 1982). The location of iron
small scale hydrothermal activity may occur by anal stone and massive sulphide bodies toward the top of
ogy with similar systems in younger terrain (Cruson the Cycle II calc-alkaline sequence in the Abitibi
and Pansze 1983). The lack of large scale hydrother Subprovince (MERQ-OGS 1984; Pyke and Middleton
mal activity at this stratigraphic level at Confeder 1970) are basically controlled by the transition from
ation Lake, for example, has been noted by Sopuck calc-alkalic volcanism of Cycle II to the komatiitic
(1977). volcanism which begins Cycle III.
The hiatus in felsic volcanic activity marked by
the contact between the endogeneous quartz-feld THE CALDERA CYCLE
spar prophyry dome and associated dome-collapse This section describes the application of conceptual
talus deposits (Pollock et al. 1970; Thurston 1981 b) is models developed for modern volcanic rocks to Ar
the site of the South Bay copper-zinc-gold vol chean sequences. This is done to show that Archean
canogenic massive sulphide deposit (Figure 7.17). volcanism does not differ substantially from
Following the conventional model for volcanogenic Phanerozoic analogues and, more importantly, that
massive sulphide genesis (Franklin et al. 1981), the these conceptual models may be used to predict the
mineralizing hydrothermal activity took place during a place of mineralization in Archean sequences. Exam
hiatus in volcanism. ples of this type of analysis for the Confederation
Lake area are described in detail, herein.
MAGMA CLAN TRANSITIONS The complexities of volcano evolution from qui
As shown in the above survey of chemical types of escent eruptions to large-scale violent Plinian erup
volcanic cyclicity, there are ample opportunities for tions, caldera formation, and renewed volcanism are
development of depositional hiatuses during the tran all part of a logical, connected series of events, the

116
P.O. THURSTON

pre-resurgent volcanic rocks

ring fracture volcanic rocks ring fracture volcanic rocks


^
slump deposits from caldera wall

Stages S&7

Figure 7.18. The Caldera cycle (after Smith and Bailey 1968). The numbers refer to stages in the Caldera
cycle explained in the text.

caldera cycle (Figure 7.18). The caldera cycle was The caldera "a circular volcanic depression, more or
developed by Smith and Bailey (1968) to unify these less circular or cirque-like in form" (Williams 1941) is
apparently disparate events into an organized con produced by the collapse of the roof of the magma
cept. Their work was based upon the series of events chamber upon the catastrophic emptying of the
at the Valles caldera in the U.S.A., and has the chamber at eruption. The eruptions are Plinian; pro
following seven stages: duced by the explosive frothing and disintegration of
1. regional tumescence and generation of ring frac magma by internally produced gas bubbles (Sparks
tures 1978). This explosive fragmentation produces a large
eruption column with a vertical extent of 30 to 50 km,
The area of tumescence is generally larger than the a high degree of fragmentation, and dispersal of the
outer ring fractures of a given cauldron. products (Walker 1973). This stage is represented by
2. caldera forming eruptions formation l at Confederation Lake.
3. caldera collapse

117
CHAPTER 7

collapse volcanic domes and associated extrusives


(Thurston 1981).
7. terminal solfataric and hot-spring activity
This stage, when present, is due to the incomplete
evacuation of the magma chamber. The remaining
magma freezes in place, but the gradual loss of heat
is accomplished by conduction by hydrothermal
fluids which: 1) alter surrounding volcanic rocks; 2)
are responsible for leaching of copper, zinc and so
on from their surroundings and deposition in cooler
areas as volcanogenic massive sulphide deposits.
andesite The hydrothermal activity of Stage VII does hot occur
during Stages III to V of the caldera cycle because
the magma chamber has been catastrophically emp
tied during Stage II, hence, there is no magma avail
Figure 7.19. Schematic cross section of a com- able which needs to lose heat by conduction through
positionally zoned magma chamber (after Hil flow by hydrothermal fluids and no source of
dreth 1979). The chamber is Si, LIL element halogens to increase the efficiency of the metal-
(Rare Earths and so on) and volatile rich at the leaching process. This stage is represented by vol
top and phenocryst poor. Silicon content, LIL canogenic copper-zinc sulphide deposits in several
elements, and volatiles decrease and Superior Province greenstone belts.
phenocrysts become more abundant down
ward. The chamber is heated by periodic intru ZONED MAGMA CHAMBERS
sion of mantle derived basalt. Within the Caldera Cycle model provided by Smith
and Bailey (1968), more recent work (Hildreth 1979,
1981; Smith 1979) has shown that many ignimbrite-
producing magma chambers are chemically zoned
The catastrophic emptying of the magma chamber (Figure 7.19). These chambers are large, with a domi
leads to piecemeal or monolithic collapse of the nant volume of rhyolitic magma forming the upper
magma chamber roof. The collapse allows the cal part of the chamber. The rhyolite is underlain succes
dera to fill with the products of Stage II above, giving sively by dacitic, andesitic, and basaltic liquid. Epi
rise to the notion of an intracaldera ignimbrite sodic addition of mantle-derived basalt to the base of
(Lipman 1976) trapped within the topographic wall of the chamber supplies heat to keep the upper part
the caldera usually volumetrically dominant, and an liquid. Convection occurs throughout the chamber
outflow facies, the smaller part, which spills out of (McBirney and Noyes 1976), and some combination
the caldera. This stage is marked by the intrusion of of convection, a slow process in viscous felsic melts,
granitic sills at Confederation Lake (Thurston (1981). and volatile streaming is active in the upper rhyolitic
4. preresurgence volcanism and sedimentation part of the chamber. In a major element sense, this
This stage chiefly involves infilling of the caldera upper part is rhyolitic; however, Hildreth (1979) de
with debris from the caldera walls by caving, ava scribed large trace element concentration gradients
lanches, and gravity sliding. Volcanism is relatively within melts of essentially constant major element
uncommon, but is found in the Creede caldera. Lake composition.
beds are often found with calderas (for example, Commonly, these chambers are catastrophically
Hildebrand 1982). This stage has not been recorded emptied during Plinian eruptions (Smith 1979). This
at Confederation Lake. may occur when the arrival of a fresh batch of
5. resurgent doming basaltic magma at the base of the chamber saturates
the felsic part of the system in volatiles which trig
This stage involves topographic doming within the gers the eruption (Sparks et al. 1977). Alternatively,
caldera as the magma chamber re-inflates. A variety the small convective cells present in a compositional-
of types of grabens, with dips up to 65C are produced ly zoned chamber may rapidly roll over (Rice 1981;
by the doming. The question of the causes of resur Huppert et al. 1982). This process can occur (Huppert
gence and associated doming was addressed by et al. 1982) when the specific gravities of the basaltic
Marsh (1981). He feels that in a theoretical analysis, and overlying rhyolitic magmas become equal. This
regional detumescence, the sinking of the regional can come about through the fractionation of mafic
surface after inflation prior to the first eruption, is minerals of high specific gravity from the basalt. This
favoured because it produces the observed time lag has two effects. It immediately makes the basaltic
of about 105 years between caldera initiation and magma lighter, and renders the magma supersaturat
resurgence. ed in volatiles, causing vesiculation which again de
6. major ring-fracture volcanism creases its specific gravity.
This stage involves volcanism from the moat or ring- Thurston and Hodder (1982) have analyzed the
fracture and the products are often intercalated with development of Archean stratigraphy at Confeder
sediments from Stage IV above. This stage often ation Lake in terms of a model involving the tapping
completely fills the caldera. M this stage, about 800 of a compositionally zoned magma chamber during
000 years from caldera initiation will have elapsed. resurgent volcanism (Stage VI of Smith and Bailey
This stage is represented in several areas by post- 1968). Observations fitting the model include:

118
P.O. THURSTON

1. a progressive decrease in SiO2 with stratigraphic be developed which is based upon stratigraphic suc
height within Cycle III cessions such as ash-flows (Plinian) followed by
2. a decrease of Si02 with stratigraphic height in domes, flows, and small-scale ash flows. These
individual ignimbrite depositional units models involve caldera collapse after ash-flow erup
tions, re-inflation of a compositionally zoned cham
3. crossing rare earth elements patterns related to ber, and resurgent volcanism. This pattern of collapse
the heavy rare earth element enriched character and resurgence occurs around a compositionally zon
of the top of the Cycle III magma chamber similar ed chamber as evidenced by the major and trace
to that found in younger, compositionally zoned element variation patterns and stratigraphic charac
chambers teristics.
Thurston and Hodder's (1982) analysis indicates An understanding of these processes and cyclic-
that Cycle III of Confederation Lake represents cal ity on a variety of scales permits the geologist to
dera collapse and resurgent magmatism developed predict more confidently probable sites of mineraliza
from a compositionally zoned magma chamber. tion. This, of course, does not avoid the necessity for
These authors suggest both features are present in conventional exploration procedures. It simply pro
many copper-zinc mineralized successions. Further vides a new means of evaluating the mineral poten
analysis showed (Thurston el al. 1984) that rhyolites tial of large tracts of "greenstone" successions.
involved in development of copper-zinc deposits are
produced by contamination of felsic magma with
large volumes of sialic crust. The crust provides the REFERENCES
abundant fluorine and other volatiles needed for met Adams, G.W.
al transport. 1976: Precious Metal Veins of the Berens River Mine,
Northwestern Ontario; Unpublished M.Se. Thesis,
APPLICATIONS TO EXPLORATION University of Western Ontario, London, Ontario,
The stratigraphy of Cycle III at Confederation Lake 114p.
has been analyzed in terms of resurgent volcanisms American Geological Institute
in a caldera cycle model involving a compositionally 1972: Glossary of Geology; edited by M. Gary, R.
zoned magma chamber. The question is whether this McAfee, Jr., and C.L. Wolf, Washington, D.C.
problem is repeated elsewhere and whether there is Anhaeusser, C.R.
a pattern with application to exploration. Some intrigu 1971: Cyclic Volcanicity and Sedimentation in the
ing possibilities exist. Evolutionary Development of Archean Green
The stratigraphy of Noranda has been analyzed stone Belts of Shield Areas; p.57-70 in Sympo
in terms of a caldera collapse (de Rosen-Spence sium on Archean Rocks. Canberra, edited by J.E.
1976). Gibson has demonstrated (Gibson et at. 1983) Glover, Geological Society of Australia, Special
that post-collapse volcanism is directly related to Publication Number 3.
copper-zinc deposits. Composite dikes mapped by Arndt, N.T.
Gibson (Geologist, Falconbridge Copper, personal 1975: Ultramafic Rocks of Munro Township and Their
communication, 1983 ) include xenoliths of partly Volcanic Setting; Unpublished Ph.D. Thesis, Uni
melted granitic rocks, showing directly the involve versity of Toronto, Toronto, Ontario.
ment of melted sial in petrogenesis. This scenario is 1978: Ultramafic Lavas in Munro Township: Economic
also borne out by analysis of trace element geo and Tectonic Implications; p.617-658 in Metal
chemistry (Gelinas and Ludden 1984). logeny and Plate Tectonics, edited by D.F.
Caldera collapse is described in the Setting Net Strong, Geological Association of Canada, Spe
Lake area (Ayres 1977), where alteration within the cial Paper Number 14, 660p.
caldera sequence is widespread (L.D. Ayres, Profes Arndt, N.T., Naldrett, A.J., and Pyke, D.R.
sor, University of Manitoba, personal communication, 1977: Komatiitic and Iron-Rich Tholeiitic Lavas of
1980). Lead-rich vein deposits occur within the cal Munro Township, Northeast Ontario; Journal of
dera sequence (Adams 1976). Petrology, Volume 18, p.319-369.
Stratigraphic and volcanologic analysis of other Ayres, L.D.
Archean terrains should yield similar histories of vol- 1969: Early Precambrian Stratigraphy of Part of Lake
canological processes in that collapse often follows Superior Provincial Park. Ontario, Canada, and Its
large ignimbrite eruptions. In fact, Thurston et al. Implication for the Origin of the Superior Prov
(1985) suggested that ignimbrite eruptions were the ince; Ph.D. Dissertation, Princeton University.
dominant style of Archean felsic volcanism. The com 1977: Importance of Stratigraphy in Early Precambrian
positionally zoned nature of many Archean felsic Volcanic Terranes: Cyclic Volcanism at Setting
successions is shown by a unique trace element Net Lake, Northwestern Ontario; p.243-264 in Vol
geochemical signature (Campbell et al. 1984) which canic Regimes in Canada, edited by W.R.A.
Thurston et al. (1985) maintained was the result of Baragar, L.C. Coleman, and J.M. Hall, Geological
compositionally zoned magma chambers. Association of Canada, Special Paper Number
16.
SUMMARY Bennett. G.
In this paper, it is noted that a knowledge of stratig 1978: Geology of the Northeast Temagami Area, Dis
raphic position in particular types of volcanic cycles trict of Nipissing; Ontario Geological Survey, Re
is essential. A model of the volcano's behaviour can port 163, 128p. Accompanied by Maps 2323 and
2324, scale 1 inch to 1/2 mile.

119
CHAPTER 7

Blackburn, C.E., Bond, W.D., Breaks, F.W., Davis, Fyfe, W.S., and Kerrich R.
D.W.. Edwards, G.R., Poulsen, K.H., Trowell. N.F., and 1984: Gold: Natural Concentration Processes;
Wood, J. p.99-127 in Gold '82: The Geology, Geochemistry
1985: Evolution of Archean Volcanic-Sedimentary Se and Genesis of Gold Deposits, edited by R.P.
quences of Western Wabigoon Subprovince and Foster, Geological Society of Zimbabwe, Special
Its Margins; in Evolution of Archean Supracrustal Publication Number 1, 753p.
Successions, edited by LD. Ayres, P.C. Thurston, Gelinas, L., and Ludden, J.N.
K.D. Card, and W.W. Weber, Geological Associ 1984: Rhyolitic Volcanism and the Geochemical Evo
ation of Canada, Special Paper Number 28. lution of an Archean Central-Ring Complex: The
Bliss, N.W., and Stidolph, P.A. Blake River Group Volcanics of the Southern Ab
1969: The Rhodesian Basement Complex; A Review; itibi Belt, Superior Province; Physics of the Earth
p.305-333 in Upper Mantle Project, Pretoria, Geo and Planetary Interiors.
logical Society of South Africa, Special Publica Gelinas, L., Trudel, P., and Hubert, C.
tion Number 2. 1984: Chemostratigraphic Division of the Blake River
Brooks, C., Ludden, J., Pigeon, Y., and Hubregtse, Group, Rouyn-Noranda Area, Abitibi, Quebec;
J.J.M.W. Canadian Journal of Earth Sciences, Volume 21,
1982: Volcanism of Shoshonite to High K Andesite p.220-231.
Affinity in an Archean Arc Environment, Oxford Gibson, H.L, Watkinson, D.H., and Comba, C.D.A.
Lake, Manitoba; Canadian Journal of Earth Sci 1983: Silicification: Hydrothermal Alteration in an Ar
ences, Volume 19, p.55-67. chean Geothermal System Within the Amulet
Campbell, l.H., Lesher, C.M., Coad, P., Franklin, J.M., Rhyolite Formation, Noranda, Quebec; Economic
Gorton, M.P., and Thurston, P.C. Geology, Volume 78, p.954-971.
1984: Rare-Earth Element Mobility in Alteration Pipes Giles, C.W.
Below Cu-Zn Sulfide Deposits; Chemical Geol 1982: The Geology and Geochemistry of the Archean
ogy, Volume 45, p. 181-202. Spring Well Felsic Volcanic Complex, Western
Cruson, J., and Pansze, A. Australia; Journal of the Geological Society of
1983: Ore Deposits and Applied Volcanology, San Australia, Volume 29, p.205-220.
Juan Mountains, Colorado Field Guide; Cruson Giles, C.W., and Hallberg. J.M.
and Pansze, Geologists, Golden, Colorado. 1982: The Genesis of the Archean Welcome Well
de Rosen-Spence, A.F. Volcanic Complex, Western Australia; Contribu
1976: Stratigraphy, Development, and Petrogenesis of tions to Mineralogy and Petrology, Volume 80,
the Central Noranda Volcanic Pile, Noranda, Que p.307-318.
bec; Ph.D. Thesis, University of Toronto, Toronto, Glikson, A.Y.
Ontario, 116p. 1976: Trace Element Geochemistry and Origin of Ear
Dimroth, E., Imreh. L., Rocheleau, M., and Goulet, R. ly Precambrian Acid Igneous Series, Barberton
1982: Evolution of the South-Central Part of the Ar Mountain Land, Transvaal; Geochimica et Cos-
chean Abitibi Belt, Quebec, Part l: Stratigraphy mochimica Acta, Volume 40, p. 1261-1280.
and Paleogeographic Model; Canadian Journal of Glikson, A.J., and Jahn, B.M.
Earth Sciences, Volume 19, p. 1729-1758. 1984: REE and LIL Elements, Eastern Kaapvaal
Doepel, J.J.E. Shield, South Africa: Evidence of Crustal Evolu
1965: The Geology of the Yilmia Area, West of Lake tion by 3-Stage Melting; in Evolution of Archean
Lefroy, Western Australia; Thesis, University of Supracrustal Successions, edited by L.D. Ayres,
Western Australia. P.C. Thurston, K.D. Card, and W.W. Weber, Geo
Edwards, G.R. logical Association of Canada, Special Paper
1984: Geology and Evolution of the Phinney-Dash Number 28.
Lakes Volcanic-Plutonic Complex, Northwestern Goodwin, A.M.
Ontario; Unpublished Ph.D. Thesis, University of 1967: Volcanic Studies in the Birch-Uchi Lakes Area
Western Ontario, London, Ontario, 500p. of Ontario; Ontario Department of Mines, Mis
Edwards, G.R., and Hodder, R.W. cellaneous Paper 6, 96p.
1981: Evolution of an Archean Felsic Volcanic-Plu 1968: Archean Protocontinental Growth and Early
tonic Complex in the Kakagi-Pipestone Lakes Crustal History of the Canadian Shield; Interna
Area; p.67-79 in Geoscience Research Grant Pro tional Geological Congress 23rd, Prague, Volume
gram, Summary of Research, 1980-81, edited by 1, p.69-81.
E.G. Pye, Ontario Geological Survey, Miscella 1977: Archean Volcanism in Superior Province, Cana
neous Paper 98, 340p. dian Shield; p.205-241 in Volcanic Regimes in
Canada, edited W.R.A. Baragar, L.C. Coleman,
Franklin, J.M., Sangster, D.M., and Lydon, J.W. and J.M. Hall, Geological Association of Canada,
1981: Volcanic-Associated Massive Sulfide Deposits; Special Paper Number 16, 476p.
p.485-627 in Economic Geology, edited by B.J. 1982: Archean Greenstone Belts and Gold Mineraliza
Skinner, Seventy-Fifth Anniversary 1905-1980, tion, Superior Province, Canada; p.71-97 in Gold
New Haven, Economic Geology Publishing Com '82: The Geology, Geochemistry and Genesis of
pany. Gold Deposits, edited by R.P. Foster, Geological
Society of Zimbabwe, Special Publication Num
ber 1, Rotterdam, A. Balkema, 753p.

120
P.O. THURSTON

Goodwin, A.M., Ujike, O., and Gorton, M.P. Jensen, L.S.


1982: Trace Element Geochemistry of Archean Vol 1976: A New Cation Plot for Classifying Subalkalic
canic Rocks and Crustal Growth in Western Volcanic Rocks; Ontario Division of Mines, Mis
Wabigoon Belt, Superior Province, Canada; Geo cellaneous Paper 66, 22p.
logical Society of America, Abstracts, 1982 An 1978a: Regional Stratigraphy and Structure of the
nual Meeting, Volume 14, p.499. Timmins-Kirkland Lake Area and the Kirkland
Groves, D.I., and Gee, R.D. Lake-Larder Lake Area; p.67-72 in Summary of
1980: Excursion Guide-Regional Geology and Mineral Field Work, 1978, by the Ontario Geological Sur
Deposits of the Kalgoorlie-Norseman Region; Sec vey, edited by V.G. Milne, O.L White, R.B. Barlow,
ond International Archean Symposium, Perth and J.A. Robertson, Ontario Geological Survey,
1980, Guidebook, Geological Society of Australia. Miscellaneous Paper 82, 235p.
1978b: Archean Komatiitic, Tholeiitic, Calc-Alkalic
Grunsky, E.G. and Alkalic Volcanic Sequences in the Kirkland
1983: Batchewana Synoptic Project; p.54-58 in Sum Lake Area; p.237-259 in Toronto '78 Field Trips
mary of Field Work, 1983, by the Ontario Geologi Guidebook, edited by A.L Currie and W.O. Mac
cal Survey, edited by John Wood, Owen L. White, kasey, Geological Society of America-Geological
R.B. Barlow, and A.C. Colvine, Ontario Geological Association of Canada-Mineralogical Association
Survey, Miscellaneous Paper 116, 313p. of Canada, 361 p.
Hallberg, J.M., Johnston, C., and Bye, S.M. 1985: Stratigraphy and Petrogenesis of the Abitibi
1976: The Archean Marda Igneous Complex, Western Subprovince, Ontario; in Evolution of Archean
Australia; Precambrian Research, Volume 3, Supracrustal Successions, edited by L.D. Ayres.
p.111-136. P.C. Thurston, K.D. Card, and W.W. Weber, Geo
Heinrichs, T.K., and Reimer, T.O. logical Association of Canada, Special Paper
1977: A Sedimentary Barite Deposit from the Archean Number 28.
Fig Tree Group of the Barberton Mountain Land Johnson, R.W., Mackenzie, D.E., and Smith, I.E.M.
(South Africa); Economic Geology, Volume 72, 1978: Volcanic Rock Associations at Convergent
p.1426-1441. Plate Boundaries: Reappraisal of the Concept Us
Hickman, A.H., Horwitz, R.C., Dunlop, J.S.R., and ing Case Histories from Papua New Guinea; Geo
Buick, R. logical Society of America, Bulletin. Volume 89,
1980: Excursion Guide-Archean Geology of the Pil- p.96-106.
bara Block; Second International Archean Sympo Letros, S., Strangway, D.W., Tassilo-Hirt, A.M., Geiss
sium, Perth 1980, Geological Society of Australia, man, J.W., and Jensen, L.S.
Western Australia Division. 1983: Aeromagnetic Interpretation of the Kirkland
Hildebrand, R.S. Lake-Larder Lake Portion of the Abitibi Green
1982: A Continental Arc of Early Proterozoic Age at stone Belt; Canadian Journal of Earth Sciences.
Great Bear Lake, Northwest Territories; Un Volume 20, p.548-560.
published Ph.D Thesis, Memorial University of Lipman, P.W.
Newfoundland, 237p. 1976: Caldera Collapse Breccias in the Western San
Hildreth, W. Juan Mountains, Colorado; Geological Society of
1979: The Bishop Tuff: Evidence for the Origin of America, Bulletin, Volume 87, p.1397-1410.
Compositional Zonation in Silicic Magma Cham Marsh, B.D.
bers; p.43-75 in Ash-Flow Tuffs, edited by C.E. 1981: Mechanics of Cauldron Resurgence; Geological
Chapin and W.E. Elston, Boulder, Colorado, Geo Society of America, Abstracts with Programs, Vol
logical Society of America, Special Paper Number ume 13, Number 7, p.503.
180. McBirney, A.R., and Noyes, R.M.
1981: Gradients in Silicic Magma Chambers: Implica 1976: Factors Governing Crystal Setting and Layering
tions for Lithospheric Magmatism; Journal of in Igneous Intrusives; Report, Centre for Volcanol
Geophysical Research, Volume 86, ogy and Department of Chemistry, University of
p.10153-10192. Oregon, Eugene, Oregon.
Hodgson, C.J., and Lydon, J.W. McGeehan, P.J., and Hodgson, C.J.
1977: The Geological Setting of Volcanogenic Mas 1981: The Relationship of Gold Mineralization to Vol
sive Sulfide Deposits and Active Hydrothermal canic and Alteration Features in the Area of the
Systems: Some Implications for Exploration; Campbell Red Lake and Dickenson Mines, Red
Canadian Institute of Mining and Metallurgy Lake Area, Northwestern Ontario; p.94-110 in
Transactions, Volume 70, p.95-106. Genesis of Archean Volcanic-Hosted Gold De
Hubregtse, J.J.M.W. posits, Symposium Held at the University of
1976: Volcanism in the Western Superior Province in Waterloo, March 7, 1980, Ontario Geological Sur
Manitoba; p.279-288 in The Early History of the vey, Miscellaneous Paper 97, 175p.
Earth, edited by B.F. Windley, John Wiley and MERQ-OGS
Sons, New York, 619p. 1984: Lithostratigraphic Map of the Abitibi Sub
Huppert, H.E., Turner, J.S., and Sparks, R.S.J. province; Ontario Geological Survey/Ministere de
1982: Replenished Magma Chambers; Effects of I'Energie et des Ressources, Quebec, scale 1:500
Compositional Zonation and Input Rates; Earth 000, catalogued as Map 2484 in Ontario and DV
and Planetary Science Letters, Volume 57, 83-16 in Quebec.
p.345-357.

121
CHAPTER 7

Muir, T.L Setterfield, T., Watkinson, D.H., and Thurston, P.C.


1982: Geology of the Hemlo Area, District of Thunder 1983: Quench-Textured, Pillowed Metabasalts and
Bay; Ontario Geological Survey, Report 217, 65p. Copper Mineralization, Maybrun Mine, North
Accompanied by Map 2452, scale 1:31 680. western Ontario; Canadian Institute of Mining and
Nisbet, E.G. Metallurgy Bulletin, Volume 76, p.69-74.
1982: The Tectonic Setting and Petrogenesis of Shegelski, R.J.
Komatiites; p.501-520 in Komatiites, edited by 1980: Archean Cratonization, Emergence, and Red
N.T. Arndt and E.G. Nisbet, London. Allen and Bed Development, Lake Shebandowan Area,
Unwin. Canada; Precambrian Research, Volume 80,
O'Hara, M.J. p.331-347.
1977: Geochemical Evolution During Fractional Cry Smith, R.L
stallization of a Periodically Refilled Magma 1979: Ash-Flow Magmatism; p.5-27 in Ash-Flow Tuffs,
Chamber; Nature, Volume 266, p.503-507. edited by C.E. Chapin and W.E. Elston, Geologi
Patterson, G.C. cal Society of America, Special Paper Number
1984: Field Trip Guidebook to the Hemlo Area; On 180, Boulder, Colorado.
tario Geological Survey, Miscellaneous Paper Smith, R.L, and Bailey, R.A.
118, 33p. 1968: Resurgent Cauldrons; p.613-662 in Studies in
Pirie, J. Volcanology, edited by R.R. Coats, R.L. Hay, and
1981: Regional Geological Setting of Gold Deposits in C.A. Anderson, Geological Society of America,
the Red Lake Area, Northwestern Ontario; p.71-93 Memoir 116.
in Genesis of Archean, Volcanic-Hosted Gold De Sopuck, V.J.
posits, Symposium Held at the University of 1977: A Lithogeochemical Approach in the Search for
Waterloo, March 7, 1980. Ontario Geological Sur Areas of Felsic Volcanic Rocks Associated with
vey, Miscellaneous Paper 97, 175p. Mineralization in the Canadian Shield; Unpublish
Ploeger, F.R. ed Ph.D. Thesis, Queens University, Kingston,
1980: Kirkland Lake Gold Study, District of Timiskam Ontario.
ing; p. 188-190 in Summary of Field Work, 1980, Sparks, R.S.J.
by the Ontario Geological Survey, edited by V.G. 1978: The Dynamics of Bubble Formation and Growth
Milne, O.L White, R.B. Barlow, J.A. Robertson, in Magmas: A Review and Analysis; Journal of
and A.C. Colvine, Ontario Geological Survey, Mis Volcanology and Geothermal Research, Volume
cellaneous Paper 96, 201 p. 3, p. 1-37.
Pollock, G.D., Sinclair, I.G.L, Warburton, A.F., and Sparks, R.S.J., Self, S., and Walker, G.P.L
Wierzbichi, V. 1973: Products of Ignimbrite Eruptions; Geology, Vol
1970: The Uchi Orebody: A Massive Sulphide Deposit ume 1, p. 115-118.
in an Archean Siliceous Volcanic Environment; Sparks, R.S.J., Sigurdsson, H., and Wilson, L.
p.299-308 in International Geological Congress 1977: Magma Mixing: A Mechanism for Triggering
24th, Montreal, Volume 4. Acid Explosive Eruptions; Nature, Volume 267,
Pyke, D.R. p.315-318.
1978: Regional Geology of the Timmins-Matachewan Stott, G.M., and Schnieders, B.M.
Area; p.73-77 in Summary of Field Work, 1978, by 1983: Gold and Regional Deformation in the Sheban
the Ontario Geological Survey, edited by V.G. dowan Belt; The Northern Miner, April 14, 1983,
Milne, O.L White, R.B. Barlow, and J.A. Robert p. 16.
son, Ontario Geological Survey, Miscellaneous
Paper 82, 235p. Syme, E.G., Bailes, A.H., Price, D.P., and Ziehlke, D.V.
1982: Flin Flon Volcanic Belt: Geology and Ore De
Pyke, D.R., and Middleton, R.S. posits at Flin Flon and Snow Lake, Manitoba; Trip
1970: Distribution and Characteristics of the Sulphide 6, Geological Association of Canada Mineralog
Ores of the Timmins Area; Ontario Department of ical Association of Canada, Field Trip Guidebook,
Mines, Miscellaneous Paper 41, 24p. 91p.
Rice, A. Thurston, P.C.
1981: Convective Fractionation: A Mechanism to Pro 1981 a: Economic Evaluation of Archean Felsic Vol
vide Cryptic Zoning (Macrosegregation), Layer canic Rocks Using REE Geochemistry; p.439-450
ing, Crescumulates, Banded Tuffs, and Explosive in Archean Geology, edited by J.E. Glover and
Volcanism in Igneous Processes; Journal of Geo D.I. Groves, Geological Society of Australia, Spe
physical Research, Volume 86, p.405-417. cial Publication 7, Canberra.
Robinson, D.J., and Hutchison, R.W. 1981 b: The Volcanology and Trace Element Geo
1982: Evidence for the Volcanogenic-Exhalative Ori chemistry of Cyclical Volcanism in the Archean
gin of a Massive Nickel Sulphide Deposit at Red Confederation Lake Area, Northwestern Ontario;
stone, Timmins, Ontario; p.211-254 in Precam Unpublished Ph.D. Thesis, University of Western
brian Sulphide Deposits, edited by R.W. Hutch Ontario, London, Ontario, 553p.
inson, L.D. Spence, and J.M. Franklin, Geological 1982: Physical Volcanology and Stratigraphy of the
Association of Canada, Special Paper Number Confederation Lake Area, Kenora District (Patricia
25, 791 p. Portion); Ontario Geological Survey, Open File
Report 5373, 191p.

122
P.O. THURSTON

Thurston, P.C., Ayres, L.D., Edwards, G.R., Gelinas, L, Trowell, N.F., Blackburn, C.E., and Edwards, G.R.
Ludden. J.N., and Verpaelst, P. 1980: Preliminary Geological Synthesis of the Savant
1985: Archean Bimodal Volcanism; in Evolution of Lake-Crow Lake Metavolcanic Metasedimentary
Archean Supracrustal Successions, edited by L.D. Belt, Northwestern Ontario, and Its Bearing Upon
Ayres, P.C. Thurston, K.D. Card, and W.W. Weber, Mineral Exploration; Ontario Geological Survey,
Geological Association of Canada, Special Paper Miscellaneous Paper 89, 30p. Accompanied by
Number 28. Chart A.
Thurston, P.C., and Fryer, B.J. Viljoen, R.P., and Viljoen, M.J.
1983: The Geochemistry of Repetitive Cyclical Vol 1969: The Geological and Geochemical Significance
canism from Basalt Through Rhyolite in the Uchi- of the Upper Formations of the Onverwacht
Confederation Greenstone Belt, Canada; Contri Group; p. 113-152 in Upper Mantle Project, Geo
butions to Mineralogy and Petrology, Volume 83, logical Society of South Africa, Special Publica
p.204-226. tion Number 12.
Thurston, P.C., and Hodder, R.W. Walker, G.P.L
1982: Trace Element Geochemistry and Volcanology 1973: Explosive Volcanic Eruptions-A New Classifica
of a Mineralized Felsic Center; Geoscience Re tion Scheme; Geologische Rundschau, Volume
search Seminar, December 8-9, 1982, Abstracts, 62, p.431-446.
Ontario Geological Survey, 15p. Wallace, H., Thurston, P.C., and Corfu, F.
Thurston, P.C., Wan, J., Squair, H.S., Warburton, A.F., In Press: The Western Uchi Subprovince: A Case
and Wierzbicki, V.W Study; in Volcanism and Mineral Exploration, edit
1978: Volcanology and Mineral Deposits of the Uchi ed by H. Wallace, Ontario Geological Survey,
Confederation Lakes Area, Northwestern Ontario; Miscellaneous Paper.
p.302-324 in Toronto '78 Field Trips Guidebook, Williams. H.
edited by A.L Currie and W.O. Mackasey, Geo 1941: Calderas and Their Origin; California University
logical Society of America-Geological Association Publications in the Geological Sciences, Volume
of Canada-Mineralogical Association of Canada, 25, p.239-346.
361 p.
Wilson, H.D.B., Morrice, M.G., and Zielke, D.V.
1974: Archean Continents; Geoscience Canada, Vol
ume 1, p. 12-20.

123
Chapter 8

Recognition of Alteration in Volcanic Rocks Using


Statistical Analysis of Lithogeochemical Data
E.G. Grunsky

CONTENTS 12a. K20 unprocessed .............................. 137


Abstract ........................................................... 125 12b. K20 residual....................................... 137
Introduction .................................................... 125 13a. Ti02 unprocessed ............................. 138
Geology of the Ben Nevis Township Area 126 13b. Ti02 residual...................................... 138
Alteration ........................................................ 127 14a. C02 unprocessed .............................. 139
Lithogeochemistry ........................................ 128 14b. C02 residual ...................................... 139
Isochemical Contour Plots............................ 129 8 15a. Sulphur unprocessed ....................... 140
Normalization Schemes and Techniques 15b. Sulphur residuals .............................. 140
for Identifying Alteration .............................., 147 16a. H 2O^ unprocessed........................... 141
Statistical Techniques .................................., 149 16b. HJO+ residual ................................... 141
Conclusions ..................................................., 161 17a. Gold unprocessed ............................ 142
Acknowledgments ........................................, 161 17b. Gold residual..................................... 142
References ....................................................., 172 18a. Copper unprocessed ........................ 143
18b. Copper residuals............................... 143
TABLES 19a. Lithium unprocessed ........................ 144
Correspondence analysis: major 19b. Lithium residual ................................ 144
oxides ..................................................... 150 20a. Nickel unprocessed.......................... 145
2. Correspondence analysis: major 20b. Nickel residual .................................. 145
oxides and trace elements .................. 159 21a. Zinc unprocessed ............................. 146
Dynamic cluster nucleii and average 21b. Zinc residual...................................... 146
compositions of each cluster ............. 163
22. Distribution of normative corundum . 148
Dynamic cluster nucleii and average
compositions of each cluster ............. 167 23. Distribution of normative calcite....... 148
24a to 24e. Correspondence analysis,
FIGURES factor scores of samples and
chemical components ......................... 151
8.1. Location map ....................................... 125
25a to 25e. Contour expressions of
8.2. Geology of the Ben Nevis area......... 126 Factors 1 to 5 ....................................... 152
8.3. AFM diagram of the Ben Nevis area 126 26a to 8.26e. Correspondence analysis,
8.4. Distribution of samples in the Ben factor scores of samples and
Nevis area........................................... 128 chemical components ......................... 156
8.5a. Distribution of SiO2 outlining rock 27a to 8.27e. Positive and negative
types .................................................... 130 anomalies.............................................. 157
8.5b. Si02 residual ...................................... 130 28a to 8.28e. Geographic presentation
8.6a. AI203 unprocessed ............................ 131 of some of the groups in the Ben
8.6b. AI 203 residual .................................... 131 Nevis area, and location of some of
the groups in the factor space .......... 161
8.7a. Fe203 unprocessed ........................... 132
.29a to 8.29d. Geographic presentation
8.7b. Fe203 residual.................................... 132
of certain groups in the Ben Nevis
8.8a. FeO unprocessed .............................. 133 area using dynamic cluster analysis
8.8b. FeO residual ...................................... 133 and groups in the factor space. ........ 166
8.9a. MgO unprocessed ............................. 134
8.9b. MgO residual ..................................... 134 PHOTOGRAPHS
8.10a. CaO unprocessed ........................... 135 8.1 Carbonate, quartz, and chlorite
8.10b. CaO residual.................................... 135 amygdules in a pillowed basalt....................... 127
8.11a. Na20 unprocessed.......................... 136 8.2. Replacement of Ca-rich plagioclase
8.11b. Na20 residual .................................. 136 phenocryst by calcite........................................ 127

124
EC. GRUNSKY

ABSTRACT INTRODUCTION
A statistical study of the lithogeochemistry of the Volcanic rocks are commonly host to several types of
volcanic rocks in the Ben Nevis area of Ontario has mineral deposits such as massive sulphide deposits
shown that spatial presentation combined with cor (Sangster and Scott 1976) and epithermal deposits
respondence analysis and dynamic cluster analysis (Rose and Burt 1979). Alteration is associated with
can be used to delineate stratigraphy as well as these deposits and is discernible in the form of
alteration zones characterized by carbonatization and mineralogical, textural, and chemical changes due to
sulphur enrichment. An extensive zone of carbonatiz- the circulation of hydrothermal fluids. Most deposits
ed volcanic rocks surrounds a zone of mineralization are surrounded by haloes of alteration defined by
in this area. anomalous chemical abundances; these zones are
Correspondence analysis calculates factors spatially much larger than the ore deposits them
which explain the distribution of data with respect to selves and form significant exploration targets. The
the variation patterns that are represented by the use of lithogeochemistry can be instrumental in de
chemical component abundances. In the case of the tecting these alteration zones if statistical techniques
Ben Nevis data, when major oxides are used, the first are used effectively to recognize patterns of alter
and most significant factor describes the com ation within sample populations.
positional variation in the original igneous trend A lithogeochemical study was carried out by the
(fractionation trend); the second factor characterizes Ontario Geological Survey in the Ben Nevis Township
the compositional variation due to the process of area, Ontario (Figure 8.1), in which zones of alter
carbonatization; the third factor indicates com ation associated with mineralized occurrences
positional variation in the form of sulphur enrichment (Figure 8.2) were identified using the technique of
associated with mineralization. The use of major ox correspondence analysis combined with dynamic
ides combined with trace elements produces similar cluster analysis. A previous study by Wolfe (1977) in
results. the same area outlined a zone of zinc enrichment
Dynamic cluster analysis groups together sam related to a dispersion halo which Wolfe attributed to
ples that have been affected by similar processes. an alteration pipe associated with the formation of
Groups related to fractionation trends can be clearly volcanogenic massive sulphide deposits.
distinguished from groups that have undergone alter Locally, the two most significant mineral occur
ation processes. rences are the Canagau Mines Deposit and the Crox-
When properly applied and interpreted, these sta all Property. Detailed property and deposit descrip
tistical techniques can assist in mineral exploration. tions can be found in Jensen (1975).
The Canagau Mines Deposit is underlain by
strongly carbonatized, sericitized, and silicified mafic
and felsic volcanic rocks. Mineralization consists of
galena, sphalerite, gold, silver, and pyrite within east-

Figure 8.1. Location map.

125
CHAPTERS

ii4.'-*r; A
vCahaga
-Mihes

^^an'ge'
Lake

mineral occurrence ® mafic and intermediate intrusive rocks


fault —— mafic and intermediate volcanic rocks
granitic rocks n~ri felsic volcanic rocks

Figure 8.2. Geology of the Ben Nevis area.

trending fractures and shear zones that dip 40C to 60C nected by planar stringers of quartz and/or carbonate
toward the south. Grades and tonnages are unknown, •O mm across. These stringers probably represent a
but the deposit is not currently considered to be microfracture system that increased the permeability
economic. of the rocks and controlled the circulation of fluids.
The Croxall Property consists of a zone of brec Many zones of large amygdules cut across pillows
ciated and sheared rhyolite with interstitial pyrite,
FEO (TOTAL)
chalcopyrite, chlorite, calcite, and quartz. Gold as
says have been reported up to 0.04 ounce per ton.

GEOLOGY OF THE BEN NEVIS TOWNSHIP


AREA_________________________
The Archean volcanic rocks of the Ben Nevis area
comprise the top of the Blake River Group within the
Abitibi volcanic-sedimentary belt in Ontario. This
group is exposed in a broad east-trending syn
clinorium from south of the Matheson area in Ontario
eastward to the Noranda area of Quebec (see Figure
8.1). The area has been mapped in detail by Jensen
(1975; Figure 8.2) and is underlain by volcanic rocks
of calc-alkalic affinity (Figure 8.3). The most common
volcanic rocks are basaltic pillowed flows, pillow
breccias, and breccias.
Many of these volcanic rocks appear to be amyg
daloidal, with vesicles varying in amounts from -clVo
to ^00Xo, and with a size range of 1 mm to 3 cm
across. Such vesicularity provides the porosity for the
circulation of hydrothermal fluids. In some areas, Figure 8.3. AFM diagram of the Ben Nevis area.
many of the larger amygdules ^5 mm) are con Note the calc-alkalic trend.

126
EC. GRUNSKY

carbonate-rich
groundmass

Photo 8.1. Carbonate, quartz, and chlorite amyg- Photo 8.2. Replacement of calcium-rich plagioclase
clules in a pillowed basalt. The larger "ovoids" phenocryst by calcite. Groundmass contains
are interconnected by quartz-carbonate tilled fine-grained calcite and dolomite.
microfractures and may be secondary in origin. Mellinger, Research Scientist. Saskatchewan Re
search Council, personal communication, 1985).
Petrographic studies have shown the presence of
and pillow selvages. This would suggest a secondary saussurite that formed from the breakdown of
origin. Macdonald (1983) suggested that "ovoids" in plagioclase. Saussurite occurs throughout the mafic
mafic volcanic flows, that are commonly mistakenly to intermediate volcanic sequence where C02 phases
identified as amygdules, are possibly due to secon were not present ( Michel Mellinger, Research Scien
dary effects related to alteration. It seems probable, tist, Saskatchewan Research Council, personal com
therefore, that many of the larger quartz-carbonate munication. 1985). Sericite is also present in both the
ovoids that are connected by microfractures are sec mafic to intermediate volcanic rocks and the felsic
ondary in origin and related to the development of volcanic rocks. Its presence within the felsic volcanic
the alteration zone. rocks may be explained by the breakdown of or
Two major felsic volcanic units consisting of thoclase, albite, and other potassium-bearing min
rhyolitic and dacitic tuff, tuff-breccia, and flows occur erals during metamorphism; however, the sericite
within the predominantly mafic volcanic sequence. within the mafic to intermediate volcanic rocks sug
The volcanic environment in the Ben Nevis area is gests that fluids enriched in potassium passed
interpreted as proximal, with a volcanic centre occur through these rocks causing alteration.
ring in the vicinity of the Clifford Stock. The volcanic In the field, the most obvious form of alteration is
sequence is intruded by gabbroic and dioritic bodies pervasive carbonatization (Photo 8.1). The bleached
of tholeiitic affinity (Figure 8.3) and is folded into a appearance and deep weathering rind typical of
domical anticlinal structure within the larger Blake these rocks allow for easy visual identification.
River Synclinorium (see Figure 8.1).
Intense pervasive silicification occurs only in the
The area is intersected by several faults that are Canagau Mines Deposit. Within the main zone of
believed to be related to volcanic activity and later pervasive carbonatization, the quartz-carbonate
doming of the sequence. A major north-trending fault ovoids are much less abundant. Ovoids that do occur
in the eastern part of Ben Nevis Township is part of a contain only carbonate. This may be due to replace
regional lineament that transects the Blake River ment of quartz by calcite. Alternatively, quartz could
Group. This fault may be a deep seated structure; a have formed only away from the main centre of
possible conduit for hydrothermal fluids that passed carbonate alteration where different temperature or
through the eastern part of the Ben Nevis area. chemical conditions prevailed.
In thin section, the carbonate occurs as large
ALTERATION anhedral patches in the matrix of mafic flows (Photo
Rocks of the Ben Nevis area have been metamor 8.2). Pervasive replacement of the matrix is most
phosed under conditions of burial metamorphism and widespread close to the north-trending fracture in the
are represented by zeolite facies and prehnite-pum- eastern part of Ben Nevis Township. X- ray diffraction
pellyite facies (Jensen 1975). Around the felsic intru studies of the carbonate indicate that the dominant
sions, the metamorphic grade is albite-epidote horn phase is calcite with only trace amounts of mag
fels facies. nesite, dolomite, ankerite, and siderite (Geoscience
Through the Ben Nevis area, chlorite is a com Laboratories, Ontario Geological Survey, Toronto). Do
mon constituent in the amygdules and in the ground lomite was noted to be more common in the matrix
mass of the mafic to intermediate volcanic rocks. The than in the ovoids or amygdules. Thin section studies
origin of the chlorite is probably due to the inter indicate that the carbonate commonly formed through
action of C02-rich hydrothermal fluids with the host replacement of plagioclase; thus, it appears that cal
rock and the resultant destabilization of Ga and the cium was not added to the system, but was recom-
resultant assemblage of chlorite and/or albite (Michel bined with externally derived C02. Other evidence,
that will be presented below, suggests that calcium

127
CHAPTER 8

790 48'00"
48"20'30

;- -- \ :\ v.\ --W
\ \ N, V . ' \ \ ,
\ \ \ \ .-\ \

- —--—l 48" 16'25"


79" 37'32"

Figure 8.4. Distribution of samples in the Ben Nevis area.

was removed from the main centre of carbonatiza The samples collected by Jensen and Wolfe
tion. were analyzed by techniques outlined by Wolfe
Away from the main zone of carbonatization, the (1977, p. 10); samples collected by the author were
pervasive carbonate alteration decreases, and there analyzed by methods outlined by Grunsky (in prep
is an increase in carbonate and silica flooding (Photo aration). A total of 864 samples were used for the
8.2). The flooding commonly takes the form of amyg study and 39 components were analyzed for each
dule or "ovoid" fillings and interconnecting microfrac- sample: Si02, AI 203. Fe203, FeO, MgO, CaO. Na2O,
tures filled with quartz and/or calcite. The increase K 20, Ti02 , P 2O5, MnO, CO2 , S, H 2CK, H 2O-, Ag, As, Au,
of flooding and decrease of pervasive alteration may Ba, Be, Bi, CI, Co, Cr, Cu, F, Ga, Li, Ni, Pb, Zn, B. Mo,
reflect a temperature gradient in the alteration zone. Sr. V, Y, Zr, Se, and Sn. Every outcrop sampled in the
Textural relationships within quartz-rich ovoids gen area is represented in the data by at least one
erally show that the chlorite-rich rims formed first, sample typical of the outcrop. Figure 8.4 shows the
followed by infilling with quartz. Calcite occurs as the distribution of the samples over the area. It is impor
latest mineral phase within the ovoids. tant to note that the distinction between pervasive
and non-pervasive alteration cannot be distinguished
Locally, zones enriched in pyrite occur in the by lithogeochemistry alone.
Canagau Mine area and the Croxal! Property. These
zones contain disseminated pyrite and minor Complications in sampling commonly occurred
amounts of other sulphides and occur within the because many breccia units are heterolithic and be
larger alteration zones surrounding both mineral oc cause amygdaloidal rocks are highly variable in
currences. A zoning of sulphide abundance is more amygdule/ovoid content. One of the purposes of the
pronounced at the Croxall Property where the min study was to determine if any significant indications
eralization is in the form of a breccia-pipe from which of alteration could be detected by sampling the typi
sulphur-rich fluids circulated outward into the sur cal or dominant rock type of a given outcrop. Thus,
rounding host rock. The effects of S enrichment will samples were selected for their geochemical signa
be shown in the subsequent treatment of the data. ture with respect to alteration as opposed to their
original rock type. The lithogeochemistry of a car-
bonatized heterolithic breccia may not provide a use
LITHOGEOCHEMISTRY ful indication of the different rock types that com
The samples used in this study were collected from prise the unit; however, the amount of C02 present
three sources. These are: will show up regardless of the rock types involved.
1. samples collected by Jensen (1975) On the other hand, the lithogeochemistry of a
silicified heterolithic breccia will probably not reflect
2. samples collected by Wolfe (1977) an increase in silica since the rock might be inter
3. samples collected by the author from 1979 to preted as a rhyolite. Such problems had to be consid
1981 ered in the interpretation of lithogeochemical data.

128
E.G. GRUNSKY

Samples rich in sulphides were collected and 3. local zones of mineralization-chalcophile distribu
analyzed; however, some were eliminated in the sub tion
sequent data processing. Such samples tend to ex Typically, the spatially mapped abundances of
hibit highly varied component abundances. This Si02 (Figure 8.5a), AI 203 (Figure 8.6a), Fe203 (Figure
causes spiked peaks in spatially distributed anoma 8.7a), FeO (Figure 8.8a), MgO (Figure 8.9a), CaO
lies and can mask the more subtle lithogeochemical (Figure 8.10a), K 20 (Figure 8.12a), Ti02 (Figure
indicators of alteration. Because sulphide-rich rocks 8.13a), C02 (Figure 8.14a). H 2CT (Figure 8.16a), and
are very different compositionally from unmineralized Ni (Figure 8.20a) reflect the compositional variation.
volcanic rocks, they tend to produce a high degree of However, some elements such as MgO, CaO, Fe203,
variance in the data and can result in misleading Zn, Cr, and H 20 not only vary with composition due
interpretations. Emphasis in this study has been to rock type, but also vary in abundance due to the
placed on selecting samples that will yield broad effects of hydrothermal alteration. Elements such as
generalized patterns of alteration detectable on a Au (Figure 8.17a), Cu (Figure 8.18a), Zn (Figure
reconnaissance scale that enable selection of sites 8.21 a), Pb, and Sn are typically low in abundance at
for mineral exploration. the regional scale. Locally, high abundances of these
components are often found around zones of alter
ISOCHEMICAL CONTOUR PLOTS ation and/or mineralization. Zinc is unique because it
Figures 8.5 through 8.21 contain isochemical contour can substitute for Fe^ 2 in lattices of ferromagnesian
plots of the elements that were analyzed for the minerals; thus, its abundance varies directly with
study. The contour diagrams are modified from plots rock composition. Hydrothermal alteration can cause
drawn by the Surface II Graphics Systems (Sampson the breakdown of these ferromagnesian minerals.
1975). Each figure is composed of two parts. Figure This frees the Zn. In the vicinity of an alteration halo,
"A" shows the contoured raw data. Figure "B" shows the Zn may recombine in part with S, and substitute
the "residual" value of the chemical component, that into the chlorite lattice to create an anomaly asso
is, the abundance of a chemical component after an ciated with rock composition, hydrothermal alteration,
"expected" value has been subtracted from the ac and sulphide concentration.
tual abundance. The "expected" value is defined as The association of certain components with alter
the component abundance that would be expected ation and mineralization cannot always be easily de
for a given rock type. tected. As discussed earlier, compositional variation
These expected values were defined in the fol due to rock type can mask these secondary features.
lowing way. The standards (expected values) were If the influence due to rock type is removed, it is
computed from the lithogeochemical database for the possible to "see" which components have been af
study area only. This was done because rock types fected by alteration, and which are associated with
that are "normal" (unaltered) in the Ben Nevis area mineralization. To "normalize" or correct for rock
may be somewhat different in composition from other type, the expected value of the component is sub
areas. tracted from its measured value, the difference being
termed the "residual". The "residual" value does not
Each sample was classified using the chemical necessarily reflect the amount of alteration. Some
classification methods of Irvine and Baragar (1971) components such as Si02 show a highly variable
and Jensen (1976). For each chemically classified concentration in individual rock types. Residual val
group of samples (for example, calc-alkalic basalts), ues should only be considered anomalous if greater
a mean and standard deviation was computed for than the standard deviation or some other determined
each chemical component. Every component of each confidence level. Figure 8.5b shows Si02 anomalies
sample was then compared with the mean of each with residual values ^.0 070 (silicification) and ^.07o
component for the calculated group. If the component (silica leaching). The pattern is erratic over the area,
value exceeded the mean plus two standard de but locally, strong silica enrichment is seen in the
viations, then the sample was rejected. A new mean vicinity of the Canagau Mine Deposit and the Croxall
for each component of each group was calculated on Property. Silica depletion occurs in sulphide-rich
the sample population that was not rejected, and the zones and mafic plutons.
comparison of the samples with the new mean val
ues was repeated. This method was carried out three More typically, residuals reflect the components
times, forcing a "normal" or "expected" value on associated with alteration and mineralization. Compo
each chemical component of each chemically clas nents such as AI 203 (Figure 8.6b), Fe203 (Figure
sified group. 8.7b), MgO (Figure 8.9b), CaO (Figure 8.10b), K20
(Figure 8.12b), Ti02 (Figure 8.13b), C02 (Figure
This can be thought of as a method of correcting 8.14b), Li (Figure 8.19b), Ni (Figure 8.20b), and Zn
or normalizing the geochemical data which is re (Figure 8.21 b) show anomalous abundances in the
quired because of the natural chemical variation in a form of addition or depletion around the Canagau
volcanic suite even before alteration. This method Mines Deposit and the Croxall Property. Elements that
has limitations and is discussed below. are typically considered to be "immobile" under most
The unprocessed (Figure"A") isochemical plots conditions, such as AI 203 (Figure 8.6b), Ti02 (Figure
typically reflect three phenomena: 8.13b), Ni (Figure 8.25b) have in fact undergone
1. compositional variation due to rock type considerable changes in abundance.
2. regional zones of alteration (regional car
bonatization, Ga depletion)

129
CHAPTERS

felsic Hi ^0.0
rocks l—1R4.0-70.

l 154.0-58.0
mafic mm --c/i n
rocks 111LU <54.0

Figure 8.5a. Distribution of Si02 outlining rock types.

SiO

Figure 8.5b. Si02 residual, showing small zones of addition/depletion due to alteration and misclassification
(plutonic rocks).

130
EC. GRUNSKY

AI2O3 UNPROCESSED
Compositional Variation and Alteration Zones

kilometres

Figure 8.6a. AI2 O3 unprocessed, showing compositional variation and alteration zones.

AI2O3 RESIDUAL
Depletion Around Zones of Alteration

\\*

l t/J
Figure 8.6b. AI2 03 residual, showing depletion around zones of alteration,

131
CHAPTER 8

Fe2O3 UNPROCESSED
Compositional Variation and CO2 Alteration

Figure 8.7'a. Fe2 03 unprocessed, showing compositional variation and CO2 alteration.

/ Fe2O3 RESIDUAL

\\\\\
\\ \ \\\\
Zone of Alteration Depletion

Figure 8.7b. Fe2 03 residual, showing zone of alteration and depletion.

132
EC. GRUNSKY

s
/
FeO UNPROCESSED
Compositional Variation

X
/
A
\

Figure 8.8a. FeO unprocessed, showing compositional variation.

FeO RESIDUAL
Flat X
x
\ \ \\ \' /-•l
\\

li^ * ^
\

-r -' c^

Figure 8.86. FeO residual, showing minor depletion around Canagau Mine, Croxall Property, and Verna Lake
Stock.

133
CHAPTER 8

MgO UNPROCESSED
Compositional Variation

\\

Figure 8.9a. MgO unprocessed, showing compositional variation.

S MgO RESIDUAL v
/ Slight Indication of Zones of Alteration
\ \\ \ \\
/ \ \\\ \ \
/ \ \\\ \
A

\;^.Y~
L/ ^^
s kilometres

Figure 8.9b. MgO residual, showing slight indication of alteration zones.

134
EC. GRUNSKY

CaO UNPROCESSED Compositional Variation^


Depletion in Mineralized and Altered Areas

\\\ \\

Figure 8.10a. CaO unprocessed, showing compositional variation and depletion in mineralized and altered
areas.

RESIDUAL Alteration Zones


Enrichment Around Altered Zones

Figure 8.1 Ob. CaO residual, showing depletion around alteration zones and zone of enrichment around
altered zones.

135
CHAP TER 8

/ NaO UNPROCESSED Erratic


Depletion in Sulphur Enriched Areas \

Figure 8.11 a. Na2 0 unprocessed, showing erratic depletion in S enriched areas.

Na 2O RESIDUAL Alteration Zones


Depletion in Areas of Sulphur Enrichment /
\\\\ \\
\\.\\ \\

kilometres

Figure 8.11 b. Na2 0 residual, showing alteration zones and depletion in areas of S enrichment.

136
E.G. GRUNSKY

K2O UNPROCESSED
Compositional
Variation

Figure 8.12a. K2 0 unprocessed, showing compositional variation.

. K2O RESIDUAL
' Alteration Zones

\\.\\ \\

Figure B. 12b. K2 0 residual, showing enrichment in alteration zones.

137
CHAPTERS

TiO2 UNPROCESSED
Compositional Variation
-\\ \ o\\ -"

Figure 8.13a. Ti02 unprocessed, showing compositional variation.

S TiO2 RESIDUAL
Alteration Zones

O____1 2
•••^ZI^^MMZZ
kilometres

Figure 8.13b. TiO2 residual, showing depletion in alteration zones.

138
EC. GRUNSKY

CO 2 UNPROCESSED

\
> 6.0\ X
i——i 3.0-6.0/
1.0-3.0

Figure 8.14a. C02 unprocessed, showing hydrothermal alteration.

CO2 RESIDUAL l
Hydrothermal Alteration
Carbonatization

Figure 8.14b. C02 residual, showing hydrothermal alteration and carbonatization.

139
CHAPTER 8

/ S UNPROCESSED
/ Sulphide Mineralization

Figure 8.15a. Sulphur unprocessed, showing sulphide mineralization.

S RESIDUALS
Sulphide Mineralization
\ \\ \ \\
\ \\\ \\
\
\

Figure 8.15b. Sulphur residuals, showing sulphide mineralization.

140
E.G. GRUNSKY

l ' H 2O* UNPROCESSED X X


li/ Compositional Variation
^^^ X
(^ ^ Altered Areas ^^
y
\ ' \ x"*^X. U
.f—^

Figure 8.16a. /-^CT unprocessed, showing compositional variation and some indication of alteration zones.

Figure 8.16b. HiO* residual, showing slight indication of alteration zones.

141
CHAPTER 8

"7
Au UNPROCESSED

kilometres

Figure 8.17a. Gold unprocessed, showing enrichment.

Figure 8.17b, Gold residual, showing enrichment.

142
EC. GRUNSKY

Cu UNPROCESSED

Figure 8.18a. Copper unprocessed, showing local enrichment.

Figure 8.18b. Copper residuals, showing enrichment.

143
CHAPTER 8

7—Y
7 Li UNPROCESSED
/ CO2 Alteration Hydrothermal 7
\ \\\ X
7
\ \\\
\ \\\

figure 8.19a. Lithium unprocessed, showing hydrothermal alteration.

Li RESIDUAL
CO2 Alteration
Hydrothermal
\ \ \\ \\
\ \\\ \
\ \

Figure 8.19b. Lithium residual, showing CO2 alteration hydrothermal.

144
EC. GRUNSKY

Figure 8.20a. Nickel unprocessed, showing compositional variation in volcanic rocks.

Ni RESIDUAL
CO 2 Alteration
Depletion
\ \\\ \\
\ \\\ \

Figure 8.20b. Nickel residual, showing alteration zones.

145
CHAPTER 8

Zn UNPROCESSED
Compositional Variation
Felsic Volcanics
Hydrothermal Systems

Figure 8.21 a. Zinc unprocessed, showing compositional variation of volcanic rocks and hydrothermal
alteration.

Zn RESIDUAL
S Enrichment
COo Alteration

Figure 8.21 b. Zinc residual, showing sulphur enrichment and CO2 alteration.

146
B.C. GRUNSKY

NORMALIZATION SCHEMES AND TECHNIQUES be determined. The method assumes AI 203 immobil
FOR IDENTIFYING ALTERATION_________ ity. Aluminium does not remain immobile in Archean
rocks (Gibson et al. 1983; Riverin and Hodgson
Sopuck (1977), Sopuck et al. (1980), and Lavin 1980), although it does not vary as much as other
(1976) used Si02 as an independent variable against elements. Beswick (1981) has shown that discrimi
which all other oxide/element abundances would be nant function analysis in conjunction with LMPR plots
measured. Regression curves were derived for each can be used to calculate "scores" that assist in the
oxide/element with respect to Si02. Residuals were identification of mineralized zones based on the al
then computed based on the actual abundance of an teration of several components.
oxide/element in comparison to its expected value
determined from the Si02 content of the rock and the The use of molecular proportions (Pearce 1969)
regression formula. This classification scheme works and mass balance transfers (Gresens 1967) allow the
providing the original Si02 content of the volcanic precise calculation of a component where there has
rocks has not changed. Studies by Gibson et al. been addition or depletion. Again, these methods
(1983), Franklin and Thorpe (1982), Deptuck et at. assume that at least one component is immobile.
(1982), Knuckey et al. (1982), Urabe and Salo (1978), Normative mineral calculations have been used in
Knuckey and Watkins (1982), Riverin and Hodgson conjunction with mass balance calculations (Gresens
(1980), and MacGeehan and Maclean (1980) all 1967) by Knuckey et al. (1982), and Riverin and
show that Si02 as well as other oxides/elements are Hodgson (1980) to show which components have
mobile in altered volcanic domains. Thus, the use of been added or subtracted from the rocks, as well as
any individual oxide/element as an independent or determining volume changes. Normative minerals cal
"immobile" variable by which the expected abun culated for unmetamorphosed "Kuroko type" volcanic
dance of other components can be determined is rocks have been used to determine the original com
questionable. positions of alteration pipes.
In this study, the two classification schemes Studemeister (1983) has shown that the ratio of
which are used are based on components that are Fe+VFe (total) is a good indicator of the oxidation
known to be mobile. The classification scheme of state which prevailed in zones where hydrothermal
Jensen (1976) uses Al, Fe3, Fe2, Ti, Mn, and Mg; but alteration has occurred.
Mg and Fe are known to be mobile around sulphide Gelinas et al. (1977) have used normative corun
deposits (Riverin and Hodgson 1980; Knuckey et al. dum as an indication of alteration. The presence of
1982). The classification scheme of Irvine and corundum indicates that Na, K, Ca, Al, and Si are not
Baragar (1971) uses Na20, K20, MgO, FeO, Si02 , and present in the correct proportions for formation of
AI 203. Na and K are particularly mobile in altered normative feldspars. The mobility of components
areas and in regional metamorphic domains. This can (usually K and Na) are indirectly recognized using
cause significant errors in the classification of the this method. Figure 8.22 displays the abundance of
volcanic rocks. All classification schemes will fail normative corundum in the Ben Nevis area, several
when the independent variables used are susceptible anomalous zones have been delineated by its high
to alteration. The mobility of these components can abundances.
be readily recognized because their use will lead to Excessive amounts of calcite in a normative min
inconsistent results within the classification scheme. eral calculation within volcanic rocks could indicate
If a rock is misclassified because the critical compo that carbonatization had occurred. Figure 8.23 shows
nents to make a particular classification have been the distribution of normative calcite throughout the
altered, the expected values for other components area. Numerous zones of Ca and CO2 enrichment are
within that sample are likely to show abnormal abun outlined in the figure and indicate some degree of
dances. As an example, if a basalt has been carbonate alteration. However, Ca is notably absent
silicified, a regression equation would indicate that around the Canagau Mines area (see Figure 8.1 Ob),
the Na or K are too low and Ti. Fe, and Mg are too hence normative calcite does not show up in the
high. These would show up as large residual values vicinity of the mine. Figure 8.14a shows the wide
on contour maps. Similarly, the use of the cation spread abundance of C02 throughout the Canagau
classification scheme of Jensen (1976), should show Mines area. The C02 that cannot form calcite be
that rocks enriched in Mg will indicate high residual cause of the low Ca level probably forms dolomite,
values in Si and Al. magnesite, or siderite. If normative mineral calcula
Various classifications exist in which the calcula tions were modified to compute these minerals, then
tion of residual values is part of the classification the zone of CO2 alteration would be more extensive
process. They can be used successfully if properly than shown in Figure 8.14b.
interpreted. However, the problems stated above are The abundance of several other normative min
unavoidable, and interpretation of residual data must erals can be used to detect various alteration pat
take these problems into account. terns. Minerals such as acmite indicate excess Na,
Beswick and Soucie (1978) and Beswick (1981) and the undersaturated minerals such as nepheline
have shown that logarithmic molecular proportion ra and leucite indicate silica depletion and alkali enrich
tio (LMPR) diagrams produce straight lines when the ment.
the major oxide values of modern day volcanic rocks Normative minerals that are "expected" in a nor
are used as data. Thus, rocks that do not fit on the mative mineral calculation (for example quartz,
lines can be interpreted as being altered. Beswick olivine, albite, and so on) must be used cautiously
and Soucie (1978) developed a correction procedure because their abundance will vary with rock com-
through which original component abundances can

147
CHAPTER B

NORMATIVE
CORUNDUM/

Figure 8.22. Distribution of normative corundum.

Figure 8.23. Distribution of normative calcite.

148
EC. GRUNSKY

position; only carefully calculated residual values silicification, and alkali depletion. In a suite of unal
would be helpful in delineating altered zones. tered volcanic rocks, there is generally an inverse
relationship between (Na, K) and (Ca, Mg, Fe). If the
STATISTICAL TECHNIQUES data distribution were governed only by those com
ponents, the compositional variation would be domi-
A drawback with methods using either single compo nantly along one axis illustrating a differentiation
nent or multicomponent residual values is that ex trend (that is, Harker diagrams). However, if the rocks
pected values are required in order to calculate the within a given suite have been altered by some
residual values. Again, the determination of residual process such as carbonatization then, not only is the
values is based on the assumption that the compo data distributed along a direction defining its
nent abundances are normally distributed, and that petrogenesis, but also along an axis that describes
the classification schemes use immobile components the departure of the data by one or more of the
in order to determine residuals. For reasons stated affected components (for example C02 ).
earlier, residual values can be misleading since
rocks must first be classified before residuals can be In correspondence analysis, the factors are char
calculated. If the rock is misclassified, then the resid acterized by eigenvectors which determine their ori
ual values will be incorrect. entation in the data space and by eigenvalues which
measure how much of the data variation occurs
Any method that uses models with the data (that along each factor.
is, comparison of the data with expected values) is
subject to scrutiny since such models assume an Table 8.1 a shows the eigenvalues and percent
understanding of the distribution of the data. Tech age contribution of each factor. Note that the first
niques such as discriminant function analysis predict factor accounts for 35.33 07o of the variation of the
the expected behaviour of data based on models. data, and the first five factors combined explain
Since the data being used with the discriminant func 92.86 07o of the data variation. Table 8.1 b lists the
tions may not reflect the same geological process computed factor values for each component. Figure
and/or environment as those for which the technique 8.24a shows projections of the samples and compo
was developed, the resultant residual values may not nents onto the first five axes. Table 8.1 c gives the
be significant. For example, if the expected value for contribution of each chemical component over the
a basalt is that typical of a tholeiitic basalt, but the five computed factors (relative contribution or prox
rock that is being tested is in fact calc-alkalic, resid imities to the factorial axes/or squared correlations)
ual values will mostly reflect the difference between and the percentage that each component contributes
a tholeiitic and a calc-alkalic basalt. Any residual to each factor (absolute contribution/or contributions
effect due to alteration will probably be masked by to the factorial axes inertias). Note that in Table 8.1 c,
this more significant difference. Si, Fe, Mg, Ca, K. and H 20 contribute heavily to the
first factor and are the components that define the
For these reasons, it was decided that a statisti compositional variation due to magmatic differenti
cal approach employing a minimum of assumptions ation (see Figure 8.24a). Over 94 070 of the second
regarding expected component values would best factor is defined by the distribution of C02 and over
distinguish altered from unaltered rocks; Correspon 90 07o of the third factor is defined by the distribution
dence Analysis is such a technique. of S. This can be seen in Figures 8.24a and 8.24b.
"Correspondence analysis can be viewed as The ability to plot the component-factor coordi
finding the best simultaneous representation of two nates (R-mode) and the sample factor coordinates
data sets that compose the rows and columns of a (Q-mode) is a unique feature of correspondence ana
data matrix" (Lebart ef al. 1984). This means that a lysis. The distribution of the data along the first
matrix consisting of rows of samples and columns of factor (F1) reflects the compositional variation due to
chemical components represent the data matrix from the magmatic trend of volcanic differentiation. The
which the simultaneous relationship of variables with basalts have a greater Ca, Fe, and Mg abundance
samples and samples with variables can be extract relative to the rhyolites which are enriched in K;
ed. The details of the method will not be discussed samples plot closest to the components they contain
here, but can be found in Lebart et al. (1984), Jambu in greater abundance relative to the other samples in
and Lebeaux (1983), David et al. (1977), Hill (1975), the population. As the values along the second factor
and Teil (1975). Correspondence analysis was increase, this reflects an increasing C02 content in
originally developed for contingency tables, which samples (Figure 24a and 24c). Figure 24c shows the
were based on probabilities, that consisted of posi distribution of the altered samples in a projection
tive numbers and were used in a variety of applica looking along the compositional line (Factor 1) of the
tions. Applications of this technique has been carried magmatic trend in the F2-F3 plane. The fourth factor
out in the geological sciences with continuous mea (F4) indicates that Ca, Na, and Mg account for most
surement data by Teil (1975), David et al. (1977), and of the variation of the data in that factor. The ele
Mellinger (1984). ments K, Na, and Ca account for most of the vari
An aim of correspondence analysis is to repre ation in the fifth factor (F5) (see Table 8.1 c).
sent the data in terms of a number of axes (factors) Comparison of the relative contributions of the
that describe the distribution of the data. Each factor components over the 5 factors in Table 8.1 c shows
can be thought of as describing geological processes that most of the components are accounted for by
such as differentiation (partial melting, crystal frac F1, the first factor. Only Na, K, Ca, CO2, and S are
tionation, and so on) and alteration in so far as each mostly accounted for by other factors. The second
process produces variation patterns in the data under factor (F2) accounts for over 99 07o of the C02 dis-
study. Such processes include carbonatization,

149
CHAPTER 8

TABLE 8.1: CORRESPONDENCE ANALYSES, MAJOR OXIDES.


TABLE 8.1a.
R MODE: MEAN EIGENVALUES 07o OF VARIATION CUMULATIVE Ve
VARIABLES VALUES (NON TRIVIAL EIGENVALUES)
Si02 58.56 0.037 787 25 35.32 35.32
AI203 15.56 0.026 188 00 24.48 59.80
Fe203 1.74 0.019 76203 18.47 78.27
FeO 4.74 0.009 276 52 8.67 86.94
MgO 4.10 0.006 328 67 5.92 92.86
CaO 5.68 0.003012 14 2.82 95.67
Na20 3.31 0.001 45605 1.36 97.04
K?0 0.80 0.001 294 54 1.21 98.25
TiO2 0.83 0.001 012 32 0.95 99.19
P205 0.12 0.000385 18 0.36 99.55
MnO 0.10 0.000 266 72 0.25 99.80
C02 1.32 0.000 15547 0.15 99.95
S 0.13 0.000 057 44 0.05 100.00
H2CH 2.65
TABLE 8.1 b.
FACTORS (COORDINATES)
VARIABLE 1 2 3 4 5
Si02 -0. 1 20 4 -0.016 2 -0.012 3 0.012 3 -0.001 9
AI 203 0.058 4 -0.038 3 -0.013 8 -0.000 8 0.005 9
Fe203 0.244 4 -0.163 5 0.057 5 -0.0159 -0.004 3
FeO 0.338 4 0.004 0 0.111 9 -0.115 7 -0.066 5
MgO 0.420 0 -0.021 4 0.033 5 -0.1642 -0.116 9
CaO 0.382 5 0.035 5 -0.045 6 0.272 4 0.113 8
Na20 -0. 1 1 1 3 -0.070 0 -0.120 8 -0.284 7 0.222 5
K20 -0.560 1 0.178 2 0.191 9 0.201 0 -0.551 0
Ti02 0.292 5 -0.047 1 0.001 5 -0.070 0 -0.013 8
P205 0.2193 -0.026 6 0.041 7 -0.095 0 -0.016 7
MnO 0.267 7 0.084 5 0.032 3 -0.047 3 -0.051 7
C02 -0.015 7 1.363 5 0.051 4 -0.080 1 0.069 5
S -0.493 2 -0.304 7 3.774 8 0.059 1 0.554 3
H 2O* 0.309 9 0.020 3 0.045 7 -0.041 1 -0.098 8
TABLE 8. 1C.
ABSOLUTE AND RELATIVE CONTRIBUTIONS
WEIGHT AC(1) RC(1) AC(2) RC(2) AC(3) RC(3) AC(4) RC(4) AC(5) RC(5)
Si02 0.587 735 22.54 96.21 0.59 1.75 0.45 1.01 0.96 1.01 0.03 0.02
AI 2O3 0.156 120 1.41 66.80 0.88 28.77 0.15 3.73 0.00 0.01 0.09 0.69
Fe203 0.017 417 2.75 66.33 1.78 29.70 0.29 3.67 0.05 0.28 0.01 0.02
FeO 0.047 572 14.41 79.04 0.00 0.01 3.01 8.65 6.87 9.25 3.33 3.06
MgO 0.041 165 19.21 80.69 0.07 0.21 0.23 0.51 11.97 12.34 8.89 6.25
CaO 0.057 007 22.07 61.78 0.27 0.53 0.60 0.88 45.60 31.34 11.68 5.47
Na20 0.033 195 1.09 7.62 0.62 3.02 2.45 8.98 29.01 49.90 25.98 30.48
K20 0.008 065 6.70 43.19 0.98 4.37 1.50 5.07 3.51 5.56 38.70 41.80
Ti02 0.008 343 1.89 92.14 0.07 2.38 0.00 0.00 0.44 5.27 0.03 0.21
P205 0.001 178 0.15 80.35 0.00 1.18 0.01 2.90 0.11 15.10 0.01 0.47
MnO 0.001 038 0.20 84.56 0.03 8.42 0.01 1.23 0.02 2.63 0.04 3.15
C02 0.013 271 0.01 0.01 94.22 99.25 0.18 0.14 0.92 0.34 1.01 0.26
S 0.001 260 0.81 1.63 0.45 0.62 90.83 95.66 0.05 0.02 6.12 2.06
H 20-f 0.026 632 6.77 87.31 0.04 0.37 0.28 1.90 0.49 1.54 4.11 8.88

150
EC. GRUNSKY

o, M
oo'
4
|CO2
-K IAJO R O XII )E s-
!
-
orr
'

*J —
O '
— 1—
'
O
0- <
*.lLJ-- *
, 1 \

0
' ' tt .
t* le
**
^*
*J * **
Ai K4 4
^. J t ^C a
o /* V ;Si^ •*?;l
** .
rV M 9
o
d f
*r^
^ 1jm.v VN^
!t!lti^t'
^t, V
h
DF:

-a- J5
o
O •A •Q
i F Zl R 1
-0.40 0.00 0.40 O.IJO 1.1?0

Figure 8.24a to 8.24e. Correspondence analyses,


factor scores of samples (+J and chemical
components.

151
CHAPTERS

tribution and the third factor (F3) accounts for over 5 indicate S enrichment while more moderate values
95 07o of the S distribution. The fourth and fifth factors (0.1 to 0.3) indicate Na enrichment.
show that Ca, Na, and K, which are generally consid Correspondence analysis was also applied to the
ered to be the most mobile elements in zones of combined major oxides and trace elements. A scaling
alteration, are the major contributions. problem exists between the two groups of compo
Figure 8.25 displays contour plots of the first 5 nents because the major oxides are expressed in
factors for the Ben Nevis area. As described pre weight percent and the trace elements are expressed
viously, the first factor accounts for the original com in parts per million. In order to maintain the propor
positional variation, and this can be seen in Figure tions of relative abundance within the sample popula
8.25a. The plot closely resembles the lithologic map tion, the weight percent major oxides were trans
of the area (Figure 8.2) for example, negative factor formed into parts per million.
values (Figure 8.24a) represent the Na, K-rich sam The results of the combined correspondence
ples, most notably the felsic volcanic rocks. Examina analyses are shown in Table 8.2 and in Figure 8.26
tion of a contour plot of factor 2 (Figure 8.25b) shows and 8.27. The results are nearly identical to those of
that the positive anomalies are coincident with high the major oxides. Part of the reason for this is that
C02 values (see Figure 8.24a). Figure 8.25c shows the trace elements have small weights relative to the
that the positive anomalies of Factor 3 are the result major oxides; however, the trace elements provide
of the presence of sulphides (see Figure 8.24b); additional information and verify what was observed
good targets for exploration. Positive Factor 4 values in the isochemical plots. Table 8.2c shows the actual
show a tendency towards Ca enrichment (see Figure and relative contributions of the components. It is
8.24d). In Figure 8.25d. positive Factor 4 anomalies clearly seen from an examination of Table 8.2c and
are found around the carbonatized zone in the Figure 8.26a that the Si02, Al,03 . Fe203, FeO, MgO,
Canagau Mines deposit area. These anomalies repre CaO, Ti02, P 205, MnO, H 2CT. Co, Cr, Ni, V, and Zr
sent Ca enrichment around the main zone of car distributions are accounted for in the first factor and
bonatization. Negative Factor 4 anomalies (not represent the compatibilities of trace elements that
shown) indicate Na depletion around the Canagau co-exist with the primary magmatic mineralogical
Mines Property and the Croxall Property. Factor 5 phases. This is to be expected because these com
contours in Figure 8.25e show zones of K enrichment ponents are part of the igneous process of com
associated with negative Factor 5 anomalies (seealso positional variation in volcanic rocks.
Figure 24d). Extremely high values (X3.40) of Factor

/ MAJOR OXIDES FACTOR 1


/
Compositional Variation
\ \ \
\\

Figure 8.25a. Contour expression of Factor 1 with potassium enriched rocks ^0.20 and mafic rocks X).25.

152
EC. GRUNSKY

X MAJOR OXIDES FACTOR 2


CO2 Enrichment
\ \\ \ \\
\ \\\ \\
\~\ \\ \
i\\\.
o-/
x^"\ /r" 7 X

Figure 8.25b. Contour expression of Factor 2 values X). 15 representing carbonatized zones.

MAJOR OXIDES FACTOR 3


, S Enrichment

\ \\\ \\

kilometres

Figure 8.25C. Contour expression of Factor 3 values X). 15 representing areas enriched in sulphur.

153
CHAPTERS

MAJOR OXIDES FACTOR 4


Ga Enrichment

\ \\\ \\
\ \\\ \\
\ \\\ \

\\ ii L/
l ' —N

kilometres

figure 8.25d. Contour expression of Factor 4 values X).07 representing rocks anomalously rich in calcium.

S MAJOR OXIDES FACTOR 5


K Enrichment

/' \ \\ \ \\
\ \\\ \\ .

kilometres

Figure 8.25e. Contour expression of Factor 5 values ^. 1 representing rocks enriched in potassium.

154
E.G. GRUNSKY

Figures 8.26a, 8.26b, 8.26c, and 8.26d show the Factor 5 accounts for only S.91% of the data
samples and components of Factor 1 plotted against distribution (Table 8.2a) and is significantly contri
the other four. Figure 8.26a clearly shows the com buted by Na20, K2, Ba, and Zn. The association of
positional variation of the sample population along Na20, K20, and Zn with alteration is well established
Factor 1. The addition of the trace elements enhance through the isochemical plots of Figures 8.11, 8.12,
the compositional line by extension due to the pres and 8.21. Positive Factor 5 anomalies indicate K20,
ence of Gr, Mi, and Co at the mafic end of the factor Zn, and Ba enrichment (Figure 8.26e) and both the
(X3.10), while Ba and Zn occur toward the felsic end Croxall Property and Canagau Mines Limited Property
of the factor K-0.10). anomalies are defined in Figure 8.27e.
Figure 8.27a shows the distribution of the more Within the distribution of the data over the fac
felsic volcanic rocks in the map area. The actual tors (axes), it can be seen that several "clouds" or
contributions of components to the second factor is groups of sample points occur (Figures 8.24 and
weighted heavily by C02 variation as indicated in 8.26). Some of these groups have an obvious geo
Table 8.2c. The C02 abundance is great. It accounts logical interpretation such as those relating to car
for 94.18 07o of the component. From the relative con bonatization or fractionation. It is difficult, however, to
tribution of Factor 2, it can be seen that 55.33 07o of "see" some groups of points that may occur along
the Li variation is accounted for by the second factor. the factor axes which are easily obscured when
The association of C02 and Li is well displayed by several groups of data are projected onto a two-
this factor and is verified by comparison of Figures dimension plot for visual presentation. A technique
8.14b and 8.24b with Figure 8.27b. The pattern in for detecting groups of points in n-dimensioned
Figure 8.26a is almost identical to that of Figure space is that of Dynamic Cluster Analysis. This meth
8.24a in that the departure of the samples from the od was developed by Diday (1973), and is also
main compositional trend line is the same, with en discussed in Lefebvre and David (1977). The dy
richment in COo and Li. The second factor obviously namic cluster analysis method works by selecting
outlines the trend line zone of hydrothermal alter groups of samples closest to randomly chosen
ation. Also, the first factor shows that nearly 16 07o of nuclei! over the factored space derived from the
the Li variation is accounted for by the main mag correspondence analysis. By iteration, the nucleii lo
matic trend. This indicates in an indirect way, the cations are refined until the locations no longer
relative amount of trace element compatibility that change and the nucleii represent centres of sample
can be explained over the data space. groups.
Factor 3 accounts for the distribution of S and Cu The results of the dynamic cluster analysis on
almost exclusively (Table 8.2c). A minor component the major oxide data from Ben Nevis rocks are shown
of Zn associated with S also shows up in the relative in Figure 8.28a and Table 8.3. Figure 8.28a outlines
contributions column. It is not surprising to see the the spatial positioning of the groups; Table 8.3a
obvious relationship of Cu and S. Figure 8.26b dis shows the factor space coordinate of the groups as
plays the relationship of Cu and S-enriched samples well as the mean composition and standard deviation
with the main compositional trend line. Figure 8.27c of each component for each group. The mean com
shows the S-Cu rich areas and as such is a good positions and standard deviations allow the analyst to
target for the investigation of sulphide occurrences. determine which components define to the unique
Factor 4 accounts for Sl.43% and 49.89 07o of the ness of each group. Dynamic cluster analysis iden
CaO and Na2 variations respectively in Table 8.2c; tified 28 groupings based on the factor coordinates
MgO, Ti02 and Li are also accounted for in lesser of the groups. Each of these groups reflects some
amounts (Table 8.2c). Examination of Figure 8.26d geological process. Groups 1 and 2 represent the
shows that positive Factor 4 values are associated mafic volcanic rocks (Table 8.3b). Groups 7, 8, 9, 12,
with relative CaO enrichment and negative values are 14, 13, 17, and 27 contain anomalous C02. These
associated with relative Na20 enrichment. This re groups, when spatially plotted (Figure 8.28b and e),
flects the inverse relationship of CaO and Na20 show the progressive increase of C02 within the main
abundances between mafic and felsic volcanic zone of carbonatization in the eastern part of Ben
rocks. Thus, it might be expected that positive Factor Nevis Township. Groups 11, 20, 21, 22, 23, 26, and
4 values outline mafic volcanic rocks and negative 28 indicate increasing S within the sample popula
Factor 4 values outline felsic volcanic rocks. How tion. The reader should realize that not all groups
ever, this pattern does not emerge from an examina could be on the figures because of space problems.
tion of Figure 8.27d. This is due to the fact that only It is noteworthy that Group 11 (Figure 8.28 a, c, e)
8.637o of the data distribution (Table 8.2a) is defined represents 17 samples. Of these 17 samples, 14 are
by Factor 4. The positive anomalies of Figure 8.27c from the Croxall Property area in western Ben Nevis
appear to outline zones of CaO enrichment similar to Township and represent significant S enrichment.
that outlined in the correspondence analysis of the The 18 samples in Group 10 are significant be
major oxides. Thus, a zone of CaO enrichment ar cause of their high Ga values. These samples are
ound the main zone of carbonatization is delineated. from around the main zone of carbonatization and
Since the bulk of the sample analyses plotted in may reflect a chemical zoning effect of Ga enrich
Figure 8.26c have Factor 4 values X).0, only the ment away from the main zone of hydrothermal cir
extreme negative values outline the zones of Na20 culation (Figure 28d). Groups 7, 8, 14, and 17, which
enrichment. are associated with C02 enrichment, are also slightly
depleted in Ga relative to other groups.

155
CHAPTER 8

CO,
CN
MAJOR OXIDES
o ^_
r tt TRACE ELEMENT!
O *
•'
O
<
LL
0
(O
d * .,
. LI

- l
* - . Si;, rt :" Ga Ni
•' * *V
la
^
*4- Jjj o1

1
rfl
C*
Gr
v 1
-e ^

LX' M,
S NiJ

d
\f
F:A CT Ol R
i-
-0.40 0.00 0.40 0.80 1 1.20

t
*

3. S ;s
FACTOR MAJOR OXIDE! o
MAJOR OXID ES'S
O -x 1 rRACE ELEME NI
T'RACE ELEMENT s
c )u
, 4
Qf
- <
O
in
0
in U.K Y
P2
*

l
0 Z d Ir
-C^0
.Ba. ^le Si Zn vs Ga
?:2 ii' r*
b *Hr cr Ni

S i
K K2T
2 ^.

Ai^ -g^p
-'r jjwjj SS ja&fe ^ ^ Fe sSJolg
/^
? •Vi CR
-•^L

X :a
Mg K ia LJ*

^
N f)
Li C IN
Fe J Ni Ci
o o
h-
(d ~ -ACTOR i FrA CI
•Q
R 1
-0.40 0.00 0.40 0.80 1.20
-0. 40 0. DO o.-*0 O.fJO •4 i
20

Figure 8.26a to 8.26e. Correspondence analyses,


factor scores of samples (+J and chemical FACTOR
5 MAJOR OXIDES l—
o
components. TRACE ELEMENTS-

K LSI

a ^2f!r*
** .
i ' 3r
.s\ tfr.
i
** r , B Nl'
l* I& ^7 "\ —X
•MG

^Ji
iS^E
o
v^ *?!\ HR|
4* ^*

^*t **
-1
0 V*
* \ *
Na ( Co
C 32
o
1*.
d
FACTOR 1
-0.40 0.00 0.40 0.80 1.20

156
EC. GRUNSKY

MAJOR OXIDES FACTOR 1


TRACE ELEMENTS COMPOSITIONAL VARIATION

factor score '


1^ -0.20
kilometers

Figure 8.27a. Negative anomalies outline sodium, potassium, barium-enriched felsic volcanic rocks.

MAJOR OXIDES FACTOR 2 OXLi.Zn \^


TRACE ELEMENTS HYDROTHERMAL ALTERATION
\ \ \ '

\ \ \\\
\ \\
\\
\ \

Figure 8.27b. Positive anomalies outline C02, Li, Zn enriched areas.

157
CHAPTERS

MAJOR OXIDES FACTOR 3


ELEMENTS S.Cu ENRICHMENT

factor score
^ > 0.05
kilometers

Figure 8.27c. Positive anomalies indicate Cu, S rich zones (sulphide mineralization).

MAJOR OXIDES FACTOR 4


TRACE ELEMENTS Ga ENRICHMENT

Figure 8.27d. Positive anomalies indicate Ca enriched zones. Note the band of Ca enrichment around the
carbonated area. Compare with Figure 8.27b.

158
EC. GRUNSKY

MAJOR OXIDES FACTOR 5


TRACE ELEMENTS Zn,K,Ba ENRICHMENT

/f \ \\ v "
//
A
\

Figure 8.2?'e. Positive anomalies indicate Zn, K, Ba enriched zones.

TABLE 8.2: CORRESPONDENCE ANALYSIS, MAJOR OXIDES AND TRACE ELEMENTS.


TABLE 8.2a. OXIDES AND TRACE ELEMENTS.
R MODE: MEAN EIGENVALUES 07o OF VARIATION CUMULATIVE 070
VARIABLES VALUES (NON TRIVIAL EIGENVALUES)
SiOo 585 593.55 0.03 786 090 35.21 35.21
AI 263 155551.22 0.02617004 24.34 59.55
Fe,03 17 354.01 0.01 978 271 18.40 77.95
FeO 47 398.54 0.00 927 626 8.63 86.58
Mgo 41 015.45 0.00 635 597 5.91 92.49
CaO 56799.15 0.00 304 222 2.83 95.32
Na 20 33 074.45 0.00 146906 1.37 96.68
K20 8 035.89 0.00 130 136 1.21 97.89
Ti02 8312.53 0.00 101 779 0.95 98.84
P205 1 173.97 0.00 038 944 0.36 99.20
MnO 1 034.31 0.00 026 862 0.25 99.45
C02 13222.87 0.00016093 0.15 99.60
S 1 255.11 0.00013438 0.12 99.73
H 2CH 26 535.04 0.00 009 840 0.09 99.82
Ba 208.11 0.00005 193 0.05 99.87
Co 22.61 0.00 003 896 0.04 99.90
Cr 85.37 0.00 003 444 0.03 99.94
Cu 56.18 0.00 002 528 0.02 99.96
Li 17.01 0.00 002 042 0.02 99.98
Mi 78.88 0.00 001 446 0.01 99.99
Zn 88.78 0.00 000 386 0.00 99.99
Sr 135.11 0.00 000 241 0.00 100.00
V 131.40 0.00 000 220 0.00 100.00
Y 24.13 0.00 000 093 0.00 100.00
Zr 132.48

159
CHAPTERS

TABLE 8.2b.
FACTORS (COORDINATES)
VARIABLE 1 234 5
SiOo -0.1205 -0.0163 -0.0124 0.0122 0.001 7
AL203 0.058 3 -0.038 2 -0.0139 -0.000 6 -0.005 8
Fe203 0.244 4 -0.1633 0.057 4 0.0162 0.004 5
FeO 0.338 3 0.004 4 0.111 6 -0.1154 0.066 5
MgO 0.420 1 -0.020 9 0.033 2 -0.1642 0.1168
CaO 0.382 1 0.035 9 -0.045 8 0.272 8 -0.1136
NA20 -0.111 1 -0.070 2 -0. 1 20 8 -0.284 5 -0.222 3
K20 -0.560 9 0.1778 0.192 4 0.201 0 0.551 9
Ti02 0.292 5 -0.046 7 0.001 4 -0.069 6 0.0139
P205 0.219 2 -0.026 3 0.041 5 -0.094 8 0.0170
MnO 0.267 6 0.084 8 0.032 1 -0.047 1 0.051 8
C02 -0.017 2 1.3634 0.051 8 -0.079 9 -0.070 4
S -0.491 2 -0.306 7 3.774 2 0.058 8 -0.554 4
H2o* 0.309 7 0.020 7 0.045 5 -0.040 9 0.098 5
Ba -0.304 3 0.047 6 -0.012 3 0.063 7 0.334 7
Co 0.432 0 -0.068 9 0.1199 -0.091 3 0.008 1
Cr 0.597 7 -0.036 4 0.051 0 -0.220 9 0.161 7
Cu 0.030 6 -0.092 7 0.881 4 0.051 5 -0.071 1
Li 0.196 1 0.364 9 0.1070 -0.202 5 0.1289
Ni 0.525 3 -0.027 1 0.018 5 -0.1663 0.084 4
Zn 0.058 7 0.149 2 0.1242 -0.022 5 0.272 6
Sr 0.203 1 -0.151 2 -0.011 7 0.062 0 -0.083 3
V 0.423 2 -0.066 1 0.004 7 -0.008 9 -0.024 3
Y -0.095 3 -0.051 6 -0.020 6 0.002 4 -0.020 4
Zr -0.1400 -0.026 3 0.023 3 -0.006 8 0.030 9

TABLE 8.2C.
ABSOLUTE AND RELATIVE CONTRIBUTIONS
WEIGHT AC(1) RC(1) AC(2) RC(2) AC(3) RC(3) AC(4) RC(4) AC(5) RC(5)
Si02 0.587 158 22.51 96.22 0.60 1.77 0.45 1.01 0.94 0.99 0.03 0.02
AI203 0.155967 1.40 66.77 0.87 28.77 0.15 3.78 0.00 0.01 0.08 0.67
Fe2O3 0.017400 2.75 66.40 1.77 29.63 0.29 3.66 0.05 0.29 0.01 0.02
FeO 0.047 525 14.37 79.11 0.00 0.01 2.99 8.61 6.83 9.21 3.31 3.06
MgO 0.041 125 19.17 80.73 0.07 0.20 0.23 0.50 11.95 12.33 8.82 6.24
CaO 0.056 951 21.97 61.69 0.28 0.54 0.60 0.89 45.68 31.43 11.55 5.45
Na20 0.033 163 1.08 7.61 0.62 3.04 2.45 8.99 28.94 49.89 25.79 30.47
K20 0.008 057 6.69 43.20 0.97 4.34 1.51 5.08 3.51 5.55 38.61 41.83
Ti02 0.008 335 1.88 92.22 0.07 2.35 0.00 0.00 0.43 5.21 0.03 0.21
PA 0.001 177 0.15 80.43 0.00 1.16 0.01 2.89 0.11 15.04 0.01 0.48
MnO 0.001 037 0.20 84.50 0.03 8.49 0.01 1.22 0.02 2.62 0.04 3.17
C02 0.013258 0.01 0.02 94.18 99.24 0.18 0.14 0.91 0.34 1.03 0.26
S 0.001 258 0.80 1.62 0.45 0.63 90.62 95.66 0.05 0.02 6.09 2.06
H20* 0.026 606 6.74 87.36 0.04 0.39 0.28 1.89 0.48 1.52 4.06 8.84
Ba 0.000 209 0.05 43.85 0.00 1.08 0.00 0.07 0.01 1.92 0.37 53.08
Co 0.000 023 0.01 87.15 0.00 2.22 0.00 6.71 0.00 3.89 0.00 0.03
Cr 0.000 086 0.08 81.92 0.00 0.30 0.00 0.60 0.05 11.19 0.04 5.99
Cu 0.000 056 0.00 0.12 0.00 1.08 0.22 97.83 0.00 0.33 0.00 0.64
Li 0.000017 0.00 15.98 0.01 55.33 0.00 4.76 0.01 17.03 0.00 6.90
Ni 0.000 079 0.06 88.50 0.00 0.23 0.00 0.11 0.02 8.87 0.01 2.29
Zn 0.000 089 0.00 2.97 0.01 19.20 0.01 3.30 0.00 0.44 0.10 64.09
Sr 0.000 135 0.01 54.98 0.01 30.47 0.00 0.18 0.01 5.12 0.01 9.25
V 0.000 132 0.06 97.25 0.00 2.37 0.00 0.01 0.00 0.04 0.00 0.32
Y 0.000 024 0.00 72.12 0.00 21.14 0.00 3.38 0.00 0.05 0.00 3.32
Zr 0.000 133 0.01 89.77 0.00 3.16 0.00 2.48 0.00 0.21 0.00 4.38

160
EC. GRUNSKY

Trace elements were also used in conjunction Several oxides and some trace elements are use
with major oxides for the dynamic cluster analysis. ful indicators of mineralization; Factors 2 and 3 from
Figure 8.29a shows the spatial position of some of the correspondence analysis summarize the effects
the groups delineated by the dynamic cluster analy of the major element and trace element alteration
sis along the factor axes. Figure 8.29b shows the around the Ben Nevis area. Dynamic cluster analysis
distribution of the groups over the Ben Nevis area, can assist in identifying groups of data related to S
and Table 8.4 lists the factor coordinate positions enrichment (Croxall Property) or carbonatization
and mean abundances for each component of each (Canagau Mines Deposit) which were not readily ap
group. Groups 2, 3, and 4 contain most of the mafic parent after correspondence analysis alone.
volcanic rocks; Groups 5, 6, 10, and 12 include inter It is important to have a full understanding of the
mediate to felsic volcanic rocks (Table 8.4). Groups 7 geological complexities of an area to best interpret
and 8 are enriched in Zn, Li, C02. S and K (Figure lithogeochemical information. A mixture of chemical
8.29b and d) and represent samples around the al environments (that is, calc-alkalic and tholeiitic
tered areas of the Croxall Property and the Canagau rocks) would make interpretation of the Ben Nevis
Mines Deposit (Figure 8.29a). Group 11 contains S data more difficult; certain critical components may
and Cu enriched samples that occur at the Canagau not be as useful in discriminating zones of alteration
Mines Deposit and Croxall Property as well as some under those circumstances.
isolated sulphide enriched samples (Figure 8.29c).
Group 6 represents Cr, Ni, enriched samples asso
ciated with mafic intrusive and tholeiitic volcanic ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
rocks of the area. Group 10 represents rocks of the The author wishes to thank Dr. F.P. Agterberg of the
Ga enriched zone, similar to Group 10 in the previous Geological Survey of Canada, Dr. M. Mellinger of the
analysis using major oxides. The progressive C02 Saskatchewan Research Council, and Henry Wallace
enrichment that was clearly shown by Groups 7, 8, of the Ontario Geological Survey for critical reviews
and 14 in the major oxides analysis also show up of this work. The comments and suggested improve
when the major oxides and trace elements are com ments are greatly appreciated. The author also wish
bined. Thus, trace elements reflect and/or enhance es to thank Dr. R. Froidevaux of Currie, Cooper, and
the analysis of the major oxides. Lybrand Limited for his original suggestion of the
application of correspondence analysis. Thanks are
CONCLUSIONS also due to Walter Volk (Geological Assistant, Ontario
Geological Survey), to Barbara Moore (Draftsperson,
When using any technique for locating mineralized Ontario Geological Survey) for the drafting of the
areas, it is essential to select the proper components figures, to Doug Webster (Geological Assistant, On
in order to locate anomalous zones. Chemical com tario Geological Survey) who assisted in the field
pounds such as Si02 , Al,03, MgO, Ti02, Ni, Co, Cr, V, work and petrographic studies early on in the study,
and Zn are all very useful indicators for discriminat and finally to Dave Good (Geologist, Ontario Geologi
ing rock types due to their variation associated with cal Survey) who as a geological assistant helped in
fractionation in calc-alkalic suites. In hydrothermal the field work and sample collection program.
systems, certain components are known to be mobile
and these components are desirable indicators when
searching for altered rocks. In the Ben Nevis area,
certain major oxides and trace elements were noted
for such characteristics. For hydrothermal systems,
Na, K, Ca, C02, F, Zn, B, As, and Li are useful
indicators of alteration.
Dynamic Cluster Analysis
Figure 8.28a. Geographic
presentation of some of
the groups computed
from the Dynamic
Cluster Analysis in the
Ben Nevis area.

161
CHAPTER 8

0 D i
CM -fo IA,JO R ^
O)(CE* •^r MAJOR OXIDES
-^ 1 *-
o o
DC
j
-ff- *

fS-
t
Grc up 14 <
sd sd LL

i
m:
S

1
•-' ~ rCaroup 10
4 i^.,1
I^S
^
^2 i——*-
— -*"

* Si :a
^ tPM^r** ^^
;v t-^t roi P 7 &S
V*
B*1

1 ^ v^ r|*
n"1 N
gp
; *. *

n*l ki
o o **

*** ^
1 *vv
t** o^tG
^* **

? Sf ?
K^t
^ 0 MG

,s c

o o
r^
h- - -ACTOR 1 Y FACTOR 1
? l
-0.40 0.00 0.40 0.80 1.20 -0.40| 0.00 0.40 0.80 1.20

Figure 8. 28 b. Locations of Groups 7, 8, and 14 in Figure 8.28d. Location of Group 10 in the factor
the factor space. space.

i
BEN NEV S MflJOR S <^'/. ** 1

CO -r\ rtA MAJOR OXIDES


0
JOR OXDES o t
co *
H cc
O
o
li. if *
*-

sd ——r G 'OUJ51 1
o
U)
d
Gr OUf 1
——

1i
^
^i Sfe
P- ^
^ i?
S ^1 =: *2±1
Gr OU| ) 1t
^s
|
•^
h"
S&
•K^ris^^^s^
^*
.?u. Fi fKK, J* ^w 4 ' Or
^ ' o
Q~
*\i r^- fi*
•K-
r ' c*
2: B l\
(3ro Up 7 1 8

o
? -FrACTOR J2-
FA(:TOR i
8 -0.40 0.00 0.40 0.1JO 1.20
•-D.60 -O.W -0.20 -0.00 0.20 0.10 O.W 0.80 1.00 I.JO I.W -0.40 0.00 0.40 0.80 1.20

Figure 8.28c. Location of Group 11 in the factor Figure 8.28e. More locations of Groups 7, 8, 11,
space. and 14 in the factor space.

162
EC. GRUNSKY

pppppppppppppp'-*-T-pc\j--T-T-cvjpoop*-p
dddddo'do'ddddo'do'o'o'doddddddddd

cc
UJ
CO CDCVJLOOOOJOO'-LOOO'staJCMO^aJOOCDr^'-COCDCOOOO'-CVJO)

dx pO'-ppppppoop-'-pppppppp'-pppovjT-oo*-
o'o'dodo'o'dddo'o'do'dddo'do'dddddddd
o
UJ

CO
CO ac
O
g O
CO
h;
OOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOOO'-OO'-OO'-O
OO OO
CO 1 1 II
o
o.
o
o
UJ
c CM 0000000^00^-000^-^-00^00-^-0^-^-100^-000
ac dddddddddddddddddddddddddd-^d
i i i i i i ii ii i i it ii i
UJ

co

O
UJ or
O
O UJ ooooooooooooooooooooooooooocp
Z
cc
lil
CO CO
ui UJ
N
O
O CO
O CO

UJ
2
CO Q.
CO CO D
CO cd O
cc
UJ ui O
-J -t
m m

163
CHAPTERS

q
CO

to OO'—
o

q
co

O
O)

(O
C/)
•*^
O)

o
DC

CO
o9

g
i-
DL 0) i-^^^^ovjovidovic\id'-
GC
O
CO z
UJ
O UJ
Q.
CO
O
en
O
CO
CO
> q
<
z
5
<
c
CO
3 q
d CO

o
i
<
z
o
g
CO
A
CO
CO D.
UJ
O
03 cc
< O

164
EC. GRUNSKY

q
CO

4-
q
i

q pp'-pppppppcvji-pp'-pT^pojpirjippppppp
co d d ddd ddd dd dddd dddddddddddd dd

to p p p p p p p p p p en p p p p p p p ^-p iq p p p p o? "t oq
dddddddddddddddddddLri-^cviiriddoodoo

q
co o o o o o o o o o o o o--"-o o o o o o--o d d d d d d

O •^•CO^OOOOCOOJOOCDOCOCOLOOOCOLOCOCD^CDOOinOr-^OLOCbCM
o
q
— ' COtNCsJCJOvJCVJCOOJCvlCOCOCOlOCOincOOJOO-'itCOCJ)^}-
pppppppppppppppppppppppppppp
co d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d d do
O

"~ — d d d d d do d d d d d d d o o o o o o o o o o o o o o
Q
C
~ p O p O O ^- p O O O p O O O O O O O O "- O p O O O O O p
Z co dddddddddddddd ddd ddd dd dddd dd

co
,t 0
J2 o. d dod d oo o oddddd doddd o do o ooooo

dodddddddddddddddddddddddddd
UJ

O,
'-: dddd'-J dddddddddddd'^; ddd^ddddd

q
CO O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O O d

Q
wZ q
co" o o o o o o d o o o o o o d---o-^ o o-i-o o d o d d d o

8 q
CO
™ Z

® n
uj fL
-I ^N
CD g: '-'-•^-'-•^-•^-•^-'-•^-•^-CVJCJCgCUCMCMCvJCNJCvJ
O

165
CHAPTER 8

MAJOR OXIDES Dynamic Cluster Analysis Figure 8.29a. Geographic


TRACE ELEMENTS presentation of Group

\\ \\\ \\ >
11 (S, Cu enrichment)
and Groups 7, 8, and 14
(C02, Li, and Zn
\\\ \
xuV enrichment).

V-V 7 \S\\ Group 7 k 8

,' ^ k
\ ,^r \iJr~
GROUPS 7,8,14 - CO2,Li,Zn ENRICHMENT
GROUP 11 - S.Cu ENRICHMENT kilometers

MAJOR OXIDES

Figure 8.29b. Locations of Groups 7, 8, and 14 in Figure 8.29c. Location of Group 11 in the factor
the factor space. space.

MAJOR OXIDES

Figure 8.29(1. Locations of Groups 7,8, 11, and 14


in the factor space.

166
EC. GRUNSKY

8dddddddddddddddddddddddddddd
i i i i i i i i i i i i i ii ii
OC
Lil
CO
ID
-l
"" pp^^p^pppp^p^pppppppp T~ppp cvi'r~ c?'^
S
Vj
dli
d d dl d dII
d d d d dII
d d dl d d d dIII
d do dII
od dII
dd d
lil
U.
0 CO

g O ^^^o^^^o^o
o
^ w PPPPPPPPPP^PPPPPPPP^^^^PP^^P
ddddddddddddddddddd'-: dd"-: dd*-: d"-:
t/j rr i i i i i iii iii
O
o.
O
O OOOOOI^-CDOCvJCDOOOCOCDO'-aOCOOOCOOOaJ'^-CMCMCOOCO^J-'-
lil
P CM
OC O O O O O O O O O O 00 O 00 O 00 O O O O O O O O'- O
III l l l l l l II II l l l l l II l

O CO
Q.

o
Iii Siii
O dddoodooooooooooooooodoooQQQ

ui O
w {g
ac ui
O O N
X O co
O to
2 z
Z UI

S - a
ao ao O
ui uj 0
ffi ffi

167
CHAPTER 8

(Ooo(or^r^-o)-^--^co
ooo)ooo)O5c^(O(O-*i-

*" oO'-o\i(o-^-cocoioio(oco(^Tr-^-iot^-ooo-^-o)i^
Y- r- -r- ,- ,- Od i— -r- -i- T- -r- Od Od Od

lOCOOOdOOI^-O)OOOlOOOOdO(OlOt--TrcOOOO(^00
(OOOOlOt^-OdOOOlOOOlOOdlOI-^h-.(OOd-^-OOO(DTr
ore
^ (^-i-O)O)CO-*l-TO)-'-(^--'tO)r-Oir)'''}-*--'-OCOOd(O(OO)TOOlOh~
(DlOCOOO-r-(^-lO(OOOOOOO-tfr(Dr-- lOTfOdOO-^-T-LOI^-Tj-l^. IO-.-

q
CO

•rr-r-OCOCOlOOJ(DOO)OOOOOdlOOt^O)OOOO-^OOOOO
r^ to *— (O(^-*r-'i-odiooiooo(or^-O''*-cooooo-'— ooooo
oC3)
2 lOh~OdN-(O-^-OOh-COOdOOlOOOOOdOOd-^Oh~'-t^-^-OOTl-lOCO'^-
IO T Tf Od h- IO OO OOOO-*lOlO-^--^-Od-^-(OOO'-'^-OdT-O)-^-00'-

Od OO (D *— (O 00 IO CO to
fTt *— m m m r^ m ef*i f~*i
q
"^ Q -* w vw w wu IM uj ^- w ^ u^ vw i*/ u^ w VM -^ — I-M ^- ^r

2 CNJ T- T- T- ,- Od

o
H
<

Q— ^~ O)OO)'-lO(DO)'-O-^-(D'-O(OOOOOOOd-VOdOa)O)-^-T-lOOOO
1010-^-00-^1^-101000-^0010(01000-^0004(^(^0010-^-00-^-^0010

o
z
h-
co q
00 CO
CO
lil
D
— o --— ,..^..-. ^co-r-ooo'troococooooooooooo
Z *J '-"•S"-— lO-tOdO)(OOT-"3-OOlOOOOOCD-'l-lOOPOOOOOOO
p
- ^ d)
U. LULL OOaDO(OCOlOOOOOCO'-O)(DO)O)CO(^O)OO)r^CO'fl-(OO)T-'^-'-O)
g 2 OO-^Od'- Od -*- i- Od-^-r- T- -r-T-^^OOOO OdOO *-
o
CO
111 cpcocp(pcpcpoop5p(i-oooooooO'-(^-^(DipT-o
o
3
o
p
w
cc
c
CO OOOOOCOI^OOOO(OO(O(DOOOOOI^-^OdOOOOOO)OOOOOO
— -TcoooodOJCO-^ppooN.oop-^pasr^iqpooooodpppppp
^f Q o'co'cpcpod-^Kcpo'^-^oo'ocoui^-^couoooooTrooQ'o'p'cJ
v^ J?
^ rf OOOOCO(--lOO)-^-(OCOOOOlOT-OOdlO(DOdCO-^t-(OCOOO(^lO(^OdlO
2 (D(O(DlOOOlOlOTrOO(DlOlOTl-Tl-Od(DTLO(DOdOdlOlO(OO)LOO
<
cc
UJ
CO Q

3 .
— *" (^••-••-OOr--lOOdlO-.-OOOdOlOlOlOO(D"*lOO)^f(Q
O -r-OdOdOdOdOOOO(^OOOO(DOO-^OOOOOO-C-OOOdO)-^-lO

o
2 (^OOT-COOdCOOTOCOO)OOOOOlOI-^CO-'frOI-^(^-'*OOOOOO
^ ino)co-^;(D-r-T-o)p^;if)i^incnc\j(Di- -^;io(ocO'-pppppo
Z ^ oi(doo'^T-'a3-v'-^irJoooN-odoo(d(d-^-^i^(D(b(~--'oc3OOO
^^ •— ^" O) CO ^— C5 Od ^^ O) C5 (O (O ^T ^ -^ ^- C5 Od ^ IO h-- OO '— Od *^- O) Od CO
O co
Jo
•^
06 a
*" 2 •^OdOOTj-lOCO(--COO)O'-OdOO-^-UO(O(^-COO)O-^OdOO'^-lO(O(-~CO
O T--r-T--^-T--^i--r-^^OdOOOdOdOdOOOOOOOd
3 w

168
E.G. GRUNSKY

cMOO)cpcocMr^-cpcooc\i'*ocMCOcDcpCMrocpcpTr

D 000 — CD — — . --^ . . . . -- --
^ inooocnin-'tr^ioocnininoocDN.inin — — incMoo

O ' pcMCDpocoooooi^-'sr- —
o
T}- Tj- CM CM CO CD 00 — h- IT)T-

CO 00 00 CO CNJ IO CO T— 00 CNJ CD ^f h^ CO CM CD F^ CO CD 00 "^" 00


p in p T oq — cq— p CM cq — — •^cnoqcMh-.oocqpppppppp
o ^CNJin^oDQDCppuicoT*'—cop^fcp^oiooinirioooooo
^\ CD O^ O) ~ - -— . .
. CM — —
CO

COLD — TfCMaoini-^ocoinooocDOoocoCTioooh-ajoooooo
OicooD'— CNJ — ino)poocpr--mh--poo — oppcocDCNipppppp
f\ CD CJ) 00 ^" CD CO 00 CO CO f*~ f^* f^ CM ^" IO 00 **~ CO m 00 CD ^ CO CO CO CO CO CO
;t TTini^CM'— COO)r~-OO'— — CD — OI^OO^COCMPOCD— OOOOOO
CM CO CO 1^~ ^" ^" CM CM CD CO CD CO UT) ^3" m CO CO m T— CO 1^* CO CO CO O} CM CO *—
— — — ^-^^ T- — — — — — — — — — CM —

uoopincqcp — rrpa)- pcnin — CM — •^CMOIOO^OOOOOO


O g
co q

O
O500 — •^•h-OCNJ-'J-O- — COO— OCO-^-CDOOOOO-^rOOOOOO
cocMcoooinp-'S;C7)pcD-^;ooini~-;pcocMo\ipoooo — pppppp
^-rvlcoo^o^T— iricMO)00i~~mmooaoo5UDOooot^.oooooo
Qw TTCNJO— ini^-CNJ— in— — CMOO— lOO- OOO-*r^-CMCMQOOOCM
Q 0-
o:
O
Z oo ooojincDCM
in— cotoco'tococDcooooooo
mcMinocDCNjinin — oocnr^in—
CO Q
^^ O) CO CO CD CO *"- CXJ C\J C7) C\J 0^ CO
00 CO CM — — — — 00 — 00 — — CM— — — CSJ — CM
CO
UJ
3

> COOOOCTJ —
20
OO5CT)CDCOC\ICX5QOCOQOCOCf)OOOOC\JCOir)^

— pcqppCNip — — pppppp
ooaboCT)'*t: c6i~--irir^CT)iricoo6o-^: oooooo
cDcooomo —

p oo
h~.OOCDI^ — OOOOOt^-cnOOOCD — — COOOO — OOOOOO

— CDCMO)OT)TTCNJCMCDinOOCOI^COr^-a)- — COCO

o
lil
ocNooin-tmcocoocn

o
o
O5-VTJ-TJ-CVJ-

00
UJ
-l CMCMCMCMCMCMCMCMCM
m

169
CHAPTER 8

COCOCOLOGOCMOO^OOCOCO'^'N-COt*-*— 05 Is- lO O t"-


ci T— (O CD O) CD CD ^3" CO O) CO CN CD ^" ID OO CO CO CD f*1- CD t^* CO CD CD CD CD CD CD

CO
c^u^r^^^r^^S^c^^co^co^c^coiSc^i8cRS c' C' cic' C' c'
f- CO ^ ^t CO

CMCDincDCTJooo^i-OTrror^oocMOOcO'r-cooin'^-oooooo
s CMTr-^CMOOCOTj-t^CvlOCOCMCOCDO-ninCOCOCO'-^cnOOOOO
O ?SSS^S^in^SScocnin^^incM5"f5coc?LOcocMo"
T— ^ CO T- O) CM T—

inCMf--O)*— OOOO}COt~-O5h~CO^'^'CDT— O)'— t^ T— ^"OOOOOO


Q
CO ^" m ^f co o) ^j" to m ^~ ^^ co cxj "^ co *~~ in c^ CM co

CT)oor~--V'-ino)OTj-cocDr^-oo5incDCMO5CDCoincooooooo
T-T-mCMO)N-COCO-V'-OOOt-CMCD-^OOOOCO|-~-COOOOOOO
k.
o CMwr-^ S^f- coino-,- co CM - o co co m - v OT co CM co

/••K

Q .
COO ScMS2cM^^^inf5oco2cM^o2o5Seo^cooooooo
IT!-^: iniriCMh-'lri'— CM^rCM^-^-COCMlrih^CMt^CMlriCDOOOcJoO
CO i- t- CM T—

0
H

5
UJ O
incD^o^^o^^cooocMoooco^^^cof-in^-oooooo
CO C^ CO in ^^ ^~~ O) CO CM CO CO xj* CO CM CO O5 ^f ^" '— CD CM ^- C^ C^ C3 CO CO CD
DO cncDtO'*coco^CM^ooo)mcococo*-'-cDr^incMO)incocoooco
CMCMCM'- COCMCM CM'-CMCMCM CM'- CM'-'-CMinT-OOCO'-CM
D
CC
D
Z

co d r^^co^cMtowi^^cocoiKinScMcoo^co^^Soooooo
e0 CO 555^COCOCJ5CO^CDC^COc5cOC?^^CO?!S?o5cO CiOOOC:' 0
T-T- T- T- T- ^ CMCM*-1-*-
CO
UJ
D

in-^-i^-cocninin'-inco'tfCMincMCMO'-oooh-.O'-oooooo
cocococDinincor-r-cjiocMCMCDtoo^h-ocooh-oooooo
52
*t CD COCMOr^.-^'OCDCO'^-COCMCDCOr^OOCDI^-incOOI^-OOOOOO
^u nj ^T ttJ ^* m "^ -*' i^ ^" -Jj c\j t^ r^- uj LIJ cxj ^"~ uj CM ^~~ "J UJ ^o UJ ttj CD CM
UJ
2

c7)i^coo)i^inh-'ircMoocoh-er)-^-O'^-'-'-ocoh-.-^
ci Sr^^c5c?c^co^c^Sc^cBc^^c^cSc5cS^c^oc^^ c' cicicic'
CO
^S^^c^S^^So^Sc^SInS^S^^S

co ^^ O5 tSh- co f*** ^~ f***- C3 c\i co O) ^D C5 c^ c^ co ^~ co co co r*-- c^ c^ o CD CD CD


•^ cO ^~ CD f*** CM CO O) lO LO ^~ CO CD ^~ CD CD LO ^' CD CO CO LO CD CD CD CD CD CD
+
O co^^^S^CM^coin^coocoocMCMoScococMoooSoo
cocDcocMCMCMcocMcococococoincO'-inin-^-cocoocooinco^co
I T-h-T-cocoin^toO'-CMOcncO'-inr^-cMO'^-cocoinoocoincocoO)
COCMCO^ COCOCM'-COCMCMCOCO'-CMCM'--VCM'-CMCM TTTT^-T-

h~r~-oo-c-^-ooinincocO'-cO'-cno5ooh-h--co in-^-
D coinoo5ino^h--inincnci)CJjCMCJjcococj)ro *— o
. CO -*in'-oocMoots--incocooDor^.r^ocoococo coco
Q •^- CM evil- -^ *- CM in in
UJ
3
Z
t- r^r--coooTrcMcot^-ocomT)-oinoooojOOCor^-oooooo
cocM-^-cMoooO'-ojinTrco^inoinooinoocoinoooooo
oo)ocot--T-inocMOh-.Ti-cMOjr--oocMinococooooooo
0 CO •fl'CD'^-aiCOCO-^-l^-'-COi-Tl-CO'-COT-OCnCMOCOCMOOOOOO
o CMCMininCMCOCOOTCOCOCOin'^in^^TCOCM-'— OCDCMO"^'— CMCMT—
O) *— O CO O O CJl^OO
.d in ^- CM in co co

09
UJ
a
3 ••-CMCo-*mcD^roo)O'r-CMCo^mcDr^coo)OT-CMooTj-incois-oQ
CD 2 T-^-'T--r-^-^-^-^^T-CMCMCMCMCMCMCMCMC\l

< o
i-

170
EC. GRUNSKY

0'
CO co in TT ^ ^ in co in w ri co co in TJ-co Ti-CD K-a-- cb co

- -. , , - — - — — -^ - -^ ^

q ^ ^
CO

C^CNicNJC^COC^^C^COCNC^CNJ^^C^CMCNJCO^COCVICSJ^^^^CVi^

q
CO

q
CO
co -^ cocor^oinc)a)C\icoc)C\jc\i^cbiricpcprT0^tf?™QOOOOin
^m ^ Is** If) h*- O) *-~ O5 ^" C^ *— O^ O) lO C\J CNJ

g
H
^

Sq
tr
Q
Z

cow
08
CO
UJ

c\i^c\icjcbcDCDC\ic\icoc\jcDco6c\icocooxrco
T— r— T- CO CO CO

UJ
2
N oocor^(^^^c\i^Tr^r^O)C\io)Tri---a)inTrc\ic\icbcD'*co cSo
*- T- T- T-CM CNJCM O)'-

d
.2
.'~-
COCJIMCNJ inCO-V CJTTCOCNJT- COCM

c^ oo co r^- *~ CD c^ r^- *— ^- ^~
^M c^ in c^ o^ co co cvj CD co ^H- ^* c^ in o)
Z^-O)O)co cooi^- h-inoooo

h~C\Jh-C\ICDCOCOO)CMOOI^-COCOCOOO)COCMCOh-O

Q Q ^irico'^^i^r^Tr^'cri^^r^oodiricNi^^cDCNiiriocJcDOOO
UJ CO
3
Z
f-
O

J3

i s
-. O ^-T-^'-'-r-T-T-^^rgcacvicgcMCMCMCNjcNi
00 O

171
CHAPTERS

REFERENCES Irvine, T.N., and Baragar, W.R.A.


1971: A Guide to the Chemical Classification of the
Beswick, A.E.
Common Volcanic Rocks; Canadian Journal of
1981: Regional Alteration in Archean Greenstones:
Earth Sciences, Volume 8, p.523-546.
Application to Exploration for Massive Sulphide
Deposits; Grant 58, p.25-37 in Geoscience Re Jambu, M., and Lebeaux, M.O.
search Grant Program, Summary of Research, 1983: Cluster Analysis and Data Analysis; North-Hol
1980-81, edited by E.G. Pye, Ontario Geological land Publishing Company, New York, 898p.
Survey, Miscellaneous Paper 98, 340p. Jensen, LS.
Beswick, A.E., and Soucie, G. 1975: Geology of Clifford and Ben Nevis Townships,
1978: A Correction Procedure for Metasomatism in an District of Cochrane; Ontario Division of Mines,
Archean Greenstone Belt; Precambrian Research, Geoscience Report 132. 55p. Accompanied by
Volume 6, p.235-248. Map 2283, scale 1 inch to 1/2 mile.
1976: A New Cation Plot for Classifying Subalkalic
David, M., Dagbert, M., and Beauchemin, Y.
1977: Statistical Analysis in Geology: Correspon Volcanic Rocks; Ontario Division of Mines, Mis
cellaneous Paper 66, 22p.
dence Analysis Method; Quarterly Journal of the
Colorado School of Mines, Volume 72, Number 1. Joreskog, K.G., Klovan, J.E., and Reyment, R.A.
60p. 1976: Geological Factor Analysis: Elsevier Scientific
Publishing Company, 178p.
Deptuck, R., Squair, H., and Wierzbicki, V.
1982: Geology of the Detour Zinc-Copper Deposits, Lebart, L, Morineau, A., Warwick, K.M.,
Broullia Township, Quebec; p.319-342 in Precam 1984: Multivariate Descriptive Statistical Analysis,
brian Sulphide Deposits, H.S. Robinson Memorial Correspondence and Related Techniques for
Volume, edited by R.W. Hutchinson, C.D. Spence, Large Matrices; John Wiley and Sons, 231 p.
and J.M. Franklin, Geological Association of Knuckey, M.J., and Watkins, J.J.
Canada, Special Paper Number 25, 791 p. 1982: The Geology of the Corbet Massive Sulphide
Diday, E. Deposit Noranda District, Quebec; p.297-318 in
1973: The Dynamic Clusters Method in Non-Hierar- Precambrian Sulphide Deposits, H.S. Robinson
chial Clustering; International Journal of Com Memorial Volume, edited by R.W. Hutchinson,
puter and Information Sciences, Volume 2. p. C.D. Spence, and J.M. Franklin, Geological Asso
61-88. ciation of Canada, Special Paper Number 25,
791 p.
Franklin, J.M., and Thorpe, R.I.
1982: Comparative Metallogeny of the Superior, Slave Knuckey, M.J., Comba, C.D.A., and Riverin, G.
and Churchill Provinces; p.3-90 in Precambrian 1982: Structure, Metal Zoning and Alteration at the
Sulphide Deposits, H.S. Robinson Memorial Vol Millenbach Deposit, Noranda, Quebec; p.255-296
ume, edited by R.W. Hutchinson, C.D. Spence, in Precambrian Sulphide Deposits, H.S. Robinson
and J.M. Franklin, Geological Association of Memorial Volume, edited by R.W. Hutchinson,
Canada, Special Paper Number 25, 791 p. C.D. Spence, and J.M. Franklin, Geological Asso
ciation of Canada, Special Paper Number 25,
Gelinas, L, Brooks, C., Perrault, G., Carignan, J.,
791 p.
Trudel, P., and Grasso, F.
1977: Chemo-Stratigraphic Divisions Within the Abitibi Lavin, O.P.
Volcanic Belts Rouyn-Noranda District, Quebec; 1976: Lithogeochemical Discrimination Between Min
p.265-295 in Volcanic Regimes in Canada, edited eralized and Unmineralized Cycles of Volcanism
by W.R.A. Baragar, L.C. Coleman, and J.M. Hall, in the Sturgeon Lake and Ben Nevis Areas of the
Geological Association of Canada, Special Paper Canadian Shield; Unpublished M.Sc.Thesis,
Number 16, 476p. Queen's University, 249p.
Gibson, H.L, Watkinson, D.H., and Comba, C.D.A. Lefebvre, D., and David, M.
1983: Silicification: Hydrothermal Alteration in an Ar 1977: Dynamic Clustering and Strong Patterns Rec
chean Geothermal System Within the Amulet ognition: New Tools in Automatic Classification;
Rhyolite Formation, Noranda, Quebec; Economic Canadian Journal of Earth Sciences, Volume 14,
Geology, Volume 78, p.954-971. Number 10, p.2232-2246.
Gresens, R. L. Macdonald, A.J.
1967: Composition-Volume Relationships of 1983: A Re-Appraisal of the Geraldton Gold Camp;
Metasomatism; Chemical Geology, Volume 2, p. 194-197 in Summary of Field Work, 1983, by
p.47-65. the Ontario Geological Survey, edited by John
Wood, Owen L. White, R.B. Barlow, and A.C. Col
Grunsky, E.C. vine, Ontario Geological Survey, Miscellaneous
In Press: Statistical Techniques for the Recognition of
Paper 116, 313p.
Alteration in Volcanic Rocks in the Abitibi Belt,
Ontario; Ontario Geological Survey, Study. MacGeehan, P.J., and MacLean, W.H.
1980: An Archean Sub-seafloor Geothermal System,
Hill, M.O.
"Calc-Alkali" Trends, and Massive Sulphide De
1974: Correspondence Analysis: A Neglected Mul
posits; Nature, Volume 286, p.767-771.
tivariate Method, Applied Statistics, Volume 23,
Number 3, p.340.

172
EC. GRUNSKY

Mellinger, Michel Sopuck r V.J.


1984: Evaluation of Lithogeochemical Data by Use of 1977: A Lithogeochemical Approach in the Search for
Multivariate Analysis: An Application to the Ex- Areas of Felsic Volcanic Rocks Associated with
ploration for Uranium Deposits in the Athabaska Mineralization in the Canadian Shield; Unpublish-
Basin of Saskatchewan, Canada, in Applications ed Ph.D. Thesis, Queen's University, 296p.
of Computers and Mathematics in the Mineral sopuck, V.J., Lavin, O.P., and Nichol, l.
Industries, 18th. International Symposium, Institu- 1980; Lithogeochemistry as a Guide to Identify
tion of Mining and Metallurgy. Favourable Areas for the Discovery of Vol-
Pearce, T.H. canogenic Massive Sulphide Deposits; Canadian
1969: A Contribution to the Theory of Variation Dia- Institute of Mining and Metallurgy Bulletin, Vol-
grams; Contributions to Mineralogy and Petrology, ume 73, Number 823, p. 152-166.
Volume 19, p. 142-147. Studemeister. P.A.
Riverin. G., and Hodgson. C.J. 1983: The Redox State of Iron. A Powerful Indicator of
1980: Wall-Rock Alteration at the Millenbach Cu-Zn Hydrothermal Alteration; Geoscience Canada,
Mine, Noranda, Quebec; Economic Geology, Vol- Volume 10, Number 4, p. 189-194.
ume 75, p.424-444. je jl N.
Rose, A.W., and Burt, D.M. 1975: Correspondence Factor Analysis: An Outline of
1979: Hydrothermal Alteration in Geochemistry of Hy- its Method; Mathematical Geology, Volume 7,
drothermal Ore Deposits; edited by H.L. Banes, Number 1, p.3-12.
John Wiley and Sons, 798p. Urabe T and Sato T
Sampson, R.J. 1978: Kuroko Deposits of the Kosaka Mine, Northeast
1975: Surface II Graphics System; Revision One Hanshu, Japan-Products of Submarine Hot
(1978), Kansas Geological Survey, 240p. Springs on Miocene Sea Floor; Economic Geol-
Sangster, D.F, and Scott, S.D. W- Volume 73 ' P-161-179.
1976: Precambrian Massive Cu-Zn-Pb Sulphide Ores Wolfe, W.J.
of North America, p. 129-222 in Handbook of 1977: Geochemical Exploration of Early Precambrian
Stratabound and Stratiform Ore Deposits, edited Sulphide Mineralization in Ben Nevis Township,
by K.H. Wolf, Elsevier, Volume 6. District of Cochrane; Ontario Geological Survey,
Study 19, 39p.

173
Index
Aa flows ............................................................................ 9 Ash cloud surge......................,.................................... 19
Abitibi Belt................................................................. 43,45 Ash-flows ................................................................ 19,113
Western Part, types of mineralization.................... 70 Plinian.....,.............................................................. 119
Abitibi Subprovince ............... 69,74,81,83,107,109-111 Assays:
Mineralization ............................................................ 84 Gold ...............................................................,......... 126
Adams Mine ............................................................ 77,116 Silver........................................................................... 66
Adams River Bay........................................................... 53 Autoclastic rocks .....................................,................... 11
Age dating: Autoclastic volcanic breccia..................................,... 13
Carbonate beds ........................................................ 91
Cycle l ........................................................................ 96 Baird Township .........................,............................ 94,95
Deloro Group ........................................................ 71,82 Balmertown ............................................................... 94-96
Felsic pyroclastic rocks ...................................... 93,94 Balmertown-Cochenour area ................................. 94,95
Felsic volcanics ........................................................ 91 Bamaji-Fry Lakes area .......,........................................ 99
Helen iron range ....................................................... 66
Hunter Mine Group ................................................... 72 Barite...................................................................... 114,115
Kidd Creek Rhyolites........................................... 72,82 Barium............................................................................ 14
Pacaud Tuffs ............................................................. 72 Barium-gold mineralization,,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,,. 115
Radiometric dating............................................... 45,55 Basaltic flood eruption ,,.,.,,,,,,,.,.,,,,.,,,.,,,,, 6
Red Lake Belt ....................................................... 91,96 Basalts ,,,,,,,,.,,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,.,,.,,.,,,,,,,., 94
Southern sequence, Red Lake Belt........................ 96
Stromatolitic carbonate unit.................................... 93 Base surge ,,,.,,,,,,,,,,.,,,,.,..,,,.,,.,,,,,,,, 19
Upper Formation ....................................................... 82 Base-metal ,,,,,.,,,,,.,,,,,.,,.,,,.,,.,,,,,,,.,, 74
Upper Supergroup..................................................... 71 Deposits ,,.,,,,,,.,,,,.,,,,.,,.,.,,,.,.,,,,, 74,91
Uranium-lead zircon ................................................. 58 Deposits, potential ,,,,,,,.,,,.,.,,.,,,,,,,,,,, 85
Volcanic activity........................................................ 99 Deposits, Sturgeon Lake,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 46
Wabewawa-Catherine-Skead Mineralization ,,,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 74,8
Supergroup ................................................................ 71 Mineralization, potential ,,,.,,,.,,,,,,,.,,,,.,.
Albite-epidote hornfels facies .................................. 127 Bedding thickness terms ,,,,,,,,,.,.,,,,,.,,,,,
Alexo Deposit ................................................................ 81 Bell Allard orebody ,,,.,,,,,,,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,., 43
Algal mats, laminated................................................... 45 Berry Lake ,,,,,.,.,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,,,., 35,54
Allard Anticline .............................................................. 43 Berry Lake Stock.,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 53
Alloclastic rocks ............................................................ 11 Berry River ,.,,.,,,,,,,.,,,,,,,.,,,,,,.,,,,,,,,, 54
Alloclastic volcanic breccia ........................................ 13 Berry River formation ,,,,,,,,,,,, 34,35,53,54,58,60
Alteration: Radiometric age ,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,,,.,.,.,.,,, 54
Effects ...................................................................... 147 Bimodal succession ,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,.,,,.,,,,, 94
Haloes ...................................................................... 125 Bimodal volcanic cycles ,,,.,,,,,,,,,,,.,,.,,.,, 109
Immobile component.............................................. 147 Birch Lake ,,,,,,,.,,,,.,,,,,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 99,100
Patterns .................................................................... 147 Birch-Uchi-Confederation Lakes area ,,,.,,,,,,,, 99
Pipe........................................................................... 125
Black Lake volcanics ,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,.,,,, 53,54
Amulet rhyolite .............................................................. 36
Blake River Group ,,,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,, 71,72,75,77,78,
Amygdules ........................................................ 9,126-128 84,85,108,109,126,127
Analyses: Blake River synclinorium ,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,.,,.,,,, 127
Archean volcanic facies.......................................... 32
Cluster..................................................... 125, 155, 161 Bobjo Prospect ,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,,,,,.,,,, 114
Major element............................................................ 54 Boston Township ,,,,,.,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,.,.,,,,,,., 77
Markov Chain ............................................................ 44 Bouma Sequences ,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 35
Andalusite ...................................................................... 94 Breccia:
Ankerite ........................................................................ 127 Characteristics ,,,.,,,.,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,,,,., 20
Anomalous zones, criteria for location.................... 161 Mafic ,,.,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,,,.,,,.,,.,,,,,.,.,,,,, 65
Phreatic ,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 24
Anticlinorium.................................................................. 90 Pyroclastic ,,,,,,,,.,,,,,,,,,.,,,.,,,,,,, 5,32,33
Red Lake ............................................................... 95,96 Tuff,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 33
Antigorite ........................................................................ 83 Units,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 128
Archean composite cone............................................. 53 Volcanic ,,,,,,,,,,,.,,.,,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 13
Archean cyclical volcanism ...................................... 108 Bryce Township ,.,,,,,.,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,,,,,,., 32,35
Archean island volcanic system, model...................... 8 Bug Lake ,,,,,.,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,.,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 53
Archean stromatolites .................................................. 44
Table........................................................................... 45 Cadmium ,,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,,.,,,,.,,..,,.,,,.,,,.,, 75
Armit Lake ...................................................................... 58 Calc-alkalic flows ,,,,,,,,,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,,, 54
Asbestos ............................................................. 74,83-85 Calc-alkalic unit ,,,,.,,,,,,,,,,,,,.,,,.,,,,,.,, 107
Location...................................................................... 75 Calc-alkalic volcanic rocks, origin ,.,.,,,,,,.,,,,, 77
Ash................................................................................. 14

175
VOLCANOLOGY AND MINERAL DEPOSITS

Caldera: Confederation Lake........................... 90,91,94,108,109.


Collapse ................................................................... 119 111-116,118,119
Cycle.......................................................... 105,113,117 Contacts:
Cycle model...................................................... 118,119 Deloro-Porcupine Groups ........................................ 72
Forming eruptions ................................................... 117 Endogeneous quartz-feldspar porphyry
Structure ..................................................................... 97 dome - associated dome-collapse talus
Valles ........................................................................ 117 deposit...................................................................... 116
Cameron Lake ............................................................... 58 Felsic volcanics-sedimentary rocks ...................... 72
Canadian Shield.......................................................... 108 Komatiitic flows-sediments ..................................... 74
Canagau Mines ............................................ 128,129,147 Timiskaming-Kinojevis-Blake River
Groups ........................................................................ 72
Canagau Mines Deposit...................... 125,127,152,161
Contour diagrams ....................................................... 129
Canagau Mines Property .......................................... 152
Contour plots ............................................................... 152
CaO enrichment.......................................................... 155
Convective cells ......................................................... 118
Carbonate .................................................................... 127
Beds, age dating ....................................................... 91 Copper............................................................. 66,118,119
Complex ..................................................................... 63 Copper-lead-zinc deposits .......................................... 84
Facies iron formation ............................................... 65 Copper-zinc deposit ..................................................... 90
Units............................................................................ 91 South Bay-type .......................................................... 97
Carbonatization ........................................................... 127 Copper-zinc-gold deposit .......................................... 116
Effects ............................................................... 147,149 Copper-zinc-lead sulphide deposits,
Carbonatized komatiitic flows .................................... 81 location ........................................................................... 75
Catherine Group............................................................ 78 Corbel Mine .............................................................. 35,36
Cauldron: Geology ...................................................................... 36
Megacauldron............................ 70,72,74,77,80,82,84 Corless Lake.................................................................. 99
Central facies ........................................................... 23,26 Correlation:
Central Synclinorium .................................................... 72 Precision .................................................................... 46
Central vent composite volcano: Techniques, table ..................................................... 43
Facies variation......................................................... 26 Volcanic rocks, problems ........................................ 41
Products ..................................................................... 28 Correspondence analysis................................... 125,152
Central vent facies rocks ............................................ 78 Discussion ............................................................... 149
Major oxides ............................................................ 150
Central Volcanic Belt.................................................... 54 Major oxides and trace elements ......................... 159
Chabanel Township...................................................... 63 Creede caldera ........................................................... 118
Chalcopyrite ..................................................... 68,82,126 Crow (Kakagi) Lake...................................................... 51
Chemically zoned magma chambers ...................... 105 Croxall Property.............. 125,126,128,129,152,155,161
Chert ............................................................................. 115 Cycle Four...................................................................... 66
Chlorite ......................................................................... 126 Cycle l............................................................. 95,96,98,99
Origin ........................................................................ 127 Age dating.................................................................. 96
Chromite ......................................................................... 82 Rocks, targets for gold ............................................. 98
Chromium ....................................................................... 94 Cycle II........................... 91,93,94,96,97,99,109,110,116
Classification: Cycle III....................... 91,93,96,97,99,108-114,116,119
Extrusive volcanic rocks............................................. 8 Formation K ...................................................... 113,114
Fragment shape ........................................................ 18 Formation L............................................... 113,116,117
Fragment type ...................................................... 17,18 Formation M ............................................................. 113
Grain size .............................................................. 12,17 Cycles:
Granulometric, pyroclastic rocks............................ 13 Felsic volcanic rocks ............................................... 65
Schemes, problems ................................................ 149 Major cycles ............................................................ 106
Schemes, volcanic rocks ...................................... 147 Mini-cycles.......................................................... 91,106
Volcanic eruptions ....................................................... 6 Minor cycles ............................................................ 106
Volcanic fragmental rocks ................................. 11,13
Cyclical volcanism ..................................................... 105
Clifford Stock............................................................... 127
Cyclicity......................................................... 107,108,112
Cluster analysis ........................................... 125,155,161 Mineral deposits, relationship............................... 105
Component-factor coordinates ................................. 149
Factor 1 .................................................................... 155 Debris flow..................................................................... 12
Factor 2 .................................................................... 155 Deformation zones:
Factor 3 .................................................................... 155 Pipestone Bay-St. Paul Bay ..................................... 95
Factor 4 .................................................................... 155 Post Narrows ............................................................. 97
Factor 5 .................................................................... 155
Deloro Group ....................................................... 71,72,78
Composite dikes ......................................................... 119 Age dating............................................................. 71,82
Concentration of metals .............................................. 77 Deloro Township ........................................................... 83
Conceptual models..................................................... 116

176
VOL CANOL OG Y AND MINERAL DEPOSITS

Deposits: Extrusive deposits ........................................................... 5


Explosive/Pyroclastic ................................................. 5 Extrusive volcanic rocks, classification ....................... 8
Extrusive........................................................................ 5
Ross lode ................................................................... 84 Facies ............................................................................ 5,8
Destor-Porcupine Fault Zone ........... 70,72,79-81,83-85 Albite-epidote hornfels .......................................... 127
Diabase dikes........................................................... 63,71 Analysis................................................................... 4,21
Diapir, mantle ........................................................... 70,72 Central................................................................... 23,26
Distal...................................................................... 24,26
Dikes: Epiclastic................................................................... 24
Composite ................................................................ 119 Greenschist field criteria ......................................... 25
Diabase ................................................................. 63,71 Models................................................................ 5,21,31
Lamprophyre ............................................................. 63 Prehnite-pumpellyite .............................................. 127
Diorite, quartz sill .......................................................... 36 Proximal................................................................. 24,26
Dirtywater Lake ............................................................. 53 Subgreenschist ......................................................... 71
Discriminant function analysis ................................. 149 Variation in central vent composite
Distal deposited pyroclastic rocks ............................. 35 volcano....................................................................... 26
Variation in shield volcano ..................................... 27
Distal facies .............................................................. 24,26 Vent........................................................................ 23,26
Dogpaw Lake................................................................. 53 Zeolite....................................................................... 127
Dogtooth Lake volcanics ............................................. 53 Facing indicator, consistent facies
Dolomite ................................................................ 127,147 variation.......................................................................... 65
Dome Stock.................................................................... 96 Factor coordinate positions....................................... 161
Doming, resurgent....................................................... 118 Factored space ........................................................... 155
Double-graded sequence ............................................ 30 Faults:
Dryberry Batholith ......................................................... 53 Porcupine-Destor Break ........................................... 45
Dryberry Lake ................................................................ 53 Pipestone-Cameron .................................. 52,63,58,60
Dryden .......................................................................... 110 Favourable Lake area ................................................ 109
Dunraine Mines Ltd....................................................... 68 Favourable Lake Belt ................................................... 99
Duprat-Montbray Complex ......................................... 108 Favourable suites for mineralization ......................... 84
Dynamic Cluster Analysis .......................... 125,155,161 Fe-tholeiitic flows ......................................................... 55
Feldspar porphyries ..................................................... 60
Eastern Peninsula ......................................................... 53 Felsic flows:
Eigenvalues ................................................................. 149 Porphyritic .................................................................. 25
Eigenvectors ................................................................ 149 Pyroclastic ................................................................. 26
Eleanor iron range ........................................................ 63 Felsic metatuff .............................................................. 25
Elk Lake.......................................................................... 32 Felsic pyroclastic rocks, age dating ..................... 93,94
English River.................................................................. 50 Felsic volcanic rocks, cycles...................................... 65
Environment, factor in volcanism.................................. 7 Felsic volcanics, age dating ....................................... 91
Epiclastic facies ............................................................ 24 Felsic volcanism, hiatuses ........................................ 115
Epiclastic rocks ............................................................. 35 Ferruginous dolomite ................................................... 65
Epiclastic volcanic breccia ......................................... 13 Flavrian andesite .......................................................... 36
Epigenetic model .......................................................... 81 Flin Flon........................................................................ 111
Eruptions: Flows:
Basaltic flood ............................................................... 6 Breccias, photo ......................................................... 23
Hawaiian ....................................................................... 6 Carbonatized komatiitic ........................................... 81
Magmatic....................................................................... 5 Mafic........................................................................... 31
Phreatic (steam)....................................................... 5,6 Magnetite-bearing..................................................... 65
Phreatomagmatic ..................................................... 5,6 Morphology ................................................................ 11
Plinian............................................. 6,113,115,116,118 Aa lava .............................................................. 10,11
Strombolian................................................................... 6 Pahoehoe lava ................................................. 10,11
Sub-Plinian.................................................................... 6 Pillowed lava .................................................... 10,11
Surtseyan ...................................................................... 5 Near vent.................................................................... 74
Vulcanian ...................................................................... 6 Porphyritic felsic ....................................................... 25
Unit................................................................................. 8
Eruptive centre .............................................................. 97 Concept..................................................................... 7
Eruptive mechanisms ...................................................... 5 Fluorine......................................................................... 119
Evolution of Western Abitibi Subprovince ................ 72 Fly Lake........................................................................ 113
Exhalative models of iron formation.......................... 78 Folding and faulting, relationship to
Exploration: volcanism ....................................................................... 70
Implications................................................................ 37 Fractional crystallization............................................ 111
Targets........................................................................ 97
Fragment shape ............................................................ 13
Explosive/Pyroclastic deposits ..................................... 5

177
VOLCANOLOGY AND MINERAL DEPOSITS

Fragmental composition ........................................ 13, 14 Heyson Township ......................................................... 96


Fragmentation, types.................................................... 11 Hiatuses ....................................................................... 114
Fuchsite..................................................................... 80,83 Felsic volcanism ..................................................... 115
Stratigraphic ........................................................... 113
Gabbro, peridotite sill.................................................. 83 Hill-Sloan-Tivey quartz horizon ................................ 115
Galena .......................................................................... 125 Hollinger deposit........................................................... 79
Garrison lode deposit................................................... 84 Holloway Township ...................................................... 79
Garrison Stock ............................................................... 83 Hope Lake...................................................................... 60
Garrison Township................................................... 83 50 Hot spring activity ......................................................... 36
Geochemistry .............................................................. 129 Hoyles Bay................................................................ 91,93
Lithogeochemical information, Hunter Mine Group................................... 63,72,75,77,78
interpretation ........................................................... 161 Age dating.................................................................. 72
Lithogeochemistry, sample sources .................... 128 Huronian Supergroup ................................................... 71
Geophysical correlation ............................................... 45 Hyaloclastics, photo ..................................................... 23
Gibi Lake volcanics ................................................. 53,54 Hydrothermal alteration ............................................. 114
Glomeroporphyritic horizon......................................... 43 Hydrothermal circulation system................................ 37
Gold............................. 60,74,75,79,83,112,114-116,125 Hydrothermal solutions ................................................ 75
Gold deposits .............................................. 68,83,85,110 Hydrothermal system ................................................. 114
Lode.................................................................. 81,84,85
Types ...................................................................... 74 Ignimbrite ...................................................... 116,118,119
Model.......................................................................... 79 Pumice........................................................................ 19
Stratigraphy, relationship......................................... 98
Stratiform............................................................... 78,80 Immobile component, alteration effects.................. 147
Gold exploration............................................................ 58 "Immobility" variable ................................................. 147
Gold mineralization: Indicators of mineralization....................................... 161
Location...................................................................... 83 Intermediate pyroclastic flow...................................... 26
Stratiform.................................................................... 84 Intravolcanic iron formations ...................................... 45
Model...................................................................... 79 Iron-enrichment cycles .............................................. 111
Types .......................................................................... 75 Iron enrichment trend ................................................. 107
Gold occurrences, categories ..................................... 58 Iron formation ...................................................... 78,84,85
Gold potential area, shear zones .......................... 58,60 Exhalative .................................................................. 78
Gold showings............................................................... 66 Intravolcanic .............................................................. 45
Golden Arrow lode deposit.......................................... 84 Lithologic correlation methods ............................... 63
Golden Arrow Mine ....................................................... 83 Michipicoten .................................................... 63,65,66
Sedimentary............................................................... 78
Goldlund Deposit .......................................................... 58 Source ........................................................................ 78
Grain size classification .............................................. 12 Iron ore ...................................................................... 74,77
Granulometric classification: Iron ranges:
Polymodal volcanic pyroclastic rocks ................... 14 Helen .......................................................................... 66
Pyroclastic deposits ................................................. 14 Josephine-Bartlett................................................ 63,65
Pyroclastic rocks ...................................................... 13 Kathleen ..................................................................... 54
Graphic Lake ................................................................. 53 Lucy ....................................................................... 63,65
Greenschist facies, field criteria ................................ 25 Ruth............................................................................. 65
Ground surge................................................................. 19 Island systems ................................................................. 8
Growth faults ................................................................. 80 Isochemical contour plots ......................................... 129
Guatemala...................................................................... 35 "Expected" value.................................................... 129
Gullrock Lake ................................................................ 91 "Residual" value..................................................... 129

Halliday Dome .......................................................... 77,82 Jensen cation plots ...................................................... 54


Harker Township........................................................... 84 Josephine-Bartlett iron range................................. 63,65
Harper, G........................................................................ 68 Jubilee Stock ....................................................... 63,66,68
Hart Deposit................................................................... 81 Kakagi Lake......................................................... 51,55,58
Hawaiian eruption ............................................................ 6 Kambalda Deposit ........................................................ 82
Hawk Lake granitic complex, age dating.................. 66 Kamiskotia Gabbroic Complex ................................... 82
Heather Lake ....................................................... 32,33,34 Kathleen iron range ...................................................... 65
Heazlewoodite............................................................... 82 Katimiagamak Lake volcanics .................................... 55
Helen iron formation................................................ 45,66 Kenogamissi Batholith ................................................. 72
Helen iron range, age dating ...................................... 66 Kenora .......................................................................... 114
Hemlo............................................................................ 115 Kerr Addison Mine ........................................................ 79
Hemlo deposits ............................................................. 80

178
VOLCANOLOGY AND MINERAL DEPOSITS

"Key Tuffite".................................................................. 43 Mafic breccia................................................................. 65


Kidd Creek Rhyoiites............................................... 72,75 Mafic flows .................................................................... 31
Age dating............................................................. 72,82 Subaqueous, model.................................................. 31
Kinojevis Group........................................................ 71,78 Mafic shield volcano, products .................................. 28
Kirkland Lake ................................... 71,77,80,81-85,111 Magma chambers, chemically zoned........................ 15
Kirkland Lake "Main Break" zone......................... 83,84 Magma clan .......................................................... 106,116
Kirkland Lake area ....................................................... 44 Magma clan units........................................................ 108
Kirkland Lake Camp ..................................................... 84 Magmatic eruptions ......................................................... 5
Kirkland Lake-Cadillac Fault Zone ............................ 70 Magmatic fluid model................................................... 81
Kirkland Lake-Larder Lake Fault Zone 72,79-81,83-85 Magmatism, resurgent................................................ 119
Kishquabik Lake Stock ........................................... 35,60 Magnesian tholeiitic flows (MTF) .......................... 54,55
Knee Lake area............................................................. 43 Magnesite..................................................... 74,83-85,147
Komatiite class ............................................................ 107 Location...................................................................... 75
Komatiitic unit.............................................................. 107 Magnetite........................................................................ 82
Koza, H. .......................................................................... 68 Magnetite-bearing flows .............................................. 65
Magpie River.................................................................. 63
Lahar............................................................................... 12 Major cycles ................................................................ 106
Coarse-grained deposits comparison ................... 12 Major element analyses............................................... 54
Origin .......................................................................... 12
Major ring-fracture volcanism ................................... 118
Lake Abitibi.................................................... 75,77,83,85
Malartic Group ..................................................... 71,81,82
Lake Abitibi Batholith .............................................. 72,83
Manitoba....................................................................... 110
Lake of the Woods ............................................. 37,50,58
Preliminary stratigraphic synthesis........................ 52 Mantle diapir............................................................. 70,72
Stratigraphy ............................................................... 51 Mantle-derived tholeiitic liquid ................................. 112
Lake St. Joseph............................................................. 99 Mapping progress ......................................................... 62
Laminated algal mats ................................................... 45 Marbidge Deposit.......................................................... 81
Lamotte Township......................................................... 81 Markov Chain Analysis ................................................ 44
Lamprophyre.................................................................. 83 Massive copper-zinc-lead sulphide
Dikes........................................................................... 63 deposits, model............................................................. 75
Langmuir Deposit.......................................................... 81 Massive sulphides, "stacked"
Lapilli-tuff.................................................................. 13,33 configuration.................................................................. 77
Larder Lake............................................................... 79,80 Massive-sulphide deposits..................................... 35-37
Larder Lake Camp ........................................................ 84 Massive-sulphide lens ................................................. 36
Larder Lake Group ................................... 71,78,79,81-83 Matachewan ........................................................ 82,83,85
Larder Lake Mining Camp ........................................... 81 Matheson...................................................... 79,83,85,126
Late felsic intrusions .................................................... 84 Mats, laminated algal................................................... 45
Lateral facies variation ................................................ 30 Mattagami area ............................................................. 43
Lava domes ................................................................... 11 Maybrun Mine.............................................................. 114
Lead-quartz vein ........................................................... 66 McKenzie Island .................................................. 91,93,96
Lead-uranium zircon dating programs ...................... 58 McWalters Deposit........................................................ 81
Lesser Antilles volcanic arc........................................ 23 Meen-Dempster Lakes Belt ......................................... 99
Lithic block deposit...................................................... 19 Megacauldron..................................... 70,72,74,77,80,82
Model.......................................................................... 84
Lithogeochemical information,
interpretation................................................................ 161 Melting, partial............................................................... 77
Sediments .................................................................. 84
Lithogeochemistry, sample sources ........................ 128
Metamorphism, effect on volcanic rocks.................. 21
Lithologic correlation methods:
Iron formation ............................................................ 63 Metavolcanic sequences ............................................. 51
Rock composition ..................................................... 63 Michipicoten iron formation .............................. 63,65,66
Lobstick Bay .................................................................. 35 Midlothian Township .................................................... 83
Lode gold deposits ............................................. 81,84,85 "Mill-rock"..................................................................... 4,5
Long Bay ........................................................................ 35 Millenbach deposit, geology ....................................... 36
Long Bay-Lobstick Bay area .................................. 54,58 Millenbach Mine............................................................ 35
Lower Formation ................................................. 79,81,82 Millenbach volcano ...................................................... 35
Lower Supergroups.................................................. 75,83 Millerite........................................................................... 82
Lower Tisdale Group .................................................... 71 Miminiska Lake ............................................................. 99
Lucy iron range ........................................................ 63,65 Mineral deposits............................................................ 58

Madsen area............................................................. 94-96

179
VOLCANOLOGY AND MINERAL DEPOSITS

Mineral exploration: "Ovoids"................................................................ 127,128


Applications ............................................................... 44 Owl Creek ...................................................................... 79
Volcanic facies ......................................................... 37 Oxford Lake ................................................................. 110
Mineral potential: Oxidation state indicator............................................ 147
Evaluation ................................................................ 119
Wawa area ................................................................. 68 Pacaud Tuffs ....................................................... 72,78,83
Mineralization: Age dating.................................................................. 72
Abitibi Subprovince .................................................. 84 Pahoehoe flows ............................................................... 9
Asbestos .................................................................... 47
Barium-gold ............................................................. 115 Pamour ........................................................................... 79
Base-metal............................................................ 74,85 Partial melting................................................................ 77
Cadmium .................................................................... 75 Penhorwood Township................................................. 83
Chalcopyrite ....................................................... 68,126 Pentlandite ..................................................................... 82
Chlorite ..................................................................... 126 Peridotitic-gabbro sills ................................................. 83
Copper................................................................. 66,119
Favourable suites ..................................................... 84 Perrigo Lake Intrusion .................................................. 99
Galena ...................................................................... 125 Phinney-Dash Lakes area ......................................... 115
Gold .......................................................... 74,75,79,125 Phreatic breccias .......................................................... 24
Iron ore ....................................................................... 74 Phreatic eruption.......................................................... 5,6
Magnesite................................................................... 74 Phreatomagmatic (Surtseyan) eruptions .................. 5,6
Nickel..................................................................... 74,82
Pyrite..................................... 68,112,113,125,126,128 Physical volcanology .................................................. 4,5
Pyrrhotite .................................................................. 113 Conceptual sense ........................................................ 4
Silver.................................................................... 75,125 Empirical sense............................................................ 4
Sphalerite .......................................................... 113,125 Pickle Lake .................................................................... 99
Talc ............................................................................. 74 Pillow lavas ................................................................. 8,11
Tin ............................................................................... 75 Pipestone Bay..................................................... 91,93-95
Types, Western part of Abitibi Belt ........................ 70 Pipestone Bay-St. Paul Bay Deformation
Zinc ...................................................................... 66,119 Zone................................................................................ 95
Mini-cycles.............................................................. 91,106 Pipestone-Cameron Fault ............................ 52,53,58,60
Minor cycles ................................................................ 106 Platinum values ............................................................. 66
Mist Inlet.................................................................... 35,54 Plinian eruption ................................. 6,113,115,116,118
Molecular proportions ................................................ 147 Plots .............................................................................. 155
Mud flow......................................................................... 12 Point Bay group ........................................................ 53,54
Munro Township....................................................... 81,83 Polycyclic volcanism............................................. 99,100
Muscovite-bearing metagreywacke ........................... 25 Polymodal volcanic pyroclastic rocks:
Musquash Township .................................................... 63 Granulometric classification ................................... 14
Pontiac Group ................................................................ 78
N-dimensioned space ................................................ 155
Populus volcanics ............................................... 52,53,60
Near tuffs ....................................................................... 74
Porcupine Group ...................................................... 78,82
Near vent flows ............................................................. 74
Porcupine-Destor Break ............................................... 45
Negative factor values ............................................... 152
Porphyritic felsic flows ................................................ 25
New Keloro Mine........................................................... 83
Porphyry, vent facies ................................................... 35
Nickel.................................................................... 74,82,94
Deposits ..................................................................... 84 Post Narrows Deformation Zone ................................ 97
Redstone .............................................................. 112 Prehnite-pumpellyite facies ...................................... 127
Nickel sulphide ........................................................ 66,85 Preresurgence volcanism and
Hydrothermal emplacement.................................... 82 sedimentation .............................................................. 118
Immiscible liquid model........................................... 82 Problems of interpretation ...................................... 42,43
Sulphurization model ............................................... 82 Products:
Volcanic exhalative model...................................... 82 Central vent composite volcano............................. 28
Noranda................................................................. 113,119 Mafic shield volcano................................................ 28
Noranda area................................................................. 35 Prograding volcano ...................................................... 53
Noranda Mining Camp ................................................. 75 Proterozoic succession.............................................. 111
Noranda-Rouyn area .................................................... 34 Proximal facies......................................................... 24,26
Normetal Mine ............................................................... 75 Proximal tuffs ................................................................ 74
North Spirit Lake Belt ................................................... 99 Proximal vent facies rocks.......................................... 78
Proximal vent flows ...................................................... 74
Ohanapecosh Formation ............................................. 34 Proximal volcanic environment ............................... 4,33
Oldest cycle................................................................... 66 Pumice ............................................................................ 19
Orchan orebody ............................................................ 43 Pyrite ............................... 65,68,82,112,113,125,126,128
Ore zones, structure ..................................................... 98

180
VOLCANOL OG Y AND MINERAL DEPOSITS

Pyroclast............................................................................ 5 Rhyolites......................................................................... 94
Pyroclastic breccia ............................................. 13,32,33 Endogeneous dome ............................................... 113
Formation mechanism.............................................. 19 Magma...................................................................... 118
Photo........................................................................... 22 Ross lode deposit......................................................... 84
Pyroclastic deposits: Ross Mine.................................................................. 83,84
Explosive ....................................................................... 5 Round Lake Batholith ......................................... 72,83,84
Fall ......................................................................... 14,17 Rouyn-Noranda, city ..................................................... 35
Granulometric classification ................................... 14
Types ..................................................................... 14,16 Ruth iron range .............................................................. 65
Pyroclastic flows: Sample point "clouds" or groups ............................. 155
Deposits ................................................................ 14,17
Felsic .......................................................................... 26 Sample sources, lithogeochemistry......................... 128
Intermediate............................................................... 26 Sampling problems ..................................................... 128
Types ..................................................................... 18,19 Santiaquito ..................................................................... 35
Subaqueous ............................................................... 30 Saussurite .................................................................... 127
Pyroclastic rocks................................................... 5,11,54 Savant Lake ......................................................... 50,51,58
Distal deposited ........................................................ 35 Savant Lake-Crow Lake area...................................... 43
Granulometric classification ................................... 13
Polymodal volcanic .................................................. 14 Scoria.............................................................................. 19
Skead Group......................................................... 32,37 Seafloor model.............................................................. 81
Subdivision ................................................................ 20 Seagrave Lake .............................................................. 99
Unimodal.................................................................... 13 Second cycle ................................................................. 66
Well sorted ................................................................. 13 Second factor.............................................................. 155
Pyroclastic surge deposits ..................................... 14,17 Sedimentary models of iron formation ...................... 78
Types .......................................................................... 19
Sediments, partial melting ........................................... 84
Pyroclastic-epiclastic rocks, terms ............................ 15
Selco Inc......................................................................... 91
Pyrrhotite ................................................................. 82,113
Sericite.......................................................................... 127
Quartz, blue ................................................................... 35 Setting Net Lake................................................... 113,119
Quartz lenses ................................................................ 68 Shaw Dome.......................................................... 77,78,82
Quartz veins................................................................... 80 Shebandowan.............................................................. 110
Lead ............................................................................ 66 Sherman Mine ............................................................. 116
Quartz-carbonate shear zone ..................................... 60 Shield volcano............................................................... 21
Quartz-carbonate veins ............................................... 80 Facies variation......................................................... 27
Quartz-diorite sill........................................................... 36 Mafic, products ......................................................... 28
Quartz-feldspar porphyry ....................................... 33-36 Siderite ............................................................ 65,127,147
Quebec ...................................................................... 35,81 Silicification ................................................................. 127
Quetico Subprovince .................................................... 50 Sill:
Peridotitic-gabbro ..................................................... 83
Radiometric age determination methods .................. 45 Quartz-diorite............................................................. 36
Radiometric ages, Red Lake Belt ............................... 91 Silver.................................................................. 66,75,125
Assay .......................................................................... 66
Radiometric dating........................................................ 55
Silver-quartz vein .......................................................... 66
Rare earth element data ............................................ 107
Si02 independent variable......................................... 147
Red Lake .................... 53,91,94,96,97,107,108,112,114
Sioux Lookout................................................................ 58
Red Lake anticlinorium ........................................... 95,96
Site selection criteria.................................................. 129
Red Lake area, stratigraphic development............. 100
Skead Group ............................................. 30,34,77,78,83
Red Lake Belt ................................... 89,90,91,93,96-100 Pyroclastic rocks ................................................. 32,37
Radiometric ages ...................................................... 91
Skead Township............................................................ 77
Red Lake Camp............................................................. 97
Snake Bay formation .......................................... 52,55,60
Redeposited fragmental rocks .................................... 11
Snake Bay formation-Aulneau Batholith
Redstone nickel deposit ............................................ 112 contact............................................................................ 53
Reed Narrows ................................................................ 58 Snake Bay volcanics ............................................... 52,54
Regina Bay..................................................................... 58 Solfataric, terminal and hot-spring activity ............. 118
Regina Bay Stock .......................................................... 60 Sothman Deposit........................................................... 81
Regina Mine ................................................................... 60 South Bay ................................................................ 90,116
Regional correlation, volcanic stratigraphy .............. 72 South Bay Mine ............................................................. 97
Relationship between stratrigraphy and South Bay-type copper-zinc deposits........................ 97
mineral deposits............................................................ 69
Southern sequence, age dating.................................. 96
Resurgent doming ....................................................... 118
Spatial position ..................................................... 155,161
Resurgent magmatism................................................ 119

181
VOLCANOLOGY AND MINERAL DEPOSITS

Spatially mapped abundance ................................... 129 Pentlandite ................................................................. 82


Sphalerite ........................................................ 82,113,125 Pyrite........................................................................... 82
Spherulite .......................................................................... 9 Pyrrhotite.................................................................... 82
Sphalerite................................................................... 82
Spiked peaks ............................................................... 129 Violarite ...................................................................... 82
St. Anthony Mine........................................................... 58 Sunshine Lake............................................................. 111
St. Vincents .................................................................... 43 Super cycles ................................................. 106,107,111
Stage II.......................................................................... 118 Supergroups................................................................... 71
Stage IV ........................................................................ 118 Superior Province.................................... 81,100,109,111
Steep Rock Mines Ltd................................................... 58 Surface II Graphics Systems..................................... 129
Stock, Regina Bay......................................................... 60 Surge:
Stoughton-Roquemaure Group.......................... 71,78,82 Ash cloud ................................................................... 19
Stratiform gold: Base............................................................................ 19
Deposits ................................................................ 78,80 Ground........................................................................ 19
Mineralization ............................................................ 84 Surtseyan eruptions......................................................... 5
Model...................................................................... 79 Synclinorium ..................................................... 71,91,126
Stratigraphic contact, significance............................. 74
Stratigraphic hiatuses ................................................ 113 Talc ....................................................................... 74,84,85
Stratigraphic position ................................................. 119 Location...................................................................... 75
Stratigraphic scheme, evolution ................................. 89 Tectonostratigraphic model.................................... 90,91
Stratigraphy and mineral deposit, Tephrochronology......................................................... 43
relationship ............................................................... 69,77 Terminal solfataric and hot-spring activity ............. 118
Stromatolites .................................................................. 91 Texmont Deposit........................................................... 81
Archean ...................................................................... 44 Thickness:
Stromatolitic carbonate ................................................ 91 Upper Supergroup..................................................... 72
Age dating.................................................................. 93 Wabewawa-Catherine-Skead
Stromatolitic horizons, potential correlation Supergroup ................................................................ 72
tools ................................................................................ 45 Thio complex ............................................................... 112
Stromatolitic marble...................................................... 91 Tholeiitic to calc-alkalic flows and
Strombolian eruption ....................................................... 6 pyroclastic rocks........................................................... 54
Studemeister, P. ............................................................ 68 Tholeiitic unit............................................................... 107
Sturgeon Lake ............................................................... 58 Thunder Bay ................................................................ 110
Base-metal deposits................................................. 46 Timiskaming Group.......................................... 44,81,110
Styles of Archean cyclical volcanism ..................... 108 Timmins ................................ 71,72,77,78,80-85,112,114
Sub-Plinian eruption ........................................................ 6 Timmins Mining Camp........................................ 79,81,84
Subaqueous mafic flows, model................................ 31 Tin ................................................................................... 75
Subaqueous pyroclastic flows: Tisdale Group ................................................ 74,79,81-83
Discussion ................................................................. 30 Lower.......................................................................... 71
Model.......................................................................... 30 Trace elements..................................................... 155,161
Subaqueous transport.................................................. 29 Tuff............................................................................. 13,14
Subcycle......................................................................... 65 Lapilli ..................................................................... 13,33
Subgreenschist facies ................................................. 71 Near ............................................................................ 74
Submarine eruption ...................................................... 29 Pacaud ............................................................. 72,78,83
Age dating ............................................................. 72
Submarine hydrothermal systems ............................. 36 Proximal...................................................................... 74
Sulphide minerals ......................................................... 82 Tuff-breccia ................................................................... 33
Chalcopyrite .............................................................. 82
Chromite..................................................................... 82 Tuff-chemical sediment unit..................................... 107
Heazlewoodite........................................................... 82 Tuffite ............................................................................. 43
Magnetite ................................................................... 82 Tumescence ................................................................ 117
Massive sulphides: Types of Archean cyclical volcanism ..................... 108
Copper-zinc-lead deposits .................................. 75 Types of volcanoes ...................................................... 25
Deposits ............................................................ 35-37
Lens ........................................................................ 46 Uchi Subprovince ............................... 89,91,99,100,110
"Stacked" configuration ...................................... 77
Millerite....................................................................... 82 Uchi-Confederation Lakes area ................. 90,91,97,98
Nickel..................................................................... 66,85 Stratigraphic development.................................... 100
Hydrothermal emplacement................................ 82 Uchi-Confederation Lakes Belt................. 89,91,97,100
Immiscible liquid model....................................... 82 Upper Formation ........................................................... 78
Sulphurization model ........................................... 82 Age dating.................................................................. 82
Volcanic exhalative model.................................. 82 Upper QFP ................................................................. 35,26

182
VOLCANOLOGY AND MINERAL DEPOSITS

Upper Supergroup .................................... 71,75,79,82-84 Volcanogenic massive-sulphide deposits:


Thickness................................................................... 72 Exploration criteria.................................................... 37
Uranium-lead zircon dating programs ....................... 58 Occurrences .............................................................. 36
Vulcanian eruption........................................................... 6
Valles caldera ............................................................. 117
Varioles ............................................................................. 9 Wabasee Group ............................................................ 43
Horizons ..................................................................... 43 Wabewawa Group.................................................... 78,83
Lavas ............................................................................. 9 Wabewawa-Catherine-Skead Supergroup ........... 71,84
Origin ............................................................................. 9 Thickness................................................................... 72
Vein: Wabigoon Fault............................................................. 58
Lead-quartz................................................................ 66 Wabigoon Subprovince...................... 34,50,51,108-111
Silver-quartz............................................................... 66
Warclub group ..................................................... 34,35,53
Vent facies ................................................................ 23,26 Rock types, stratigraphic details ............................ 53
Porphyry ..................................................................... 35 Sediments .................................................................. 52
Rocks .......................................................................... 35
Warrawoona Group....................................................... 45
Vesicles ..................................................................... 9,126
Water depth .................................................................. 9 Watabeag Batholith ...................................................... 84
Violarite .......................................................................... 82 Watson Lake Group ...................................................... 43
Volcanic activity, age dating....................................... 99 Wawa area ..................................................... 45,63,66,68
Mineral potential ....................................................... 68
Volcanic breccia: Structure ..................................................................... 63
Alloclastic .................................................................. 13
Autoclastic ................................................................. 13 Wawa Greenstone Belt................................................. 78
Epiclastic.................................................................... 13 Wawa Lake .................................................................... 63
Pyroclastic ................................................................. 13 Wawa Subprovince..................................................... 110
Types .......................................................................... 13 Wawa supracrustal belt............................................... 62
Volcanic centre ...................................................... 63,127 Wawa supracrustal sequence, cycles ....................... 62
Volcanic cycles ................................... 63,72,90,105,119 Western Abitibi Subprovince, evolution .................... 72
Volcanic domes .......................................................... 118 Western Australia............................................. 45,82,114
Volcanic environment ................................................ 127 Woman Lake............................................................. 91,93
Volcanic facies ............................................................. 54
Analysis, Archean..................................................... 32 Yellow Girl Bay.............................................................. 53
Mineral exploration ................................................... 37 Yellow Lake ................................................................... 53
Regimes, recognition ................................................... 4 Yoke Lake ............................................................. 110,111
Volcanic fragmental rocks, classification............ 11,13 Young Davidson Mine .................................................. 83
Volcanic products ............................................................ 6 Yttrium ....................................................................... 94,96
Volcanic rocks.................................................................. 5
Volcano evolution, complexities............................... 116 Zeolite facies............................................................... 127
Volcanoes, types .......................................................... 25 Zinc .................................................................. 66,118,119
Volcanogenic deposits................................................. 82 Zircon.............................................................................. 94
Uranium-lead dating program ................................. 58
Zirconium .................................................................. 94,96

183
calcite
land quartz!
•calcite!

jcarbonate-rich(!
groundmass
D
D

Anda mungkin juga menyukai